ST 133-67-1967 Chevrolet Chassis Service Manual 10 To 60 Truck
ST 133-67-1967 Chevrolet Chassis Service Manual 10 To 60 Truck
CHASSIS
a -« n
*V3»
SECTION 0
GENERAL INFORMATION
AND LUBRICATION
INDEX
Page Page
Series and Model Identification..................... ................. o -l Manual Transm ission...................................................... 0-6
Unit and Serial Number L o c a t io n s ................................. 0-2 Towing ........................................................................... 0-6
G.V.W. Serial Number Plate .................................... 0-2 Push Starts - Trucks equipped with automatic
Engine N u m b e r ............................................................... 0-2 tra n s m is s io n ............................................................... 0-6
Service Parts .Identification P l a t e ................................. 0-4 Lifting Chevy Van with H o is t .......................................... 0-6
Keys and L o c k s ............ .................................................. 0-4 Lifting with Auto Jack ................................................ .. 0-6
Pushing, Towing, and L if t in g .......................................... 0-6 Load Capacity C h a rt................................................... 0-6
GENERAL INFORMATION
The 1967 Truck model line up consists of 474 models on the left door hinge pillar on Conventional and L.D.F.C.
on 37 wheelbases, an increase of 107 more models and 2 models, on the upper left hand side of dash panel on
more wheelbases. cowl models, and on the steering column on Forward
A lettered prefix and 5-digit basic series numbering Control models. On Tilt cab models (fig. 2) the serial
system is introduced for 1967 Truck model identification. number and G.V.W. plates are located on the left door
A new combination G.V.W. and serial number plate is hinge pillar.
used on all models (fig. 1) except Tilt Cab and is located
CHEVROLET
M A X IM U M G V W RATING
0^ ---------------------
1
VEHICLE o
1 w
IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
1 C S 107047P10 0 0 ^ 5 1
D PI I
F ig . 4 - Rear A x le (Except H a lf Ton) Fig . 5 - 2-Speed A x le Serial Number Fig. 6 - Tandem A x le , Forward U nit -
- Forward Upper Surface o f C arrier Unit and Assembly Numbers Stamped
on Left Side of C arrier
GENERAL INFORMATION 0-3
Fig . 7 - Tandem A x le , Rear U n it - Unit Fig . 8 - 3-Speed Transmission U nit Fig. 9 - 4 -Speed Transmission Unit
and Assembly Numbers Stamped on Number Located on Lower Left Side Number Stamped on Rear of Case,
Upper Portion o f C arrier o f Case A d jacen t to Rear o f Cover Above Output
Fig . 10 - N e w Process 5-Speed Unit Fig . 11 - 5 -Speed C lark Transmission F ig . 12 - 4-Speed A u x ilia ry Transmission
Number Stamped on Rear Face of Case Unit Number Stamped on Left Rear Unit Number
to Left of Drain Plug, Spicer 3000 Series o f C ase, N e a r P . T . O . Plate
Above Plug, Spicer 5000 Series on
N am eplate Left Side of Case at Rear
IfwAT'C
tuffBO
F ig . 13 - A lliso n Transmission Part Fig. 14- Powerglide Transmission U nit Fig . 15 - The Turbo H yd ra-M atic
Number and Production Date on Tag Number Located on Right Rear Transmission Serial Number is Located
Left Side of Case V e rtic a l Surface of O il Pan on the Light Blue Plate on the Right
Side of the Transmission
GENERAL INFORMATION 0-4
Fig . 16 - 6 -C ylin d er Engine Unit Fig. 17 - 8-C ylin d er Engine Unit F ig . 18 - Diesel Engine (Four C y c le )
Number Located on Pad at Right Number Located on Pad at Front, Serial Number
Hand Side o f C y lin d e r Block at Right Hand Side of C ylin d er Block
Rear of Distributor
Fig . 19 - Diesel Engine Serial Number Fig. 20 - Delecotron Unit Serial Number Fig . 21 - Battery Code Number
6-C ylind er Forward of Right C y lin d e r Located on C e ll C over Top of Battery
Head, 3, 4 -C ylin d er Rear
Right of C y lin d e r Head
The Chevrolet Truck Service Parts Identification Plate REFER TO THIS INFORMATION WHEN ORDERING
(fig. 23) is provided on all Truck models. On most series PARTS.
it will be located on the inside of the glove box door, on P
series it will be located on an inner body panel. The KEYS AND LOCKS
plate lists the vehicle serial number, paint information Two keys (hexagonal head) are provided with each ve
and all Production options or Special Equipment on the hicle. The keys operate the ignition switch and door
vehicle when it was shipped from the factory. ALWAYS locks.
GENERAL INFORMATION 0-5
Lock cylinders are furnished for service uncoded, this 1. Lay the key on the diagram (fig. 25) with bottom of
necessitates the coding of these replacement lock cyl key flush with edge of the drawing, head and point
inders. carefully lined up.
The side bar type lock (fig. 24) is used for the ignition 2. Read the code in numbers 12345 from the head of key
and doors. To protect owners, truck lock manufacturers to the end from positions 1 to 6 inclusive. As each
stamp the lock numbers on the lock core, shaft, etc., depth is determined write that number in the blank
where they will not show until lock is removed. space provided above the position numbers (1-2-3-4-
5-6).
3. With key properly lined up on diagram, all cuts that
show in the first section are to be marked " 1 ".
TUMBLERS
4. Cuts that fall in the first black section, mark "2”.
5. Cuts that fall in the first white section, mark "3".
o) C3 6 . Cuts that fall in second black section, mark "4".
7. Cuts that fall in the second white section, mark "5".
(prvvvvvj)
After the numbers have been determined and written
SPRING RETAINER
above the cutting positions the lock cylinder should be
assembled as follows.
Fig. 24 - Side Bar Lock
Lock Cylinder Assembly—Refer to Figure 26
In addition, when a lock cylinder requires replacement
the lock code number may be obtained either from the 1. Hold cylinder with head of cylinder away and starting
at the head of the cylinder, insert the tumblers in
key, if available, or from old lock cylinder which is being
their proper slots in the order called for by the
replaced.
code, ribbed side toward you and long point down.
Once the code number of the lock is obtained look up
2. After all tumblers are in place, check for correct
this number in a key cutting book.
ness with the code. Then press tumblers down with
All side bar locks furnished to the field by the Parts
one finger.
Department are uncoded, that is, they are furnished with
3. Insert one tumbler spring in the space provided
out tumblers, springs or spring retainers, these parts
above each tumbler.
are serviced separately. The tumblers come in five dif
ferent depths, indicated by numbers. CAUTION: If the springs are tangled, do not
The side bar locks have six tumbler positions, and in pull them apart—unscrew them.
looking up the cutting code, the following may be used as
an example. After key code number is determined, either
from key or from number stamped on lock cylinder refer
to your code book and record the key cutting information
as follows:
Key of Lock Key Cutting
Code Number Code Numerical
0V11 545431
Cutting or Tumbler 123456
position from head
of lock
NOTE: Key blanks used for ignition and door
locks are stamped with an "A".
The number that is written above the cutting or tumbler
position indicates each different tumbler which is to be
dropped into each tumbler slot of the lock.
In cases where a code book is not available, the dia
gram shown on Figure 25 may be used to determine the
tumblers required to assemble an uncoded lock cylinder.
4. Reverse the lock cylinders so that the head of the vehicle is to be towed at speeds above 30 MPH.
cylinder is now toward you. Insert the spring re Both manual and automatic transmissions should be ^
tainer so that one of its six prongs enters into each towed in neutral only, with parking brakes fully released.
of the springs and the two large end prongs slide When towing a vehicle on its front wheels only, the
into the slots at either end of the cylinder. P ress steering wheel should be secured to maintain a straight
the retainer down with one finger. forward position.
5. To check, insert proper key and if tumblers are
installed properly the side bar will be allowed to Push Starts—Trucks Equipped with
drop down. If bar does not drop down, remove the Automatic Transmission
key, spring retainer, springs and tumblers and re
assemble correctly. Do not attempt to start the engine by pushing the truck.
Should the battery become discharged, it will be neces
6 . If after checking it is found that the lock is as
sembled properly, remove key and place cylinder in sary to use an auxiliary battery with jumper cables to
a vise using leather or wood on each side to prevent start the engine.
damage to the cylinder.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to electrical
7. Stake the retainer securely in place by staking the
system never connect booster batteries in ex"
cylinder metal over both edges of the retainer ends
cess of 1 2 volts and connect positive to positive
using a suitable staking tool at right angles to the
and negative to negative.
top of the retainer and from the cast metal of the
cylinder over the retainer at each corner.
Lifting Van With Hoist
PUSHING, TOWING, AND LIFTING Many dealer service facilities and service stations are
equipped with a type of automotive hoist which bears upon
NOTE: Towing to start is not recommended some part of the front and rear axles in order to lift the
due to the possibility of the disabled truck ac vehicle. In Figure 27 the shaded portions indicate areas
celerating into the tow vehicle. recommended for hoist contact.
MANUAL
GENERAL INFORMATION 0-7
T IR E S A N D E Q U IP M E N T 1
W H EEL FRONT FRONT REAR REAR R E C O M M E N D E D T IR E S M IN IM U M M A N D A T O R Y E Q U IP M E N T F O R
MODEL BASE GVW GCW AXLE S P R IN G S AXLE S P R IN G S FRONT REAR G V W R A T IN G
10500* 7. 0 0 -2 0 -8 7. 0 0 -2 0 - 8D
12000 ... 4000 4000 11000 11000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 D
125 14000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 - 2 0 - 8D R P O J70 P o w e r b r a k e E q u ip m en t
CS 40 137 R P O Z71 r e q u ir e s : R P O F47 F r o n t A x le , R P O F60
15000**
149 15000 7 .5 0 - 2 0 - 8 7. 5 0 -2 0 -1 0 D F r o n t S p rin g s , R P O H07 R e a r A x le in clu d in g
CE 40 167 16000 § 15,000 lb R e a r S p rin g s , R P O J70 P o w e r B ra k e
5000 6000 13500
157 E qu ip m en t
P S 40 175 R P O Z85 r e q u ir e s R P O F47 F ro n t A x le , R P O F60
18000** 17500 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 2 D F r o n t S p rin g s , R P O H07 R e a r A x le , R P O G55
R e a r S p rin gs. R P O J70 P o w e r B ra k e E qu ip m en t
10500* 7. 0 0 -2 0 -8 7. 0 0 -2 0 - 8D
97 12000 11000 11000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 -2 0 - 8D
TS 40 109 14000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 -2 0 - 8D R P O J70 P o w e r B ra k e E qu ip m en t
133 R P O Z71 r e q u ir e s : R P O H07 R e a r A x le
15000**
T E 40 145 15000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 -2 0 - 10D In clu d in g 15000 lb. R e a r S p rin g s, R P O J70
16000§ ... 5000 6000
175 13500 P o w e r B r a k e E qu ip m en t
R P O Z85 r e q u ir e s : R P O H07 R e a r A x le ,
18000** 17500 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 12D R P O G55 R e a r S p rin gs
R P O J70 P o w e r B ra k e E q u ip m en t
T IR E S A N D E Q U IP M E N T S
W H EEL FRO NT FRONT REAR REAR R E C O M M E N D E D T IR E S M IN IM U M M A N D A T O R Y E Q U IP M E N T F O R
MODEL BASE GVW GCW AXLE S P R IN G S AXLE S P R IN G S FRO NT REAR G V W R A T IN G
10500* 4500 4000 7. 0 0 -2 0 -8 7. 0 0 - 2 0 - 8D
11C00 11000 R P O F47 F r o n t A x le and
14000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 50 -2 0 - 8D
R P O F60 F ro n t S p rin gs
15000** R P O F47 F r o n t A x le , R P O F60 F ro n t S p rin gs,
15000 7 .5 0 -2 0 -1 0 7. 5 0 -2 0 -1 0 R P O H07 R e a r A x le in clu d in g 15000 lb. R e a r
SS 40 16000§
149 ---- 5500 6000 S p rin g s R P O J70 P o w e r B r a k e E qu ip m en t
13500 R P O Z85 r e q u ir e s
18000** 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 12D R P O F47 F r o n t A x le , R P O F60 F ro n t S p rin gs,
17500 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 12
R P O H07 R e a r A x le , R P O G55 R e a r S p rin gs;
R P O J70 P o w e r B r a k e E qu ip m en t
1 5 0 0 0 **
15000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 - 2 0 - 8D
16000* 5000 6000
CS 50 125 17000 32000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
R P O G55 R e a r S p rin g s
137 19500 § (C S )
149 R P O Z86 r e q u ir e s
15000
167 R P O F4 8 F r o n t A x le in clu d in g 3500 lb
CE 50 189 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 9. 0 0 -2 0 -1 0 D F r o n t S p rin g s , R P O G56 R e a r S p rin g s.
2 2 0 0 0 ** 7000 7000 20800
R P O F03 H e a v y Duty F r a m e .
In ad d itio n to a b o ve eq u ip m en t, m u st o r d e r
51000
R P O L41 366 E n gin e
97 150001^
15000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 50 -2 0 - 8D
TS 50 109 16000*
T E 50
133 17000 _ 7000 7000 15000 17500 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D R P O G55 R e a r S p rin g s
145 19500 §
175 R P O Z86 r e q u ir e s
22 0 0 0 ** 20800 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D
R P O G56 R e a r S p rin g s
M S 50 149 24000* 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 5 0 - 2 0 - 8D
167 30000§
--- 7000 7000 28000 30000
M E 50 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
185
CS 60 19000* 32000 18400 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
125 7000 7000 17000
C E 60 24000 § 20800 9 .0 0 -2 0 -1 0 10. 0 0 -2 0 -1 2 D RPO G56 R e a r S p rin g s
137
149 RPO Z76 r e q u ir e s
CE 60 167 2 7 5 00** 51000 9000 9000 18500 23000 1 0 .0 0 -2 0 -1 2 10. 0 0 -2 0 -1 2 D RPO F43 F r o n t A x le , R P O F9 4 F ro n t S p rin gs
RPO H66 R e a r A x le , R P O G58 R e a r S p rin gs
189
RPO Z50 F r a m e R e in f. R P O L41 366 E n ein e
TS 60 „ 97 19000* 32000 18400 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
7000 7000 17000
T E 60 109 24000 § 20800 9. 0 0 -2 0 -1 0 10. 0 0 -2 0 -1 2 D RPO G56 R e a r S p rin gs
133 RPO Z76 r e q u ir e s
T E 60 145 RPO F43 F r o n t A x le , R P O F 94 F ro n t S p rin gs
27 5 0 0 ** 51000 9000 9000 18500 23000 10. 0 0 -2 0 -1 0 10. 0 0 -2 0 - 12D
175 RPO H66 R e a r A x le , R P O G58 R e a r S p rin g s
RPO Z50 F r a m e R e in f. R P O L41 366 E n ein e
30000* 7000 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
36000§ ... 9000 9 .0 0 -2 0 -1 0 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D R P O F43 F r o n t A x le
9000
149 39 0 0 0 ** 30000 34500 R P O Z82 r e q u ir e s R P O F4 3 F r o n t A x le
M E 60 167 R P O Z78 r e q u ir e s : R P O F4 4 F ro n t A x le
4 1 0 0 0 **
185 ... R P O F96 F ro n t S p rin g s R P O L41 366 E n gin e
11000 11000 1 0 .0 0 -2 0 -1 2 10. 0 0 -2 0 - 12D R P O Z79 r e q u ir e s : R P O F 44 F r o n t A x le
45 0 0 0 ** 34000 39000 R P O F96 F r o n t S p rin g s , R P O H58
34000 lb. B o g ie , in c lu d e s 19500 lb. S p rin gs
R P O L41 366 E n gin e
SS 520 16000* 15000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 50 -2 0 - 8D
189 17000 5500 6000 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10
SE 520 17500 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
R P O G55 R e a r S p rin g s
19500§ 9 .0 0 -2 0 - 10 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D
SS 525
217-1/2 15000 R P O Z86 r e q u ir e s :
SE 525
SS 528 22 0 00** ... 7000 R P O F 48 F r o n t A x le
235 7000 20800 9 .0 0 -2 0 - 10 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D
SE 528 in clu d in g 3500 lb. e a c h F r o n t S p rin gs
R P O G56 R e a r S p rin g s
16000* 15000 7. 5 0 -2 0 -8 7. 50 -2 0 - 8D
SE 531 253-1/2 18000 ... 7000 7000 15000 17500 8. 2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D R P O G55 R e a r S p rin g s
22000 § 20800 9 .0 0 -2 0 -1 0 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D R P O G56 R e a r S p rin g s
SE 600 235 19000* ... 18400 8 .2 5 -2 0 -1 0 8. 2 5 -2 0 - 10D
7000 7000 17000
253-1/2 23000 § 20800 9. 0 0 -2 0 -1 0 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D R P O G56 R e a r S p rin g s
GENERAL INFORMATION 0-9
T IR E S A N D E Q U IP M E N T J
W H EEL FRONT FRONT REAR REAR R E C O M M E N D E D T IR E S M IN IM U M M A N D A T O R Y E Q U IP M E N T F O R
MODEL BASE GVW GCW AXLE S P R IN G S AXLE S P R IN G S FRONT REAR G V W R A T IN G
T IR E S A N D E Q U IP M E N T J
W H EEL FRONT FRO NT REAR REAR R E C O M M E N D E D T IR E S M IN IM U M M A N D A T O R Y E Q U IP M E N T F O R
MODEL BASE GVW GCW AXLE S P R IN G S AXLE S P R IN G S FRO NT REAR G V W R A T IN G
36000* 55000 9. 0 0 -2 0 -1 0 9. 0 0 -2 0 - 10D
55000 9000
43000 §
65000 R P O L 29, 478M E n g in e .
R P O F5 4 F r o n t A x le , in c lu d e s 4500 L b . each
55000 34000 34000 F r o n t S p rin g s , R P O F07 F r a m e R e in fo r c e m e n ts ,
151 on JM 814-817, R P O M 61, M 65 o r M71
45 0 0 0 ** 12000
1 0 .0 0 -2 0 -1 2 10. 0 0 -2 0 - 12D A u x ilia r y T r a n s m is s io n .
169 65000 In A d d itio n to a b o ve e q u ip m en t, m u st o r d e r
JM 80 9000 R P O L 29, 478M E n g in e.
198 R P O G77 R e a r A x le , in c lu d e s 19, 000 lb. each
4 7 000** 65000 9000 R e a r S p rin g s , R P O L 29, 478M E n gin e R P O F07
210 F r a m e R e in fo r c e m e n t s on JM 814-817.
38000 38000 R P O F 54 F r o n t A x le , in clu d es 4500 lb. each
F r o n t S p rin g s , R P O G77 R e a r A x le , in clu d es
4 8 0 0 0 ** 65000 12000 1 0 .0 0 -2 0 -1 2 11. 0 0 -2 0 - 12D 19,000 lb. e a c h R e a r S p rin g s , R P O L 29, 478M
E n g in e , R P O F07 F r a m e R e in fo r c e m e n ts on
JM 814-817.
#- B e c a u s e fro n t a x le lo a d in g on T i l t cab m o d e ls cou ld p o s s ib ly be g r e a t e r than that o f the C o n ven tio n a l m o d e ls , fr o n t end lo a d in g should be
c a lc u la te d to e n s u re that the fr o n t su sp en sion c a p a c ity is not e x c e e d e d . I f lo a d in g e x c e e d s the r a te d c a p a c ity o f the b a s e fro n t su spen sion ,
the o p tio n a l h e a v y -d u ty unit m u st be used.
A v a ila b le on A i r B ra k e ( ’ 13) m o d e ls on ly.
R e in fo r c e m e n ts r e q u ir e d f o r dump and o f f - r o a d a p p lic a tio n on ly.
LUBRICATION
INDEX
Page Page
E n g in e ............................................................ ....................... 0-11 Crankcase Ventilation S y s t e m ....................................... .... 0-13
G a s o l i n e ........................................................................... 0-11 Crankcase B re a th e r................................................... .... 0-14
Crankcase C apacities................................................... 0-12 T ran sm issio n s..................................................................... .... 0-14
Oil Viscosity N u m b e r s .......................................... ..... 0-12 P o w e r g lid e ..................................................................... .... 0-14
Maintaining Crankcase Oil Level ........................ ..... 0-12 Turbo H y d ra-M atic ......................................................... .... 0-14
When to Change Crankcase O i l .............................. ..... 0-12 S y nchrom esh.................................................................. .... 0-14
Crankcase D ilu tio n ................................................ ..... 0-12 Recommended L u b ric a n ts ................................................... .... 0-14
Oil Filter . ............................................................. ..... 0-12 Four-Wheel D r i v e ............................................................... .... 0-15
D is t r ib u t o r .................................................................. 0-12 Wheel Bearings .................................................................. .... 0-15
Fuel F i l t e r ...................................................................0-12 Rear A x l e s ........................................................................... .... o-15
D iesel................................................................................. 0-12 Master C y lin d e r .................................................................. .... 0-15
Oil Q u a l i t y ...................................................................0-12 Full A ir B r a k e s .................................................................. .... 0-15
Oil C h an ge s.................................................................. 0-13 Hydrovac and A ir Over Hydraulic Brakes ........................ .... 0-15
Multi-Viscosity Lubricating Oils ........................ ......0-13 Steering Gear ..................................................................... .... 0-16
Cold Weather O p e r a t io n ....................................... ......0-13 Propeller Shaft Slip Joints ................................................ .... 0-16
Oil F i l t e r ............................................................... ......0-13 Universal J o in t s .................................................................. .... 0-16
A ir Box Drain T u b e s ............................................. ......0-13 Brake and Clutch Pedals ................................................... .... 0-16
Fuel F i l t e r ...................................................................0-13 Speedometer Adapter ......................................................... .... 0-16
Fuel S t r a in e r ................................................................0-13 Parking Brake Linkage ...................................................... .... 0-16
A ir Cleaner ......................................................................0-13 Tachometer - M e c h a n ic a l................................................... .... 0-16
G o v e rn o r............................................................................0-13 Body Lubrication ............................................................... .... 0-16
B a tte ry ...............................................................................0-13 Diesel Oil Specifications...................................................... .... 0-16
Throwout B e a r i n g .............................................................0-13 Lubrication D ia g r a m s ......................................................... .... 0-18
The 1967 Truck engine and chassis recommended periods. Sustained heavy duty and high speed operation
lubrication intervals are outlined in this section. or operation under adverse conditions may require more
The time or mileage intervals are intended as a guide frequent servicing.
for establishing regular maintenance and lubrication
oils. These oils are grouped in accordance with their clogged, remove, clean, and reinstall tubes. Air box
ability to meet the service requirements common to drain tubes should be cleaned at tune-up intervals even
Heavy-Duty engine operation. though clogged condition is not apparent. If engine is
equipped with air box drain tank, drain sediment periodi
Oil Changes cally.
It is recommended that new engines be started with
100 hour oil change periods. For highway vehicles this
FUEL FILTER
corresponds to approximately 3,000 miles and for city-
Drain daily and replace every 12,000 miles.
service vehicles approximately 1,000-2,000 miles. The
drain interval may then be gradually increased, or de
creased following the recommendations of the oil sup
FUEL STRAINER
plier until the most practical oil change period for the The frame mounted fuel strainer assembly, located
particular service has been established. between the fuel pump and fuel tank should be replaced
At each oil change, besides draining engine crankcase, every 1 2 , 0 0 0 miles or oftener if fuel pressure falls below
drain oil filter and oil cooler. An oil cooler, rear drain- recommended minimum (35 psi at operating speed).
cock is for oil drain.
Solvents should not be used as flushing oils in running AIR CLEANER
engines. Dilution of the fresh refill oil supply can occur
which may be detrimental. NOTE: Under prolonged dusty driving condi
tions, it is recommended that these operations
TYPE USAGE be performed more often.
MIL-L-2104A Generally satisfactory for light general Oil Bath Type - Check every 1 2 , 0 0 0 miles (2 , 0 0 0 miles
service with fuels containing less than on Diesel engines). Clean, if necessary, and refill with
(API-DG) 0.5% sulphur. engine oil, SAE 50, when temperature is above freezing
and SAE 20 below freezing.
Supplement 1 All Diesel engines - Normal service
(S-l) Oil Wetted Paper Element - F irst 1 2 , 0 0 0 miles inspect
(API-DM) or test element; if satisfactory, re-use element but re
check every 6,000 miles until replaced. Element must
NOTE: Oils of higher additive levels such as not be washed, oiled, tapped, or cleaned with an air hose.
S-3 (API designation DS) tend to form excessive
ash deposits that could result in engine damage; Oil Wetted Paper Element with
such oils are not recommended for use in
Polyurethane Wrap
Chevrolet Diesel engines.
Every 12,000 miles inspect air cleaner. Remove poly
Multi-Viscosity Lubricating Oils urethane wrap and wash in suitable solvent. Check oil
wetted element and replace if necessary. Check every
Multi-Viscosity lubricating oils may be used to facili 6 , 0 0 0 miles thereafter until element is replaced.
tate starting when prolonged exposure of the engine to
temperature below freezing is unavoidable. Consult your
GOVERNOR
supplier regarding the performance characteristics of
this type of oil and obtain his assurance of adequate lub Replace air filter every 12,000 miles.
rication before subjecting the engine to heavy-duty se r
vice. BATTERY
Cold Weather Operation Every 6,000 miles clean and oil battery terminals and
oil felt washer. Clean top of battery with diluted am
The proper lubricating oil viscosity grade when operat monia or soda solution and flush with clean water. Check
ing at temperatures above 30°F. is SAE 30. It is permis state of charge especially in freezing weather. An under
sible to use a lighter grade of oil in order to facilitate charged battery may freeze and break.
starting as shown in the following table:
THROW OUT BEARING
AMBIENT VISCOSITY
TEMPERATURE GRADE On trucks equipped with a yoke and shaft type release
lever, the release bearing is lubricated by means of a
Above 30 °F SAE 30 hose attached to a grease cup. The grease cup is filled
O
SAE 20-20W
O
CO
O
-*o->
At every oil change the system should be tested for 2. Remove any dirt or gravel from area around indica
proper function and serviced, if necessary. tor in right side of engine compartment. With engine
running at 1 0 0 0 rpm remove indicator from case,
*Under prolonged dusty driving conditions, it is recom wipe clean, reinsert and carefully withdraw again.
mended that these operations be performed more often.
CAUTION: Exercise extreme care to prevent
Crankcase Breather dirt from entering filler tube when checking
fluid level.
At each oil change, crankcase breather should be re
moved and cleaned in suitable solvent. Do not oil ele Add fluid only when level reaches L mark (1 qt. low)
ment. on the indicator.
3. With engine operating at 1000 rpm add sufficient
TRANSMISSIONS "Automatic Transmission Fluid - Type A" or "Type
C" - to bring level to full mark on indicator.
Powerglide Transmission
NOTE: Every 12,000 m iles, it is recommended CAUTION: Fluid level should never go higher
that the Powerglide low band be adjusted as than " F " mark on indicator when fluid is at
specified in Section 7 of this manual. operating temperature. An excessively full
transmission will result in aeration of the fluid
General Motors Automatic Transmission Fluid (Part
The expanding fluid may then be forced out of
numbers 1050568, 69, 70) or equivalent should be used
the filler tube. Sufficient fluid may be lost to
in the Powerglide transmission. If this fluid is not avail
seriously damage the transmission?
able, refill with Automatic Transmission Fluid type "A"
bearing mark AQ-ATF followed by a number and suffix
letter "A". 4. Reinstall indicator and turn the cap 1/4 turn to lock.
NOTE 2: Lubricate with Multi-Purpose gear The bearings should be thoroughly cleaned before re
lubricant meeting requirements of U.S. Ord packing with lubricant.
nance Spec. M IL-L-2105B. The front wheels are equipped with tapered roller
bearings on all trucks except P -20, P-30 that are
The following table shows the proper viscosity "Multi- equipped with ball bearings. Lubricate every 30,000
Purpose” gear lubricant to be used during vehicle opera miles with high melting point wheel bearing lubricant.
tion. Do not mix wheel bearing lubricants.
Outside Temperature Viscosity Lubricant to be Used CAUTION: " Long fibre" or "Viscous" type of
lubricants should not be used on bearings front
Below 10 °F SAE 80 wheel.
Up to 100 °F SAE 90
Above 100 °F REAR AXLES
Consistently SAE 140
Check lubricant level (including the interaxle differ
FOUR WHEEL DRIVE ential) every 6,000 miles. When necessary, refill to level
of filler plug hole using Multi-Purpose Lubricant speci
Most lubrication recommendations and procedures for fied in Note 2.
4 wheel drive equipped trucks remain the same as for Drain the lubricant every 24,000 miles. If the vehicle
corresponding components of conventional drive trucks. is operated in exceptionally heavy work or at continuous
Only the front axle, including the differential and Cardon high speeds, the lubricant should be changed every 1 2 , 0 0 0
joint, the transfer case, which permits power from the miles. It may be necessary to change lubricant more
transmission to either front or rear axles, and associated often if vehicle is used off road in dusty areas.
linkage points and air vents require special procedures.
NOTE: The electric or air-torsion spring shift
Front Axle units should be filled to the level of the filler
plug hole with SAE 10 engine oil every 12,000
The front axle should be checked every 6,000 miles miles or three months whichever comes first.
and refilled with lubricant specified in Note 2 when nec In Positraction axles use special Positraction
essary. With the differential at operating temperature, Rear Axle Lubricant.
fill to the level of filler plug hole. If differential is cold,
fill to the level of 1 / 2 " below the filler plug hole. On MA50 trailing axle, check lubricant level of each
wheel hub every 6,000 miles. When necessary, refill
Cardon Joint hub to oil level mark with lubricant specified in Note 2.
After every 6,000 miles of driving, remove the slotted MASTER CYLINDER
pipe plugs from the ball ends of the axle housing. Check
lubricant and refill with lubricant specified in Note 2 Check master cylinder fluid level every 6,000 miles.
(1/2 pt. per joint) if necessary. Replace the pipe plugs If the fluid is low in the reservoir, it should be filled to
securely. a point about 1/4" from the top rear of each reservoir
with GM Supreme No. 11 Hydraulic Brake Fluid or
Air Vent and Hose equivalent.
Check vent hose for kinks and proper installation every
FULL AIR BRAKES
miles.
6 .0 0 0
Compressor
Transfer Case
Check the transfer case level every 6,000 miles and, Every 6,000 miles - Remove compressor air strainer
if necessary, add lubricant to bring to the level of the and inspect or replace every 6,000 miles or oftener. The
filler plug hole. Use lubricant specified in Note 2. element can be cleaned in kerosene or mineral spirits.
Cleaners of the aromatic compound must not be used.
Control Lever and Linkage The element should be squeezed (not wrung) dry after
cleaning.
Since no grease fitting is provided in the control lever
it is necessary to brush or spray engine oil on the lever Camshaft Bracket Bushings
pivot point and on all exposed control linkage every
6 . 0 0 0 miles. Lubricate monthly or every 6,000 miles with chassis
lube. Avoid over lubrication because excess grease will
WHEEL BEARINGS ruin brake linings.
cylinder. Fill to plug level with Bendix Vacuum Cylinder BRAKE AND CLUTCH PEDALS
Oil or Delco shock absorber fluid or equivalent at 12,000
mile intervals or each six month period, especially prior On Forward Control models the clutch pedal is lubri
to the start of cold weather. cated from a pressure gun lubrication fitting in the end
The Hydrovac assemblies are the diaphragm type. of the shaft and the brake pedal is also equipped with a
lubrication fitting.
CAUTION: These units do not require lubrica On Forward Control models, the clutch idler support
tion. Do not add oil of any type to diaphragm is equipped with a lubrication fitting. Use lubricant
chamber. specified in Note 1 at these points.
Vacuum brake air cleaner for frame mounted vacuum SPEEDOMETER ADAPTER
boosters should be cleaned semi-annually.
On trucks so equipped, lubricate adapter at fitting with
STEERING GEAR lubricant specified in Note 1 every 6,000 miles.
PROPELLER SHAFT SLIP JOINTS The quality of the fuel oil used for high speed Diesel
engine operation is a dominating factor in satisfactory
Propeller shaft slip joints should be lubricated every engine life. Suitable fuel oil must be clean, completely
6,000 miles with lubricant specified in Note 1. distilled, well refined, non-corrosive and be of low sul
fur content.
DISTILLATION RANGE, CETANE NUMBER, and SUL
UNIVERSAL JOINTS FUR CONTENT are the three most important properties
of high-speed diesel engine fuel oils.
Universal joints equipped with lubrication fittings, The following shows the specifications which must be
should be lubricated every 6 , 0 0 0 miles with lubricant met in a suitable Diesel oil.
specified in Note 1. Engine operation at altitudes above 5,000 feet requires
More frequent lubes may be required on heavy duty use of next lighter class of fuel oil than would normally
or "off the road" operations. be used.
Distillation
Type of Typical General Fuel Cetane Sulfur
Engine Service Application Classification 90% Boiling Final Boiling Number Content
Point (Max.) Point (Max.) (Min.) (Max.)
Heavy Load and high Winter No. 2-D* 625° F. 675° F. 45 0.50%
Highway Trucks
speed with idling. Summer No. 2-D* 625° F. 675° F. 40 0.50%
♦NOTE: For most satisfactory engine life, use only those No. 2-D diesel fuel oils containing 0.50% or less sulfur.
Fig . 28
Fig . 29
Fig. 30
Fig . 31
Lubrication Type of
No. Lubrication Points Quantity Remarks
Period Lubrication
♦Replace Lubricator at 24,000 m ile intervals. **D iesel Engine not illustrated.
F ig . 33
*Under favorable driving conditions, 25,000 miles. **Diesel Engines not illustrated.
Fig . 34
HEATER
INDEX
Page Page
General Description............ ............................................. 1A-1 Control Assembly ....................................................... 1A-8
Component Replacement and R e p a i r .............................. 1A-4 Control C a b l e s ............................................................. 1A-8
Blower Assem bly.......................................................... 1A-4 Blower Switch................................................................ 1A-9
Blower, Core Case, and Core A s s e m b l y .................. 1A-5 Thermostatic V a lv e ............................ .. ....................... 1A-9
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
O UTLETS
DELUXE AIR HEATER switch. The third lever operates a temperature door
which passes the airflow either through the heater core,
Components of the heater attach to the right side of the around the core, or partially through and partially around
firewall. The blower motor, heater core, and hose as the core.
sembly mount on the engine side of the firewall while the
distributor ducting, and controls are under the dash (fig. 1 ). CHEVY VAN HEATER
The heater operates on outside air only with the blower
receiving its airflow from the cowl vent plenum chamber. The Chevy Van heater assembly is mounted on the toe
Engine coolant constantly flows through the heater core board inside the van. Outside air flows to the heater
during engine operation. Heater output is adjusted by through a grille in the front end panel and across to the
varying the airflow through the system. A dash mounted heater air inlet (fig. 3). The air passes by the tempera
three lever control system is employed (fig. 2). One ture door where it is directed either through the core,
lever controls the defroster air deflector. The second bypassed around the core, or split between the two to
lever opens the air door and operates the three speed fan vary the air temperature. The bypass channel is a de-
CONTROLS
DELUXE AIR HEATER
DEF Lever
HEAT Lever
AIR Knob
FAN-HEAT Knob
TEM PER A T U RE
DOOR
TO D EFR O ST ER
O U T S ID E
O UTLETS
A IR IN L E T TOE BO A RD
D EFRO STER
DOOR
L
FLO O R BLO W ER
O UTLETS A SSEM BLY
HEATER C O R E
AIR CONTROL
CABLE
KNOB
SWITCH
TEMP.
CONTROL
CABLE f \
DEFROSTER BRACKET INSTRUMENT DEFROSTER AIR CONTROL
CONTROL CABLE PANEl CONTROL CABLE CABLE
Chevy Van
Removal
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Unclip the blower wire at the blower flange terminal
and note or mark the motor flange position in re
lation to the blower case.
3. Remove the blower assembly mounting screws.
4. Remove the blower assembly (pry the flange away
from the case carefully if the sealer acts as an ad
hesive).
5. Remove the nut attaching the blower wheel to the
motor shaft and separate the assembly.
Installation
1. Assemble the blower wheel to the motor with the
open end of the blower away from the motor.
2. Install the assembly into the blower case, connect
ground strap, and connect the motor wire.
3. Connect the battery ground cable.
SPACER RESISTOR DUCT HEATER AND
DEFROSTER ASM. Tilt Cab
DISTRIBUTOR
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
Fig . 7 - T ilt Cab H eater Assembly 2. Roll the floor mat back from the heater motor area.
I
HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONING 1A-5
Installation
1. Assemble the blower wheel to the motor with the
open end of the blower away from the motor.
2. Position the blower assembly below the opening in
the housing and lift the heater assembly until the
blower wheel will enter the opening. Lift the assem
bly into position and mount to the housing.
3. Connect the motor wire.
4. Replace core case brace to cowl panel screw and the Fig. 9 - H eater Hoses
blower housing brace to cowl panel screw.
5. Replace the floor mat and connect the battery ground outboard case attachments, the right front fender
cable. skirt should be loosened and moved. Remove enough
skirt mounting screws and bolts (from the rear for
BLOWER, CORE CASE, AND CORE ASSEMBLY ward) to move the skirt a sufficient amount.
7. Remove the case retaining screws and sheet metal
10-60 Series (Exc. Tilt Cab and Chevy Van) nuts. Pull the case away from the mounting studs
and inboard to remove it.
Removal 8 . Remove the screws attaching the core retainers to
1. Drain radiator. the case and remove the core.
2. Disconnect battery ground cable.
3. Unclip the blower motor wire at the blower flange
terminal.
4. Disconnect heater hoses at the core tubes.
5. (Under dash) Remove the seal on the temperature
door cable at the distributor duct adapter and dis
connect the cable from the temperature door.
6 . (10-30 Series) In order to gain access to the lower
to the water pump attaches to the upper core tube). 7. Connect the defroster and air door cables and check
6 . Connect the motor wire and battery ground cable. adjustment.
7. Refill the Cooling System. 8 . Connect the motor wire.
9. Replace the glove box.
Chevy Van 10. Connect heater hoses below the toe pan.
11. Refill the Cooling System.
Removal 12. Connect the battery ground cable.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Drain the radiator. Tilt Cab
3. Disconnect heater hoses below toe pan.
4. Remove glove box. Removal
5. Unclip the blower motor wire at the motor flange 1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
terminal. 2. Drain radiator.
3. Remove exterior air intake grille panel below wind
shield.
4. Loosen the clamp at the top of each rubber elbow
Fig. 12 - T ilt Cab Heat C ab le Access Plate Fig. 13 - T ilt Cab Thermostatic V a lv e C a p illa ry
15. Refill cooling system. 3. (AIR - FAN control) Connect the blower wire con
16. Connect battery ground cable. nector to the control.
4. Install the control to the steering column mounting
DEFROSTER DUCT plate with the escutcheon and nut. Replace the knob.
All Models 5. Check control operation.
The defroster hose and outlet assemblies for all ve
hicles are illustrated in Figure 8 . Tilt Cab
CONTROL ASSEMBLY Removal
Deluxe Air Heater 1. Remove the screws at the upper edge of the control
Removal unit.
1. Remove the control assembly retaining screws at 2. Remove the screws which attach the control unit
the lower edge of the dash. brace to the lower edge of the dash and lower the
2. Lower the unit and remove the blower switch. assembly.
3. Remove the cables from the control unit one by one 3. Remove the blower switch knob and blower switch.
and mount them in their respective positions on the 4. Remove cables from the control unit one by one and
replacement unit. Check cable adjustment. mount them in their respective positions on the re
placement unit. Check cable adjustment.
Installation
1. Attach the blower switch and wiring to the control Installation
unit. 1. Attach the blower switch and wiring to the control
2. Place the unit in position in the dash and replace unit. P ress the knob onto the switch lever.
mounting screws. 2. Place the unit in position in the dash and replace
brace and unit mounting screws.
C h e v y V an
CONTROL CABLES
Removal
1. (Any control) Remove the knob from the control Deluxe Air Heater
shaft. Remove retaining nut and escutcheon, and
remove control from the steering column to dash Remove the control assembly as outlined under CON
mounting plate. TROL ASSEMBLY and replace the affected cable or
2. (HEAT - FAN control) Disconnect the blower wiring cables. Check cable adjustment before installing control
connector from the control. assembly in dash. Access to the temperature door cable
3. (AIR or DEFROSTER control) Remove the cable from at the heater is through the plastic seal at the duct
the air distributor duct and actuating lever. adapter.
4. (TEMPERATURE control) Remove the glove box as
sembly. Remove the cable end retainer from the Chevy Van
temperature door link. Remove the cable case clip
The control cables are complete control units covered
attaching screw, and remove the cable.
under CONTROL ASSEMBLY.
Installation
Tilt Cab
1. Attach the cable to the case and actuating lever.
2. (TEMPERATURE control) Replace the heater assem Remove the control assembly as outlined under CON
bly and mount it to the firewall. Replace the glove TROL ASSEMBLY and replace the affected cable or
box assembly. cables. When replacing the temperature cable, remove
the glove box assembly to reach the temperature cable
access plate at the top of the core case. Check cable
adjustment before installing control assembly in dash.
AIR CONDITIONING
INDEX
Page Page
General Description..........................................................1A-10 Component Replacement and Minor R ep airs..................... 1A-22
General Information..........................................................1A-12 Refrigerant Line Connections .................................... 1A-22
Precautions in Handling Refrigerant— 1 2 .................. 1A-13 Repair of Refrigerant L e a k s ....................................... 1A-22
Precautions in Handling Refrigerant L i n e s ............... 1A-13 Refrigerant Hose F a ilu re ............................................. 1A-23
Maintaining Chemical Stability in the Conditioning System for Replacement of
Refrigeration System ............................................. 1A-14 Component P a r t s ...................................................... 1A-23
Gauge S e t ......................................................................1A-14 Sight Glass R eplacem en t............................................. 1A-23
Charging S ta tio n ..........................................................1A-15 Control A sse m bly ................................................... . . 1A-23
Leak T e s tin g ................................................................1A-15 Condenser......................................................... ... 1A-24
Vacuum P u m p .............................................................1A-16 Receiver D eh yd ra to r................................................... 1A-25
Availability of Refrigerant— 1 2 ................................. 1A-17 Expansion Valve ......................................................... 1A-26
Inspection and Periodic Service....................................... 1A-17 P.O.A. V a l v e ............................................................... 1A-26
Pre-D elivery Inspection............................................. 1A-17 Blower A s se m b ly ......................................................... 1A-26
6000 Mile Inspection................................................... 1A-17 E v a p o r a t o r .................................................................. 1A-27
Periodic S e r v ic e ..........................................................1A-17 Blower and Evaporator C a s e ....................................... 1A-27
Installing Gauge Set to Check System Operation . . . 1A-17 Heater C a s e .................................................................. 1A-28
Performance T e s t ...................................................... 1A-17 Heater C o r e .................................................................. 1A-28
Performance D a t a ...................................................... 1A-18 Blower Resistor U n i t ................................................... 1A-28
Evaporator Control Valve (POA) .............................. 1A-18 Muffler and Connector B lo c k ....................................... 1A-29
Expansion V a l v e ..........................................................1A-18 Kick Panel A ir Valve A ctu ato r.................................... 1A-29
Engine Idle Compensator .......................................... 1A-19 Kick Panel A ir V a l v e ................................................... 1A-30
Evacuating and Charging P ro ced u re s .............................. 1A-19 Plenum A ir V a lv e ......................................................... 1A-31
Purging the S y s t e m ....................................................1A-19 Compressor ............................................................... 1A-32
Evacuating and Charging the S y s t e m ........................ 1A-19 Wiring D i a g r a m ............................................................... 1A-33
Checking O i l ............................................................... 1A-20 Special T o o ls ..................................................................... 1A-34
Adding Oil to the System ............................................. 1A-22 Specifications ..................................................................
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
FOUR-SEASON SYSTEM
The Four-Season system uses an evaporator pressure The heater core will be hot at all times since no water
control known as the POA (Pressure Operated Absolute) valve is present in the system.
valve. The six-cylinder reciprocating compressor is System operation is as follows (See Figure 20): Air,
bracket-mounted to the engine and belt driven from the either outside air, recirculated air or a mixture enters
crankshaft pulley. The condenser is mounted ahead of the the system and is forced through the system by the
engine cooling radiator and the receiver-dehydrator is blower.
mounted in the refrigerant line downstream of the con
denser. All cooling system components are connected The air passes by the temperature door and is directed
by means of flexible refrigerant lines. through the heating or cooling cores, or split to flow
Both the heating and cooling functions are performed through both. After flowing through the core or cores,
by this system. Air entering the vehicle must pass the air passes the outlets door which directs it to the
either through the cooling unit (evaporator) or through dash or floor outlets or both. Air directed to the dash
the heating unit, or through both. The system is thus outlets is finally controlled by the position of the air
referred to as a parallel system. outlets. Air directed to the floor outlets passes the
The evaporator provides maximum cooling of the air defroster door which directs the air out the floor outlets,
passing through the core when the air conditioning sys the defroster outlets, or both.
tem is calling for cooling. The control valve acts in the Linkage is so designed that when the system controls
system only to control the evaporator pressure so that are calling for heat, air will enter the vehicle through the
minimum possible temperature is achieved without core floor distributor duct, and when the system controls call
freeze-up. The valve is preset, has no manual control, for cooling, air will enter through the three dash outlets.
is automatically altitude compensated, and non The side dash outlets may be rotated to provide either
repayable. soft, diffused airflow or spot cooling. Rotate half way to
shut off airflow. The barrel type outlet in the center of
the dash will direct air up or down or, if desired, shut it
off.
Controls
Full control of the Four-Season System is obtained
through the use of a single control panel (fig. 18). The
control levers make use of bowden cables to activate the
various doors and switches necessary for system opera
tion. Therefore, control adjustment is a matter of
properly setting these bowden cables. The following
F ig . 18 - Four-Season System Controls paragraphs explain each control.
EVAPORATOR
OUTLET
F ig . 20 - A irflo w Schematic
GENERAL INFORMATION
PRECAUTIONS IN HANDLING REFRIGERANT-12 operation. It would be unwise to place the drum on a
In any vocation or trade, there are established proce gas stove, radiator or use a blow torch while pre
dures and practices that have been developed after many paring for the charging operation, for a serious
years of experience. In addition, occupation hazards accident can result. Don’t depend on the safety
may be present that require the observation of certain plug - many drums have burst when the safety plug
precautions or use of special tools and equipment. Ob failed. Remember, high pressure means that great
serving the procedures, practices and precautions of forces are being exerted against the walls of the
servicing refrigeration equipment will greatly reduce the container. A bucket of warm water, not over 125°F,
possibilities of damage to the customers’ equipment as or warm wet rags around the container is all the heat
that is required.
well as virtually eliminate the element of hazard to the
serviceman. Do not weld or steam clean on or near the system.
Refrigerant-12 is transparent and colorless in both the Welding or steam cleaning can result in a dangerous
gaseous and liquid state. It has a boiling point of 21.7°F pressure buildup in the system.
When filling a small drum from a large one, never
below zero and, therefore, at all normal temperatures
fill the drum completely. Space should always be
and pressures it will be a vapor. The vapor is heavier
allowed above the liquid for expansion. If the drum
than air and is noninflammable, nonexplosive, non-
were completely full and the temperature was in
poisonous (except when in contact with an open flame)
and noncorrosive (except when in contact with water). creased, hydraulic pressure with its tremendous
force would result.
The following precautions in handling R-12 should be
observed at all times. Discharging large quantities of R-12 into a room can
• All refrigerant drums are shipped with a heavy metal usually be done safely as the vapor would produce
screw cap. The purpose of the cap is to protect the no ill effects, however, in the event of an accidental
valve and safety plug from damage. It is good prac rapid discharge of the system it is recommended
tice to replace the cap after each use of the drum. that inhalation of large quantities of R-12 be avoided.
• If it is ever necessary to transport or carry a drum This caution is especially important if the area con
or can of refrigerant in a car, keep it in the luggage tains a flame producing device such as a gas heater.
compartment. Refrigerant should not be exposed to While R-12 normally is nonpoisonous, heavy con
the radiant heat from the sun for the resulting in centrations of it in contact with a live flame will
crease in pressure may cause the safety plug to produce a toxic gas. The same gas will also attack
release or the drum or can to burst. all bright metal surfaces.
• Drums or disposable cans should never be subjected Protection of the eyes is of vital importance! When
to high temperature when adding refrigerant to the working around a refrigerating system, an accident
system. In most instances, heating the drum or can may cause liquid refrigerant to hit the face. If the
is required to raise the pressure in the container eyes are protected with goggles or glasses, no
higher than the pressure in the system during the serious damage can resu lt Just remember, any
is in operation)
R - 1 2 liquid that you can touch or that touches you is • When disconnecting any fitting in the refrigeration
at least 21.7UF. below zero. The eyeballs can’t take system, the system must first be discharged of all
much of this temperature. If R-12 liquid should refrigerant. However, proceed very cautiously r e
strike the eyeballs, here is what to do: gardless of gauge readings. Open very slowly, keep
1. Keep calm. ing face and hands away so that no injury can occur
2. Do not rub the eyes! Splash the affected area with if there happens to be liquid refrigerant in the line.
quantities of cold water to gradually get the tem If pressure is noticed when fitting is loosened, allow
perature above the freezing point. The use of min it to bleed off very slowly.
eral, cod liver or an antiseptic oil is important in
providing a protective film to reduce the possibility CAUTION: Always wear safety goggles wnen
of infection. opening refrigerant lines.
3. As soon as possible, call or consult an eye specialist
for immediate and future treatment. • In the event any line is opened to atmosphere, it
REMEMBER - "An ounce of prevention is worth a
should be immediately capped to prevent entrance
pound of cure." of moisture and dirt.
PRECAUTIONS IN HANDLING REFRIGERANT LINES • The use of the proper wrenches when making con
• All metal tubing lines should be free of kinks, be nections on "O" ring fittings is important. The use
cause of the restriction that kinks will offer to the of improper wrenches may damage the connection.
flow of refrigerant. The refrigeration capacity of the The opposing fitting should always be backed up with
entire system can be greatly reduced by a single a wrench to prevent distortion of connecting lines or
kink. components. When connecting the flexible hose con
• The flexible hose lines should never be bent to a nections it is important that the swagged fitting and
radius of less than 1 0 times the diameter of the hose. the flare nut, as well as the coupling to which it is
• The flexible hose lines should never be allowed to attached, be held at the same time using three dif
come within a distance of 2 - 1 / 2 " of the exhaust ferent wrenches to prevent turning the fitting and
manifold. damaging the ground seat.
• Flexible hose lines should be inspected at least once • "O" rings and seats must be in perfect condition.
a year for leaks or brittleness. If found brittle or The slightest burr or piece of dirt may cause a leak.
leaking they should be replaced with new lines. • Sealing beads on hose clamp connections must be
• Use only sealed lines from parts stock. free of nicks and scratches to assure a perfect seal.
5 LB. CHARGING
CYLINDER
LEAK
DETECTOR
FREON DRUM
CONTROL VALVE
The high pressure gauge is used for checking pres All evacuation and charging equipment is hooked to
sures on the high pressure side of the system. gether in a compact portable unit (fig. 24). It brings air
The connection at the left is for attaching the low conditioning service down to the basic problem of hooking
pressure gauge line and the one at the right the high on two hoses, and manipulating clearly labeled valves.
pressure gauge line. The center connector is common to This will tend to insure that the job will be done without
both and is for the purpose of attaching a line for adding skipping operations. As a result, you can expect to save
refrigerant, discharging refrigerant, evacuating the sys time and get higher quality work, less chance of an over
tem and other uses. When not required, this line or or undercharge, or comeback.
connection should be capped. The pump mount is such that the dealer may use his
own vacuum pump. The gauges and manifold are in com
NOTE: Gauge fitting connections should be in
mon use. Thus a current air conditioning dealer can use
stalled hand tight only and the connections leak
the equipment on hand and avoid duplication.
tested before proceeding.
The hand shutoff valves on the gauge manifold do not LEAK TESTING THE SYSTEM
control the opening or closing off of pressure to the
gauges. They merely close each opening to the center Whenever a refrigerant leak is suspected in the system
connector and to each other. During most diagnosing or a service operation performed which results in dis
and service operation, the valves must be closed. The turbing lines or connections, it is advisable to test for
only occasion for opening both at the same time would be leaks. Common sense should be the governing factor in
to bypass refrigerant vapor from the high pressure to performing any leak test, since the necessity and extent
the low pressure side of the system, or in evacuating of any such test will, in general, depend upon the nature
both sides of the system. of the complaint and the type of service performed on
the system. It is better to test and be sure, if in doubt,
J-8393 CHARGING STATION than to risk the possibility of having to do the job over
The J-8393 Charging Station is a portable assembly of again.
a vacuum pump, refrigerant supply, gauges, valves, and
most important, a five (5) pound metering refrigerant NOTE: The use of a leak detecting dye within
charging cylinder. The use of a charging cylinder elim the system is not recommended because of the
inates the need for scales, hot water pails, etc. following reasons:
The chief advantage of this unit is savings. A very 1. Refrigerant leakage can exist without any oil leakage.
definite savings in refrigerant and time can be obtained In this case the dye will not indicate the leak, how
by using this unit. Since the refrigerant is metered into ever, a torch detector will.
the system by volume, the correct amount may be added 2. The addition of additives, other than inhibitors, may
to the system and charged to the customer. This, coupled alter the stability of the refrigeration system and
with the fact that the unit remains "plumbed" at all times cause malfunctions.
and thus eliminates loss of refrigerant in purging of 3. Dye type leak detectors which are insoluble form a
lines and hooking-up, combines to enable the operator curdle which can block the inlet screen of the ex
to get full use of all refrigerant purchased by the pansion valve.
dealership.
Leak Detector
Tool J-6084 (fig. 25) is a propane gas-burning torch
which is used to locate a leak in any part of the system.
Refrigerant gas drawn into the sampling tube attached to
the torch will cause the torch flame to change color in
proportion to the size of the leak. Propane gas fuel
cylinders used with the torch are readily available
commercially throughout the country.
CAUTION: Do not use lighted detector in any
place where combustible or explosive gases,
dusts or vapors may be present.
Operating Detector
1. Open control valve only until a low hiss of gas is
heard, then light gas at opening in chimney.
2. Adjust flame until desired volume is obtained. This
is most satisfactory when blue flame is approxi
mately 3/8" above reactor plate. The reaction plate
will quickly heat to a cherry red.
3. Explore for leaks by moving the end of the sampling
hose around possible leak points in the system. Do
not pinch or kink hose.
NOTE: Since R-12 is heavier than air, it is
good practice to place open end of sampling tube
immediately below point being tested, particu
F ig . 25 - Leak Detector larly in cases of small leaks.
FIVE A M P
TIME D ELAY
FUSE
C O R D TO PUM P PU M P D IS C H A R G E
110 A C S O U R C E INLET OUTLET
system, a filter must be connected to the intake system. It is available in 1 quart graduated bottles
fitting to prevent any sludge from contaminating the through Parts Stock. This oil is as free from moisture
working parts, which will result in malfunction of the and comtaminants as it is possible to attain by human
pump. processes. This condition should be preserved by im
• Do not use the vacuum pump as an air compressor. mediately capping the bottle when not in use.
See "Air Conditioning System Capacities” for the
AVAILABILITY OF REFRIGERANT-12
total system oil capacity.
Refrigerant-12 is available through Parts Stock in 25 Due to the porosity of the refrigerant hoses and con
lb. drums and in 15 oz. disposable cans. Valves are nections, the system refrigerant level will show a definite
available for the disposable cans, which may be used as drop after a period of time. Since the compressor oil is
individual cans or as a group of up to four cans (fig. 44). carried throughout the entire system mixed with the
Tool J-6272 is used with one through four cans. The refrigerant a low refrigerant level will cause a dangerous
use of the four-can fixture makes it possible to charge lack of lubrication. Therefore the refrigerant charge in
the system with a known quantity of refrigerant without the system has a definite tie-in with the amount of oil
the use of weighing equipment necessary with the larger found in the compressor and an insufficient charge may
drum. The single can Valve J-6271 can be used for com eventually lead to an oil build-up in the evaporator.
pleting the charge and for miscellaneous operations such
as flushing. The valves are installed by piercing the top COMPRESSOR SERIAL NUMBER
seal of the cans. The compressor serial number is located on the serial
Evacuating and charging procedures later in this se c number plate on top of the compressor. The serial num
tion will make use of the J-8393 Charging Station which ber consists of a series of numbers and letters. This
uses the 25 lb. drum of refrigerant. serial number should be referenced on all forms and
COMPRESSOR OIL correspondence related to the servicing of this part.
Special refrigeration lubricant should be used in the
3. Vehicle in NEUTRAL with engine running at 2000 EVAPORATOR CONTROL VALVE (POA)
rpm. Four Season
4. Air Conditioning controls set for -
• Maximum cooling. The only check for proper POA valve operation is to
• High blower speed. check the suction pressure at the valve as during a
5. TEMP knob and AIR knob set for full recirculating performance test. The POA valve is an absolute valve
air. On Comfortron systems move the control lever and will provide different gauge readings based on the
to REAR and pull the white vacuum hose from the altitude where the readings are being taken. Correct
transducer. Plug the hose. An alternate method is gauge reading at sea level is 29.5 psig. Gauge readings
to install the J-22368 Tester (described later in this will be one-half psi higher for each additional 1 0 0 0 feet
section) and operate it on MANUAL control to main of elevation. The following table lists gauge readings at
tain maximum cooling and blower speed. different altitudes. If a valve gives improper gauge
6 . Gauge set installed. readings, it must be replaced since it is not repairable
7. System settled out (run-in approximately 10 minutes). or adjustable.
8 . A thermometer placed in front of vehicle grille and
another in the right hand diffuser outlet. 29.5 psig. - - Sea Level
30.0 psig. — 1000 ft.
PERFORMANCE DATA 30.5 psig. — 2000 ft.
31.0 psig. — 3000 ft.
The following Performance Data define normal opera 31.5 psig. — 4000 ft.
tion of the system under the above conditions. Relative 3 2.0 psig. — 5000 ft.
humidity does not appear in the tables because after 32.5 psig. — 6000 ft.
running the prescribed length of time on recirculated air 33.0 psig. — 7000 ft.
and maximum cooling, the relative humidity of the air 33.5 psig. — 8000 ft.
passing over the evaporator core will remain at ap 34.0 psig. — 9000 ft.
proximately 35% to 40% regardless of the ambient tem 34.5 psig. — 10000 ft.
perature or humidity.
Should excessive head pressures be encountered at EXPANSION VALVE
higher ambient temperatures, an 18" fan placed in front
of the vehicle and blowing into the condenser will provide A malfunction of the expansion valve will be caused
the extra circulation of air needed to bring the pressures by one of the following conditions: valve stuck open,
to within the limits specified. valve stuck closed, broken power element, a restricted
screen or an improperly located or installed power
NOTE: Higher temperatures and pressures
element bulb. The first three conditions require valve
will occur at higher ambient temperatures. In
areas of high humidity it is possible to have replacement. The last two may be corrected by replacing
thermometer and gauge readings approach but the valve inlet screen and by properly installing the
not reach the figures listed in the performance power element bulb.
tables and still have a satisfactory operating Attachment of the expansion valve bulb to the evapo
unit. However, it is important to remember that rator outlet line is very critical. The bulb must be
low pressure has a direct relationship to nozzle attached tightly to the line and must make good contact
outlet temperature. If pressure is too low, ice with the line along the entire length of the bulb. A loose
will gradually form on the evaporator fins, r e
stricting airflow into the passenger area and
resulting in insufficient or no cooling.
Four Season Systems
Temperature of
Air Entering 70° 80° 90° 100° 110° 120°
Condenser
Discharge Air 38 38 40 41 43 48
Temp, at Right 41 41 43 44 46 51
Hand Outlet
F ig . 28 - Evaporator Pressure Control V a lv e POA
bulb will result in high low side pressures and poor NOTE: If engine idle is erratic, hold the idle
cooling. On bulbs located outside the evaporator case compensator valve closed with a pencil or
insulation must be properly installed. wooden dowel while adjusting the idle mixture
The external equalizer line shown in Figure 55 is not screw(s). Never attempt to bend the bimetal
used in the Custom and Chevy II All-Weather systems. strip or attempt any valve adjustment.
Indications of expansion valve trouble provided by the
Performance Test are as follows:
cylinder and be certain bleed valve is closed 8. After evacuating for 15 minutes, add 1/2 pound of
securely. R-12 to system as described in Step 7 above. Purge
this 1/2 pound and reevacuate for 5 minutes. This
NOTE: It will be necessary to close bleed second evacuation is to be certain that as much con
valve periodically to allow boiling to subside to tamination is removed from the system as possible.
check level in sight glass. 9. Only after evacuating as above, system is ready for
charging. Note reading on sight glass of charging
Installing Charging Station to System cylinder. If it does not contain a sufficient amount
for a full charge, fill to the proper level.
1. Be certain all valves on charging station are closed. 10. With High and Low pressure Valves (1 and 2) open,
2. Connect high pressure gauge line to high pressure close Vacuum Control Valve (3) and open freon con
gauge fitting. (See "Installing Gauge Set to Check trol valve (4 ). Operating the heater and air con
System Operations.") ditioner blower with the controls set for cooling
3. See Figure 30. Turn high pressure control (2) one will help complete the charging operation.
turn counter-clockwise (open). Crack open low pres
NOTE: If the charge will not transfer com
sure control (1 ) and allow refrigerant gas to hiss
pletely from the station to the system, close
from low pressure gauge line for three seconds,
then connect low pressure gauge line to low pressure the high pressure valve at the gauge set, set
gauge fitting. the air conditioning controls for cooling, check
4. System is now ready for performance testing. that the engine compartment is clear of obstruc
tions, and start the engine. Compressor opera
Evacuating and Charging System tion will decrease the low side pressure in the
system.
1. Install charging station as previously described. System is now charged and should be performance
Refer to Figure 30 while performing the following tested before removing gauges.
operation.
2. Remove Low Pressure gauge line from compressor. CHECKING OIL
3. Crack open high (2) and low (1) pressure control
valves, and allow refrigerant gas to purge from In the six cylinder compressor it is not recommended
system. Purge slow enough so that oil does not that the oil be checked as a matter of course. Generally,
escape from system along with Refrigerant. compressor oil lever should be checked only where
4. When refrigerant flow stops, connect Low Pressure there is evidence of a major loss of system oil such as
gauge line to compressor. might be caused by:
5. Turn on vacuum pump and open Vacuum Control • A broken refrigerant hose.
Valve (3). • A severe hose fitting leak.
6 . With system purged as above, run pump until 28-29
• A very badly leaking compressor seal.
inches of vacuum is obtained. Continue to run pump • Collision damage to the system components.
for 15 minutes after the system reaches 28-29 inches As a quick check on compressor oil charge, with the
vacuum. engine off, carefully crack open the oil drain plug on the
7. If 28-29 inches cannot be obtained, close Vacuum bottom of the compressor. If oil comes out, the com
Control Valve (3) and shut off vacuum pump. Open pressor has the required amount of oil. To further check
Refrigerant Control Valve (4) and allow 1/2 pound of the compressor oil charge, should the above test show
R-12 to enter system. Locate and repair all leaks. insufficient oil, it is necessary to remove the compressor
from the vehicle, drain and measure the oil.
H IG H PR ESSU RE
G A U G E FITTING*
PO A VALVE
L O W PR ESSU RE
G A U G E FIT TIN G
M UFFLER
■COMPRESSOR
H IG H PR ESSU R E.
L O W PRESSURE
G A G E VALVE
G A G E VALVE
VALVE
VALVE
R EFR IG ER A N T
SU PPLY
► TO VACUUM SU PPLY
F ig . 31 - Charging Schematic
add an additional 1 fluid oz. to the compressor. ADDING OIL TO THE SYSTEM
4. In the event that it is not possible to idle the com
pressor as outlined in Step 1 to effect oil return to The system should be completely assembled and un
it, proceed as follows: charged before adding oil. Use only uncontaminated
a. Remove the compressor, drain, measure and refrigerant oil and add as follows:
discard the oil. 1. Connect the low pressure gauge line to the low
b. If the amount drained is more than 1-1/2 fluid pressure gauge fitting on the P.O.A. valve.
oz. and the system shows no signs of a major 2. Connect the high pressure line from the charging
leak, add the same amount to the replacement station gauge set to the compressor muffler.
compressor. 3. Disconnect the high pressure line from the gauge
c. If the amount drained is less than 1-1/2 fluid oz. set, make certain that the line is clean, and place
and the system appears to have lost an excessive the end in a graduated oil container.
amount of oil add 6 fluid oz. of clean refrigeration 4. Pour enough refrigerant oil in the container so that
oil to replacement compressor, 7 fluid oz. to a the required volume may be drawn into the system
repaired compressor. by the high pressure hose.
If the oil contains chips or other foreign ma 5. Close the high pressure valve at the gauge set, and
terial, replace the receiver-dehydrator and flush
open the low pressure valve.
or replace all component parts as necessary. Add 6 . Operate the vacuum pump to drop the pressure within
the full 1 1 fluid oz. of new refrigeration oil to the
the system and cause atmospheric pressure to force
replacement compressor.
oil through the high pressure line into the system.
5. Add additional oil in the following amounts for any When the oil level has dropped the required volume,
system components being replaced. pull the line out of the oil container and continue
E v a p o ra to r................................................ 3 fluid oz. vacuum pump operation to force the oil contained in
Condenser ................................................ 1 fluid oz. the line into the system.
Receiver-Dehydrator ............................ 1 fluid oz. 7. Shut off the vacuum pump and connect the high pres
NOTE: When adding oil to the compressor, it sure line to the gauge set. Open the high pressure
will be necessary to tilt the rear end of the valve and evacuate the system through the high and
compressor up so that the oil will not run out low pressure side of the system. Complete the
of the suction and discharge ports. Do not set charging operation as outlined in Step 10 under
the compressor on the shaft end. "Evacuating and Charging System".
COMPONENT REPLACEMENT AND MINOR REPAIRS
REFRIGERANT LINE CONNECTIONS CAUTION: Use no sealer of any kind.
“ O” Rings
3. Install clamps on hose, hooking the locating arms
Always replace the ”0 '' ring when a connection has over the cut end of the hose.
been broken. When replacing the "O" ring, first dip it 4. Tighten the hose clamp screw to 35-42 lb. in.
in refrigeration oil. Always use a backing wrench on torque. DO NOT RETORQUE. The clamp screw
”0 " ring fittings to prevent the pipe from twisting and torque will normally decrease as the hose conforms
damaging the "O” ring. Do not overtighten. Correct to the force of the clamp. The screw should be
torque specifications are as follows: retorqued only if its torque falls below 1 0 lb. in.
In this case, retorque to 20-25 lb. in. Further
Metal Thread and Steel Alum. tightening may damage the hose.
Tube Fitting Tubing Tubing
Removal
O.D. Size Torque* Torque*
1. Carefully, with a sharp knife, make an angle cut in
1/4 7/16 13 6
the hose as shown in Figure 32. This should loosen
3/8 5/8 33 12
the hose so that it may be worked off the fitting.
1 /2 3/4 33 12
2. Cut off slit end of hose when reinstalling. Reinstall
5/8 7/8 33 20
as described above.
3/4 1-1/16 33 25 CAUTION: Use only approved refrigeration
* Pound Feet hose. Never use heater hose. Use extreme
care not to nick or score the sealing beads when
NOTE: Where steel to aluminum connections cutting off the hose. Cutting the hose lengthwise
are being made, use torque for aluminum tubing. may result in this problem"!
Hose Clamps REPAIR OF REFRIGERANT LEAKS
When hose clamp connections are encountered special
Any refrigerant leaks found in the system should be
procedures are necessary for both installation and r e
repaired in the manner given below:
moval.
Installation Leaks at “ O” Ring Connection
1. Coat tube and hose with refrigeration oil. 1. Check the torque on the fitting and, if too loose,
2. Carefully insert hose over the three beads on the tighten to the proper torque. Always use a backing
fitting and down as far as the fourth, or locating wrench to prevent twisting and damage to the "O"
bead. Hose must butt against this fourth bead. ring. Do not overtighten. Again leak test the joint.
Removal
F ig . 32 - Hose Clamp Connections 1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove the screws in the lower lip of the dash which replace mounting bolts. Be certain shims are in
attach the control assembly bracket to the dash. stalled at lower condenser mount bolts.
3. Move the unit toward the front of the vehicle and 2. Move radiator into place and replace mounting bolts.
lower it. Replace shroud lower mounting screws.
4. Disconnect the blower harness connector and illumi 3. Replace the hood catch assembly.
nating lamp sockets. Remove the blower switch and 4. Connect the refrigerant lines, to the condenser using
mounting bracket. new "O" ring seals.
5. Remove the control cables and transfer them to the 5. Add one fluid ounce of refrigerant oil to the system
replacement control unit. Check them for adjust if a new condenser was installed. Charge the system
ment. and check performance.
RECEIVER-DEHYDRATOR
Removal
1. Purge the system.
2. Remove the inlet and outlet connections from the
receiver- dehydrator.
3. Remove the receiver-dehydrator mounting bolts and
carefully remove it.
4. Cap the system if the receiver-dehydrator will not
be replaced immediately. Cap the receiver if it
will be reused.
Installation
1. Place the receiver-dehydrator in position and re
place attaching bolts. Do not uncap the unit until
immediately before connecting lines.
2. Uncap any previously capped connections and con
nect the fittings using new "O" ring seals.
3. Evacuate and recharge the system. If a new
receiver-dehydrator was installed, add one fluid
ounce refrigerant oil to the system.
P.O.A. VALVE
Removal
1. Purge the system.
2. Remove evaporator oil bleed line and expansion valve
equalizer line. Cap the connections.
3. Remove retaining clamp screw and loosen P.O.A.
valve outlet pipe clamp mounting screw.
4. Remove P.O.A. valve inlet and outlet connections
and remove P.O.A. valve. Cap the open tubes.
5. Remove clamp from P.O.A. valve.
Installation
1. Assemble clamp on P.O.A. valve and connect inlet
and outlet connections.
2. Secure P.O.A. valve clamp and outlet line clamp.
3. Connect the evaporator oil bleed line and the ex
pansion valve equalizing line to the P.O.A. valve.
4. Evacuate and charge the system.
Installation
1. Mount the expansion valve to the bracket.
2. Connect the inlet and outlet connections. Tighten
the inlet pipe clamp.
3. Connect the equalizer line to the P.O.A. and mount
the capillary bulb to the evaporator outlet pipe.
4. Evacuate and charge the system. Check perform
ance. F ig. 3 6 - Evaporator and Blower Assembly
ground strap, and connect the motor wire. Connect the outboard case half. Replace case to case, case
cooling tube to motor. to back up plate, and case to firewall mounting
3. (10-30 Series) Remount the hood hinge aligning it screws.
carefully with the scribed lines. Check hood align 2. Attach the vacuum lines to the vacuum reservoir.
ment. 3. Mount the expansion valve capillary bulb to the
4. Connect battery ground cable. evaporator core outlet pipe.
4. Connect the evaporator outlet pipe to the P.O.A.
EVAPORATOR valve using a new "O" ring. Install the pipe clamp.
Removal 5. Connect the evaporator oil bleed line to the P.O.A.
1. Purge the system. valve.
2. Disconnect the line (between the evaporator and the 6. Connect the line from the evaporator to the expansion
thermostatic expansion valve) at the expansion valve. valve.
Cap the open connections. 7. If a new evaporator was installed, add three fluid
3. Disconnect the evaporator oil bleed line at the P.O.A. ounces of refrigerant oil to the system. Evacuate
valve. Cap the open connections. and charge the system. Check performance.
4. Disconnect the evaporator outlet pipe at the P.O.A.
valve. Cap the open connections. Remove the evap BLOWER AND EVAPORATOR CASE
orator outlet pipe clamp. Removal
5. Detach the expansion valve capillary bulb from the 1. Purge the refrigeration system and drain the radi
evaporator outlet pipe. ator.
6 . Disconnect the vacuum lines at the vacuum reservoir. 2. Disconnect battery ground cable.
7. Remove the screws attaching the inboard case half 3. Unclip the blower motor wire at the blower flange
to the outboard case half, back up plate, and firewall. terminal.
8 . Remove inboard case half and evaporator core. 4. Disconnect heater hoses at the core tubes.
5. Disconnect the refrigerant lines at the P.O.A. valve
Installation outlet and the expansion valve inlet. Cap all open
1. Assemble evaporator core and inboard case half to connections.
6 . Remove vacuum hoses to vacuum reservoir and 3. Remove the sheet metal nuts from the heater case
plenum air valve actuator. studs which project through the firewall to the engine
7. Disconnect temperature door cable. side.
8 . (10-30 Series) In order to gain access to the lower 4. Remove the glove box.
outboard case attachments, the right front fender 5. Unplug the relay connector.
skirt should be loosened and moved. Remove enough 6. Remove the right ball outlet hose.
skirt mounting screws and bolts (from the rear 7. Remove the screw attaching the dash outlets air
forward) to move the skirt a sufficient amount. distributor to the heater case and move distributor
9. Remove the case retaining screws and sheet metal away from case.
nuts. Pull the case away from the mounting studs 8. Remove the heater case to firewall retaining screws.
and inboard to remove it. 9. Pull the heater case away from the firewall and
Installation reach in and disconnect the resistor connector.
1. Check the position of the blower and evaporator case 10. Remove the resistor harness grommet and remove
to firewall seals then position the case over the studs the harness from the case. Withdraw the heater
projecting through the firewall and attach the screws case.
and nuts to retain the case. Connect the blower Installation
motor ground strap. Replace spacer between case 1. Place the heater case under the cash and insert the
and firewall at the screw next to the temperature resistor harness and install the grommet and connect
door lever. the resistor connector.
2. (10-30 Series) Remount the right front fender skirt, 2. Position the heater case against the firewall and
skirt. push it into place. Check that nothing is pinched
3. Connect temperature door cable and vacuum hoses between the case and firewall. Install the heater
(hose to engine vacuum source attaches to vacuum case to firewall retaining screws.
tank connection nearest the engine). 3. Position the dash outlets distributor against the
4. Connect the refrigerant hoses to the expansion valve heater case, insert the forward lip into the retaining
inlet and the P.O.A. outlet using new "O" ring seals. clip, and install the retaining Screw.
5. Connect the heater hoses to the core tubes. 4. Install the right dash outlet hose.
6 . Connect the blower motor wire to the motor flange 5. Connect the relay connector.
terminal, and connect the battery ground cable. 6 . Install the glove box.
7. Refill the cooling system, and evacuate and charge 7. Install the sheet metal nuts to the heater case studs
the refrigeration system. which project forward through the firewall.
8 . Attach the heater hoses to the core tubes.
HEATER CASE 9. Refill the engine cooling system and test system
Removal operation.
1. Drain the radiator.
2. Remove the heater hoses from the core tubes. Heater Core
Removal
1. Remove the heater case as outlined under Heater
Case.
2. Remove the screws retaining the core mounting
straps.
3. Remove core.
Installation
1. Install the core into the case and seal it with non
hardening sealer.
2. Mount the core with the core straps and retaining
screws.
3. Replace the heater case in the vehicle as outlined
under Heater Case.
Installation
1. Attach actuator to bracket.
2. Connect actuator rod to link and install pin. Fig. 42 - Vacuum Harness
3. Mount the bracket to the kick panel.
4. Connect the valve return spring. Connect the vacuum
hose to the actuator.
KICK PANEL AIR VALVE
Removal
1. Remove actuator mounting bracket from kick panel. PLENUM V A LV E
2. Remove valve return spring.
3. Pull the top pivot pin downward against spring tension
until it clears the upper pivot hole. Pull valve in
ward and withdraw lower pivot from pivot hole.
4. Remove the valve from the actuator link.
Installation
1. Attach the valve to the actuator link.
2. Insert the lower pivot pin into the lower hole, retract
KICK PAD
VALVE
L-6 ENGINE
the upper pivot pin and insert into the upper pivot 2. Disconnect the diaphragm link from the connecting
hole. shaft arm.
3. Install the valve return spring and mount the actuator 3. Remove the screw attaching the connecting shaft to
bracket to the kick panel. the tube extending forward from the valve.
4. Remove the screws attaching the nylon bearing plate
PLENUM AIR VALVE to the firewall and slide it forward. Remove valve
Removal return spring.
1. Remove cowl grille panel. Refer to Section 11. 5. Pull the rear valve pivot pin forward against spring
F ig . 45 - Vacuum Diagram
tension until it clears the rear bearing. Lift the evidence of contamination to determine if remainder
valve at the rear and withdraw the valve shaft from of system requires servicing. Compressor servic
the firewall. ing information is located in the Chassis Overhaul
Installation Manual.
1. Insert the tube shaft on the valve into the firewall
hole and lower the valve into position with the rear Installation
pivot pin retracted. When the rear pin is aligned 1. If oil previously drained from the compressor upon
with its bearing, allow it to extend into position. removal shows no evidence of contamination, replace
2. Attach valve return spring and nylon bushing. a like amount of fresh refrigeration oil into the com
3. Assemble the connecting shaft to the valve and pressor before reinstallation. It it was necessary
actuating diaphragm. to service the entire system because of excessive
4. Replace the cowl grille panel. contamination in the oil removed, install a full
charge of fresh refrigeration oil in the compressor.
COMPRESSOR 2. Position compressor on the mounting bracket and
install all nuts, bolts and lock washers.
Removal 3. Install the connector assembly to the compressor
1. Purge the refrigerant from the system. rear head, using new "O" rings.
2. Remove connector attaching bolt and connector. Seal 4. Connect the electrical lead to the coil and install
connector outlets. and adjust compressor belt.
3. Disconnect electrical lead to clutch actuating coil. 5. Evacuate and charge the system.
4. Loosen brace and pivot bolts and detach belt. 6 . Leak test the system and check for proper operation.
5. Remove the nuts and bolts attaching the compressor
brackets to the mounting bracket. Compressor Belt Tension Adjustment
6 . Before beginning any compressor disassembly, drain Adjust the compressor belt to the specifications shown
and measure oil in the compressor. Check for in the Tune-Up chart in the Engine section of this manual.
*
CHEVROLET TRUCK SERVICE M ANUAL
HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONING 1A-33
r^nlnja
ED
-20B-
■120R1
■12PPL-
-14DBL-
-180R-'
16DG-DBL/WS COMPRESSOR
-14Y SWITCH
ON POS.
LIGHT
HARNESS
COMPRESSOR-
ASM
GROMMET- ■14Y-----------
16Y-DBL-B/S— [
■180R--------
FIREW ALL ■
■14BRN------ ^ |o)—
----------------------------------------- /
r
-FUSE
POS’N CONTACTS
12OR OFF B TO NONE
LOW B TO L
LEGEND
J
MED B TO L & M
---------- EXISTING WIRING HIGH B TO L & H
---------- WIRING PART OF EQUIPMENT
----------- AIR CONDITION WIRING
SPECIAL TOOLS
BODY
CONTENTS OF THIS SECTION
Page
Conventional B o d y ................................................... .. IB-1
Chevy V a n .............................................................................. IB-19
Step-Van B o d y ..................................................................... IB-27
Tilt Cab Body ..................................................................... IB-35
Special Tools ..................................................................... IB-55
CONVENTIONAL BODY
INDEX
Page Page
General Description ......................................................... IB -1 E n d g a t e s ............ .. ..................................................... IB -8
Service O p e ra tio n s ............................................................ IB-1 D o o r s ........................................................................... IB -9
Body S h e l l ..................................................................... IB-1 Door Assembly ...................................................... IB -9
General Body Construction .................................... IB -1 Door Lock and Striker .......................................... I B - 9
Body Mounting ......................................................... IB -1 Door C h e c k ............................................................ IB-10
Body Sealing ............................................................ IB -2 Door Ventilator Assembly .................................... IB-11
Front E n d ..................................................................... IB -4 Door Window A s s e m b ly .......................................... IB-12
Windshield G l a s s ...................................................... IB -4 Window R e g u la to r................................................... IB-13
Rear View M irror ................................................... IB -6 Door Opening W eath erstrip .................................... IB-13
Instrument Panel Compartment .............................. IB -6 Door Trim Panel Seal Replacement........................ IB-13
Instrument Panel Cover Assembly ........................ IB -6 Door Handles and Locks .......................................... IB-14
Cowl V en tilato r......................................................... IB -6 Rear Window W e a th e rs tr ip .................................... I B - 15
Grille .................................................................. IB -6 Seats ........................................................................... IB-16
Valve .................................................................. IB -7 Cleaning Soft Trim - A ll M o d e l s ........................... IB-16
Windshield W i p e r s ................................................... IB -7 Conventional Cab ................................................... IB-16
Arm Adjustm ent................................................... I B - 8 Level R i d e ............................................................... I B - 16
Wiper Arm Pivot Shafts and Link R o d ............... IB -8
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The information contained in this part of Section 1
deals with servicing of components found on all models elsewhere in Section 1.
except Tilt Cab (T), Step Van (P) and Chevy Van (G) ve Service write-ups which follow may be applied to all
hicles which are covered under appropriate headings remaining models unless otherwise stated.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
BODY SHELL Heading the list of standard safety features are seat
belts, shoulder belt anchorages, padded instrument panels
GENERAL BODY CONSTRUCTION and devices to prevent accidental pivoting of front seat
backs.
Figure 1 is a view of a typical cab showing assembled Improvements in durability are gained by new cab-to-
components in related position on the cab. Figure 1 is frame mounts, door hinges, and a standard steel floor on
not intended to accurately reflect the availability of serv pick-up beds.
ice repair parts. It will be apparent upon reviewing the New door locks require a revised procedure for window
parts catalog which of the panels shown are available for regulator, CV channel and lock servicing.
service installation. Seat tracks are strengthened, as are floor pans.
The Chevrolet Truck body is designed to provide a Windshield and back window glass replacement proce
strong, fully welded unit which has a universal application dures are revised.
to as many model types as possible; thus the cab used on The basic cab is used on Models 10-60, with reinforce
the Pickup is also used on heavier units with the addition ments for heavier duty usage.
of various combinations of front end sheet metal, rocker
panel extensions, transmission covers (floor plates), etc. BODY MOUNTING
This results in a line of trucks which answers any need The number one double rubber biscuit is retained for
but is easily serviced with a minimum parts inventory. heavy duty vehicles and extended to the light-duty units
The 1967 truck cabs are completely redesigned incor (fig. 2). The upper cushion features a steel flange collar
porating numerous engineering improvements and added on the bottom side to protect the cushion when fitted into
safety features. the body bracket.
1. H eater Hole C o ver Assembly 8. Pad Assembly and Defroster O u tlet 15. Dome Lamp Assembly
2. Hole Tapping - Dash and Toe 9. Ash Tray Assembly and C over Cab and W / S Cowl 16. Door S ill Plate and Plugs Cab
3. Side Cowl V e n tila to r Cab and W / S Cowl 10. Instrument Panel Compartment 17. Sunshade and Inside M irror
4. W / S W ip er Motor 11. Instrument Panel Compartment Door 18. Short and Long Arm M irror
5. W / S W asher Ja r and Hoses 12. W / S and Back W indow Installation 19. Seat Belt Installation
6. W / S W ip e r Linkage 13. Transmission C over 20. Fuel Caution Plate
7. W / S W ip e r Blades 14. Dash M ats and Floor Insulators 21. Body Mounting
BODY SEALING
Cab construction details showing location and applica Close all windows and vents, turn air conditioning or
tion of sealing compound and undercoating are shown in heater blower motor to high position and outside air and
Figure 5 and 6 . In servicing complete panels or only a close doors. Run water over suspected leak area in a
portion of a particular section it is helpful to know where small controllable stream and observe area for pressure
the panel is sealed. bubbles.
An alternate method for locating leaks is as follows:
Locating Dust and Water Leaks Remove the following trim from inside the cab: Floor
mats, dash and toe panel pad and kick pads.
A quick method for locating many air and water leaks Dust leaks will be evident when these pads and mats
at windshield, backglass, bolt holes, weatherstripping and are removed. Leaks can be located sometimes by putting
joints is as follows: a bright light under the cab or body, while checking the
interior of the cab or body at joints and weld lines. NOTE: Water does not always enter the cab or
All openings that allow dust leaks will also provide body in the location where leaks show up, there
water leaks. When checking for water leaks a helper fore, back-tracking the path of water will show
should be used on the inside of the cab or body to locate the true entrance of the leak.
the entrance of water, while it is applied on the outside.
Removal
1. Before removing the windshield, mark the location of
the break on the windshield rubber channel and the
body. Protect the paint finish inside of the cab.
Mask around the windshield opening and outside, lay
a suitable covering across the hood and fenders.
FRONT END
C USTO M STANDARD
WINDSHIELD GLASS
The windshield is a one-piece type and is retained in Fig . 7 - Cross Section of W indshield W eatherstrip (Typ ical)
F ig . 8 - Loosening Weatherstrip
2. Remove the reveal moulding from the windshield on b. Outer edge of glass to parallel body metal.
custom models. 7. Mark areas of body metal or flange to be reformed,
remove glass and correct as necessary.
NOTE: Shift reveal moulding caps over to
8 . Recheck windshield in its opening and if satisfactory
either moulding of two being covered by cap, to
proceed as follows.
facilitate bending of rubber channel (fig. 7) for
windshield removal. Do not try to remove re
Installation
veal mouldings while windshield is in body
opening.
CAUTION: Always wear gloves when handling
3. To free windshield rubber channel of weatherstrip glass.
loosen the lip of the windshield weatherstrip from the
pinchweld flange along the top and at the sides by 1. Lay glass on protective covering curved ends up.
applying pressure with palm of the hand to the edge 2. Place one piece rubber weatherstrip channel around
of the glass. At the same time assist the lip of the perimeter of glass.
rubber weatherstrip channel over the pinchweld 3. Place chalk string in depression of weatherstrip
flange with a flat bladed tool such as a tongue de- channel completely around perimeter twice. Tape
presser, or shaped mycarta blade (fig. 8 ). ends of chalk string to inside of glass at bottom
(fig. 1 0 ).
Checking Windshield Opening 4. Place protective covering over plenum grille, front
fenders and hood.
Due to the expanse and contour of the windshield it is 5. Smear caulking on windshield opening.
imperative in the event of a strain break that the wind 6 . Two men place windshield in position laying upper
shield opening be thoroughly checked before installing a angled corners in opening first and have assistant
replacement windshield. The replacement glass is used push from outside inward, while technician inside
as a template. cab pulls chalk line from under rubber channel
1. Check for the following conditions at the previous (fig. 1 1 ).
marked point of fracture. 7. Apply weatherstrip cement beneath outside lip of
a. Chipped edges on glass. weatherstripping.
b. Irregularities in body opening.
c. Irregularities in rubber channel weatherstrip.
2. Remove all sealer from flange and body around wind
shield opening.
3. Check flange area for solder, weld high spots, or
hardened spot-weld sealer. Remove all high spots.
4. Check windshield glass to opening, by supporting
glass with six spacers contained in packet J - 22577
(fig. 9).
CAUTION: Do not strike glass against body
metal. Chipped edges on the glass can lead to
future breaks.
5. With the windshield supported and centered in its
opening, check the relationship of the glass to the
body opening flange around the entire perimeter of
the glass.
6 . Check the relationship of glass to opening as follows:
a. Inside edge of glass to body flange. F ig . 11 - Pulling String to Seat Rubber Lip
Replacement
Removal of the entire assembly including door may be
accomplished by removing ten screws just inside box and
compartment lamp wire (if so equipped),, The door may
be removed, leaving the compartment intact, by removal
of four screws and bumper shown in Figure 13. Access
to the door stop bumper is gained by reaching up beneath
instrument panel.
Also shown in Figure 13 is the lock. Engagement of
lock in striker may be adjusted by loosening striker re
taining screws and moving the striker to desired position.
The lock cylinder may be serviced as outlined in Sec
tion 0, General Information and Lubrication.
Removal
The plenum chamber, located below the air inlet grille,
can be flushed out without having to remove the air inlet
grille from the cowl. However, if necessary air inlet
grille can be readily removed from cowl opening as
follows:
1. Remove windshield wiper arms from wiper pivot
shafts.
Replacement
Entire outlet valve assembly may be removed from the
vehicle by removing two screws and depress the pins.
Refer to Figure 16. Also refer to Figure 17 for disas
sembly of the flat face cowl air ventilator assembly.
Installation
WINDSHIELD WIPERS
COWL AIR VENTILATOR VALVE ASSEMBLY
Windshield wiper units on all models are of the two-
speed electric type. A single wiper motor unit, mounted
to center of cowl inside cab, power both wiper blades. 4. Before installing wiper arm s, operate wiper motor
The wiper blade operating link rods and pivot mountings momentarily which should rotate pivot shafts to park
on these models are located in the outside air inlet position. Install arms and shafts.
plenum chamber.
(NOTEl CHAIN
ASM. IS MARKED
WITH LETTER "L”
OR "R" FOR |
LH OR RH USAGE.
Wiper Arm Pivot Shafts and Link Rod (Fig. 18) STEPSIDE
Removal
1. Remove windshield wiper arms from pivot shafts.
Procedure for removing arms is explained previ
ously under "Arm Adjustments."
2. Remove screws which attach outside air cowl venti
lator grille to cowl. Carefully remove grille forward
from cowl.
VIEW B
3. At center of cowl, remove retainer (fig. 18) which
attaches each link rod to motor drive linkage and
arm assembly. Disengage link rods from pins.
4. Remove two screws which attach arm transmission
pivot shaft assembly to cowl. Remove pivot shaft
assembly with link rod from plenum chamber.
Installation
1. Place pivot shaft assembly with link rod into position
at cowl brapket. Secure assembly to bracket with
two screws (fig. 18).
2. Attach end of link rod to linkage of motor drive and
arm assembly at center of cowl. Secure rod with FLEETSIDE In o t e I in stall rods
retainer. If opposite pivot shaft and link rod was IN POSITION SHOWN
removed, install it at the same time.
3. Install outside air cowl ventilator grille to top of
cowl using screws (fig. 15). F ig . 19 - Endgates - Stepside and Fleetside
Stepside
Replacement
1. Unhook end gate chain assembly at each side.
2. Remove bolt and lockwasher from each trunnion in
ca rrie r box end gate shown in Figure 19.
3„ Remove end gate.
4. Reverse procedure for installation. Align slot in
trunnion to coincide with hole in end gate to permit
using a tool to hold trunnion while tightening nut
view "A" (fig. 19).
DOOR ASSEMBLY
Replacement
F ig . 20 - Door Hinge Bolt W rench J-22585
Remove the door assembly from the body by removing
the hinge from the door.
Adjustment
Door adjustment may be accomplished at two places; at
the hinge straps-to-door panel and at the hinge cage-to-
pillar. Before adjustment is made on any door, however,
the strik er plate should be removed. The door can be
moved fore, aft, up and down at the hinge pillar and the
door also can be moved in and out at the hinge-to-door
panel. However, in order to adjust the door assembly at
the body hinge pillar it is necessary to use special door
hinge bolt wrench Tool J - 22585. Move door as required
and tighten bolts.
The door should have a normal clearance of 5/32"
around the entire outer lip of door except at the bottom
Replacement
See door lock and regulator assembly (remote control),
in this same section for the door lock. Remove and re
place four bolts for replacing the striker plate at the
door lock pillar and adjust as required below. F ig . 21 - Striker Assembly on Body Lock P illa r
Adjustment
1. Position strik er assembly on body lock pillar so that
the rotor cover outer face on the door swings into the
striker assembly with . 1 0 clearance to the lock rotor
cover. Use special burred shims as required (fig. DOOR REAR
21 ). EDGE
load to hold the door in any position between full open and
closed. The front door check-hinge assembly is replaced
as a complete unit as follows:
Removal
Removal
Installation
NOTE: Replace the door window glass and
regulate to the full down position before install
ing the door ventilator assembly.
TURN 9 0
1. Lower the ventilator assembly into the door fram e--
center into position.
2. Make certain the rubber lip is positioned before Fig. 25 - V en tila to r Assembly Removal
tightening screws.
3. Attach the two screws below the regulator assembly.
VENTILATOR ASSEMBLY
ADJUSTING NUT
AND TAB LOCK
F ig . 24 - Vent Assembly Inner Door Panel Attachment F ig . 26 - Adjusting V en tila to r Operating Tension
Adjustment
1. Adjust the ventilator adjusting nut by turning clock
wise to increase operating tension (fig. 26).
2. After making adjustment bend tabs over the hex nut.
3. Install four (4) trim panel screws and trim panel.
4. Install door and window regulator handles.
F ig . 27 - Rubber Run Removal from Door F ig . 29 - Regulator Assembly & G lass (Side Door)
iNOTE;
STRIP WITH SALVAGE
JOINT TO B E " ,
INSTALLED SO THATj
JOINT FALLS IN §
VIEW A THIS AREA v I
Removal
1. Raise window.
2. Remove inside handles with Tool J-7797.
3. Remove trim panel.
4. Remove remote control sill knob.
5. From outside the door remove screws retaining lock
to door edge and lower the lock assembly.
6 . Remove 3 screws retaining remote control.
7. Remove lock, push button rod and remote control rod
as an assembly.
Installation
1. Transfer remote rod with clip to new lock. Fig. 33 - Lock C ylin d er Installed
2. Connect remote door handle rod to lock after lock is
positioned. Front Door Lock Remote Control and Connecting Rod
3. Secure lock screws.
4. Secure remote handle. The remote control is secured to the door inner panel
5. Check all controls for proper operation before rein by the three attaching bolts.
stalling trim and handles.
6 „ Install remote control sill knob.
Replacement
1. Using a pointed tool, raise one end of the weather
strip retainer until it is far enough out to take hold
of by hand. Then pull retainer out of its channel all
around the window.
2. From inside the cab, carefully push the window glass
out through the rear of the opening.
Fig . 36 - Installing Weatherstrip Insert with J-2189
NOTE: The weatherstrip may remain in the
window opening during removal of glass. To
remove weatherstrip, merely pull it off the
edges of the door panels. On installation of new
weatherstrip, clean opening edge thoroughly,
then install with butt ends (lightly coated with
weatherstrip adhesive) at top center of opening.
3. Inspect the inner and outer flanges making sure they
are true and that there are no irregularities around
the window opening. Any irregularities must be
corrected.
4. Assemble the weatherstrip to the opening making
sure the outer channel of weatherstrip is firmly
seated on the edges of the panel all around the
opening.
5. Start one end of the glass into its channel in the
weatherstrip. Using a pointed tool, follow around
the rear lip of the glass channel so it bears against
the rear surface of the glass (fig. 35).
Fig. 35 - Rear W indow W eatherstrip Installation Fig. 37 - Cutting W eatherstrip Insert at 4 5 ° Angle
J
BODY IB -16
6. Feed one end of the weatherstrip retainer into the assembly which is being cleaned should be thoroughly
handle of Tool J-2189 and out through the end which brushed and gone over lightly with the solvent.
spreads the weatherstrip channel.
7. Starting at the bottom center, insert the end of the CONVENTIONAL CAB
tool and end of retainer in channel, tapered part of
the retainer toward the glass. Seat Replacement
8 . While holding the tool firmly, with spreading end in
channel, follow around the channel spreading it open NOTE: Seat with slide adjusters and seat back
and feeding retainer into the opening until the full can be removed as a unit.
length of the retainer has been fed into the channel.
The ends of the two retainers should join at the bot 1. Remove four cap screws and washers which attach
tom of both sides (at a 45° angle) (fig. 37). each seat to cab floor (fig. 38).
2. Tilt seat back forward; then lift seat assembly from
NOTE: Care should be used in this operation cab.
not to chip the edge of the glass. A pointed 3. Seat adjuster can be removed from seat after disen
wooden tool, if available, should be used. gaging end of seat return spring and locking remove
rod and four cap screws and washers attaching ad
SEATS justers to seat.
4. Install seat adjusters to seat finger tight with eight
CLEANING SOFT TRIM -A LL MODELS attaching cap screws and washers.
Service
Torsion Bar
Installation
1. Insert torsion bar set (No. 27) in tube being sure
that bars are engaged in retainer (No. 25) inside
tube at left hand side of seat.
2. Replace right hand side panel assembly (No. 29) with
yoke (No. 26) held in position inside housing on side
panel. Engage yoke (No. 26) on free end of torsion
bar set (No. 27).
3. Line up side panels right hand and left hand retaining
the 2 0 " dimension over side panels.
4. Reassemble seat cushion moving from front of seat
toward rear in order to engage rubber rollers (No.
45) properly in housing under seat cushion.
5. Reassemble back cushion.
6 . Replace preload adjuster assembly being sure that
Nos. 38 through 41 are in their proper positions.
Engage yoke (No. 26) hooked ends over lugs on ad
juster pin (No. 40).
7. Preload torsion bars by rotating adjuster lever as
sembly (No. 30) clockwise (figs. 41 and 43).
F ig . 40 - Ride Level Indicator 8 . Remove wood shims.
1. Base Assy. , w/Bearings 22. Shock Absorber Assy. , w/Bearings 43. Knob (Plastic)
2. O uter Lever Assy. , w/Pins and Bearings 23. Bearing K it (Shock Absorber) 44. Thrust Washer
3. Bearing, Flanged 24. Bearing, Flanged 45. Roller and Bearing Assy. , (Rubber)
4. Pin-D rive 25. Retainer (T-Bar) 46. W asher, P la in , 5/16 SA E , Z in c Plated
5. C enter Lever Assy. 26. Yoke (Adjuster) 47. Lock Washer, 5/16 SAE M ed. , Z in c Plated
6. Bearing, Housing, L. H. 27. Torsion Bar Set (2 Bars per Set) 48. N u t, Hex. 5/16-18 (U N C - 2 B ) Z in c Plated
7. Bearing, Housing, R. H. 28. Side Panel Assy. , L. H. 49. Bumper (Topping)
8. Roller and Bearing Assy. 29. Side Panel Assy. , R. H. 50. Seat Adjuster, R. H.
9. Stud 30. Adjuster Screw and Lever Assy. 51. Seat Adjuster, L. H.
10. Snap Ring 31. G ear 52. Cap Screw , 5/16-18 x 5/8 Lg. ,
11. Washer, Plain 32. Adjuster Screw F illis te r—Ph iIIips Z in c Plated
12. Lockwasher, 3/8 SA E Med. 33. Lever Assy. 53. Bumper (Bottom)
13. N u t, Hex. 3/8-16 (U N C - 2 B ) 34. Washer 54. Seat Cushion Assy.
14. Bearing, Flanged 35. Spring (Tension) 55. C over Assy. , Seat Cushion
15. W asher, P lain 7 G a . x 17/32 x 7/8 36. Acorn N u t (S e lf Locking) 56. Pad, Seat Cushion
16. Shock Lever Assy. K it 37. Pin , Drive 57. Back Cushion Assy.
17. Shock Lever Assy. 38. W asher, Plain C over Assy. , Back Cushion
18. Hinge Shaft, Shock 39. Thrust Ball Bearing Pad, Back Cushion
19. Hinge Shaft, Shock, Rear 40. Adjuster Pin 58. Universal Riser K it
20. Roll Pin 41. W asher, Plain 5/16 Thick x 11/16 x 1-1/4 59. Fastener C lip , Cushion
21. Shock Absorber Assy. K it 42. Lub. Fittings (3/32 Shank) 60. Ride Level Indicator
Refer to Fig. 41
Shock Absorber
Removal
1. Wedge upper seat in top position following operation
1 , torsion bar removal.
2. Remove preload on torsion bars following procedure
sim ilar to operation 2, torsion bar removal. Do not
disengage adjuster assembly.
3. Remove seat cushion following operation 4, torsion
bar removal.
4. Wire side panel assemblies (Nos. 28 and 29) across
front of seat to retain their position (19-3/4" from
outer surface to outer surface).
5. Remove (2) snap rings (No. 10) from ends of hinge
shaft (No. 18) at front of shock absorber.
6 . Remove hinge shaft (No. 18) by tapping out from left
hand to right hand side. This operation frees (2)
washers (No. 15).
Fig. 43 - Adjuster Lever 7. Remove (2) roll pins (No. 20) from hinge shaft at
Installation
1. With shock absorber (No. 22) in proper position,
replace hinge shaft (No. 19) at rear of shock. (Also
see fig. 44.)
2. Replace (2) roll pins (No. 20) in hinge shaft, locking
roll pin on right hand side in nibs in bent-up ear.
3. Replace hinge shaft (No. 18) at front of shock ab
sorber, driving shaft from right hand to left hand
side. Serrated end of shaft to enter shock lever
(No. 17) last. Drive shaft through (2) washers (No.
15) and through shock absorber loop.
4. Replace (2) snap rings (No. 10) at ends of front hinge
shaft (No. 18).
5. Line up side panels right hand and left hand retaining
the 19-3/4" dimension over side panels.
6 . Reassemble seat cushion following operation 4—
torsion bar installation.
7. Preload torsion bars by rotating adjuster lever as
sembly (No. 30) clockwise.
8 . Remove shims.
Lubrication
Lubrication fittings are shown in Figure 45. Level ride
seat should be lubricated whenever vehicle is lubricated.
SPECIAL TOOLS
CHEVY VAN-BODY-SPORTVAN
INDEX
Page Page
General Description......................................................... IB-20 Dash M a t ..................................................................... I B - 23
Body and F r a m e ......................................................... IB-20 Doors .............................................................................. IB-23
Front End Panel ................................................... IB-20 Front Side Doors ...................................................... IB-23
Side Panels ......................................................... IB-21 Trim Panel and Hardware .................................... IB-23
Roof Panel ............................................................ IB-21 Window G l a s s ......................................................... IB-23
Underbody............................................................... IB-21 Lock Striker ......................................................... IB-24
Sealing .................................................................. IB-21 Rear and Side Cargo Doors ....................................... IB-24
Service O p e ra tio n s ......................................................... IB-21 Rear Door Lock, Rod Assembly and Inside
Windshield G la s s ......................................................... IB-21 H a n d le .................................................................. IB-24
Side W in d o w ............................................................... IB-21 Rear Door Outside Handle and L o c k ..................... I B - 24
Windshield W ip e r s ...................................................... IB-21 Hinge S t r a p ............................................................ IB-24
Outside Rear View M irrors ........................................ IB-22 Hinge S to p ............................................................... IB-24
Instrument Panel Com partm ent................................. IB-22 Hinge Adjustm ent................................................... I B - 25
Step Assembly - Side D o o r ............................................. IB-25
Seats .............................................................................. I B - 25
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
BODY AND FRAME FRONT END PANEL
The "Chevy Van" has an integral body and frame. The The front end panel assembly consists of a plenum
unitized body consists of heavy gauge welded main struc panel assembly, instrument panel assembly, and support
tural members with an underbody of longitudinal box ing pieces welded to the hinge pillar and front end panel.
section side rails and crossmembers which form the A partial front end panel is available for service; also the
integral frame. All outer panels are welded to a flat plenum and instrument panel as separate items for
floor. replacement.
SIDE PANELS
ROOF PANEL
UNDERBODY
SERVICE OPERATIONS
WINDSHIELD GLASS 3. Weatherstrip—Inner or Outer:
The Conventional Cab Windshield Service Procedure Removal of the window frame is necessary for
applies to the Chevy Van. Further information are the weatherstrip replacement.
six 5742-01 spacers used for windshield opening checking. SIDE AND REAR STATIONARY GLASS
Conventional windshield installation is expanded to in See Rear Window Weatherstrip—Conventional Cab
clude: WINDSHIELD WIPERS
Apply a minimum of 1/32" thickness of sealer between A single wiper motor unit, mounted off center in the
the glass and the outer wall of weatherstrip completely plenum chamber, powers both wiper blades. The wiper
around the perim eter of glass. blade operating link rods and pivot mountings on these
Apply medium bodied sealer to the flat of the wind models are located on the outside air inlet plenum
shield opening rabbet along the entire length of the pillar chamber. Wiper motor is controlled by switch marked
side and extending for approximately 5 inches beyond the
upper and lower corner.
Apply medium bodied sealer to the base of the weather
strip rabbet channel along the entire perimeter of the
weatherstrip.
Fig. 49 - Heater Duct and Distributor Removal Fig. 50 - Windshield W iper Linkage Removal (T y p ica l)
DOORS
FRONT SIDE DOOR (Fig. 53)
Trim Panel and Hardware (Fig. 54)
Removal
1. Remove window regulator handle and washer by
loosening set screw and pulling from shaft.
2. Remove inside door handle and washer by loosening
Fig. 51 - Instrument Panel Compartment w/Door set screw and pulling from shaft.
3. Remove trim panel-to-door inner panel screws and
Installation remove trim panel.
4. Remove arm rest by removing two screws.
1. Slide the compartment into position and loosely in
Installation
stall the six screws.
1. Install arm rest and attaching screws to trim panel.
2. Position the compartment and tighten all screws. 2. Align holes in trim panel with holes in door inner
panel.
3. Place door in opening so hinge holes are aligned, 3. Install washer on shaft and with end of door inner
loosely install hinge screws and insert check rod in handle pointing forward, align serrations in both
hole at side of compartment. handles with shaft serrations and install set screws.
Window Glass
4. Adjust door for fit in the opening and tighten screws.
Fig. 58 - Front Side Door W ind o w Replacement Fig. 60 - Forward Side Load Door - Sport Van
SEATS
REINFORCEMENT..: f DRIVERS (Fig. 65) AND FIXED AUXILIARY (Fig. 66)
ASSEMBLY 1
1. Remove four bolts and lock washers and remove seat
RETAINER ESCUTCHEON, assembly complete from vehicle. Install seat by re
/ SPRING RC D versing procedure and torquing the bolts se 'urely to
SEMBLIES, the floor with lock washers.
1 < / / BUMPER B C D __ 1
SEAT BACK ADJUSTMENT (Fig. 67)
LOWER Replacement
GASKET The seat back is adjustable forward or backward by
loosening the top bolts (right and left side) at the lower
HANDLE - side of the seat back.
I
GASKET y \ \
ASSEMBLY
(
SPACER LOCK
OPTIONAL (FLIP-PASSENGER SEAT)
(Figs. 68 & 69)
LOCK / \
CYLINDER \ ...>> keplacement
RETAINER LOCK U N IT ^ > Remove the auxiliary seat assembly complete by re
tK *£ moving four bolts, lock washers and nuts from the seat
I j
swivel base. The seat assembly may be removed with
Fig 61 - Rear Door Outside Handle out base by lifting up and slipping off of the base. Refer
to Figure 69.
4. Connect rod through step lever with removed spring
washer and cotter pin.
5. Secure rod cover with 4 screws.
6 . Push pin through rod end and door.
7. Check door-step operation.
For adjustment, turn rod end counter-clockwise to
lengthen actuating rod; turn clockwise to shorten rod
(retract) step.
8 . From underside tighten 2 inboard bolts.
STORED!
Fig. 67 - Driver and A u x ilia ry Seat Back Adjustment CENTER AND REAR SEAT-SPORTVAN (Fig. 70)
The center and rear seat assemblies of the Sportvan
are optional equipment. The seats may be faced forward
or rearward.
Fig. 68 - Flip Swing Passenger Seat Fig. 70 - Center or Rear Seat - Sportvan
STEP-VAN BODY
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip t io n ...................................................... IB-29 P10 ..................................................................... I B -31
Service O perations...................................................... IB-30 Doors ..................................................................... I B -32
Front E n d ..................................................................... IB-30 Door A djustm ents................................................ IB-32
Windshield and Front Quarter G l a s s ..................... IB-30 Sliding Door Replacem ent.................................... IB-32
Access Doors and C o v e r s ....................................... IB-30 Window G l a s s ...................................................... IB-33
P-20-30 IB-30 Special T o o ls .................................................................. I B -36
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The following information deals with servicing proce
dures on P10, 20 and 30 Step-Van trucks. Items not under Conventional Body. Write-ups may be used on all
covered herein may be serviced as outlined in this section Step-Vans unless otherwise stated.
V/////7 / I I II I I ' \ \ \ V V
71 - P20 and 30 Access Doors and Panels
A. G lo v e Box. 2. To Carburetor.
B. Access Door to Radiator F ille r Cap. 3. To Block Drain Cock.
C. Tool Box. 4. To Dimmer Sw itch Wires.
D. Battery Access Door for Servicing or Removing. 5. To Choke and Throttle Connections to Carburetor
E. Access Door to H yd rau lic Band Adjusting Screws on Automatic 6. To Driver's Seat Bolts.
Transmission W here A p p lica b le . 7. To Vacuum W ip er Connection at Intake M anifold.
F. Removable Floor Pla te G iv e s Access As Follows: G Engine Box Lid.
1. To M ain Brake C ylin d er. H, Right Hand W indshield W ip er Inspection Plate.
A. G lo v e Box and W indshield W ip er Pivot Shaft Access. E. Switch - H eater Motor 2-Speed.
B. Access W indshield W ip e r Motor. F. Control - Fresh A ir Inlet to Heater.
C. Control Knob - W ind shield W ip er Switch. G. Access to V o ltag e Regulator and Horn Relay.
D. W indshield Defroster Diffusers. H. Engine Box Lid.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
FRONT END
P-20 and 30
WINDSHIELD AND FRONT QUARTER GLASS
Letters and numbers refer to figure 71 (F -l).
Both windshield and front quarter glass are retained in
body opening by wedge-type weatherstrip such as that Main Brake Cylinder
used on Conventional Cab rear window. To remove the floor plate in front of driver’ s seat,
release catch in stepwell, lift plate and pull out. This
ACCESS DOORS AND COVERS gives access to main brake cylinder.
M A IN
C YLIN D ER
ifgjPif
glass in front of driver to gain access to main brake 2. Pivot assemblies service through openings on each
cylinder. Figure 73. side of wiper motor.
3. Wiper switch (C) is mounted in front end header
Battery accessible through left side opening (A).
Release catch and open the lid of the engine housing (H) 4. Circuit breaker for wiper motor is located on fire
to service or remove the battery. wall directly above clutch pedal.
SLIDING DOOR
Replacement
1. Remove the inside header panel over the door open
ing.
2. Remove the upper panel on the door pocket just to the
rear of the above panel. Note the special washer
between the pivot bearing and top of mounting bracket.
3. Remove the nut and lockwasher from the bolt that Fig. 77 - W eatherstrip Installed
Replacement
1. Using a pointed tool, raise one end of the weather
strip filler until it is far enough out to take hold of
by hand. Then pull filler out of its channel all
around the window.
Fig. 80 - Tapping Stationary G lass into Weatherstrip 2. Using a pointed tool, raise one end of heavy rubber
wedge in front of stationary g lass, until it can be
8 . Install heavy rubber wedge between run channel and grasped by hand. Pull entire wedge off its channel.
inside edge of weatherstrip from front edge of 3. Pull stationary rear glass forward until it is out of
stationary glass at top around to front edge at bot rubber at the rear.
tom. The round edge enters the rubber and the 4. Using special wire hook, furnished with Body Wea-
ribbed side goes next to the run channel. therstripping Tool Set (J-2189) or sim ilar tool, work
9. Install center weatherstrip on front edge of sta top of glass out of rubber and lift out of window.
tionary glass with plush side next to sliding glass. 5. If sliding glass is still intact, slide glass back until
Apply 3-M Weatherstrip Adhesive or its equivalent front edge at top is back of joint in weatherstrip
to the inside of this channel before installing. Push rubber. Using the paint scraper or sim ilar object,
ing each end of weatherstrip on before pushing up the slip blade between channel and glass at top. Lift
center will eliminate the ends catching in the rubber up on scraper to work glass out of channel.
and give it a crowding effect at top and bottom for 6 . If sliding glass is already out and there is no dam
tighter seal. age to the weatherstrip rubber or the glass run
10. Feed one end of weatherstrip filler into handle of channel then you are ready to install a new sliding
special tool J-2189 and out through the end which glass.
spreads the weatherstrip channel. 7. To install the sliding glass follow the instructions
11. Starting at bottom center, insert the end of the tool and illustrations under "Complete Driver’s Window
and end of filler in channel, tapered part of the filler Installation." Begin with operation 3 and continue
toward the glass. through operation 12. Continue through to operation
12. While holding the tool firmly, with spreading end in 15 if new weatherstrip has been used.
channel, follow around the channel spreading it open
and feeding the filler into the opening around the en DRIVER’S WINDOW STATIONARY GLASS
tire weatherstrip. With the flat side of common
screw driver placed against the starting end of the Replacement
insert filler drive filler back an inch or two. Cut 1. Follow operations 1 through 4 under Driver's Window
off the other end to make snug joint and work into Sliding Glass Replacement. If glass is completely
channel. This prevents separation at joint after gone and there is no further damage to the window,
window has been in service. operations 1 and 2 will prepare the window for sta
13. The run channel at front of window should be opened tionary glass replacement.
2. To install the new glass follow the instruction set weight motor oil on the outside of the Everseal and
forth for "Complete Driver's Window Installation." press latch onto the glass. If it is necessary to use
Begin with operation 4 and continue through opera mallet or hammer to position latch, tap lightly. Too
tion 1 2 . hard a blow could chip or break glass or cause the
clip to open up slightly thus reducing the grip on
DRIVER’S WINDOW THUMB PULL AND glass. The Everseal should be allowed to setup a
LOCKING DEVICE few hours before too much pressure is applied to it.
Installation
1. Attach driver's window thumb pull and latch assem SPECIAL TOOLS
bly to glass using .040 x 2 -1 /4 " Everseal glass glaz
ing strip. Center the latch on leading edge of glass. A complete listing of special tools may be found at the
Fold the Everseal over edge of glass, apply No. 30 end of Section One.
TILT CAB
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip t io n ...................................................... IB-36 Body V entilation...................................................... I B -44
Service O p eratio n s......................................................... IB-37 Windshield W ip e r s ................................................... I B -45
Body Shell..................................................................... IB-37 Emblem Assembly and Front Access Panel . . . . IB-45
Cab Mounting............................................................ I B -37 Instrument Panel Com partm ent.............................. I B -45
Cab A s s e m b ly ......................................................... IB-38 Doors ........................................................................... IB-46
R e m o v a l................................................ .................. I B -3 8 A dju stm en ts............................................................ I B -46
Installation............................................................... IB-38 Door Assembly Removal and Installation............... IB-48
Tilting M echanism ................................................... I B -40 Window R e g u la t o r ................................................... I B -49
O p e r a t io n ............................................................ IB-40 Lock Striker P l a t e s ................................................ I B -49
Adjustment ......................................................... I B -40 Remote Control M echan ism .................................... IB-49
Torsion B a r ......................................................... I B -40 Door Window Glass ................................................ I B -49
Cab Rear Hold-Down and Safety Hook Assembly . . IB-41 Vent G l a s s ............................................................... IB-50
Cab In su la tio n ......................................................... IB-42 W eatherstrip............................................................ IB-52
Front End.................................................................. IB-42 Rear Quarter W i n d o w ........................... ..................... IB-54
Windshield Glass ................................................... IB-42 Rear Glass W i n d o w ................................................ IB-54
R e m o v a l............................................................... IB-42 S e a t s ........................................................................... IB-54
Checking Windshield Body O p en in g..................... IB-44 Standard Seat ......................................................... IB-54
Installation ......................................................... IB-44 Auxiliary S e a t ......................................................... IB-54
Rear View M i r r o r ................................................... I B -44 Special T o o l s .................................................................. IB-56
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
SAFETY CATCH
CHECK LINK
SAFETY CATCH
RELEASE ROD
SERVICE OPERATIONS
BODY SHELL which limits the distance cab can be tilted forward and
automatically locks the cab in the full-tilt position. Check
CAB MOUNTING link must be released before cab can be returned to nor
mal operation position.
Cab is three-point mounted with two pivot-type mount Interconnected with the cab front mountings is a torsion
ings at front and twin cushion-type mountings at rear. bar which is under load when cab is in either the operat
Refer to Figures 83 and 84 for views of mountings. ing or full-tilted position. Right end of bar is anchored
Attaching bolts at front pivot mountings should be to cab bracket and left end is anchored to frame bracket
checked at regular intervals for tightness. Loose mount as shown.
ings will allow shifting of cab and eventual failure of Bar is free when cab is tilted part way, therefore, tor
other items connecting cab to chassis. Front pivot sion bar assists operator in both the raising and lowering
mountings have fittings for lubrication purposes. of cab.
Rear mounting has positive locking mechanism to re CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the
tain cab in normal operating position in relation to chas bolts which attach torsion bar right anchor
sis frame. The rear mounting also includes an additional bracket to cab and the torsion bar left anchor
safety catch. bracket to frame be removed when cab is in op
Cab hold-down catch shaft is equipped with a lubrica erating, or full tilt positions which is when bar
tion fitting. is loaded. An iniury could result when anchor
A check link is provided near the right front mounting bracket becomes free and torsion bar twist is
LUBRICATIO N
FITTING
SAFETY
CATCH
T O R S IO N BAR
C A B REAR M O U N T IN G
C U S H IO N S CATCH
RELEA SE ROD RIGHT FRAME LEFT FRAME
SU PPO RT SUPPO RT
BRACKET BRACKET
SAFETY
CH A IN
C H ECK LINK
A N D RELEASE ROD
RELEASE
ROD LEVER
PADDED
C H A IN FALL LIFTING SLIN G
CHECK
LINK
LEFT C A B \
SU P P O R T ,
BRACKET
Fig. 87 - A lign in g Bracket Bolt Holes Fig. 89 - Right Hand Support Bracket and Check Link Fastenings
To Lower Cab
(Refer to Figure 91)
NOTE: Before lowering cab to operating posi
tion, make sure transmission shift lever is in
neutral position and hand brake lever is in the
applied position.
1. Release check link at right front mounting (see inset
view) by pulling rearward on link release rod then
pull cab back to operating position.
2. Safety catch at rear of cab will automatically become Fig. 91 - T ilt Cab Latch Mechanism
BUMPER
VIEW A
1. Body Bracket Support— O uter 6. Body Bracket Cap 11. Frame Support Bracket C ap—R. H.
2. Body Bracket Support— Inner 7. Lube Fitting 12. Stop Bracket Assembly— R. H .
3. Stop Bracket Assembly— Left Hand 8. Adjusting Lever 13. Clamp Bolt— Body Bracket—R. H.
4. Body Bracket—Left Hand 9. Torsion Bar 14. Body Bracket—R. H.
5. Frame Support Bracket Assembly— L. H. 10. Frame Support Bracket Assembly— R. H.
4. Remove two bolts retaining cap to right hand frame as possible; secure lever with bolt and nut torqued
support bracket. to 130-180 ft. lbs.
5. Slide torsion bar toward left side of vehicle and out 4. Install right hand body bracket clamp bolt and torque
of support brackets. to 65-75 ft. lbs.
5. Lubricate fittings on right hand frame bracket and
Installation left hand body bracket and tilt the cab several times.
Before replacement of torsion bar, inspect frame 6 . Move adjusting lever to required position following
brackets and cab support brackets for cracks. Do not instructions elsewhere in this section.
weld or braze brackets. If cracked, replace. 7. Recheck torque of right hand body bracket clamp bolt
New torsion bars should be handled carefully so as to (65-75 ft. lbs.).
avoid nicking surface. Never hammer on a new bar dur
ing installation. If entry into right hand body bracket is CAB REAR HOLD-DOWN AND SAFETY
difficult, open clamp with pry bar. Lubricate right hand LOCK ASSEMBLY
hex of bar with chassis grease and proceed as follows:
1. Insert bar through left hand frame support bracket Proper adjustment and lubrication of the hold-down as
and into right hand body bracket. sembly is of prime importance. Periodic inspection of
2. Install caps on right hand frame support bracket and the condition and operation of the latch should be made
left hand body bracket; torque bolts to 50-60 ft. lbs. whenever the vehicle is lubricated. Details of hold-down
3. Coat inside of adjusting lever hex with chassis assembly mechanism may be seen in Figure 93. Note that
grease and install lever over end of bar with small the length of the control handle connecting rod must be
hole in lever as near center of slot in frame bracket adjusted to 22-7/8" from center of hole in clevis to cen
BODY VENTILATION
Outside air enters cab through a vent (fig. 97) directly
in front of driver and through the outside air heating sys
tem. Air entry is made through a louvered, removable
panel, located in center of front end just above grille
opening. Air flows through plenum chamber between
outer and inner cab paneling and is dispersed to heater
or vent outlet as desired.
Figure 98 illustrates construction of fresh air ventilat
ing assembly. For ease of operation, the spring, rod and
tube shown in View "A" should be lubricated with machine
or light motor oil whenever vehicle is lubricated.
IN S T A L L IN G IN S E R T IN S E A L
Installation
1. If necessary, pull rubber seal from glass opening,
then examine opening flanges for irregular surface
which could cause glass breakage. Straighten flanges
if necessary.
2. Reposition rubber seal on flange. Raise new glass
to outside of seal, then with hook end of installer
Tool (J-2189) in glass groove of seal as shown in
Figure 95 move tool around glass to force outer lip
INTERIOR VENT
AND CONTROL
WINDSHIELD WIPERS vehicle only. Repair of wiper motors, etc. will be found
in Section 12, Electrical. Figure 99 is an exploded view
Two separate motors are used to power the wipers on of the left hand wiper assembly installation. Right hand
Tilt Cab Trucks, one switch controlling both. Covered assembly is identical; however it will be necessary to
here will be removal and installation of the units on the remove heater assembly before wiper motor may be
serviced.
Removal
1. Remove positive cable from battery terminal.
2. Remove nut retaining wiper onto shaft.
3. Pull arm, knurled driver and rain shield from shaft.
4. Remove nut retaining shaft ferrule to body outer
panel; remove washers.
5. From inside vehicle, remove four screws retaining
motor assembly to dash and remove assembly from
vehicle.
Installation
Install by following removal procedure in reverse
order. After connecting battery, test operation of wipers
thoroughly.
ADJUSTMENTS
To Reposition Door Up or Down NOTE: Access to one cap screw at door upper
hinge is gained after removing plug from door
NOTE: Door raised adjustment is limited by a inner panel. Use pointed tool to remove plug.
striker at top rear of door (View A, fig. 102).
The striker support at cab is mounted over a b. After satisfactory adjustment has been obtained,
shim which will usually provide the proper tighten hinge cap screws firmly. Open and close
clearance at top of door; however, shim can be door to check operation. If necessary, repeat
removed or another added as desired. adjustment. Install hinge cap screw access plug
in door inner panel after making final adjustment.
a. Loosen hinge-to-door cap screws slightly. Re c. Install striker plate assembly on cab lock pillar
position door on hinges to provide equal clearance as directed under "Striker Plate Adjustment."
around perimeter of door in cab opening.
...... ~
C O W L HALF 5 STRIKER
a .,,..— ,,,,,..
A D JU S T M E N T
V IE W A — D O O R UPPER SU PPO R T V IE W B — D O O R U P P E R H IN G E V IE W C— D O O R U P P E R ST R IK ER
D O O R HALF
A D JU S T M E N T STRIKER
V IE W F— LO C K ST R IK ER P LA T E
AND L O W E R ST R IK ER S U P P O R T V IE W E— D O O R L O W E R H IN G E V IE W D— D O O R L O W E R ST R IK ER
To Reposition Door Fore or Aft c. After adjustment has been made, tighten hinge cap
screws firmly. Open and close door to check
NOTE: Only the upper portion of door can be operation. Readjust if necessary.
adjusted fore or aft. This adjustment is made
NOTE: It may be necessary to reposition door
at the upper hinge. No means for this adjust
striker plate on lock pillar after making above
ment exists at the lower hinge.
adjustment.
a. Loosen upper hinge-to-door cap screws slightly. Door Lock Striker Plate
NOTE: Access to one cap screw at door upper Raised beads on the back of the striker plate and se r
hinge is gained after removing plug from door rations on both the front and back of the striker plate
inner panel. Use pointed tool to remove plug. spacers, coupled with movable anchor plates in the pillar,
allow for "in and out" or "up and down" adjustment for a
Lift upward or pull downward at rear of door to close fit of the door on the lock side.
tilt upper portion of door fore or aft as desired. The striker plate spacers must be assembled so the
b. Tighten hinge cap screws firmly after making ad vertical serrations on the spacer are toward the lock
justment. Open and close door to check opera pillar (fig. 104). Likewise, the horizontal serrations on
tion. Repeat adjustment if necessary. Install cap the lower spacer must be toward the front so they match
screw access plug in door inner paneling. the horizontal slot in the striker plate.
c. Install striker plate assembly to cab lock pillar
as directed under "Striker Plate Adjustment." A djustm ent
1. Position striker on pillar as low as possible (bottom
To Reposition Door In or Out of lock rotor housing 27/32" below striker cam) and
still provide clearance between striker cam and lock
NOTE: Horizontal cap screw slots exist in cab rotor leading edge.
half of hinge assembly to permit this adjustment.
NOTE: Striker cam must not interefere with
See Views B and E, Figure 102. «
leading edge of rotor as door is being closed.
The outer surface of door when properly installed Outline striker with a pencil. This will provide a
should be flush with adjacent panel surfaces of cab (fig. base from which to make further adjustment.
103). If necessary, reposition door as follows:
a. Loosen slightly, all cap screws which attach hinge DOOR ASSEMBLY
half to cab pillar.
b. If door is to be brought outward from cab opening, Component sub-assemblies of cab doors, such as win
apply pressure at door hinge area from inside dow regulator, door lock, remote control, vent window,
cab. If door is to be moved inward, apply pres and door window, can be replaced without necessity of
sure on door outer panel at hinge area. removing door from cab. Doors can be removed, how
ever, without prior removal of above components. Re
IMPORTANT: Excessive pressure will damage moval and installation of door window glass is described
door paneling. under Door Window Glass.
1. Vent W indow Glass 6. W eatherstrip Seal C lip 11. Regulator Handle 16. Door Lock Mechanism
2. Division Channel and Screw 12. Division Channel Upper 17. Run Channel Retainer Screws
3. Access Panel 7. Weatherstrip Seal A ttaching Screws 18. Run Channel Retainer
4. Remote Control 8. Access Panel 13. Door W indow Sash 19. Door W indow Stop Bumper
H andle 9. Division Channel Lower 14. Sash Channel 20. W indow Regulator Assy.
5. Remote Control Attaching A ttaching Screws 15. Door Lock Remote Control 21. Division Channel Center
Screws 10. Regulator A ttaching Screws Assembly Attaching Screw
5. When installed, bottom of glass must be centered in binding exists, division channel attaching screws (9
glass regulator channel (fig. 109). P ress glass with and 2 1 ) should be loosened to allow channel to shift
filler into channel until firmly seated. for free operation of window. Retighten screws after
6 . Position glass assembly into opening at bottom of making adjustment.
door (fig. 108) and engage edges of glass in door
10. Install access panel (8 ), to opening at bottom of door.
front and rear glass run channels.
7. Engage regulator arm pin in glass channel with DOOR VENT GLASS
leather washer located each side of channel as shown
NOTE: This procedure covers replacement of
in Figure 110. Install pin fastener (View B, fig. 106).
the vent glass only.
8 . Raise window, then referring to Figure 106, engage
lug of sash run channel into slot of run channel re Removal
tainer. Install two screws into holes (fig. 106) at 1. Remove small access panel from inner side of door
taching retainer to door edge framing. below vent window. Figure 111 shows access panel
9. Raise and lower door window to check for binding. If removed.
DOOR W IN D O W
A SSEM BLY
A C C E S S H O LE
T O P IV O T S C R E W
V EN T W IN D O W O UTER
SM O O TH S ID E OF FRA M E A N D RU BBER SEA L
SH ARP CO RN ER CHANNEL T H IS S ID E
D IV IS IO N C H A N N E L
FO R R IG H T DOOR
G LA SS A SSEM BLY FRA M E S C R E W
FLAT W A S H E R
BRA CKET TO P A N E L S C R E W
CH AN N EL C EN TERED
BETW EEN CO RN ERS
N Y L O N F R IC T IO N
OF G LA SS
B U S H IN G
BR A C K E T
mm
G L A Z IN G F R IC T IO N CLA M P
C LA M P SC REW
RUBBER
Fig. 109 - Door Window G lass Assembly Fig. I l l - Door Vent Window
IN S T A L L IN G G L A S S IN S E A L
G LA SS-
IN SER T
SEA L
PA N EL
T Y P IC A L
IN S T A L L IN G IN S E R T IN S E A L
Fig. 113 - Insert-Type Seat Fig. 115 - D river's Seat Adjuster Assembly
SPECIAL TOOLS
N A
mmm .«
i l l l
FRAME
INDEX
Page Page
General Description 10-60 Series T r u c k ........................ 2-1 Frame R epair..................................................................... 2-2
Frame Alignm ent............................................................... 2-1 W e ld in g ........................................................................... 2-2
Horizontal C h e c k ............................................................ 2-2 Bolting.............................................................................. 2-2
Vertical C h e c k ............................................................... 2-2 Frame Dimensions Drawings and Charts . . . 2-3 through 2-8
General Description - Chevy V a n .................................... 2-9
Underbody Alignment......................................................... 2-10
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Light duty 10-30 Series frames are of the ladder Vehicle Preparation
channel section riveted type. Heavy duty 40-60 Series Points to remember when preparing vehicle for frame
frames are of channel section design. checking:
1. Place vehicle on a level surface.
Figures 1 and 2 illustrate typical light and heavy duty 2. Inspect damaged areas for obvious frame misalign
frames with crossmembers, body mounts and suspension ment to eliminate unnecessary measuring.
attaching brackets. This section also included general 3. Support vehicle so that frame sidemembers are
instructions for checking frame alignment and recom parallel to the ground.
mendations on frame repair. Tramming Sequence
1. Dimensions to bolts and/or holes in frame extend to
dead center of the hole or bolt.
FRAME ALIGNMENT 2. Dimensions must be within 3/16".
3. If a tram bar is used, for horizontal alignment “ X ”
Horizontal frame checking can be made with tram - check from opposite and alternate reference points
ming gauges applied directly to the frame or by trans AA, BB and CC, as illustrated by the lines in Fig
ferring selected points of measurement from the frame ure 3. Error will result if a tram bar is not level
to the floor by means of a plum bob and using the floor and centered at the reference points.
layout for measuring. Figure 3 may be used as a gen 4. Obtain vertical dimensions and compare the differ
eral guide in the selection of checking points; however, ences between these dimensions with the dimensions
selection of these points is arbitrary depending on ac as shown in chart.
cessibility and convenience. An important point to r e
member is that for each point selected on one side of the
frame, a corresponding point on the opposite side of the
frame must be used for vertical checks, opposite and
alternate sides for horizontal checks.
FRAME CENTERLINE A
DIM ENSIONS TO HOLES OR SLOTS ARE MEASURED TO THE CENTER OF HOLE OR SLOT
GAUGE HOLES ARE % " DIAMETER
© IN D IC A T E S THAT THE DIM ENSIO N IS TO THE UNDERSIDE OF THE FRAME TOP SURFACE OR INSIDE
OF THE FRAME OUTER SURFACE.
FRAME
2-5
Fig. 6—40-60 Series Tandem A x le Truck Frames
J
•1
FRAME
2-6
CHEVROLET TRUCK
SERVICE MANUAL
Model A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S
CA107 9-3/8 11-7/8 13-1/4 16 10-1/4 7-1/8 10 9 15-1/2 12 11-3/8 13-3/8 43 70 127-3/4 14 16-7/8 19-1/8 16-7/8
CA109 9-3/8 11-7/8 13-3/8 16 10-1/4 7-5/8 10 9 15-1/2 12 11-3/8 13-3/8 43 82 134 14 16-7/8 19-1/8 16-7/8
CA209 9-3/8 11-7/8 13-3/8 16 10-1/4 7-1/8 10 9 15-1/2 12 11-3/8 13-3/8 43 82 134 14 16-7/8 19-1/8 16-7/8
CA310 9-3/8 11-7/8 12-3/4 16 7-1/2 - 10 10 15-1/8 - 10-1/4 13-3/8 49 90-3/8 158-1/4 14 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
CA314 9-3/8 11-7/8 12-3/4 16 7-1/2 6-1/8 10 8-3/8 17-1/8 14-1/4 14-1/4 17-1/8 49 90 180-1/2 14 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
KA107 9-3/8 11-7/8 13-3/8 16 10-1/4 7-1/8 10 9 14-5/8 12 10-3/4 13-3/8 43 70 127-3/4 14 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
KA109 9-3/8 11-7/8 13-3/8 16 10-1/4 7-1/8 10 9 15-1/2 12 10-3/4 13-3/8 43 82 139-3/4 14 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
^209
PA100 9-3/8 11-7/8 13-3/8 16 10-1/4 7-1/8 10 9 15-1/2 12 10-3/4 13-3/8 43 57 114-5/8 14 16-7/8 19-1/8 16-7/8
PA209 6-1/2 8-5/8 8-1/4 10 6-3/8 6-5/8 10 8-3/4 12-1/2 7-7/8 7-7/8 10 42-5/8 89-1/8 115-1/8 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
309
PA213 6-1/2 8-5/8 8-1/4 10 6-3/8 6-5/8 10 8-3/4 12-1/2 7-7/8 7-7/8 10 43-3/4 110-1/8 161 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
313
PA215 6-1/2 8-5/8 8-1/4 10 6-3/8 6-5/8 10 8-3/4 12-1/2 7-7/8 7-7/8 10 42-5/8 122-1/8 148-1/8 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8 16-7/8
315
Wheel
Model A B C D E F G H I J K L M N
base
CG5, 610 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 15-3/4 20 36 82-1/4 132 147-3/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 125-3/8
CG5, 612 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 94-1/4 144-1/2 169-7/8 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 137-3/8
CG5, 614 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 106-1/4 156 171-3/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 149-3/8
CG5, 617 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 127-1/4 177 218-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 167-3/8
CG5, 620 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 146-1/4 196 280-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 189-3/8
CG5, 623 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 160-1/4 210 285-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 203-3/8
SE520 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 146-1/4 196 280-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 189-3/8
SE525 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 174-3/4 224-1/2 299-3/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 217-7/8
SE5, 628 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 192-1/4 257-3/4 326-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 235-3/8
SE5, 631 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 210-3/4 260-1/2 344-3/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 253-7/8
SS414 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 36 106-1/4 156 171-3/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 149-3/8
PS414 15-3/4 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 45-1/2 106-1/2 156-1/4 185-1/2 16-1/4 16-3/4 16-3/4 157
PS421 15-3/4 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 17 20 45-1/2 124-1/2 174-1/4 215-1/2 16-1/4 16-3/4 16-3/4 175
Model A B C D E F G H I J K L M N Wheelbase
MS 5, 614 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 15-3/4 20 36 107-1/4 137-1/4 192-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 238-5/8
MS 5, 617 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 15-3/4 20 36 107-1/4 192-1/4 222-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 268-5/8
MS 5, 620 15-7/8 13-1/2 20 15-3/4 15-3/4 15-3/4 20 — 137-1/4 192-1/4 252-1/4 14-5/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 298-5/8
Wheel
Model A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R
base
TT. c
TD 14-1/2 11-3/4 13-1/8 14-1/8 16-7/8 15-3/4 20 15-3/4 17 20 15-3/8 62-1/2 112-1/4 141-1/2 33-1/2 26-3/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 97
T C 6 1 2
TT _
TD 14-1/2 11-3/4 13-1/8 14-1/8 16-7/8 15-3/4 20 15-3/4 17 20 15-3/8 74-1/2 124-1/4 156-3/8 33-1/2 26-3/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 109
™ 614
TT, ,
TD 14-1/2 11-3/4 13-1/8 14-1/8 16-7/8 15-3/4 20 15-3/4 17 20 15-3/8 98-1/2 148-1/4 177-1/2 33-1/2 26-3/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 133
TG618
TT/. c
TD ’ ’ 14-1/2 11-3/4 13-1/8 14-1/8 16-7/8 15-3/4 20 15-3/4 17 20 15-3/8 110-1/2 160-1/4 201-1/2 33-1/2 26-3/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 145
TG620
14-1/2 11-3/4 13-1/8 14-1/8 16-7/8 15-3/4 20 15-3/4 17 20 15-3/8 128-1/2 177-1/2 246-1/2 33-1/2 26-3/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 163
TG623
TT. _
TD ’ 14-1/2 11-3/4 13-1/8 14-1/8 16-7/8 15-3/4 20 15-3/4 17 20 15-3/8 140-1/2 190-1/4 257-1/2 33-1/2 26-3/8 16-3/4 16-3/4 175
TG625
UNDERBODY ALIGNMENT
One method of determining the alignment of the under of the reference locations is included in the misaligned
body is with a tram gauge which should be sufficiently area; then the parallel plane between the body and the
flexible to obtain all necessary measurements up to three tram bar may not prevail. After completion of the
quarters the length of the vehicle. A good tramming tool repairs, the tram gauge should be set at the specified
is essential for analyzing and determining the extent of dimension to check the accuracy of the repair operation.
collision misalignment present in underbody construction.
EXCESSIVE BODY DAMAGE
MEASURING (Fig. 8) If damage is so extensive that key locations are not
To measure the distance accurately between any two suitable as reference points, repair operations should
reference points on the underbody, two specifications always begin with the underbody area. All other com
are required. ponents should be aligned progressively from this area.
1. The horizontal dimension between the two points Unlike the conventional type of frame design, the unitized
to be trammed. type of body construction seldom develops the two con
2. The vertical dimension from the datum line to the ditions of “twist” and “ diamond” in the underbody area
points to be trammed. as a result of front or rear end collisions, therefore,
The tram bar should be on a parallel to that of the there usually is an undamaged area suitable as a begin
body plane. The exception to this would be when one ning reference point.
# ¥
SECTION 3
FRONT SUSPENSION
CONTENTS OF THIS SECTION
Page
Front Suspension ............................................................... 3-1
Four-Wheel D r i v e ............................................................... 3-24
FRONT SUSPENSION
INDEX
Page Page
General Description............................................................ 3-2 Installation ...................................................... .....3-12
Maintenance and Adjustments............................................. 3-4 Steering Knuckle/Steering A r m .............................. .....3-13
Wheel Bearings - A dju st................................................ 3-4 R e m o v a l............................................................ .....3-13
10 Series and Chevy V a n ..................... .................... 3-4 Installation......................................................... .....3-13
20-30 Series, I-Beam 40-60 S e r i e s ........................ 3-4 Crossmember and Suspension U n it ........................ .....3-13
I-Beam P20-30 S e r i e s ............................................. 3-4 R e m o v a l............................................................ .....3-13
I-Beam S59-T50-60 S e r i e s ....................................... 3-4 Installation ...................................................... .....3-14
Steering Stop Screw - Adjust ....................................... 3-4 I-Beam Suspension A s s e m b ly .................................... .....3-14
Front End Alignment ................................................... 3-4 Stabilizer - P20-30 ................................................ .....3-14
C a s te r......................................................................... 3-5 R e m o v a l............................................................ .....3-14
C a m b e r ..................................................................... 3-5 Installation ...................................................... .....3-14
Toe-In ..................................................................... 3-5 Chevy Van - Stabilizer - G10-20 ........................ .....3-14
Cornering Wheel R elatio n sh ip ................................. 3-7 R e m o v a l............................................................ .....3-14
Steering Axis or Kingpin Inclin ation........................ 3-7 Installation......................................................... .....3-14
Component Parts R eplacem ent.......................................... 3-8 Shock Absorbers ................................................... .....3-14
Wheel Hubs, Bearings, Drums .................................... 3-8 Spring .................................................................. .....3-15
Removal .................................................................. 3-8 G-K10 and 20 S e r ie s .......................................... .....3-15
Inspection.................................................................. 3-8 Rem oval......................................................... .....3-15
R e p a i r s ..................................................................... 3-8 Inspection............... ,...................................... .....3-15
Bearing Cups - R e p la c e ....................................... 3-8 R e p a i r s ......................................................... .....3-15
Wheel Hub and Brake D r u m ................................. 3-8 Bushing Replacement.................................... .....3-15
CP10 - Chevy V a n .......................................... 3-8 Shackle Replacem ent.................................... .....3-16
CP20-30 ......................................................... 3-8 Spring Leaf Replacem ent.............................. .....3-16
CLS40, C D L S T 5 0 ............................................. 3-8 Installation......................................................... .....3-16
T60, and SE 531................................................ 3-9 P20-30 .................................................................. .....3-16
In sta llatio n ............................................................... 3-9 R e m o v a l............................................................ .....3-16
Shock A b s o r b e r s ............................................................ 3-9 Repairs ............................................................ .....3-17
R em oval..................................................................... 3-9 Front Bushing ............................................. .....3-17
In sta llatio n ............................................................... 3-9 Rear B u s h in g ................................................ .....3-17
Coil Spring Suspension A s s e m b ly ................................. 3-9 Spring L e a f ................................................... .....3-17
Stabilizer - P 1 0 ......................................................... 3-9 Installation......................................................... .....3-17
R e m o v a l............................................................... 3-9 40-60 Series ......................................................... .....3-17
In sp ectio n ............................................................ 3-9 R e m o v a l............................................................ .....3-17
Installation............................................................ 3-10 R e p a irs ............................................................... .....3-18
Springs C-P10-C20 and 3 0 ....................................... 3-10 B u s h in g ......................................................... .....3-18
R e m o v a l............................................................... 3-10 Spring L e a f ................................................... .....3-18
Installation ......................................................... 3-10 Installation......................................................... .....3-18
Ball Joint In sp ectio n ................................................ 3-10 Steering K n u c k le ......................................................... .....3-19
Upper .................................................................. 3-10 Removal ............................................................... .....3-19
L o w e r .................................................................. 3-11 Inspection ............................................................... .....3-19
Lower Control Arm A s s e m b ly ................................. 3-11 R e p a i r s .................................................................. .....3-19
R e m o v a l............................................................... 3-11 Kingpin ............................................................ .....3-19
Repairs ............................................................... 3-11 B u s h in g s ............................................................ .....3-19
B u s h in g s ......................................................... 3-11 In s ta lla tio n ............................................................ .....3-19
Ball J o i n t s ...................................................... 3-11 I - B e a m ........................................................................ .....3-21
Installation ......................................................... 3-11 R em o val.................................................................. .....3-21
Upper Control Arm A s s e m b ly ................................. 3-12 R e p a i r s .................................................................. .....3-21
R e m o v a l............................................................... 3-12 Steering Knuckle and K in g p in ........................... .....3-21
Repairs ............................................................... 3-12 Axle Center ...................................................... .....3-21
B u s h in g s ......................................................... 3-12 In s ta lla tio n ............................................................ .....3-22
Ball J o in t......................................................... 3-12 Special T o o l s ............................................................... 1 3-22
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
UPPER
CONTROL ARM
FRONT HUB
AND BRAKE
DRUM
The Chevrolet Truck line incorporates two different crossmem ber with U-bolts. These control arms are
types of front suspension systems: Independent coil, and connected to the steering knuckle through pivoting ball
I-Beam axle with conventional leaf or tapered leaf joints. A coil spring is located between the lower control
springs (figs. 1, 2, 3). arm and a formed seat in the suspension crossmember,
The unequal length control arm coil spring independent thus the lower control arm is the load carrying member.
suspension is used on the forward control P-10 series The double acting shock absorbers are also attached to
and on conventional C -10-20-30 series (1/2, 3/4, and the lower control arms and connect with the frame to the
1-ton). This suspension consists of upper and lower con rear on the upper end. The forward control P-10 series
trol arms pivoting on steel threaded bushings on upper is equipped with a stabilizer bar connected to the lower
and lower control arm shafts which are attached to the control arm and transversely mounted to the frame side
SHOCK ABSORBER
SHACKLE
FRONT HANGAR
0
F ig . 2 - I-Beam Suspension P20-P30 F ig . 3 - I-Beam Suspension 4 0 , 50 and 60 Series
members. The front wheel bearings are tapered roller mounted stabilizer bar connected to the spring seat on the
type on the above models. axle, and ball front wheel bearings.
The I-Beam axles used on all 40-60 Series are of the The Chevy Van front suspension (fig. 4) incorporates
conventional reverse Elliott type, with solid kingpins and the ”I-Beam " type front axle; tapered leaf springs; and
delrin bushed steering knuckles. The springs are direct-acting hydraulic shock absorbers.
Chevrolet Vari-Rate, bushed at the front eye only and The "I-Beam " axle is of the conventional reverse
mounted to a rigid hanger. The rear end of the spring Elliott type, with spring and steering stop screw seats
rides in a special hanger designed to provide a relatively forged integral with the "I-Beam ". Constant diameter,
low spring rate at curb loads with increased rate at solid kingpins are used with the full-floating, "Delrin,"
higher loads. steering knuckle bushing. Front wheel spindles are cast
Front wheel bearings are tapered roller type on all integral with the steering knuckles; front wheel bearings
models. are tapered roller type.
Forward Control P20-30 I-beams incorporate conven The front spring assembly incorporates the berlin-type
tionally mounted sem i-elliptic springs, with a transverse spring eyes. The front eye is single-wrapped and has a
rubber insulated steel bushing through which the spring acting hydraulic shock absorbers.
is bolted to the spring front hanger. The rear eye is Service operation may be found at the back of this sec
shackle mounted through rubber bushings to the spring tion. Front axle differential will be found in Section 3
rear hanger. Truck Overhaul. The adapter and transfer case are cov
The K series "Four-Wheel Drive" vehicles incorporate ered in Section 7 Truck Overhaul.
a driving front axle, tapered leaf springs, and direct-
Camber
1. Determine vehicle camber angle on alignment
machine.
2. Measure dimension "A."
3. Using dimension "A" and the caster-cam ber chart
for the appropriate vehicle, shown below, find the
recommended camber angle.
4. If the angle in Step 1 does not correspond to the rec
ommended angle on the chart within ± 1 / 2 °, make
Fig . 6 - Stop Screw Adjustment necessary changes.
Shims may be changed at either front or rear to vary
top from a vertical position. Both angle adjustments are caster, or at both points equally to vary camber (fig. 1 0 ).
necessary for steering stability and safe vehicle handling.
I Beam Axle Models
Coil Spring Models On I beam axles, if camber angle does not fall within
On 10-30 Series coil spring models, caster and camber specified lim its, the axle center or steering knuckle is
adjustments are made by means of shims located betweer bent; if the axle center is bent, refer to Front Axle Re
the upper control arm shaft and the mounting bracket at pair later in this section; if the steering knuckle is dam
tached to the suspension crossmember. aged, replace as outlined under Steering Knuckle/Steering
A series of concave and convex spacers with flat oppo Arm later in this section. Caster angle is adjusted by
site sides are used. These spherical spacers allow a the use of tapered shims placed between the axle spring
positive cross-shaft-to-bracket attachment regardless of seat and spring. To increase caster, place thick end of
the number of caster/cam ber shims used. shim toward rear of vehicle; to decrease caster, place
Measure 10-30 Series caster and camber as follows thick end of shim toward front of vehicle.
(refer to Figure 8 ):
Toe-In
Caster
1. Measure frame angle ’B" at location shown in Fig- Toe-in is the amount in fractions of an inch that wheels
ure 8 . are closer together in front than at rear. Check steering
lb. axles, tie rod sockets should both be tilted in the same later in this section.
direction, forward or rearward, before tightening clamp
bolts (fig. 1 2 ). Steering Axis or Kingpin Inclination
Cornering Wheel Relationship Steering axis or kingpin inclination is the tilt of the
steering knuckle kingpin. If the inclination is not within
Cornering wheel relationship, or toe-out on turns is the specified lim its, the steering knuckle is bent and must
determined by the angle of the steering arms. If, when be replaced on IFS models; on I beam axle models, the
checking this angle, toe-out does not fall within specified axle center is bent and must be repaired as outlined un
lim its, it will be necessary to replace defective steering der Front Axle Repair later in this section.
arm as outlined under Steering Knuckle/Steering Arm
Repairs
F ig . 1 4 - Wheel Hub Bearing Cup Removal F ig . 1 5 - Installing Bearing Cup (Typ ica l)
Installation
Place shock absorber into position over mounting bolts
or into mounting brackets. Install eye bolts and nuts and
Fig . 1 6 - Pressing Hub Bolt torque as shown in Specifications, Section 15.
square with hub flange and securely seated. COIL SPRING SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY
3. Place drum, deflector gasket and deflector over hub,
indexing drain holes with holes in hub. Install drum Front Stabilizer Bar—P-10 Figure 18
to hub bolts and lockwashers and tighten securely.
Removal
T60 and SE531 —Figure 13 1. Raise vehicle and remove nuts and bolts attaching
1. Brake drum is either bolted or screwed to hub de stabilizer brackets and bushings at frame location.
pending on type of wheel used. In either case, re 2. Remove brackets and bushings at lower control arms
move screws or bolts and separate hub and drum. and remove stabilizer from vehicle.
2. If necessary to replace hub bolts, press out old bolts
and press new serrated bolts into position, making Inspection
sure bolt head is square with hub flange and securely Inspect rubber bushings for excessive wear or aging -
seated. Install bolts or screws into hub and tighten replace where necessary. Use rubber lubricant when
securely. installing bushings over stabilizer bar.
Installation
1. Pack inner and outer wheel bearings with recom
mended grease (see Section 0).
2. Place inner bearing in hub and install new seal as
sembly (or assem blies), tapping into place with soft
hammer.
3. Position hub on spindle and install outer bearing,
pressing it firmly into position in hub.
4. Adjust wheel bearings as outlined under Wheel Bear
ings-Adjust.
Shock Absorbers—Figure 17
Removal
1. Remove nuts and eye bolts securing upper and lower
shock absorber eyes.
Back Nut Up To
End of Threads I
Lower
Lower ball joints are a loose fit when not connected to
the steering knuckle. Wear may be checked without dis
assembling the ball stud, as follows:
1. Support weight of control arms at wheel hub and
drum.
2. Measure distance between tip of ball stud and tip of
grease fitting below ball joint (fig. 2 0 ).
3. Move support to control arm to allow wheel hub and
drum to hang free. Measure distance as in Step 2.
If the difference in measurements exceeds .094"
(3/32") for all models, ball joint is worn and should
be replaced.
Repairs
Fig. 22 - Positioning Lower Control Arm Shaft
Bushings
1. Remove grease fittings from bushing outer ends and 2. Place control arm over remover support and, with
unscrew bushings from control arm and shaft appropriate remover, press out ball joint (fig. 24).
(fig. 2 1 ). 3. Invert arm and place on installer support at ball
2. Slide new seal on each end of shaft and insert shaft joint area.
into control arm. 4. P ress new ball joint assembly into arm. If press
3. Start new bushings on shaft and into control arm. ram diameter is large enough to cover OD of ball
Adjust shaft until it is centered in control arm, then joint assembly, press joint into arm with ram in di
turn bushings in and torque to specifications. Figure rect contact. If ram is sm aller, use metal tube or
22 shows correct final positioning of shaft. Check block (fig. 25). Make sure ball joint assembly is
shaft for free rotation and install grease fittings. fully seated and square with arm.
17
2"
h-------27/ . " -
,1
INSTALLER SUPPORT CP 10, C20-30 REMOVER C20-30
ITl %"
,1
I----- 2 V *" -----H
I-1 Vi"-J
REMOVER SUPPORT CP10, C20-30 REMOVER CP10
REMOVER—INSTALLER TOOLS
Repairs
Bushings
1. Remove grease fittings from ends of bushings and
unscrew bushings from shaft and control arm. Re
move shaft and seals.
2. Slide new seal on each end of shaft and insert shaft
into control arm.
3. Start new bushings on shaft and into control arm.
Adjust shaft until it is centered in control arm, then
turn bushings in and torque 160 lb. ft. for CP10,
190 lb. ft. for C20-30 if spacer is used, 95 lb. ft. for
CP10, 135 lb. ft. for C20-30 if no spacer is used.
Check shaft for free rotation. Figure 26 shows cor
rect final positioning of shaft.
B all Joint
1. Center punch rivet heads and drill out rivets. Rivets
F ig . 24 - Removing Lower Ball Jo in t may also be chiseled or ground off.
2. Remove ball joint assembly and inspect arm for
cracks or distortion at the ball joint seat.
3. Install service ball joint assembly in arm using spe
cial hardened bolts only, torquing bolts 45 lb. ft.
Installation
1. Place control arm in position on bracket and install
nuts. Before tightening nuts, insert caster and cam
ber shims in the same order as when removed.
Tighten nuts 80 lb. ft. for CP10 models, 155 lb. ft.
for C20-30 models.
2. Insert ball joint stud into steering knuckle and install
nut. Tighten stud nut 70 lb. ft. on CP10 models,
120 lb. ft. on C20-30 models.
3. Remove spring compressor J-6874 if used, and re
move adjustable support from under control arm.
Install wheel and tire assembly.
4. Lower vehicle and check front end alignment and 4. Place steering arm in position on back of steering
adjust where necessary. knuckle and insert two bolts through backing plate,
steering knuckle and steering arm. Install lock nuts
Steering Knuckle/Steering Arm and tighten 80 lb. ft. CP10, 105 lb. ft. C20-30.
5. Torque brake anchor pin to 65 ft. lbs.
NOTE: It is recommended that vehicle be 6 . Install brake shoes, brake shoe hold-down clips and
raised and supported on a twin-post hoist so that return springs.
the front coil spring remains compressed, yet 7. Install wheel hub, brake drum, wheel and tire assem
the wheel and steering knuckle assembly remain bly over spindle.
accessible. If a frame hoist is used, support 8 . Insert outer wheel bearing race and roller assembly,
lower control arm with an adjustable jackstand washer and nut. Adjust front wheel bearing as shown
to safely retain spring in its curb height under Maintenance and Adjustments in this section.
position. Install new cotter pin, dust cap and hub cap.
9. Lower vehicle, recheck and readjust wheel alignment
Removal where necessary.
1. Raise vehicle and support lower control arm as noted
above. Crossmember and Suspension Unit— Figure 27
2. Remove hub cap, wheel hub dust cover, cotter pin ad
justing nut and washer, withdraw wheel and tire, Component parts of the front suspension may be serv
brake drum, and wheel hub and bearing assembly iced separately as outlined in the preceding service op
from steering knuckle spindle. erations. However, if extensive service is to be per
3. Disengage brake shoe return springs and remove formed to crossmember, frame, etc., the unit can be
brake shoe hold-down clips. Remove brake shoes removed and installed as follows:
from backing plate.
Removal
CAUTION: Keep brake shoes clean and dry. 1. Remove front springs as outlined under Spring-
Removal.
4. Remove brake anchor pin and two bolts securing 2. Support engine and remove front engine mount center
brake backing plate and steering arm to steering bolt.
knuckle. 3. Separate main brake feeder line from crossmember
5. Withdraw steering arm and brake backing plate from tee.
steering knuckle. Wire backing plate to frame. Do 4. Remove bolts retaining crossmember hangers to
not disconnect brake line. frame side rails.
5. Remove bolts securing crossmember to frame side
NOTE: Refer to Section 9-Steering, for further rail lower flange and lower the assembly from
steering arm service operations. vehicle.
Installation
1. Place steering knuckle in position and insert upper
and lower ball studs into knuckle bosses.
2. Install ball stud nuts and tighten as follows: Upper
nuts 70 lb. ft. CP10, 120 lb. ft. C20-30; lower nuts
120 lb. ft. CP10, 215 lb. ft. C20-30.
3. Place brake backing plate and wheel cylinder in posi
tion on steering knuckle and insert anchor pin.
Removal Installation
1. Disconnect the stabilizer link bolts by removing the 1. Place stabilizer in position on side rail and install
nut from the top of the link bolt and pulling the bolt side rail brackets. Leave bolts loose until final
out from the lower bracket attached to the control tightening.
arm. 2. Install link bolts, spacers, and grommets to stabi
2. Remove the bolts that attach the stabilizer brackets lizer as shown on Figure 29.
to the frame crossmember and remove bar and 3. Tighten link bolt nuts until threads bottom out.
brackets. 4. Install radiator air deflector. (See Section 11.)
Spring
Removal
1. Raise vehicle and place stand jacks under frame side
rails. Support axle so that tension and compression
are relieved in spring.
2. Remove spring-to-axle "U" bolts.
3. Remove spring front and rear eye bolts and withdraw
spring from vehicle.
Inspection
Inspect bushings for excessive wear, check spring
leaves for breaks and inspect spring clips for tightness.
Repairs
Shackle Replacement
The spring rear shackle details are shown in Figure 4.
Components may be serviced with the spring installed in
the vehicle or when the spring is removed. Inspect
shackle components and replace parts as required. Re
assemble parts as shown in Figure 4.
Inspection
Inspect all bushings for excessive wear, check spring
F ig . 35 - Installing Spring Eye Bushing leaves for breaks and spring clips for tightness.
Repairs 6 . Remove drift from center hole and install new center
bolt.
Front Bushing (Plain) 7. Install nut on center bolt and tighten securely and
1. Adapt suitable remover from J - 21058 and remove peen end of bolt to keep nut from loosening.
bushing. 8 . Align springs by tapping with a hammer and bend
2. Install new bushing in spring eye using suitable in spring clips back in position.
staller from J - 21058.
NOTE: Spring clips should be bent sufficiently
to maintain alignment, but not tight enough to
Rear Bushing (Threaded)
bind spring action.
1. Thread end of J-553 shackle bushing tool into
bushing. Installation
2. Turn pull nut on tool with wrench and remove 1. Assemble fixed end of spring to spring hanger and
bushing. install spring hanger bolt.
3. Insert end of J-553 shackle bushing tool through 2. Install nut, and tighten to 90 ft. lbs. torque.
spring eye or spring hanger and screw new bushing 3. Install shackle pins in rear spring support bushing
on end of tool until it is centered with hole in spring and in bushing in spring eye.
or hanger. 4. Locate shackle pins so that each end projects 21/32"
4. Turn pull nut of tool to press bushing into place from the ends of the bushings.
(fig. 37). 5. Place new seals and shackle plates over tapered ends
of the shackle pins.
Spring Leaf 6 . Install shackle plate, lockwashers and nuts, and
1. Place spring in a bench vise and remove spring tighten to 30 ft. lbs. torque.
clips. 7. Raise spring assembly and locate center bolt in loca
tor hole of spring seat.
NOTE: Spring clips will have to be bent open. 8 . Install shock absorber anchor plate and "U" bolts.
2. File peened end of center bolt and remove center 9. Install "U" bolt lockwashers and nuts, and tighten to
bolt nut. specified torque (see "Specifications").
3. Open vise slowly and carefully to let spring assembly 10. Connect shock absorber link or eye to shock ab
expand. Wire brush and clean spring leaves. sorber anchor plate.
4. Replace broken spring leaf. 11. Install lubrication fittings and lubricate.
5. Align center holes in spring by means of a long drift
and compress spring leaves in vise. Series 40-60—Figure 38
Removal
1. Raise vehicle to take weight off spring. Disconnect
shock absorber from lower bracket.
2. Support I-beam, disconnect "U" bolts and "U" bolt
spacers, and allow to drop. Remove caster shims
and set aside for reinstallation.
3. Remove spring front eye pivot pin nut and withdraw
pivot pin.
4. Drop spring and pull out of rear hanger.
HANGER
4 0 -6 0 SERIES
7 0 0 0 # Axles
Fig. 3 9 - Removing Spring Eye Bushing
7 0 0 0 # AXLES
Repairs
Kingpin
If kingpin is damaged, it must be replaced during reas
sembly of steering knuckle.
Bushings
Steering knuckle bushings are split type floating Delrin
bushings and can be removed by sliding them out of
knuckle bores without the use of special tools. After re
Fig . 43 - Front Spring Rear Hanger Floating Cam - moval, clean up bushing bores using medium grit abra
4-5000^ A x le Shown sive cloth. Wipe bores clean, lubricate bushing OD and
install into knuckle.
Also, lubricate and place "O" ring seal in upper
2. Install front pivot pin and nut. Tighten nut 370 lb. ft. knuckle bore under the upper bushing (fig. 44).
Heavy duty spring bushings are steel-backed bronze
and must be lubricated prior to installation of pivot Installation
pin. 1. a. On 2 200#-4000# Models
3. Raise I-beam with caster shims in position, index Position steering knuckle on axle end and slide
spring center bolt into I-beam spring seat and install thrust washer assembly, consisting of one center
"U" bolts, spacers and nuts. Torque "U" bolt nuts steel washer and two bi-m etallic upper and lower
120 lb. ft. Connect shock absorber. washers encased in dust shields, between lower
face of axle end and steering knuckle lower yoke.
Steering Knuckle—Figure 44 Grooved cooper side of upper and lower thrust
washers must be assembled toward center steel
Steering knuckle and kingpin may be removed and washer (fig. 45). Lubricate kingpin and install
serviced without removing the axle assembly from the temporarily to maintain knuckle-to-1 -beam
vehicle. alignment.
b. Chevy Van
Removal Position steering knuckle on axle end and slide
1. Raise front of vehicle and remove wheel and tire and thrust washer assembly, consisting of a bronze
front hub and bearing assembly as outlined under washer between two steel washers and encased in
"Front Hubs and Drums-Removal." dust shields, between lower face of axle end and
2. Remove bolts retaining brake backing plate to steer steering knuckle lower yoke. Dust shield is
ing knuckle and withdraw plate. Attach backing plate marked must face upward (fig. 45). Lubricate
to frame or body to prevent damage to brake hoses. kingpin and install temporarily to maintain
3. Swing steering and tie rod arm out of work area. knuckle-to-1 -beam alignment.
c. On 5000#-7000#-9000#-11,000# and P20-30
P 20-30 and 40-60 Series Position and align steering knuckle on axle cen
(Except Heavy Duty 9 0 0 0 # —1 1,00 0# ) ter slide thrust bearing assembly between lower
4. a. Remove upper and lower dust caps. face of axle end and knuckle lower yoke. Make
b. Remove kingpin lockpin nut and pull out lockpin. certain retainer is on top of bearing with lip of
c. Tap kingpin out from bottom and withdraw steer retainer down. Lubricate kingpin and install
ing knuckle, shim, and thrust bearing pack. temporarily to maintain knuckle-to-I-beam
alignment.
9 0 0 0 # -1 1 ,0 0 0 #
a. Remove upper dust cap and lower expansion plug NOTE: P ress kingpin upper sleeve over king
lock ring. pin before installing. Install kingpin from bot
b. Remove kingpin upper cotter pin and nut. On tom of steering knuckle (9000#-11,000# only).
1 1 , 0 0 0 lb. axle remove metal spacer under king
2. Place a jack under steering knuckle and raise
pin nut. knuckle enough to take up clearance between knuckle
c. Drive kingpin downward out of axle and knuckle. yoke, axle end and thrust bearing or washers. Check
Withdraw steering knuckle, thrust bearing and clearance between upper face of axle end and knuckle
spacer washers. upper yoke. On 2200-4000-5000-7000# models, if
d. Remove upper kingpin bushing. This bushing is a this clearance exceeds .005”, add shims as neces
.001"-<,003M fit and may be pushed out by hand. sary to bring clearance below this dimension. On
Inspection 9000#-11,000# models, if this clearance exceeds
1. Wash all parts in solvent and air dry. .015", add shims as required to obtain a clearance
2. Inspect steering knuckle for distortion, cracks or of .003" to .008" (fig. 46).
40 SERIES
(4000#)
P 20-30
50-60 SERIES
(4-5-7000*) 60 SERIES
(9-11000*)
3. Lubricate and install kingpin if not already installed front and tighten nut securely.
in Step 1. On all models except 9000#-11,000#, make 5. On P20-30 and Chevy Van models install new kingpin
sure milled slot on side of pin indexes with kingpin plugs in yoke and stake in place at four points. On
lockpin hole in axle end. Install kingpin from top, 4000#-5000#-7000# models install kingpin dust caps
driving it down through knuckle upper yoke, shim, with new gaskets. On 9000#-11,000# models install
axle end, thrust washer pack and lower knuckle yoke, inverted expansion plug in lower knuckle bore and
until milled slot aligns with lockpin hole in axle end. seat retaining ring. Install upper dust cap with new
On 9000#-11,000# models, install kingpin from bot gasket.
tom and install kingpin upper nut. Torque nut 250 6 . Place brake backing plate into position on steering
lb. ft. and insert new cotter pin. knuckle and install two upper locking plate to steer
4. Insert threaded end of lockpin through axle end from ing knuckle retaining bolts. Raise steering and tie
BRONZE
W A SH ER
STEEL
W A SH ER
P20-30
STEEL
W A SH ER
TH RU ST
W A SH ER
I____ D U ST S H IE L D
4 ,0 0 0 #
5 ,0 0 0 # -7 ,0 0 0 # 9 ,0 0 0 # -1 1 ,0 0 0 #
I Beam
Removal
1. Raise vehicle and support at frame to rear of spring
rear bracket. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
2. Disconnect shock absorber lower mount from U-bolt
spacer bracket or spring seat bracket. Disconnect
stabilizer lower link on P20-30 models.
3. Remove wheel hub and drum assembly. Fig. 46 - Checking Steering K nuckle Free Play
4. Remove brake backing plate and fasten to frame to
prevent damage to brake hose. See Steering Knuckle- Repairs
Removal for removal procedure. Let steering arm
tie rod and third arm hang attached to the drag link. Steering Knuckle an d Kingpin
5. Support I-beam with floor jack. Remove spring Remove and service kingpin and steering knuckle as
U-bolt nuts, lower shock absorber brackets, U-bolts outlined under Steering Knuckle.
and U-bolt spacers.
6 . Lower axle center and remove from under vehicle. A x le Center
Tape or wire camber shims to spring seats. There are two conditions which, if either exists, will
necessitate replacement of axle center. raise up against spring seats, making sure spring
1. If kingpin holes in axle center ends are worn to such center bolts index in spring seats.
an extent that a new standard or oversize kingpin fits 2. Place U-bolts and U-bolt spacers over springs. In
loosely, axle center must be replaced. stall shock absorber lower mounting brackets (where
2. If axle center has been twisted or bent more than 5 used), U-bolt nuts and torque as outlined in
degrees from original shape, center should be re Specifications.
placed. As a general rule, when an extreme bent 3. Connect shock absorber lower eye and stabilizer link
condition exists, minute fractures which may be in on P20-30 models.
visible will occur, and failure under ordinary operat 4. Install brake backing plate assembly to steering
ing conditions will result. Check axle center for knuckle as outlined in Section 5 -Brakes.
twist with alignment instruments. If equipment is 5. Install steering arm and the rod assembly and torque
available, use Magna-Flux method to check axle cen bolts as shown in Specifications.
ter for minute fractures. Axle centers should always 6 . Place hub and drum assemblies over spindles and
be straightened cold. Under no circumstances should adjust wheel bearings as outlined under Wheel Bear
heat be applied. ings-Adjust.
7. Install wheel and tire assemblies, and lower vehicle.
Installation. Check front end alignment and adjust where
1. Roll axle into position, insert caster shims, and necessary.
i
CHEVROLET TRUCK SERVICE M ANUAL
FRONT SUSPENSION 3-23
..T..-.... m r~ ------— ~\
INTRODUCTION
The four-wheel drive models are essentially conven service information on components which are common
tional vehicles which have been modified to include a to four-wheel drive and conventional vehicles.
driving front axle, a transfer case to distribute power Disassembly and repairs to the Front Axle Differen
to front and rear axles with the required propeller tial can be found in Section 3 "Front Suspension" of the
shafts and controls (fig. 1). Service information on these 1967 Truck Overhaul Manual. The Adapter and Trans
components is included in this section. fer Case assemblies are covered in Section 7 "Trans
Refer to the applicable section of this manual for mission", 1967 Truck Overhaul Manual.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Primary purpose of four wheel drive is to provide STEERING KNUCKLE AND UNIVERSAL JOINT
additional tractive effort in off-the-road driving in order To permit the front wheels to be driven as well as
to overcome such obstacles as sand, deep mud or snow, turned, the axle is equipped with steering knuckles and
hilly terrain with steep grades, etc. the axle shafts are equipped with yoke and trunnion type
With four wheels capable of driving, all the vehicle universal joints.
and payload weight is utilized to give maximum tire TRANSFER CASE
traction.
The transfer case, also known as a drop gear box, is
The power unit is driven through a Muncie three-speed the unit which transmits power from the transmission to
or Chevrolet four-speed transmission and consists of an the rear and/or front axles and power take-off (fig. 2 ).
adapter and a two speed transfer case with a steering Engagement of front wheel drive, power take-off or speed
and driving front axle. A single control lever (fig. 1) is range is accomplished through control levers in the cab.
used to shift the transfer case from direct drive to low The case is mounted to an adapter at the rear of the
four wheel drive at a ratio of 1.94 to 1, thus eight for transmission.
ward speeds and two in reverse are provided. Model number, ratio and production date are stamped
Front wheel drive may be engaged or disengaged at any on a plate located on top of the transfer case.
time without clutching when the transfer case is in direct ADAPTER ASSEMBLY
drive; however, in returning to 2 wheel from 4 wheel the
An adapter assembly has been designed to locate the
accelerator may have to be varied as steady pressure is
transfer case directly behind the transmission (fig. 2 ).
applied on lever. This releases gear tooth pressure dur
Presently there are two adapters available, one for use
ing shifting.
with the Muncie three-speed transmission, and one for
A yoke and trunnion universal joint permits continuous
use with the Chevrolet truck four-speed. This adapter
power flow to each front wheel, regardless of the turning
assembly design will allow the vehicle body to be lowered
angle.
approximately 3 inches and will also eliminate the need
Provisions for Power Take-off have been incorporated
for an intermediate propeller shaft;
in the transfer case.
The two adapters are sim ilar in that they both contain
FRONT AXLE a splined sleeve mounted in seals. The one for the
three-speed Muncie takes the place of the transmission
The front axle is a Spicer hypoid gear axle unit extension and has a straight spline input to match the
equipped with steering knuckles. Axle assembly number transmission output shaft spline. The output spline is
and production date are stamped on left tube of assembly. involute to match the input spline of the transfer case.
Refer to Specifications for Spicer Model application. The adapter assembly for the Chevrolet truck four-speed
Conventional truck service brakes are provided on all mounts on the back face of the transmission and has a
4-wheel drive units. straight through involute spline sleeve since the trans-
mission output spline and transfer case input spline are wheels when the vehicle is operated under conditions
identical. To summarize, the transfer case adapters where front wheel drive is not needed.
differ in their splined sleeves and mounting faces only. The engagement and disengagement of free-wheeling
hubs is a manual operation which must be performed at
FREE-WHEELING HUBS
Free-wheeling hubs are available for the front wheels each front wheel. The transfer case control lever must
of four wheel drive vehicles. The purpose of these hubs be in 2 -wheel drive position when locking or unlocking
is to reduce friction and wear by disengaging the front hubs. Both hubs must be in the fully locked or fully
axle shafts, differential and drive line from the front unlocked position. They must not be in the free-wheeling
position when low all wheel drive is used as the additional
torque output in this position can subject the rear axle to
severe strain and rear axle failure may result.
POWER TAKE-OFF
Provision is made for mounting a shaft type Power
Take-Off at the rear of the transfer case input shaft.
OTHER COMPONENTS
The rear axle assembly, including service brakes, is
identical to the axle used on conventional drive models.
The parking brake operates by mechanical activation of
the service brake shoes in the rear wheels through a
pistol-grip type parking brake lever mounted under the
left side of the instrument panel.
[ADAPTER1
ITRANSFER;
ICASE
Refer to Fig. 6
Removal
1. Disassemble propeller shaft from front axle differ
ential.
2. Raise front end of truck until weight is removed
from front springs. Support truck with jack stands
behind front springs.
3. Disconnect connecting rod from steering arm.
4. Disconnect brake hoses from frame fittings.
7. Remove knuckle from housing and remove bearing b. On 44-5HDF models—use a torque wrench posi
cones from axle housing. tioned on upper bearing retainer nut; knuckle
should turn with 15-35 ft. lbs. torque. Adjust
NOTE: On K20 HD models the upper king pin
preload by increasing or decreasing shim packs
bearing consists of a cup and bushing assembly.
at lower bearing only. Upper shim pack should
The king pin and bushing are slotted to receive
be .060 inch thick.
a key which acts to connect the two components
4. Position seal ring, rubber seal and felt seal against
so that they will pivot together. Removal pro
inboard face of knuckle and align bolt holes. Install
cedure for this installation is as listed above.
steel retainer ( 2 pieces).
Bearing Cup 5. Connect the steering connecting rod and tie rod.
6 . Install axle shaft assembly.
Replacement
If new bearings are to be installed, remove cups from TRANSFER CASE
axle housing. Start new cups straight in counterbore
and using a suitable driver, press cups firmly to bottom. Refer to Fig. 7
Seal Removal
1. Drain transfer case.
Replacement 2. Disconnect propeller shafts from U-joint yoke at
If new seals and retainer are to be installed, hang them case.
on axle housing in place of old parts—felt seal inboard, 3. Remove cotter pins from clevis pins. Withdraw
rubber seal next and the seal ring outboard. clevis pins to remove lever-selector from transfer
case.
Installation 4. Remove access cover on side of the Adapter Assem
1. Install bearing cones or bushing in cups in axle bly and remove two attaching bolts to the transfer
housing. case (fig. 7).
2. Place the steering knuckle over axle housing yoke 5. Remove seven bolts located on outside of Adapter
and install bearing retainers. Use same shims re Assembly.
6 . Support transfer case in suitable cradle.
moved, or equivalent amount and tighten bearing
retainer bolts or nuts to 25 ft. lbs. torque. 7. Remove two bolts from bracket at right side of the
transfer case and remove case from adapter.
NOTE: On K20 models position key in king pin
and install in bushing by aligning king pin and ADAPTER ASSEMBLY
key with key way in bushing.
Removal
3. Check bearing preload. 1. Remove bolts holding the bracket assembly, and
a. On 44-5F models—use a spring scale positioned control lever to the adapter assembly: lock, washer
in the tie rod hole; knuckle should turn with 1 1 - 2 0 and spring from lower end of lever actuating arm
lbs. pull. Add shim to decrease preload, remove (fig. 1). Push assembly to one side.
shim to increase preload. 2. Remove two bolts from mounting assembly.
REAR SUSPENSION
(SINGLE AXLE)
INDEX
Page Page
General Description ........................... . ........................ 4-1 Shackle Replacement............................................. 4-6
Series C-P10 and C20 ............................................. 4-1 Series P20 and C-P30 .................................... 4-6
Series G10 and G20 ................................................ 4-1 Series K10 and K20 ....................................... 4-7
Series K10, K-P20 and C-P30 ................................. 4-2 Series G10 and G20 . ..................................... 4-7
Series 40, 50 and 60 ................................................ 4-3 Bushing Replacement .......................................... 4-7
Component Parts Replacem ent....................................... 4-4 Series P20 and C-P30 .................................... 4-7
Shock Absorber Replacement ................................. 4-4 Series GK10 and 20 ....................................... 4-8
Tie Rod (Series C-P10 and C 2 0 ) .............................. 4-4 Spring Replacement ............................................. 4-9
Stabilizer Shaft (Series P 3 0 ) .................................... 4-4 Series P20 and C-P30 .................................... 4-9
Control Arm (Series C-P10 and C20) ..................... 4-5 Series K10 and K 2 0 .......................................... 4-9
Coil Spring and Auxiliary Leaf Spring Series G10 and G 2 0 .......................................... 4-9
(Series C-P10 and C 2 0 ) .......................................... 4-6 Series 40, 50 and 60 ....................................... 4-10
Leaf Springs ............................................................ 4-6 Spring Leaf R ep lacem en t.......................................... 4-10
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Series C-P10 and C20 Series G10 and G20
Series C-P10 (fig. 1) and C20 (fig. 2) trucks use a two- The rear suspension is of the tapered leaf spring,
link suspension with a control arm attached between each Hotchkiss drive type, with the spring rear shackle eye
end of the axle housing and the central area of the frame. mounted to the vehicle frame bracket (fig. 5).
A single "U" bolt attaches each control arm to the axle
housing and a rubber bushing is used in connecting the
forward end of each arm to a bracket on the frame be
tween the side rails and the tunnel.
A two-stage, pigtailed coil spring is seated and clamped
between each control arm and the frame, forward of the
axle.
Shock absorbers are installed between brackets riveted
to the frame, forward of axle housing, and brackets held
beneath the rear of each control arm by the MU" bolt.
The tie rod on the C-P10 (fig. 3) models is attached to
a stud inserted through a cast ear of the differential car
rie r. A rubber-bushed attachment is utilized at the
frame bucket. On the C20 models the tie rod is rubber-
bushed at both ends and is supported between an axle
housing bracket and at the frame.
Auxiliary leaf springs, available as an option on C
series vehicles, are mounted rearward of the axle and
secured by a frame mounted bracket at the rear. The
auxiliary spring bumper is retained by the "U" bolt at the
control arm (fig. 4). Fig. 1 - Rear Suspension (Series C and P10)
1. Position bushed end of control arm in pivot yoke be to 270 ft. lbs.
tween tunnel and frame, align holes with drift and 2„ Position auxiliary spring assembly in frame mounted
insert pivot bolt. Place nut on bolt finger tight. bracket so that free end of spring is positioned above
2. Position clamp inside spring as shown in Figure 16 bumper and align spring-to-bracket bolt holes. In
so that it seats freely on spring end without any stall bolt with washer through top side of bracket
hang-up. Raise control arm to the spring then pass then install nut and washer to through bolt. Torque
bolt, with flat washer installed, up through control nut to 370 ft. lbs. and install cotter pin.
arm and clamp. Install lockwasher and nut. Torque
to 50 ft. lbs.
3. Place arm adjacent to axle. Pass "U" bolt over axle
and through holes in arm.
4. Place shock absorber bracket on ends of "U" bolt,
install nuts and torque to 2 0 0 ft. lbs.
5. Lower the vehicle to put full weight of unloaded ve
hicle on the front and rear suspension, torque control
arm pivot bolts to 140 ft. lbs.
COIL SPRING AND AUXILIARY LEAF SPRING
(Series C-P10 and C20)
Removal
Coil Spring
1. Remove shock absorber bolt from mounting bracket
at control arm.
2. Remove vehicle weight from rear suspension by
jacking up frame and adjust axle-to-fram e height so
that spring is not under tension.
3. Remove upper and lower clamps from spring by
backing out lower bolt from underside of control
F ig . 17 - Spring Removal (Series C-P10 and C20)
arm, and upper bolt from inside spring (fig. 17).
4. Lower control arm sufficiently to permit removal of
spring.
A uxiliary Spring
1. The auxiliary spring is secured to the frame mounted
retaining bracket by one retaining bolt. Before at
tempting to remove spring, make sure there is no
load on spring and that spring leaf does not contact
the control arm mounted bumper (fig. 4).
2. Remove cotter pin from spring retaining bolt then
remove nut and remove spring from the frame
bracket.
3. If auxiliary spring contact bumper is to be removed,
support vehicle at rear axle, remove "U" bolts and
remove bumper from its position on the control arm.
Installation
Coil Spring
1. Place spring clamp inside spring. Position clamp so
that the end of the spring coil is within the area of Fig. 18 - Spring Shackle Details (Series P20 and C-P30)
the notch as shown in Figure 16 so that it seats
freely on spring end without any hang-up and locate LEAF SPRINGS
over bolt hole in control arm.
Shackle Replacement (Series P20 and C-P30)
2. Pass clamp bolt with washer up through hole in con
trol arm and loosely install nut. 1. Remove load from spring by jacking frame.
3. Position upper clamp inside spring and install bolt 2. Remove lubrication fitting from spring eye and
and washer. Torque nut to 50 ft. lbs. shackle pins (fig. 18).
4. Connect shock absorber to control arm bracket-- 3. Remove lock bolts from shackle and hanger.
torque nut to 130 ft. lbs. 4. Install Tool J-8118 in end of spring eye pin, and us
5. Torque spring lower clamp bolt to 45 ft. lbs. Remove ing slide hammer (Tool J-2619 with adapter
jack from beneath frame. J - 2619-4) pull pin out of spring. Pull shackle pin out
A uxiliary Spring of hanger and separate shackle from spring and
1. Position auxiliary spring bumper between the control hanger.
arm and the axle housing. Align holes in spring 5. Place bushed portion of new shackle in hanger.
bracket with those in the control arm; position shock 6 . Insert plain end of pin into hanger and shackle with
absorber bracket to underside of control arm; install slot in pin positioned to receive locking bolt when in
"U" bolt over axle and through auxiliary spring stalled. Push pin in until slot lines up with locking
bracket control arm and shock absorber bracket; bolt hole in bracket. Install locking bolt, washer and
install and alternately torque "U" bolt retaining nuts nut.
Bushing Replacement
Bushing Replacement
Removal
1. Raise rear of vehicle to relieve tension in spring and
position supports at frame side rails.
2. Loosen, but do not remove, spring-to-shackle retain
ing nut.
3. Remove nut and bolt securing shackle to spring
hanger.
4. Remove nut and bolt securing spring to front hanger.
5. Remove "U" bolt retaining nuts, withdraw "U" bolts
and spring plate from spring-to-axle housing attach
ment.
6 . Withdraw spring from vehicle.
7. Inspect spring--replace bushings, repair or replace
spring unit as outlined in this section.
Fig . 25 - Removing Spring Eye Bushing (Series 40, 50, and 60)
Installation
1. Install spring camber shim making sure shim is po
sitioned so that it corresponds to shim on opposite
side and that it is as noted in step 3 of "Removal"
procedures.
2. Place spring on shim with center bolt indexed in pad
center hole and spring ends positioned in hangers.
3. Install "U" bolt spacer over center bolt on top leaf of F ig . 2 7 - 4 0 , 5 0 , and 60 Spring Removal (Typ ica l)
REAR SUSPENSION
(TANDEM)
INDEX
Page Page
General Description ......................................................... 4-11 Equalizing B e a m s ............................................................... 4-15
Component Parts Replacem ent.......................................... 4_13 Torque Rod and B ra c k e t...................................................... 4-16
S p rings........................................................................... 4_13
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The tandem rear suspension (fig. 28) consists of the two equalizing beams between the forward and rear
springs, spring saddles and top plates, equalizing beams, ward axle housings. Replaceable bushings are used at
cross tube and torque rods. beam-to-axle mountings (fig. 30) and at cross tube-to-
The semi-elliptic spring leaves are assembled by a saddle and beam mounting (fig. 31).
center bolt and two rebound clips. The forward end of the Axle driving and braking forces are transmiited to the
upper two spring leaves form the spring eye which is vehicle through two torque rods, one at each axle. Torque
fitted with a replaceable bushing (fig. 29). This end of rod connections at each axle and at frame brackets are
the spring is secured in a hanger by a pin which is held made through tapered ball studs which are rubber
in place by a lock bolt. The rear end of the spring rides mounted in torque rod ends (fig. 32).
free in a spring hanger. Lubrication fittings are provided in spring eye pins and
Each spring is mounted at its center on a saddle sup in spring rear hangers.
ported on the end of a cross tube which passes through
TORQUE ROD
BRACKETS
TOP PLATES
SPRING
SADDLE x' c;
SADDLE
EQUALIZING
BEAMS
Frame Bracket
Torque Rod
1 Axle Bracket 5 Bolt
2 Equalizing Beam 6 Nut
3 End Bushing 7 W asher
4 Adapter T-699
A x le Bracket 5. Bolt
Equalizer Beam 6. N ut
End Bushing 7. Washer
4 . Adapter F ig . 32 - Torque Rod Stud
Disassembly of Spring
m j ■19
-----20
Coat spring leaves with a light film of graphite grease. 1. Position spring assembly on spring saddle with cen
Stack spring leaves in correct order, then compress ter bolt head in locating hole in saddle, and with
leaves using "C" clamps or an arbor press. Install cen spring ends in place at frame hangers.
ter bolt, then install rebound clip bolts and spacers. 2. Place top pad locating slide on top spring leaf, then
Tighten center bolt firmly; tighten rebound clip bolts position top pad to saddle bolts and nuts and tighten
enough to hold leaves in alignment without restricting snugly. Tighten top pad set screws to 140 ft. lbs.
free movement. torque, then tighten set screw lock nuts.
EQUALIZING BEAMS
Removal
1. Support frame so springs are lifted just enough to Fig. 36. - Equalizing Beam Details
remove weight of equalizing beam from beam-to-axle
hanger adapters. 1. Bolt 5. Nut
2. Remove nut from beam-to-axle adapter bolt and re 2. Adapter 6. C enter Bushing
move bolt and adapter by prying adapter at head of 3. End Bushing 7. Washer
bolt out of hanger (See Figure 35), then pry out oppo 4. Equalizing Beam
site adapter. Repeat this operation at other end of
beam and at both ends of opposite beam.
3. Support equalizing beams and cross tube to take
weight off center bushings. Remove nuts from four Bushing Replacement
studs securing spring saddle caps to bottom of spring End and center bushings may be removed and new
saddle (two caps at each beam). Remove caps from bushings installed using suitable tools.
studs.
Installation
CAUTION: Keep cross tube level so beams do
not slide off tube. Refer to Figure 36.
1. Apply an anti-rust lubricant to inside of beam center
4. Lower the beams and tube from vehicle and pull bushing, insert end of cross tube in bushing and push
beams off tube. tube into bottom of sleeve.
2. Apply an anti-rust lubricant to inside surface of the
Repairs center bushing in other beam and slide onto cross
tube until tube bottoms in bushing sleeve.
DRIVE LINE
REAR AXLE (CHEVROLET) SINGLE SPEED
INDEX
Page Page
General Description ......................................................... ...4-17 Axle Assembly ......................................................... 4-26
2400, 2900, 3300, 3500 and 3600 Lb. Capacity Removal ............................................................... 4-26
(Salisbury-Type) Axles ............................................. ...4-17 Installation............................................................ 4-27
5200 and 7200 Lb. Capacity A x le s ................................. ...4-17 Axle Vent R ep lacem en t............................................. 4-27
11,000, 13,500, 15,000 and 17,000 Lb. Axle Shaft—Removal and Installation........................ 4-27
Capacity A x l e s ............................................................ ...4-17 5200 and 7200 Lb. A x l e s ....................................... 4-27
Maintenance and Adjustments .......................................... ...4-17 11,000, 13,500 and 15,000 Lb. A x l e s ..................... 4-27
Lubricant........................................................................ ...4-17 17,000 Lb. A x le ...................................................... 4-28
U-Bolt and Hub N u t s ...................................................... ...4-17 Hub and D r u m ............................................................ 4-29
Rear Axle Noise D i a g n o s is .......................................... ...4-17 Removal ............................................................... 4-29
Component Parts Replacem ent.......................................... ...4-22 Cleaning ............................................................... 4-29
2400, 2900, 3300, 3500 and 3600 Lb. Capacity Inspection............................................................... 4-30
(Salisbury-Type) Axles ............................................. ...4-22 R e p a ir s .................................................................. 4-30
Axle A s s e m b ly ......................................................... ...4-22 Bearing Cup Replacement................................. 4-30
R em o v al............................................................... ...4_22 Drum R ep lacem en t.......................................... 4-31
Installation............................................................ ...4-22 Demountable-Type .................................... 4-31
Axle Vent Replacement .......................................... ...4-23 Non-demountable T y p e .............................. 4-32
Axle Shaft ............................................................... ... 4 _ 2 3 Wheel Bolt Replacement ................................. 4 - 3 2
R e m o v a l............................................................... ...4_23 Hub Stud Replacement .................................... 4-32
Wheel Bolt Replacem ent................................. ...4-23 Oil Seal Sleeve and Bearing Thrust Spacer
Oil Seal and/or Bearing Replacem ent............ 4-23 Replacem ent................................................... 4-32
Brake Flange Plate R ep lacem en t.................. ...4-23 Wheel Hub Oil Seal R eplacem ent..................... 4-33
Installation ......................................................... ...4-23 Installation............................................................ 4-34
Pinion Flange, Dust Deflector and/or Bearing A d ju s tm e n t............................................. 4-34
Oil Seal R ep lacem en t....................................... ...4-24 Drive Pinion Oil Seal
Positraction Differential U n it.............................. ...4-26 R e p la c e m e n t...................................................... 4-34
On The Vehicle C h e c k .................................... ...4-26 No-Spin Differential U n it....................................... 4-34
5200 Through 17,000 Lb. Capacity A x l e s ..................... ...4-26 On The Vehicle Check....................................... 4-35
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
an outer race and roller assembly—a precision ground
2400, 2900, 3300, 3500 AND 3600 LB. diameter on the pinion pilot functions as an inner race.
CAPACITY (SALISBURY-TYPE) AXLES Basically the two axle assemblies are identical with the
exception of drive gear ratios and brake assemblies;
The 2400, 2900, 3300, 3500 and 3600 lb. capacity however, Series C-K20 vehicles utilize a two-pinion dif
(Salisbury-Type) axle (fig. 37) is a semifloating, fabri ferential while all other series are equipped with a four-
cated construction type consisting of a cast ca rrier with pinion differential.
large bosses on each end into which two welded steel
tubes are fitted. The carrier contains an overhung hypoid 11,000, 13,500 15,000 AND 17,000 LB.
pinion and ring gear. The differential is a two pinion CAPACITY AXLES
arrangement.
The axle housing is made up of two steel welded tubes The 11,000 and the 13,500, 15,000 and 17,000 lb. capac
pressed into the crossbore of the cast carrier--each tube ity, single-speed hypoid axles, illustrated in Figures 39
is puddle welded to the carrier. Welded-on brackets and 40 respectively, have a straddle mounted drive pinion
provide attachment points for suspension components which is supported at the rear by a straight roller bear
such as spring seats, shock absorbers and control arms. ing. The pinion front bearing consists of a double row
A welded flange is provided for brake flange plate attach ball on the 1 1 , 0 0 0 lb. axle and two opposed tapered roller
ment. bearings on the 13,500, 15,000 and 17,000 lb. axles. Se
An overhung hypoid drive pinion is supported by two lective shims placed between the pinion front bearing and
preloaded tapered roller bearings. The pinion shaft is its seat in the carrier housing provide a means of adjust
sealed by means of a molded, spring loaded, rubber seal. ing pinion depth to attain correct ring gear and drive
The seal is mounted on the pinion flange which is splined pinion tooth contacts on the 13,500, 15,000 and 17,000 lb.
and bolted to the hypoid pinion shaft. axles.
The hypoid ring gear is bolted to a one-piece differen The differential is a conventional four-pinion type.
tial case which is supported by two preloaded tapered Thrust washers are used between the side gears and case
roller bearings. and also between differential pinions and the differential
case.
5200 AND 7200 LB. CAPACITY AXLES A thrust pad mounted on the end of an adjusting screw
threaded into the carrie r housing on all axles except the
The 5200 and 7200 lb. capacity truck rear axles (fig. 38) 13,500, limits deflection of the ring gear under high
are of the full floating type with hypoid ring gear and torque conditions.
drive pinion. The full floating construction enables easy Involute splines are incorporated in the axle shaft
removal of axle shafts without removing truck load and flange and in the wheel hubs of the 11,000 through 15,000
without jacking up the axle. The differential carrier is lb. axles. This design provides for the driving torque to
heavily ribbed to provide rigid support for the differential be transmitted from the axle shaft to the hub through the
assem bly--differential caps are doweled to the carrier to mating splines.
assure perfect alignment. The 15,000 and 17,000 lb. axles have a removable in
The straddle-mounted drive pinion is supported at the spection cover; 11,000 and 13,500 lb. axles do not incor
front by a one-piece double row ball bearing. The pinion porate this feature, the cover is an integral part of the
rear bearing is a roller bearing assembly consisting of axle housing.
1. Universal Jo in t Yoke 6. Drive Pinion 11. D ifferential Pinion (Spider) 15. D ifferential Bearing
2. Pinion Bearing Retainer and 7. Rear Pinion Bearing G ear 16. D ifferential Bearing Adjusting
O il Seal 8. Ring G e a r Thrust Pad 12. D ifferential Side G e a r Nut
3. O il Seal Packing 9. Ring G e a r 13. D ifferential Case - Left H alf 17. Adjusting N u t Lock
4. O il Seal 10. D ifferential Spider 14. A x le Shaft 18. D ifferential Case - Right H alf
5. Front Pinion Bearing
1. Universal Jo in t Y oke 6. Drive Pinion 11. D ifferential Pinion (Spider) 15. Differential Bearing
2. Pinion Bearing Retainer 7. Rear Pinion Bearing G ear 16. Differential Bearing Adjusting
3. O il Seal 8. Ring G e a r Thrust Pad 12. D ifferential Side G e a r Nut
4. Shims 9. Ring G e a r 13. D ifferential Case (Left H alf) 17. Adjusting Nut Lock
5. Pinion Bearing Assembly 10. D ifferential Spider 14. A x le Shaft 18. Differential Case (Right H alf)
action of transmitting the high engine torque through a ing of the ring gear and pinion teeth as a result of insuf
90° turn reducing propeller shaft speed produces noise in ficient or improper lubricant in new assemblies. Side
rear axles. This point establishes the need for a line gears rarely give trouble as they are used only when the
between normal and abnormal or unacceptable axle rear wheels travel at different speeds.
noises.
Slight axle noise heard only at a certain speed or under BEARING NOISE
remote conditions must be considered normal. Axle
noise tends to "peak" at varying speeds and the noise is Defective bearings will always produce a rough whine
in no way indicative of trouble in the axle. that is constant in pitch and usually most noticeable under
If noise is present in an objectionable form, loud or at "drive" conditions. This fact will allow you to distinguish
all speeds, an effort should be made to isolate the noise between bearing noise and gear noise.
as being in one particular unit of the vehicle. Axle noise 1. Pinion bearing noise resulting from a bearing failure
is often confused with other noises such as tire noise, can be identified by a constant rough sound. Pinion
transmission noise, propeller shaft vibration and uni bearings are rotating at a higher speed than differen
versal joint noise. Isolation of the noise as in any one tial side bearings or axle shaft bearings. This par
unit requires skill and experience. An attempt to elimi ticular noise can be picked up best by testing the car
nate a slight noise may baffle even the best of diagnosti on a smooth road (black top). However, care should
cians. Such practices as raising tire pressure to elimi be taken not to confuse tire noise with bearing or
nate tire noise, listening for the noise at varying speeds gear noise. If any doubt exists, tire treads should be
and on drive, float and coast, and under proper highway examined for irregularities that would produce such
conditions, turning the steering wheel from left to right noise.
to detect wheel bearing noise, will aid even the beginner 2. Wheel bearing noise may be confused with rear axle
in detecting alleged axle noises. Axle noises fall into two noise. To differentiate between wheel bearings and
categories: gear noise and bearing noise. rear axle, drive the vehicle on a smooth road at
medium-low speed. With traffic permitting, turn the
GEAR NOISE vehicle sharply right and left. If noise is caused by
wheel bearings, it will increase in the turns because
Abnormal gear noise can be recognized since it pro of the side loading. If noise cannot be isolated to
duces a cycling pitch and will be very pronounced in the front or rear wheel bearings, inspection will be
speed range at which it occurs, appearing under either necessary.
"drive," "float" or "coast" conditions. Gear noise tends 3. Side bearings will produce a constant rough noise of
to peak in a narrow speed range or ranges, while bearing a slower nature than pinion bearings. Side bearing
noise will tend to remain constant in pitch. Abnormal noise will not fluctuate in the above wheel bearing
gear noise is rare and usually originates from the scor- test.
COMPONENT Pt S REPLACEMENT
2400, 2900, 3300, 3500 AND 3600 LB. position vent hose to one side.
CAPACITY (SALISBURY-TYPE) AXLES 7. Disconnect hydraulic brake hose at connector on axle
housing. Remove brake drum, disconnect parking
AXLE ASSEMBLY brake cable at actuating levers and at flange plate.
Refer to Section 5 for cable removal and brake
Construction of the axle assembly is such that service
details.
operations may be performed with the housing installed in
8 . On vehicles so equipped, check coil springs to make
the vehicle or with the housing installed in a holding fix
sure that they are compressed; then on all vehicles,
ture. The following removal and installation procedure
remove axle "U" bolt nuts, "U" bolts, spacers and
is necessary only when the housing requires replacement.
clamp plates.
Removal 9. Lower axle assembly and remove from vehicle.
1. Raise vehicle, place stand jacks under frame side
rails and remove rear wheels. Installation
2. Support rear axle assembly with a hydraulic jack, or 1. Position axle assembly under vehicle and align with
other suitable lifting device, so that tention is re springs or control arms as applicable.
lieved in springs, tie rod, and shock absorbers. 2. Install spacer, clamp plate and "U" bolts to axle as
3. On vehicles so equipped, disconnect tie rod at axle sembly, loosely install retaining nuts to "U" bolts.
housing bracket or at differential carrier. 3. Position shock absorbers in lower attachment brack
4. Remove trunnion bearing "U" bolts from the axle ets and loosely install nut to retain shock.
companion flange, separate trunnion from flange, po 4. Connect axle vent hose to vent connector at carrier.
sition propeller shaft to one side and tie it to frame 5. Connect hydraulic brake hose to connector on axle
side rail. housing, connect parking brake cable to actuating
levers. Install brake drum and wheel and tire as
NOTE: Secure trunnion bearings caps to trun
sembly--bleed brakes and adjust parking brake as
nion, using masking tape or a large rubber band,
outlined in applicable portion of Section 5.
to prevent loss of bearings.
6 . Reassemble the propeller shaft to companion flange,
5. Disconnect shock absorbers at lower attachment making sure that bearing caps are indexed in flange
points and position out of the way. seat. Install and torque bearing cap retaining nuts to
6 . Disconnect axle vent hose from vent connector and specifications.
7. Remove stand jacks from frame side rails--position drain are aligned with drain hole in flange before
vehicle so that weight is placed on suspension com installing bolts.
ponents and torque affected parts to specifications.
OIL SEAL AND/OR BEARING REPLACEMENT
AXLE VENT REPLACEMENT
1. Remove the oil seal by using the button end of the
The axle vent system consists of the vent connector, axle shaft--insert the button end of the shaft behind
vent hose and associated attaching parts. When replacing the steel case of the oil seal, then pry seal out of
vent hose make sure that it is routed along original path bore being careful not to damage housing. Refer to
in such a manner that the hose is free from kinks or Figure 43 for detail of seal and bearing installation.
binds that would restrict air flow. In replacing the vent 2. Insert Tool J-8119 into bore and position it behind
connector; pry old connector from carrier, being sure bearing so that tangs on tool engage bearing outer
that entire connector is removed. Tap new connector into race. Remove bearing, using slide hammer as shown
ca rrie r with a soft-faced hammer, prick punch around in Figure 44.
edge of hole to insure fit of new connector (fig. 54). 3. Lubricate new bearing with wheel bearing lubricant,
and install bearing so that it bottoms against shoul
der in housing bore (fig. 45). To install bearing, use
Tool J - 21491 for the 2400 and 2900 lb. axles; Tool
J-21051 for the 3300 lb, 3500 lb, and 3600 lb. axles.
4. Pack cavity between the seal lips with a high-melting
point wheel bearing lubricant, position seal in axle
housing bore and tap seal into position so that it bot
toms against bearing (fig. 45). To install seal, use
Tool J - 21491 for the 2400 and 2900 lb. axles; Tool
J-21051 for the 3300 lb, 3500 lb, and 3600 lb. axles.
AXLE SHAFT
Fig. 42 - W h eel Bolt Replacement
Removal
1. Raise vehicle to desired working height and remove BRAKE FLANGE BACKING PLATE REPLACEMENT
wheel and tire assembly and brake drum.
2. Clean all dirt and foreign material from area of 1. Remove brake line at wheel cylinder inlet and disas
carrier cover. semble brake components from flange plate. Refer
3. Loosen carrier cov er-to-carrier bolts slightly to al to Section 5 for brake disassembly procedure.
low lubricant to drain from carrier. Remove car 2. Remove four nuts securing flange plate to axle hous
rier cover and gasket. ing (fig. 43).
4. Remove the differential pinion shaft lockscrew and 3. Install new flange plate to axle housing and torque
the differential pinion shaft (fig. 41). nuts to specifications.
5. Push flanged end of axle shaft toward center of vehi 4. Install brake components on flange and connect hy
cle and remove "C" lock from button end of shaft. draulic line to wheel cylinder inlet. Refer to Section
6 . Remove axle shaft from housing, being careful not to 5 for brake assembly procedure.
damage oil seal at end of housing. 5. Bleed and adjust brakes as outlined in Section 5.
F ig . 47 - D rive Pinion N ut Removal F ig . 4 9 - Drive Pinion Flange O il Seal Installation (Light-D uty)
AXLE ASSEMBLY
The optionally available Positraction differential unit is 3. On K and P20 series vehicles, remove brake drum
installed in the conventional carrier to replace the stand and disconnect parking brake cable at lever and at
ard differential unit. flange plate. (See Section 5 for cable removal.)
Service procedures for the Positraction equipped axle 4. Disconnect hydraulic brake hose at connector on rear
are the same as on a conventional axle except for the ”oji axle housing. (If vehicle is equipped with air brakes,
disconnect air line at brake chambers, and tie lines sealer (such as Permatex Type A) to bolt
out of the way.) threads. Use care in the amount of sealer ap
5. Disconnect shock absorbers at axle brackets. plied, as in too heavy an application, the sealer
6 . Support axle assembly with hydraulic jack, remove may be forced out as the bolt is installed and
spring "U" bolts, and lower axle assembly to the may destroy sealing effect of the flange-to-hub
floor. gasket.
ll,0 0 0 r 13,500 AND 15,000 LB. AXLES
Installation 1. Remove hub cap, and install Tool J-8117 in tapped
hole on shaft flange.
1. Place axle assembly under vehicle, raise into posi 2. Install slide hammer (Tool J-2619) and remove axle
tion, install spring "U" bolts, anchor plates and nuts, shaft (fig. 56).
and tighten securely. (On P30 series vehicles make 3. Thoroughly remove old gasket material from hub and
sure that stabilizer anchor plates are properly posi hub cap. Clean shaft flange and mating surfaces in
tioned on forward "U" bolts.) the wheel hub.
2. Connect and secure shock absorbers to axle 4. Install axle shaft so that the flange splines index into
brackets. hub splines. Tap shaft into position, using J-8117
3. Connect hydraulic brake hose to connector on axle and J-2619.
housing, and bleed hydraulic system as specified in
Section 5. (If vehicle is equipped with air brakes,
connect air line at brake chambers—test connections
to make sure that there is no leakage.)
4. On K and P20 series vehicles, connect hand brake
cables and adjust parking brakes as specified in
Section 5.
5. Reassemble the rear universal joint, making sure
that "U" bolts are drawn up tight and locked prop
erly. Caution should be taken not to overtighten ”U"
bolt nuts and cause bearing cups to become distorted.
6 . Install rear wheels, remove stand jacks, and lower
vehicle.
7. Test operation of brakes and rear axle.
5. Install new hub cap-to-hub gasket, position hub cap to to loosen flange and dowels.
hub and install attaching bolts—torque bolts to 14 ft. 3. Remove tapered dowels from studs and pull axle
lbs. shaft from housing. In some instances it may be
necessary to spread dowels to permit removal.
17,000 LB. AXLE 4. Thoroughly clean old gasket material from wheel hub
1. Remove the axle shaft flange-to-hub retaining nuts. and axle shaft flange, and install a new gasket over
(Refer to Figure 57.) hub studs and against hub.
2. Strike the center of shaft flange with a lead hammer 5. Install axle shaft so that splines are aligned with dif-
1. A x le Shaft 7. Drum 12. Drum-to-Hub Retaining 17. A x le Shaft Thrust 21. W h ee l Stud
2 . A x le Shaft-to-W heel Bolt 8. O il Deflector Screw Spacer 22. Drum-to-Hub Retaining Bolt
3. Adjusting N u t Lock N u t 9. O il Deflector 13. Thrust Washer 18. Hub Cap 23. Tapered Dowel
4 . Hub O uter Bearing Assembly 10. O il Seal 14. Bearing Adjusting N ut 19. Hub Cap Retaining 24. Axle-to-H ub Retaining Stud
5 . Hub O uter Bearing Retainer 11. Hub Inner Bearing 15. Adjusting N u t Lock Bolt 25. A x le Shaft-to-Hub Retaining
6. W h eel Bolt Assembly 16. G asket 20. O il Seal N ut
1. A x le Shaft 6. W h eel Bolt 11. Hub Inner Bearing Assembly 16. Gasket
2. A x le Shaft-to-W heel Hub 7. Drum 12. Drum-to-Hub Retaining Screw 17. A x le Shaft Thrust Spacer
Retaining Bolt 8 . O il Deflector 13. Thrust Washer 18. Hub Cap
3. Adjusting N u t Lock N u t 9. O il D eflector 14. Bearing Adjusting N ut 19. Hub Cap Retaining Bolt
4. Hub O u ter Bearing Assembly 10. O il Seal 15. Adjusting N u t Lock 20. Hub Inner Bearing Spacer
5. Hub O uter Bearing Retainer
ferential side gear and flange holes index over hub NOTE: On 5200 through 15,000 lb. axles, re
studs. move thrust washer from housing tube.
6 . Install tapered dowel over each hub stud. Install and
tighten stud nuts to 90 ft. lbs. torque. 5. Pull hub and drum assembly straight off axle hous
7. Observe that clearance exists between face of stud ing, using care on the 11,000, through 17,000 lb.
nuts and axle shaft flange. If no clearance exists, axles to avoid dropping outer bearing inner race and
this indicates excessive wear at studs, tapered dow roller assembly.
els, or flange holes—replace worn part if necessary.
NOTE: The hub oil seal should be replaced
HUB AND DRUM whenever the hub is removed for any reason.
(Refer to Figures 57 and 58.)
6 . Remove oil seal.
Removal
PRESS TOO L
BAR STOCK
3. Position bearing cup in hub--thick edge of cup toward NOTE: Inner bearing assembly must be re
shoulder in hub—then, using applicable cup installer moved before attempting to replace outer bear
as specified, press cup into hub until it seats on hub ing assembly.
shoulder (fig. 61). Make certain that cup is not
cocked and that it is fully seated against shoulder. 1. Using a punch of suitable length, tap bearing outer
a. J-8114 (Use with J-8092 driver handle)—5200 and race away from bearing retaining ring (fig. 62). Then
7200 lb. axles. remove retaining ring from hub—using pliers for re
b. J-8093 (Use with J-8092 driver handle)--11,000 moval of ring on 5200 and 7200 lb. axle (fig. 62),
Fig . 62 - Removing Bearing Retainer Ring (5200 and 7200 Lb. A xles)
Drum Replacement
axle shaft and hub. The drum is held to the hub by coun
tersunk, slotted screws, which are easily removed with a
screwdriver.
F ig . 68 - W h ee l Bolt Replacement should be inspected when the hub and bearing assembly is
removed from the axle housing (fig. 70).
If inspection dictates the need for replacement, pry the
sleeve and spacer assembly from the housing, being
careful not to damage machined surface of axle housing.
P ress a new bearing spacer into the ID of a new
sleeve - spacer should seat against bottom of sleeve.
CAUTION: The O P of the sleeve is the running
surface for the hub oil seal. Use extreme care
to prevent damage to this surface when install
ing the bearing spacer (fig. 70).
Tap the sleeve assembly onto the axle housing until the
bearing spacer contacts shoulder on housing.
Pry old seal from its location in the hub bore, using
care so as not to damage bore surface. Thoroughly clean
all oil and foreign matter from seal contact area in hub
bore. Pack the cavity between the seal lips with a high-
melting point wheel bearing lubricant, and position seal
in hub bore. Carefully press the seal into the hub bore,
using appropriate tool until seal is properly seated
(fig. 69)
1. J-22351 5200 and 7200 lb. axles - Seal should be
installed flush with end of hub.
2 . J-22354 11.000 lb. axle - Seal should be installed
flush with end of hub.
3. J-22352 13,500 lb. axle - Seal should be installed
flush with end of hub.
4. J-22353 15.000 lb. axle with 15 x 4 inch brake -
Seal should be installed so that it makes
direct contact with bearing race.
5. J-22335 15,000 lb. axle with 15 x 5 inch brake
M50 trailing axle (single-speed)
M50 trailing axle (two-speed)
15.000 lb. two-speed axle
17.000 lb. single-speed axle (fig. 70)
17.000 lb. two-speed axle
Seal should be installed flush with end of
F ig . 6 9 - Installing Wheel Hub O il Seal hub.
On-the-Vehicle Check
DRIVE LINE
REAR AXLE (CHEVROLET) TWO-SPEED
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip t io n ......................................................... 4-35 Shifter Spring R eplacem en t.......................................... 4-43
Maintenance and A djustm en t............................................. 4-37 Vacuum Shift Control Switch R ep lacem en t.................. 4-43
Component Parts Replacem ent.......................................... 4-37 Speedometer Adapter Control Switch Replacement . . . 4-44
Electric Shift S y s t e m ................................................... 4-37 Speedometer Adapter Control Switch Housing
Vacuum Cylinder Diaphragm R eplacem en t.................. 4-42 or Case R e p la c e m e n t................................................ 4-44
Vacuum Cylinder Oil Seal Replacement ..................... 4-42
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Chevrolet two-speed axle (fig. 73) is optionally vere service. A distinctive feature is that only the
available in both the 15,000 and 17,000 lb. capacity. In straddle mounted drive pinion and the ring gears operate
low gear, torque is transmitted to the differential case to produce the high range reduction, the planet and sun
through four planetary pinions to provide long life in se gears being locked to revolve with the ring gear.
1. Pinion Flange 10. Pinion Rear Bearing 18. Thrust Washers 26. Planet Gears (4)
2. Dust D eflector 11. D ifferential and Planet 19. D ifferential and Planet 27. D ifferential and Planet
3. Pinion O il Seal Support Support Case Support Case Cover
4. Pinion Front Bearing 12. D ifferential Bearing (Right) 20. A x le Housing Cover 28. Shift Yoke
5. Pinion Adjusting Shim 13. A x le Shaft g e ld e d ) 29. Shift Sleeve
6. Pinion Bearing Preload 14. A x le Housing 21. D ifferential Pinion 30. Anchor Bolt Lock
Spacer 15. Differential Bearing Adjusting 22. F ille r Plug 31. Anchor
7. Pinion Interm ediate Bearing N u t (Right) 23. D ifferential Pinion Shaft 32. Sun G e a r
8. Pinion 16. O il Baffle 24. D ifferential Side G e a r (Left) 33. Ring G e a r
9. D ifferential C arrier 17. Adjusting N u t Lock (Right) 25. M agnetic C hip C o lle c to r 34. Pinion and Bearing Retainer
The electric shift control system is composed of the The power lead for the shift unit is connected to the
manual control switch, speedometer adapter, axle shift "cold" side of the ignition switch at the accessory term i
unit, circuit breaker, and connecting wiring or "harness" nal, therefore, the entire system will be "dead" until the
(fig. 74). ignition switch is turned to the "ON" position.
A thermal type circuit breaker installed on the front of
MANUAL CONTROL SWITCH the dash panel provides protection in case of a short c ir
The control switch, incorporated in the transmission cuit in the electric shift system during vehicle operation.
control lever (fig. 75), has two positions, up for high axle Should a short circuit occur the breaker will intermit
range and down for low axle range. When the switch op tently de-energize the circuit until the trouble has been
erating knob is in either of these positions, a wiper con corrected.
tact on the arm completes a circuit between the battery Three wires in the shift main harness (fig. 74) are
and the motor in the axle shift unit (fig. 74). connected to the control switch. The red wire connects
To inspect or replace the control switch, disassemble the battery (thru the ignition switch and circuit breaker)
the transmission control lever knob by removing the to the control switch. The white wire connects the con
screw at top center of the knob, then lift off the knob top trol switch (thru the automatic switch) to one field of the
half to expose the switch. axle shift unit motor. The black lead connects the con
trol switch (thru the automatic switch) to the other field
SPEEDOMETER ADAPTER of the axle shift unit motor and also connects the speed
ometer adapter.
The speedometer adapter, installed behind the speed
ometer, provides correct speedometer reading with the
axle in either high or low range. By introducing a gear
OPERATION
reduction into the speedometer drive upon shift to axle The operation of the units in each speed range is ex
low range, the unit compensates for the increased pro plained in the following paragraphs.
peller shaft speed relative to vehicle forward speed en
countered in axle low range. When the axle is shifted to
high range, the speedometer drive is "straight thru" the HIGH SPEED RANGE
adapter.
The inner mechanism is prelubricated and sealed by When the control switch operating arm is moved to the
the manufacturer. In the event of failure, the adapter is up (HI) position, current is supplied to one field of the
replaced as a unit. motor in the axle shift unit. This current turns the a r
mature and the drive screw in a clockwise direction and
AXLE SHIFT UNIT moves the nut toward the bottom of the screw (fig. 77).
When the nut has traveled far enough to wind the
The axle shift unit is mounted on the differential car spring, a contact bumper on the nut breaks an electrical
rie r as shown in Figure 76. This unit contains a rev ers connection on the automatic switch which de-energizes
ible electric motor, which when energized, shifts the axle the motor and stops armature rotation. The nut is held
into the desired range through the mechanism contained at the end of its travel on the screw by a detent spring on
in the unit (fig. 74). the shift housing front cover.
SPEEDOMETER
ADAPTER
IGNITION
SWITCH
A CCESSO R Y
T E R M IN A L
MANUAL
' RED"-' CONTROL
(TO T E M P . P IN K ) SWITCH
CIRCUIT BREAKER
SHIFT MOTOR
B LA C K
R IB B E D ,
V— □ ----
CONNECTOR
AUTOMATIC
SWITCH
Fig . 7 4 - Electric Shift Control System W irin g Diagram and Shift Unit Details
1. M otor Attaching Screw 9. Jam N ut 15. Actuating Lever Shaft 22. C o ver Screw
2. C ab le C lip 10. Bearing Assembly 16. Actuating Lever 23. Drive Screw Assembly
3. Motor Assembly 11. Lock N ut 17. Torsion Spring 24. Contact Bumper
4 . M otor C over Gasket 12. Bearing Cover 18. Spring W inding Lever 25. Terminal N u t
5. Shift Housing G asket 19. C over G asket 26. Switch Screw
6. Bushing 13. Bearing C over 20. Front C over 27. Sw itch Assembly
7. Insulator 14. Screw 21. F ille r Plug 28. Sw itch G asket
AXLE
Fig . 76 - E le c tric Shift U nit Mounting Fig. 78 - Shift U nit in Low Range Position
SERVICE OPERATIONS
GENERAL MAINTENANCE SHIFT UNIT SERVICE
The only general maintenance necessary on the shift Removal
control system is to make sure that all wiring is in good 1. Disconnect one of the battery cables.
condition, with connections tight at terminals, connectors, 2. Remove two shift housing to carrie r stud nuts and
and that the axle shift unit is filled with lubricant to lock washer (fig. 76).
proper level. 3. Remove shift unit assembly from carrier (fig. 79).
The shift unit should be filled with lubricant to the Check condition of rubber seal assembly between
filler opening on the front cover using SAE 10 engine oil. shift unit and ca rrier. This seal must be in good
At ambient temperatures below 0 °F use SAE 5W. The oil condition and be held tightly to the shift yoke by the
level should be checked every 10,000 miles or 3 months, spring clamp to prevent axle lubricant from leaking
whichever occurs first. into shift unit.
Disassembly
Key numbers in text refer to Figure 74.
1. Remove six screws (22) and lock washers which at
tach cover (20) to shift motor housing (5). Drain
lubricant from housing. Remove gasket (19).
2. After removing cover, the drive screw nut (25) will
be at either top or bottom depending upon the posi
tion in which the control switch was left.
3. By turning drive screw, run nut from top or bottom
to the center of the screw (fig. 80).
F ig . 7 9 - Shift Unit Removed from C a rrie r F ig . 81 - Removing Shaft, Actuating Lever and Spring
the nut gets to either end of the screw, the screw should Observe condition of fiber contact bumper (24); if
continue to turn, but the nut should not jam or run off the broken or excessively worn, pull out old bumper and
ends. press in new.
Electric Motor. The closed type reversible field motor
(serviced only as an assembly) requires no lubrication NOTE: All gaskets removed should be re
and cannot be disassembled for repair. Motor service placed by new gaskets to assure proper sealing
ability can be determined by performing the following of the unit.
tests.
With the motor housing connected to one battery term i
nal, and either one of the two motor wires connected to Assembly
the other battery terminal, the motor will run in one di
rection. With the other motor wire connected to the bat 1. Install automatic switch assembly into housing using
tery, motor will run in the opposite direction. flat head screw to attach switch to housing. On out
Connected to a 12 volt test circuit, the shift motor, free side of housing, install insulator, and jam nuts on
running (no load), should "turn up" 10,000 RPM with a switch terminal screws. Tighten nuts firmly.
maximum draw of 6 amperes. 2. Position motor cover gasket on housing and insert
CAUTION: Do_ not overheat the motor while motor (with cover) into housing. Install cable clip
making the following tests: and the three cover screws and lock washers.
Tighten screws firmly.
Place motor in vise, then clamp a small crescent 3. Attach motor wires to switch terminals. The longer
wrench on the rectangular drive on the armature shaft wire attaches to bottom terminal. Tighten terminal
and grasp wrench handle with one hand. Connect one nuts.
motor wire to a battery terminal and connect motor hous 4. With a screwdriver inserted into slot of drive screw,
ing to the other battery terminal. The wrench should tend install bearing on end of screw with shielded side of
to turn with a torque of about 6 in. lbs. Allow wrench to bearing toward inside as shown in Figure 82. Retain
turn very slowly, making sure that this pull or torque is bearing with bearing lock nut.
present the full 360 degrees turn of the wrench. If one 5. Run drive nut to center of drive screw, then insert
section of the armature is defective, the torque will dis slotted end of screw into housing, meshing slotted
appear for a small part of the 360 degrees. end with armature shaft.
Apply enough load to the motor in test circuit to mo
mentarily stop armature rotation (stall the motor). The MOTE: Fiber bumper contact on drive nut
current draw at stall should be a minimum of 40 must be toward switch.
amperes.
Miscellaneous P arts. Inspect bearing (10), if balls are 6 . Install bearing gasket and cover with three screws
rough or chipped, replace with new bearing and snap ring and lock washers. Tighten screws securely.
assembly. Pack bearing assembly with chassis lubricant. 7. Dip above assembly in S.A.E. 10 engine oil. With
Check torsion spring (17) for breaks or wear at lever drive nut on drive screw assembly in center of
contact points. screw, and fiber contact bumper down toward switch,
position the slots of winding lever over the drive nut.
Install the lever shaft through center of assembly
into depression in housing.
8 . Install front cover gasket on housing. Install housing
front cover with detent spring against drive nut. At
tach cover securely with screws and lock washers.
Replacement
Fig . 84 - Removing Autom atic Switch 1. Remove clamps from hose connections and remove
hoses from fittings.
Installation 2. Remove the three lower retaining bolts and lock
washers that attach the vacuum cylinder to the dif
1. Check the two lead wires on the housing terminals. ferential carrier housing and remove the vacuum
2. With the seal between the carrier and shift unit po cylinder assembly from the differential carrier
sitioned correctly; slide the shift unit on the differ housing.
ential carrier studs with the torsion spring swivel 3. Remove the two retaining bolts and lock washers at
block inserted in the shift fork slot. taching the vacuum cylinder to its housing and sepa
3. Install the stud nuts, tightening to 50-70 foot-pounds rate the two assemblies.
torque. 4. Remove the screws that attach the two halves of the
4. F ill the shift unit to operating capacity with lubricant vacuum cylinder and remove the outer half.
as specified under "General Maintenance." 5. Remove the diaphragm plates, and shaft as an as
5. Check installation by making a "LO" and "HI" range sembly.
shift. Ignition must be turned on before check can be 6 . Drive the old seal out of the housing.
made. 7. Soak new seal in engine oil to provide for initial lu
brication. Coat outer diameter of seal with Perm a
NOTE: The shift unit motor runs equally well tex and replace it in the inner half of the cylinder
in either direction, however, if the lead wires with the free side of the leather down and press it
are reversed at the terminals on the shift unit, into place with seal installer Tool J-0968.
the axle will shift to the opposite range of that 8 . Assemble the diaphragm shaft assembly into the
indicated on the control switch. housing.
9. Install the outer cover, and retaining screws.
6 . Connect wire at plug.
CAUTION: Install the cover with the vacuum
VACUUM CYLINDER DIAPHRAGM line connection aligned with the connection on the
lower outer cover.
Replacement
10. Assemble the vacuum cylinder assembly into its
1. Remove clamps on hose connections at the vacuum housing, install the two retaining bolts and lock
cylinder and slip hoses off the connecting fittings. washers and tighten securely.
2. Remove the three retaining bolts and lock washers
NOTE: The felt seal and felt seal in the hous
retaining the vacuum cylinder assembly to the dif
ing should be inspected for damage and replaced
ferential ca rrier housing and remove the vacuum
when necessary.
cylinder assembly from the vehicle.
3. Remove the screws that attach the two halves of the 11. Install the completed assembly to the carrie r housing
vacuum cylinder and remove the outer half. with new gasket and the three retaining bolts and lock
4. Using two 1/2" open end wrenches, one to hold the washers and tighten securely.
push rod inner nuts and the other to remove the outer 12. Replace the hose connections and install clamps.
nut from the push rod, remove the diaphragm plates 13. Test the operation of the shifting mechanism in all
and diaphragm. speeds.
SHIFTER SPRING
Replacement
Reinstall transmission shift lever knob. VACUUM SHIFT UNIT CONTROL SWITCH
6 . Route cable to axle shift control valve, insert control
cable into valve assembly and tighten conduit retain
HOUSING OR CASE REPLACEMENT
ing fitting to 115 in. lbs. 1. Remove the two screws securing the axle shift con
7. Seat shoulder on control cable knob against housing, trol valve to the frame side member mounted
then tighten set screw to retain cable and install bracket.
valve-to-bracket retaining screws.
8 . Connect electrical leads to speedometer adapter and NOTf: Do not disconnect control valve vac
fuse block. Make sure all cable retaining clips are uum, atmosphere or air cleaner lines.
secured.
9. Test operation of shift system. 2. Tilt or slide the control valve as required to obtain
access to cable retaining screw and disconnect cable
SPEEDOMETER ADAPTER CONTROL from valve.
SWITCH REPLACEMENT 3. Withdraw cable from conduit by pulling shift knob
from switch housing on transmission shift lever.
1. Remove the transmission shift lever knob, then re 4. Remove the transmission shift lever knob, then re
move the two screws retaining switch housing to move the two screws retaining switch housing case to
transmission shift lever. Remove pin that retains transmission lever. Transfer conduit and speedom
switch housing to rubber case and slide switch hous eter adapter switch to new housing.
ing from rubber case. 5. Loosely install the new switch housing case in ap
2. Remove two screws retaining adapter control switch proximately the same position as the old housing,
to switch housing and disconnect electrical leads and install control cable and knob assembly by feed
from switch (fig. 8 8 ). ing end of cable through switch housing and conduit.
3. Connect electrical leads to new switch, position and 6 . Secure switch housing to transmission lever as spec
secure adapter control switch to switch housing with ified in Step 5 of "Vacuum Shift Unit Control Switch
retaining screws. Replacement."
4. Reinstall switch housing to rubber case and secure 7. Seat shoulder on control cable knob against housing,
with pin. Secure switch housing rubber case to then tighten set screw to retain cable at the axle shift
transmission shift lever as specified in Step 5 of control valve, and install valve-to-bracket retaining
"Vacuum Shift Unit Control Switch Replacement." screws.
5. Test operation of shift system. 8 . Test operation of shift system.
DRIVE LINE
REAR AXLE (EATON) SINGLE SPEED
INDEX
Page
General Description ......................................................... ....4-44
Maintenance and Adjustments .......................................... ... 4_46
Component Part Replacement .......................................... ....4 - 4 6
Axle Assembly ............................................................ ... 4_46
Removal .................................................................. ... 4_46
In stallation ............................................................... ... 4-46
Axle Vent R ep lacem en t................................................ ... 4-46
Axle Shaft Removal and Replacem ent........................... ... 4 _ 4 6
Hub and D r u m ............................................................... ... 4-46
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Eaton 18,500 Single Speed Spiral Bevel Drive rear pinion. Pinion bearings are of the opposed tapered roller
axle is used in regular production on the 60 Series truck, bearing type, and are a press fit on the drive pinion shaft.
except on flat face cowl models. A straight roller type pilot bearing is pressed onto the
Model 17121 and 17101 use an identical differential inner end of the drive pinion and seats in a machined bore
head assembly, the only difference being the size of the in the differential carrier.
ring and pinion gear (fig. 89). Drive pinion bearing preload adjustment is controlled
by thickness of the bearing spacer installed between the
DRIVE PINION AND CAGE two tapered roller bearings.
Shims between the pinion cage and carrier provide a
Both axles are equipped with a straddle mounted drive means for adjusting pinion depth in the carrie r to attain
correct tooth contact between the ring gear and pinion. carrier provide for adjustment of differential side bear
ing pre-load and ring gear-drive pinion backlash.
DIFFERENTIAL
The differential carrier assembly may be removed, AXLE SHAFTS AND HOUSING
while the axle is still installed in the truck, after the axle
shafts have been removed. Axle shafts are full-floating type, splined to differential
The drive pinion assembly and the differential case side gears at inner ends and attached at flanged outer
assembly are mounted in the differential ca rrier, and are ends to hubs by studs and nuts. Stud holes in each shaft
removed as part of the ca rrie r when the ca rrie r is re flange are taper-reamed to accommodate split tapered
moved from the axle housing. dowels.
The differential is a conventional four pinion type with The banjo-type axle housing is one-piece design with
ring gear bolted to flanged half of differential case. Dif spring seats welded in place. Brake flange plates are
ferential case is a two-piece type machined as a matched riveted to flanges welded on the axle housing tube. Outer
assembly, and must be replaced as such. ends of housing are machined to accommodate wheel
Thrust washers are used between differential side bearings and threads are cut at extreme outer ends for
gears and case, and between differential pinions and case. installation of wheel bearing nuts. The axle housing bowl
Adjusting rings in the differential bearing bores of the cover is welded to the axle housing.
1. Flange Nut 7. Bearing Cone - O uter 13. Bearing 18. Case Bolt 23. Bearing Cap
2. Pinion Flange 8. Adjusting Spacer 14. A x le Shaft - R .H . 19. Pinion Thrust 24. Bearing Cone
3. O il Seal 9. Bearing Cup - Inner 15. D ifferential Case Washer 25. Adjusting N u t
4. Pinion Cage 10. Bearing Cone - Inner 16. Side G e a r Thrust 20. D ifferential Pinion 26. Adjusting N u t Lock
5. Adjust ng Shims 11. D rive Pinion Washer 21. Ring G e a r 27. A x le Shaft - L.H .
6. Bearing Cup - O u te r 12. D ifferen tial C arrier 17. Side G e a r 22. Ring G e a r Bolt
1. Install the wheels, then roll the axle assembly into See 17,000 lb. Chevrolet Single Speed "Hub and Drum."
DRIVE LINE
REAR AXLE (EATON) TWO-SPEED
INDEX
Page
General Description ......................................................... .... 4 - 4 7
Maintenance and Adjustments .......................................... .... 4-47
Component Part Replacement .......................................... .... 4-48
Axle Assembly ............................................................ .... 4-48
Removal ...................................................................... 4-48
In stallatio n ............................................................... .... 4-48
Axle Vent Replacement ................................................ ... 4-48
Axle Shaft Removal and Installation ............................... 4-48
Hub and D r u m ............................................................... .... 4-48
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Eaton 18,500 capacity two-speed axles, Models for description and maintenance information on electrical
17201 and 17221 are optionally available on all 60 Series system.
trucks. The Axle Shafts, Housing, Wheels and Hubs used on the
Both models are equipped with a spiral bevel ring gear 17201 and 17221 Model axles are the same as those out
and pinion. The two axles are sim ilar in construction, lined in 17,000 lb. Chevrolet Single-Speed.
the only difference being the drive gear diameter is An improved lubrication system (fig. 90) which has a
larger on the 17221 model. steel reinforced nitrite scraper mounted to the inside of
An electric power shifting arrangement is used to as the carrier. This scraper is positioned to collect oil
sist in making ratio changes. The driver selector control from the surface of the rotating gear support case. Oil
is mounted on the shift lever. Refer to "Rear Axle (Chev is channeled to the right-hand differential bearing,
rolet) Two-Speed E lectric Shift System" in this section through the differential and planetary unit to the left-hand
differential bearing and back to the reservoir.
DRIVE LINE
TANDEM AND POWER DIVIDER (EATON)
INDEX
Page
General Description ......................................................... ....4-50
Maintenance and A djustm ent............................................. ....4-50
Rearward Rear Axle ................................................... ....4-50
Forward Rear A x l e ...................................................... ....4-50
Service O p e ra tio n s............................................................ ....4-50
Inter-Axle Differential Lock Shift S y s t e m .................. ....4-50
Vacuum Operated...................................................... ....4-50
O p e ra t io n ............................................................ ....4-50
Checking for L e a k a g e .......................................... ....4-51
Solenoid Lock Valve . . . ................................. ....4-51
Locking C y l i n d e r ................................................ ... 4-52
A ir O p e ra te d ............................................................ ....4-52
O p e ra t io n ............................................................ ....4-52
Checking for L e a k a g e .......................................... ....4-52
Control V a l v e ...................................................... .... 4 - 5 3
A ir Shift C y lin d e r................................................ ... 4-53
Differential Lockout
Removal and In s ta lla tio n .................................... ... 4-53
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The tandem rear axle installation (fig. 91) consists of a allow differential action between the two axles. When
rearward rear axle (Eaton Model 30R) and a forward rear extra traction is required to move the vehicle, the inter
axle (Eaton Model 30D) which carries a single speed axle differential can be locked out so equal power can be
power divider with an inter-axle differential. An air or delivered to each axle. A toggle switch in the driver's
vacuum operated shift mechanism is used to lock out the compartment actuates the solenoid-controlled, vacuum
inter-axle differential to provide positive drive to both operated, lock-out shift lever at the axle. The air system
axles when required. is controlled by a lever operated valve in the drivers
Drive is transmitted from the transmission through a compartment. Air pressure actuates a shift cylinder
conventional propeller shaft to the power divider input which is mounted on the axle. Both systems move the
shaft (fig. 91). The input shaft supports the inter-axle sliding clutch into engagement with the input shaft helical
differential which transmits equal driving force to two gear. A light installed on the dash warns when differen
helical gears, one mated to a gear on the forward rear tial is locked out.
axle pinion shaft to drive the forward axle and the other
mated to a gear on the power divider output shaft to NOTE: Use lockout only in slippery going.
transmit drive force through an inter-axle propeller shaft When differential is to be locked out, vehicle
to the rearward axle. Both axles drive at all times, so must be completely stopped. Continuous unnec
the inter-axle differential (3rd differential) is provided to essary use of lockout must be avoided.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
INTER-AXLE DIFFERENTIAL
LOCK SHIFT SYSTEM
VACUUM OPERATED
Operation
LOCKING CYLINDER
1. D ifferential C arrier Cover 10. Diaphragm
When leakage tests indicate the locking cylinder as 2. Bracket 11. C ylin d er (O uter H alf)
sembly leaks, it must be removed and disassembled, and 3. Push Rod Yoke 12. Vacuum Line Fitting
the rubber diaphragm in the cylinder must be replaced. 4. Boot 13. N ut
1. Disconnect the control valve hose from the cylinder. 5. Lock N ut 14. Plate Washer
Remove the cotter pin and the clevis pin which se 6. Push Rod 15. Plate (Large)
cure the bracket lever to the push rod. Remove the 7. Snap Ring 16. Plate (Sm all)
snap ring which secures the cylinder in the bracket, 8. Dowel 17. Lock-Out Shift
and remove the assembly from the bracket. Remove 9. C y lin d e r (Inner H alf) Lever
the boot from the push rod. sure limit (100 to 105 lbs.). Place lock control lever
2. Remove the clevis yoke and nut from the push rod in "LOCK" position.
(fig. 95). Remove the screws, nuts, and lock wash 2. Coat all air line connections with soap suds to check
ers which attach the two halves of the cylinder and for leakage. No leakage is permissible. Leakage
the rubber diaphragm together. Remove the outer can sometimes be corrected by tightening the con
half of the cylinder, and separate the rubber dia nection. If this fails to correct leakage, disconnect
phragm from the inner half of the cylinder. leaking fitting and replace seal ring around tube
3. Install a new diaphragm and push rod assembly in the flare.
rear half of the cylinder. 3. Coat entire surface of lock shift cylinder and control
4. Make certain the mating faces of the cylinder halves valve with soap suds to check for leakage. If leakage
are clean. Position the outer half of the cylinder on is evident in either unit, remove faulty unit and over
the rubber diaphragm, and install the screws, nuts, haul as directed under individual heads.
and new lock washers. Install the boot, nut, and
clevis yoke on the push rod. CONTROL VALVE
5. Make certain that the snap ring groove on the inner
Control valve (fig. 97) used in "Air-Operated Differen-
half of the cylinder is clean. Position the cylinder in
the bracket on the power divider with the slot in the
rear half of the cylinder at the bottom.
6 . Install the retaining snap ring and seat it solidly in
the groove. Attach the bracket lever to the rod
clevis with a clevis pin and a new cotter pin. Attach
the vacuum line to the locking cylinder. Test the
system for vacuum leaks.
AIR OPERATED
Operation
Air operated differential lock utilizes air pressure
from the air brake system for its operation. Units used
in air-operated power shift system are: Shift Control
Valve, mounted on engine side of dash; check valve, in
stalled in air line at control valve air inlet; differential
lock shift cylinder, mounted on forward rear axle torque
divider case cover; and interconnecting air lines and
fittings.
With lock control lever (fig. 96) in "UNLOCK” position,
there is no air pressure in differential lock shift cylin
der. Shift return compression spring holds cylinder
piston and lock linkage in unlocked position.
When lock control lever (fig. 96) is moved to "LOCK"
position, air pressure is admitted behind lock shift cylin
der piston. As air pressure forces the piston outward,
the differential lock is shifted into locked position.
INTER AXLE
DIFFERENTIAL
CK ! I N i n
1. Instrument 8. V a lv e Spring
Panel 9. O-ring
2. Name Plate 10. Cap Nut
3. Fulcrum Pin 11. To Intake M anifo ld
4. Control Lever or A ir Tank
5. Exhaust Port 12. To Shift C ylin d er
6. Body 13. Plunger Spring
F ig . 9 6 - D iffe re n tial Lock Control Lever and Plate (Typ ical) 7 . V a lv e Disc 14. Plunger
tial Lock" system is the same as previously described in Shift cylinder should be removed, disassembled, and
this section under "Vacuum-Operated Differential Lock." the piston seals replaced whenever leakage is indicated
at the cylinder.
AIR SHIFT CYLINDER
DIFFERENTIAL LOOKOUT
A piston type shift cylinder is mounted on forward rear
axle torque divider case cover. Piston rod is connected
to sliding clutch. As air pressure is applied to piston,
Removal and Installation
sliding clutch is shifted into locked position. When air Removal and installation instructions may be found in
pressure is exhausted from shift cylinder, spring pres the "Truck Overhaul Manual" under "Vacuum Operated
sure returns sliding clutch to unlocked position. Lockout” or "Air Operated Lockout."
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Tubular type propeller shafts and needle bearing type the wheel base of the vehicle. On vehicles which use two
universal joints are used on all model trucks. An inter or more propeller shafts, each shaft (except the rear) is
nally splined sleeve which compensates for variation in supported near its splined end in a rubber cushioned ball
distance between rear axle and transmission is located at bearing which is mounted in a bracket attached to a frame
the forward end of single or rear propeller shafts cross member. The ball bearing is a permanently sealed
(fig. 98). and lubricated type.
The number of propeller shafts used is dependent upon
1. Front Propeller Shaft and Bearing 8. Rear Propeller Shaft 17. Trunnion
Support Assy. 9. Lock Ring 18. Seal Ring
2. Front Intermediate Propeller Shaft and 10. Bearing Assembly 19. Flange and D eflecto r Assy.
Bearing Support Assy. 11. Lubrication Fitting 20. Bracket
3. Rear Intermediate Shaft and Bearing 12. Plug 21. Cushion
Support Assy. 13. Sleeve 22. S linger
4. Rear Propeller Shaft and Sleeve Assy. 14. Retainer 23. G rease Retainer
5. Frame Cross-member 15. Washer 24. Inner Deflector
6. Guard 16. Cork Packing 25. Dust Shield
7 . " U " Clamp
shaft and sleeve assembly, slide seal retainer, size or rear axles of different ratios than those furnished
steel washer and cork seal on spline of mating as standard equipment for the various units. Either one,
shaft. Assemble these parts to sleeve by turn or both, of these things will, of course, change tire revo
ing retainer onto sleeve after rear propeller lutions per mile and result in speedometer inaccuracies.
shaft is installed. When such change or changes are made, it is necessary
to change the speedometer gears or to use a speedometer
NOTE 2: Tighten front flange (transmission
adapter with the present gears. In certain combination
attachment) nuts to 29-42 ft. lbs., propeller shaft
changes of both rear axle and tires, it may be necessary
flange nuts to 100-150 ft. lbs., bearing support
to change the speedometer gears and use, in addition, an
nuts to 25-35 ft. lbs., propeller shaft guard nuts
adapter to bring about proper speedometer readings.
to 160-180 ft. lbs., and trunnion bearing "U"
Speedometer gear adapters are available if needed, to
clamp nuts to the following torques: 5 /1 6 "-2 4 --
be used separately or in conjunction with a change in
14-18 ft. lbs., 3 /8 "-2 4 — 18-22 ft. lbs.; 7 /16"-24—
speedometer gear sets.
29-43 ft. lbs.
The adapter is installed by removing the speedometer
NOTE 3: Over torquing "U" clamp nuts will cable fitting from the transmission case and screwing the
result in bearing cap distortion which will re adapter into the case. The speedometer cable is then
duce roller bearing life. connected to the adapter.
When replacing speedometer gears it is very important
SPEEDOMETER GEARS-SPEED ADAPTERS that the drive gear be pressed onto the spacer or front
In some special types of operation, purchasers of yoke of the universal joint with the shoulder or chamfer
Chevrolet trucks may desire to use tires of a different on the gear away from the universal joint.
SPECIAL TOOLS
1. J-8459 Spring Eye Bushing Remover and Replacement 6. J —8118 Rear Spring Pin P u lle r (Used w ith J —2619)
2. J-21058 Spring Eye Bushing Remover and Replacement 7. J-8448 Series C-P10 and C -30 Control Arm
3. J -7079-2 D river Handle Bushing Installer
4. J-7574-6 Series C20 Tie Rod Bushing Installer 8. J —2619 Slid e Hammer Assembly
5. J —8518 Series C-P10 Tie Rod Bushing Installer 9. J-22620 Spring Eye Bushing Remover and Installer
SPECIAL TOOLS
Fig. 101 - 2400 Through 3600 Lb. C a p acity Drive Line Sp ecial Tools
1. J —8614 Companion Flange Remover—Consisting 7. J -21491 Rear W heel Bearing and O il Sebl
of J-8614-1 Holder J-8614-2 N ut In staller— Light Duty A x le — Used
and J-8614-3 Screw w ith J-8092
2. J-21057 D rive Pinion O il Seal In s ta lle r- 8. J —2619 Rear W heel Bearing and O il Seal
H eavy Duty A x le Remover (Slid e Hammer)
3. J-21468 D rive Pinion O il Seal In sta ller—Light 9. J —8119 Rear W heel Bearing and O il Seal
Duty A x le —Used w ith J-9458 Remover—Used w ith J —2619
4. J-5748 Positraction Torque Measuring Adapter 10. J-8092 D rive H andle—Threaded Type
5. J-9458 D rive Pinion O il Seal In s ta lle r - 11. J-7079-2 D rive H andle— Insert Type
Light Duty A x le — Used with 12. J-21548 Propeller Shaft " U ” Jo in t Trunnion
J-21468 Seal Installer
6. J-21051 Rear W h eel Bearing and O il Seal 13. J-5853 Torque W re n ch —in. lbs.
In sta ller— H eavy D u ty—Used w ith 14. J —5810 Torque W rench Adapter (3/4" to 3 / 8 ")
J -7079-2 15. J-1313 Torque W re n ch —ft. lbs.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Fig . 102 - 5200 lb. C a p a c ity Sin g le Speed Through 18,500 lb. C a p a c ity Two Speed Sp ecia l Tools
1. J-22335 W heel O il Seal In staller 11. J-8092 D river Handle 21. J —22350—1 W heel Bearing Remover
2. J-22353 W heel O il Seal In staller 12. J-8093 W heel Bearing Installer 22. J-22350-2 Adapter (Used with
3. J -22351 W heel O il Seal In staller 13. J —21108 W heel Bearing Installer J —22350—1 and J -22360)
4. J -22352 W heel O il Seal In staller 14. J-22357 W heel Bearing Installer 23. J-22360 W heel Bearing Remover
5. J-22354 W heel O il Seal Installer 15. J-22349 W heel Bearing Installer 24. J —7341 W heel Bearing N u t W rench
6. J —22281 Pinion Flange O il Seal In staller 16. J-21160 W heel Bearing Installer 25. J-22343 W heel Bearing N u t W rench
7. J-2223 W heel Bearing In staller 17. J —8114 W heel Bearing Installer 26. J-5698 W heel Bearing Installer
8. J-2222 W heel Bearing N u t W rench 18. J-5669 W heel Bearing Installer
9. J-0870 W heel Bearing N u t W rench 19. J-22380 Tru-Arc Pliers Tools not Illustrated:
10. J-22359 W heel Bearing In staller 20. J —2619 Slid e Hammer w ith Adapter J-2230 W heel Bearing Remover
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
MAIN CYLINDER rear axle which are equipped with Twinplex two
cylinder, self-adjusting rear brakes. All 60
All 1967 10 through 30 series models (except CA30 and series are equipped with Wagner, two-cylinder,
PA30/14,000 lb. GVW) are equipped with a new dual manually adjusted brakes, front and rear.
brake system as a safety feature. If a wheel cylinder or
brake line should fail at either the front end or rear end Brake shoe adjustment takes place when brakes are
of the vehicle, the operator can still bring the vehicle to a applied with a firm pedal effort while the vehicle is back
controlled stop. The system is designed with separate ing. Applying the brake moves an actuator which turns
hydraulic systems for the front and rear brake using a the star wheel and lengthens the adjusting screw assem
dual main cylinder (Fig. 1). The main cylinder has two bly (Fig. 2). This action adjusts the shoes until clearance
entirely separate reservoirs and outlets in a common between the lining and drum is within proper limits.
body pasting. The front reservoir and outlet is connected Fifty series models with 15,000 lb. single or two-speed
to the front wheel brakes, and the rear reservoir and rear axle are equipped with 15 x 4 o r l 5 x 5 inch rear
outlet is connected to the rear wheel brakes. Two pistons Twinplex brakes (Fig. 3). The Twinplex, self-adjusting
within the main cylinder receive mechanical pressure rear brake is self-centering in operation, utilizing the
from the brake pedal push rod and transmit it through the momentum of the vehicle to assist in the brake applica
brakelines as hydraulic pressure to the wheel cylinders. tion. This self-energizing or self-actuating force is
Main cylinders for CA30, PA30 (14,000 lb. and over applied to both brake shoes at each wheel in both forward
GVW), and all 40 through 60 series models are of the and reverse motion.
single hydraulic system (single main cylinder reservoir)
type. MANUALLY ADJUSTED BRAKES (WAGNER)
NOTE: All 60 series models are equipped with
SELF-ADJUSTING DUO-SERVO BRAKES Wagner, two-cylinder, manually adjusted brakes,
front and rear.
NOTE: All models, 10 thru 40 series, have
self-adjusting duo-servo brakes, front and rear. The Wagner manually adjusted brakes are of two dif
Fifty series models are equipped with self- ferent types: the Type “ F ” (Fig. 4), and the “ F R -3”
adjusting duo-servo brakes front and rear, ex (Fig. 5). The “ F ” has two identical brake shoes mounted
cept those with 15,000 lb. single or two speed on the backing plate so that their toes are diagonally
PA 20-30 PA 40
EXTENSION
SIDE RAIL-LEFT
SIDE
INBOARD FORWARD
W IR E LINK
PRIMARY
SH O E
O VERRID E
LEVER
O VERRID E
S P R IN G
RETURN
S P R IN G
STAR W H E E L
PAW L
Fig. 3—Twinplex Rear Brake O 1. W h eel C y lin d e r Heat 8. Brake Shoe and Lining
Shield Assembly
1. W heel C y lin d e r Heat Shield 7. Brake Shoe Return Spring 2. Upper W h eel C ylin d er 9. Return Spring (Long)
2. W h eel C ylin d er 8. Adjusting Screw Spur W h ee l 3. Anchor Pin 10. Adjusting W h eel Lock
3. W heel C ylin d er Push Rod 9. Brake Line 4. Return Spring (Short) Spring
4. Brake Shoe 10. W h eel C ylin d er 5. G u id e Washer 11. Adjusting W h eel
5. Brake Shoe Return Spring 11. Brake Shoe Anchors 6. G u id e Bolt 12. Lower W h eel C y lin d e r
6. Brake Shoe Hold Down Bolt 7. G u id e Bolt N u t Lock W ire 13. Backing Plate
DUO-SERVO
TYPE "F*
TWINPLEX
TYPE "FR-3”
SW ITC H SW ITCH
SW ITC H
system is provided on all wheel cylinders. On a Twin models are equipped with the propeller shaft type parking
plex brake installation a bleeder valve is used only on brake.
the upper cylinder of the two used on each wheel.
BRAKE PIPE DISTRIBUTION AND
BRAKE LININGS SWITCH ASSEMBLY
CA-KA-PA10-20, GA-PA-30, and GA10-20 models
Brake linings on all 10 series models are attached to
are equipped with a brake pipe distribution and switch
the brake shoes with a special brake bonding process.
assembly (Fig. 8 ). The front and rear hydraulic brake
Only the factory bonded shoe and lining assemblies
lines are routed from the main cylinder, through the
should be used for replacement. On 20 through 60 series
switch assembly, to the front and rear brakes. The
models, linings are riveted to the brake shoes.
switch is wired electrically to the brake alarm indicator
light on the instrument panel. In the event of fluid loss in
PARKING BRAKE either the front or rear brake system, the indicator on
The parking brake on all 1/2, 3/4, and 1 ton models is the instrument panel will illuminate red. (The indicator
the mechanical type which utilizes the action of the serv will also be illuminated when the parking brake is
ice brake shoes in the rear brake assemblies. All other applied.)
REAR SHOE
ADJUSTING WHEEL
Fig . 9—Adjusting Type “ F ” Front Brakes Fig . 10—Adjusting Type “ F R -3 ” Rear Brakes
4. At other adjusting slot, repeat steps 2 and 3 to adjust to bleeder adapter and open release valve on bleeder
other shoe. equipment.
5. Install adjusting hole covers in backing plate. 4. Install brake bleeder wrench, Tool J-7647 on bleeder
valve at wheel cylinder and install one end of bleeder
BLEEDING BRAKES 5. Pour a sufficient amount of brake fluid into a trans
parent container to insure that end of bleeder hose
The hydraulic brake system must be bled whenever any
will remain submerged during bleeding. Place the
line has been disconnected or air has in some way
loose end of bleeder hose into the container. Be sure
entered the system. A ‘'spongy'’ pedal feel when the
the hose end is submerged in the fluid.
brakes are applied may indicate presence of air in the
6 . Open wheel cylinder bleeder valve by turning Tool
system. The system must be absolutely free of air at all
J-7647 counterclockwise approximately 1/3 of a turn
times. Bleeding should be done on the longest line first;
and observe flow of fluid at end of bleeder hose.
the proper sequence to follow is left rear, right rear,
7. Close bleeder valve tightly as soon as bubbles stop
right front, and left front. Bleeding of brake system may
and brake fluid flows in a solid stream from the
be performed by one of two methods—pressure or
bleeder tube.
manual.
8 . Remove brake bleeder wrench and bleeder hose from
wheel cylinder bleeder valve.
Brake Fluid 9. Repeat Steps 4 through 8 on the remaining wheel
Use GM Hydraulic Brake Fluid No. 11 or equivalent cylinders in the correct bleeding sequence.
when servicing brakes. This brake fluid is satisfactory 10. Disconnect bleeder equipment from brake bleeder
for any climate and has all the qualities necessary for adapter cover J-22489.
proper operation, such as a high boiling point to prevent NOTE: The main cylinder on certain passenger
vapor lock and the ability to remain fluid at low car models is tilted upward. When removing the
temperatures. bleeder adapter on these models, place a clean
In the event that improper fluid has entered the system, dry cloth behind and below the cylinder to absorb
it will be necessary to service the system as follows: any fluid spillage as the cover is removed.
1. Drain the entire system.
2. Thoroughly flush the system with clean alcohol, 188 11. Remove bleeder adapter J-22489. Wipe all area dry
proof, or a hydraulic system cleaning fluid such as of fluid if fluid was spilled during adapter removal.
“ Declene” . 12. Fill m aster cylinder reservoirs to within 1/4” of
3. Replace all rubber parts of the system, including reservoir rim s as shown in Figure 13.
brake hoses. 13. Install main cylinder diaphragm and cover.
4. Refill the system.
5. Bleed the system. Dual System (Dual Reservoir Main Cylinder)
1. Clean all dirt from top of main cylinder and remove
Dual System (Dual Reservoir Main Cylinder) cylinder cover and rubber diaphragm.
1. Clean all dirt from top of main cylinder and remove 2. Fill main cylinder reservoir.
cylinder cover and rubber diaphragm. 3. Install brake bleeder wrench, Tool J-7647 on bleeder
2. Reduce fluid level in main cylinder until reservoirs valve at wheel cylinder and install one end of bleeder
are approximately half full. tube J-0628 on bleeder valve.
4. Pour a sufficient amount of brake fluid into a trans
NOTE: Make sure brake fluid in bleeder equip parent container to insure that end of bleeder tube
ment is at operating level and that the equipment will remain submerged during bleeding. Place the
is capable of exerting 30 to 50 lbs. hydraulic loose end of bleeder tube into the container. Be sure
pressure on the brake system. the tube end is submerged in the fluid.
3. Install brake bleeder adapter J - 22489 (fig. 11) on NOTE: Carefully monitor fluid level at main
main cylinder. Connect hose from bleeder equipment cylinder during manual bleeding operations. Do
not bleed enough fluid at one time to drain the
reservoir completely. Replenish the reservoirs
Fig. 11—Brake Bleeder Adapter Tool J-2 2 4 8 9 Installed Fig . 12—Brake Bleeder Tool J-7 6 4 7
with fluid while bleeding to insure a sufficient times. To insure that outside air is not sucked
amount of fluid is in the main cylinder at all back into the hydraulic system, the bleeder valve
should be closed before the brake pedal reaches
the floor.
5. Open wheel cylinder bleeder valve by turning Tool
J-7647 counterclockwise approximately 1/3 of a turn.
Slowly depress brake pedal. Just before brake pedal
reaches the end of its travel, close bleeder valve and
allow brake pedal to return slowly to the fully re
leased position. Repeat this procedure until expelled
brake fluid flows in a solid stream from the bleeder
hose and no bubbles are present, then close bleeder
valve tightly.
6 . Remove brake bleeder wrench and bleeder tube from
wheel cylinder bleeder valve.
7. Repeat Steps 2 through 7 on the remaining wheel
cylinders in the correct bleeding sequence.
8 . Fill the main cylinder to the levels shown in Figure
13.
9. Install main cylinder diaphragm and cover.
FW D
Fig. 17—Eccen tric Bolt Adjustment to obtain the correct clearance between the push rod
and the m aster cylinder, rotate the eccentric bolt so
that the free pedal travel measured at the center of
3. Tighten check nut on eccentric bolt and recheck the pedal pad is approximately 1 / 8 inch (fig. 18).
movement. 2. After tightening the nut on the eccentric bolt to 40-50
ft. lbs. torque, recheck free travel.
BRAKE PEDAL & PUSH ROD TRAVEL 3. Stop light switch should be adjusted if necessary, so
ADJUSTMENT that the electrical contact is made at approximately
13/16 inch pedal pad travel.
A definite pedal push rod-to-main cylinder piston
clearance must be maintained on the dash mounted main Threaded Rod Type Adjustment
cylinder units. This clearance is adjusted as follows: 1. After the brake pedal and pedal bumper have been
assembled, install the push rod and its attaching
Eccentric Bolt Type Adjustment parts. Tighten nut to 40-50 ft. lbs. torque. Then to
Refer to Figure 17. obtain the correct clearance between the push rod
1. After the brake pedal and pedal bumper have been and the master cylinder, adjust the push rod so that
assembled, install the eccentric bolt with the pro the free pedal travel measured at the center of the
jection on the head in top or bottom position. Then pedal pad is approximately 1 / 8 inch (fig. 18).
2. After tightening the locknut on the adjustable push
rod to 17-23 ft. lbs. torque, recheck free travel.
3. Stop light switch should be adjusted if necessary, so
that electrical contact is made at approximately
13/16 inch pedal pad travel.
GIO and G20 Series (Fig. 21) Propeller Shaft Parking Brake—(Band Type)
(Fig. 24)
1. Pull parking brake lever two notches from fully
released position. 1. Set hand brake lever in the “ fully released” position.
2. Loosen the equalizer clevis forward check nut, and 2. Loosen lock nut on brake pull rod and disconnect pull
tighten the rear nut until a light to moderate drag is rod from brake operating cams by removing cotter
felt when rear wheels are rotated. pin and clevis pin. Set brake cam rest flat on the
3. Tighten check nuts securely. upper brake band bracket.
4. Fully release parking brake and rotate rear wheels;
no drag should be present.
PI 0-20-30 Models
1. Raise rear of vehicle and place on jack stands.
2. Set parking brake lever in fully released position.
3. Loosen front cable clevis check nut and adjust
clevis-to-equalizer lever connection to obtain a
clearance of 1/4 inch between idler lever and rear
end of slot in guide (fig. 22). Tighten lock nuts.
4. Pull parking brake lever to the applied position.
5. Check drag on each rear wheel. An equal amount of
drag should be present at each wheel. If drag is not
equal, loosen applicable rear cable connection and
adjust as required.
6 . Release parking brake lever. Check rear wheels to
insure no drag is present. If necessary adjust front
cable clevis-to-equalizer connection to eliminate
drag.
7. Tighten all lock nuts and lower vehicle. Fig. 21—Ch evy V an Parking Brake Idler Linkage—Exploded V ie w
Adjustment
1. Turn adjusting knob of lever asm. counterclockwise
to bottom position. Attach brake cable to Orscheln
brake lever asm. With the lever in the “brake off”
position, adjust brakes for proper clearance and
remove slack from brake cables by adjusting clevis
at transmission.
2. Test the brakes by pulling to the “brake on”
position. A definite snap-over-center should be felt.
Turn the adjusting knob in a clockwise direction until
a snap-over-center is felt.
3. Oil all moving parts.
T Models (Figs. 23 and 26) Hydraulic brake tubing used on all trucks is a double
layer flexible steel, copper coated and tin plated tubing
Tilt Cab vehicles are equipped with a compound type which resists corrosion and also stands up under high
lever that applies the transmission mounted parking pressures developed when brakes are applied. Mainte
brake by means of a flexible cable. The lever incor nance of the tubing should consist of a periodic check on
porates a cable adjustment feature that allows the oper the tubing; especially, in the event of rattles and/or
ator to adjust the "ov er-cen ter” position required to lock crimping or slow leakage due to possible stone damage,
the parking brake in the applied position. loose connections, etc.
TD 50-60
Fig. 24—Propeller Shaft Parking Brake (Band Type) Fig. 25—Propeller Shaft Parking Brake (Shoe Type)
V IE W A
TG 50 -60
V IE W A
TA40, TD-TE-TS50
SERVICE OPERATIONS
MAIN CYLINDER-DUAL SYSTEM "Main Cylinder - Single Reservoir Type (Mid
land R oss)" under Power Brakes.
NOTE: This model cylinder is installed on
CA-KA.-PA10-20, and CA-PA30 series vehi When servicing the Delco Moraine dual master cylin
cles. When service procedures for CE-CS- der, follow the rules below when replacing either com
SA50-60 series models are required, refer to plete master cylinder or the component pistons of the
cylinder. It is equally important to use only the correct protector, and secondary seal from the primary
service parts when servicing a Bendix main cylinder. piston.
1. The two-letter identification stamp on the end of the Cleaning and Inspection
master cylinder indicates the displacement capa 1. Remove main cylinder casting from vice and inspect
bilities of that particular cylinder. Master cylinders the bore for corrosion, pits, and foreign matter. Be
should only be replaced with another cylinder bear sure that the outlet ports are clean and free of brass
ing the same two-letter identification. cuttings from the tube seat removal operation.
2. The length of the component pistons in the master 2. Inspect the fluid reservoirs for foreign matter.
cylinders are critical factors in displacement capa Check the bypass and compensating ports to the cyl
bilities of a particular m aster cylinder. These pis inder bore to insure that they are not restricted. Do
tons are coded, using rings or grooves in the shank not use wire to check ports.
of the piston. It is mandatory that when pistons are
replaced, the replacing piston must contain the same NOTE: Before washing parts, hands must be
identification marks and the same contour at the push clean. Do not wash hands in gasoline or oil
rod ends as the piston which was removed. before cleaning parts. Use soap and water only.
3. Delco Moraine dual master cylinders, used with 3. Use Declene or equivalent to clean all metal parts
drum-type brakes, contain a rubber check valve and thoroughly. Immerse parts in the cleaning fluid and
check valve spring in each outlet boss. Follow in brush with hair brush to remove foreign matter.
structions given below under disassembly when re Blow out all passages, orifices, and valve holes. Air
placing check valves. dry the parts and place on clean paper or lint-free
clean cloth.
Removal
1. Wipe main cylinder and lines clean with a clean NOTE: Be sure to keep parts clean until re
cloth. Place dry cloths below main cylinder area to assembly. Rewash parts, if there is any occa
absorb any fluid spillage. sion to doubt cleanliness.
2. Disconnect hydraulic lines at main cylinder. Cover
4. Check pistons for scratches or other damage; replace
line ends with clean lint-free material to prevent if necessary.
foreign matter from entering the system.
3. Disconnect the push rod from the brake pedal. Assembly( Fig. 27)
4. Unbolt and remove the main cylinder. Use care when reassembling the main cylinder check
5. Remove the main cylinder mounting gasket and boot. valves. Improper assembly of the check valve seats will
6 . Remove the main cylinder cover and dump-out the result in distortion of the seats. If this occurs, there will
fluid. Pump the remaining fluid from the cylinder by be no check valve action and a loss of brake pedal travel
depressing the push rod. will result; the pedal will have to be pumped one or more
times before actual car braking occurs.
Disassembly (Fig. 27) 1. Place the main cylinder in a vice with the outlet
1. Clamp main cylinder in a bench vice. holes facing up. Place the check valve springs in the
2. Remove push rod retainer. outlet holes. Be sure the springs are seated in the
3. Remove secondary piston stop bolt from bottom of bottom of the holes. Place new rubber check valves
front fluid reservoir. over the springs, being careful not to displace the
4. Remove the snap ring retainer and primary piston springs from the spring seats.
assembly. Remove the secondary piston, piston 2. Place new brass tube seats in the outlet holes. Be
spring, and retainer by blowing air through the stop sure seats are not cocked as this would cause burrs
bolt hole. (If no air is available, a piece of wire may to be turned up as the tube seats are pressed in.
be used. Bend approximately 1/4 inch of one end into Thread a spare brake line tube nut into the outlet
a right angle, hook the secondary piston and pull it hole and turn the nut down until the tube seat
out.) bottoms. Remove the tube nut and check the outlet
5. Position main cylinder in vice with outlet holes hole for loose burrs, which might have been turned
facing up. up when the tube seat was pressed down. Repeat this
6 . Drill a 13/64 inch hole through both check valve process to bottom the second seat.
seats. 3. Put new secondary seals in the two grooves in the
7. Tap out both seats using a 1/4 x 20 tap. end of the secondary piston assembly. The seal
8 . Install a spare brake line tube nut in the outlet hole. which is nearest the end will have its lips facing to
Place a flat washer on a one inch screw (threaded to ward that end. The seal in the second groove should
screw into tapped hole), and thread screw into have its lips facing toward the portion of the second
threaded hole in tube seat. Hold the screw to keep it ary piston which contains the small compensating
from turning and back out the tube nut. This will re holes.
move the tube seat. 4. Assemble a new primary seal protector and primary
9. Repeat Step 8 above on second tube seat. seal over the end of the secondary piston with the
10. Remove the check valves and springs from the cavi flat side of the seal seats against the seal protector,
ties beneath the tube seats. and the protector against the flange of the piston
11. Remove the primary seal, primary seal protector, which contains the small compensating holes.
and secondary seals from the secondary piston. Re 5. Assemble the new secondary seal into the groove on
move the piston extension screw securing the pri the push rod end of the primary piston. The lips of
mary piston spring to the primary piston. Remove this seal should face toward the small compensating
the spring retainer, primary seal, primary seal holes in the opposite end of the primary piston.
6 . Assemble the new primary seal protector and pri the other provides a hydraulic assist for clutch
mary seal on the end of the primary piston with the operation.
flat side of the seal seated against the seal protector,
Removal (Fig. 1)
and the protector against the flange on the piston
which contains the compensating holes. D ual C ylinder (except tilt cab)
7. Assemble the spring retainer in one end of the pri 1. Disconnect clutch and brake pedal return springs.
mary piston spring and the secondary piston stop in 2. Detach push rod boots from cylinder tubes.
the other end. Place the end of the spring over the 3. Remove clutch and brake cylinder lines from main
end of the primary piston with the spring retainer cylinder.
seats inside of the lips of the primary seal. 4. Remove the three bolts retaining cylinder assembly
8 . Remove all cleaning liquid from the threaded hole in to the front of dash.
the primary piston. Place the piston extension screw 5. Remove cylinder assembly from vehicle.
down through the secondary piston stop and the pri 6 . Remove cover and dump fluid out of cylinder.
mary spring retainer and screw it into the primary
Tilt Cab
piston until it bottoms out. 1. Tilt cab forward and block in place.
9. Coat the bore of the master cylinder with clean brake 2. Disconnect brake and clutch lines at cylinder and slip
fluid. Coat the primary and secondary seals on the rubber dust boots off cylinder tubes.
secondary piston with clean brake fluid. Insert the 3. Remove 3 cylinder attaching bolts and remove cyl
secondary piston spring retainer into the secondary inder (allowing brake and clutch pedal push rods to
piston spring. Place the retainer and spring down fall loose).
over the end of the secondary piston until the re 4. Repair the dual brake and clutch cylinder as re
tainer locates inside of the lips of the primary cup. quired. See disassembly, inspection and assembly
10. Hold the master cylinder with the open end of the procedures.
bore down. Push the secondary piston into the bore
until the spring seats against the closed end of the Single C ylind er
bore. 1. Disconnect brake pedal return spring.
11. Position the master cylinder in a vise with the open 2. Disconnect the brake hydraulic line at the main cyl
end of the bore up. Coat the primary and secondary inder mounted on the cab. Also disconnect lines at
seal on the primary piston with clean brake fluid. the dash and toe pan.
Push the primary piston assembly, spring end first, 3. R e m o v e cylinder retaining bolts and remove
into the bore of the master cylinder. Hold the piston cylinder.
down and snap the lock ring into position in the small 4. Remove cover from top of cylinder and dump out
groove in the I.D. of the bore. fluid.
12. Push the primary piston down to move the secondary Disassembly (Fig. 28)
piston forward far enough to clear the stop screw
hole in the bottom of the front fluid reservoir. Install Dual Cylinder
the stop screw. Brake cylinder side
13. Install reservoir diaphragm in the reservoir cover 1. Remove piston stop snap ring.
and install the cover on the main cylinder. Push bail 2. Remove piston, primary cup, cup expander, piston
wire into position to secure the reservoir cover. return spring, check valve and check valve seat.
Installation Clutch cylinder side
1. Assemble the push rod through the push rod retainer, Remove same as brake cylinder side except for re
if it has been disassembled. moval of check valve and check valve seat.
2. Push the retainer over the end of the main cylinder.
Assemble new boot over push rod and press it down Single C ylinder
over the push rod retainer. Slide new mounting gas 1. Remove lock ring, secondary cup and piston from
ket into position. main cylinder.
3. Secure the main cylinder to the firewall or frame 2. Remove the primary cup, spring valve assembly and
rail as applicable, with mounting bolts. valve seat.
4. Connect the push rod clevis to the brake pedal with 3. Remove reservoir cover and gasket from top of main
pin and retainer. cylinder.
5. Connect the brake lines to the main cylinder.
6 . Fill the main cylinder reservoirs to the levels shown Inspection and Repair
in Figure 13. Bleed the brake system as outlined in Clean all dirt and grease from the main cylinder with a
this section. non-toxic, non-petroleum solvent.
7. If necessary, adjust the brake pedal free play as out 1. Wash all parts in clean alcohol. Make sure that in
lined in this section. take and compensating ports in main cylinder hous
ing, bleeder holes in piston and vent in filler cap are
clean and open.
MAIN CYLINDER-SINGLE RESERVOIR TYPE
NOTE: Before washing parts, hands must be
NOTE: These main cylinders are of the basic clean. Do not wash hands in gasoline or oil be
single hydraulic reservoir type. Cylinders in fore cleaning parts. Use soap and water to
stalled on PA-TA40, and TA50-60 models have clean hands.
two pistons in the body casting, side by side.
One piston provides regular braking action and 2. Inspect cylinder bores to make sure they are smooth.
Inspect primary and secondary cups, valve and valve a. Place spring assembly in the housing bore with
seat for damage or swelling. Swelling of rubber the stamped retainer toward the open end of the
parts is due to the use of improper brake fluid or bore.
washing parts in gasoline or kerosene. b. Place primary cup over the spring, with the flat
side outward.
NOTE: The primary cup has a brass support
c. Using the piston push the cup inward sufficiently
ring vulcanized in its base to prevent it from
to allow assembly of the piston stop snap ring,
imbedding in the bleeder holes during braking
then release piston against snap ring.
action.
d. Insert a straight wire (tag wire, or any wire of
Check piston fit in cylinder bore (fig. 29). The approx. . 0 2 0 dia.) through the small compensating
clearance between piston and wall of the cylinder port into the housing bore (fig. 30).
should be from .001” to .005". e. While moving the wire back and forth in the com
Replace parts as required. pensating port, push the piston inward very gently
Check clearance between the edge of the primary cup until a slight drag on the wire is felt.
and the edge of the compensating port. To check this f. Check clearance between the end of the piston and
clearance, proceed as follows: the snap ring. This clearance should be .035
Fig . 29—Checking M ain C ylin d e r Piston Fit Fig . 30—M ain C y lin d e r—Cross Section
minimum. If the clearance is leSs than .035, the 4. Fill cylinder and bleed brakes and clutch systems as
primary cup should be replaced. noted in above installation (except tilt cab).
5. Install cover on main cylinder.
Assembly (Fig. 28)
6 . Adjust linkage if necessary.
Dual C ylinder
Single C ylind er (Fig. 1)
B rake C ylinder Side 1. Install boot in position and install main cylinder to
NOTE: Moisten all parts except snap ring with firewall with bolts, washers and nuts.
brake fluid as assembly progresses. 2. Connect hydraulic lines at dash, toe pan, and
cylinder.
1. Carefully position check valve seat at outlet end of 3. Connect brake pedal return spring.
cylinder bore. 4. Fill main cylinder reservoir and bleed brakes as
2. Insert check valve; then the piston return spring with outlined in this section.
primary cup expander toward open end of cylinder. 5. Install cover on main cylinder.
3. Install primary cup, skirt first. Take care that skirt
is not rolled back or torn during installation. BRAKE COMPONENTS-SELF ADJUSTING
4. Insert piston with secondary cup toward open end of
cylinder. Same care to be observed on secondary cup FRONT AND REAR BRAKES
as on primary.
5. Install piston stop snap ring. Brake shoe adjustment takes place when brakes are
applied with a firm pedal effort while vehicle is backing
Clutch C ylind er Side up. Applying the brakes moves an actuator which turns
the star wheel and lengthens the adjusting screw assem
Replace same as brake cylinder except for replacement bly (fig. 31). This action adjusts the shoes until clearance
of check valve and check valve seat. between the lining and drum is within proper lim its.
Single C ylinder Should low pedal heights be encountered, it is rec
NOTE: Moisten all parts except snap ring with ommended that numerous forward and reverse stops be
brake fluid as assembly progresses. performed with a firm pedal effort until a satisfactory
brake pedal height results.
1. Install valve seat, valve, spring, and primary cup in
cylinder bore. NOTE: Frequent usage of an automatic trans
2. Install piston and secondary cup; secure with lock mission forward range to halt reverse vehicle
ring. motion may prevent the automatic adjusters
Installation from functioning, thereby inducing low pedal
heights.
D ual C ylinder (except Tilt Cab) (Fig. 1)
1. Reverse above applicable removal procedures. Retracting Self Adjusters
2 . Fill main cylinder reservoir end bleed brakes as
outlined in this section. A lanced “ knock out" area is provided in the web of
3. Check operation of brakes and clutch. the brake drum on all models except the P20, P30 and 50
4. Install cover on main cylinder. and the rear wheels of the K20 and C30. On these models
the access hole is located in the flange plate. This hole is
Tilt Cab (Fig. 1)
for service purposes in the event retracting of the brake
1. Align pedal push rods, position cylinder against shoes is required to remove the drum. However, in order
mounting flange and bolt in place. to back off the adjuster, it will be necessary to hold the
2. Slide end of rubber dust boots over cylinder tubes actuating lever away from the starwheel (fig. 32).
and connect fluid lines.
3. Tilt cab down. Brake Drums, Shoes and Linings
NOTE: If brake drums are worn severely, it
may be necessary to retract the adjusting screw
as previously outlined.
CAUTION: After knocking out the metal, be
sure to remove it from the inside of the drum
and clean all metal from the brake compartment.
A new hole cover must be installed when drum
is reinstalled.
\m JL o
Removal ^ 0
1. Raise the vehicle and place on stand jacks.
2. Loosen check nuts at forward end of parking brake
cable sufficiently to remove all tension from brake
cable.
3. Remove brake drums.
NOTE: Since boots are recessed in grooves on
wheel cylinders to prevent pistons from leaving
cylinders, it is not necessary to install wheel
F ig . 31—S e lf Adjusting Brake cylinder clamps when brake shoes are removed;
kvA
M sy
CHEVROLET TRUCK SERVICE M ANUAL
BRAKES 5-19
Fig. 32—Brake Adjuster Access Hole Fig. 34—Removing Hold Down Springs and Pins
Using Tool J -22348
2. If working on rear brakes, lubricate parking brake NOTE: Loose adjustment may occur from an
cable. adjusting screw that is not properly operating.
3. On rear brakes only, lubricate fulcrum end of park If the lubrication in the adjusting screw of as
ing brake lever and the bolt with brake lube, then sembly is contaminated or destroyed, the ad
attach lever to secondary shoe with bolt, spring justing screw should be thoroughly cleaned and
lubricated.
5. Connect brake shoes together with adjusting screw
spring, then place adjusting screw, socket and nut
in position.
CAUTION: Make sure the proper adjusting
screw is used (left hand or right hand). The star
wheel should only be installed with the star
wheel nearest to the secondary shoe and the
adjusting screw spring inserted to prevent inter
ference with the star wheel.
6 . Install parking brake cable (rear only).
7. Secure the primary brake shoe (short lining faces
forward) first with the hold down pin and spring using
a pair of needle nose pliers. Engage shoes with the
wheel cylinder connecting links.
8 . Install and secure the actuator assembly and second
ary brake shoe with the hold down pin and spring
using a pair of needle nose pliers (on rear position
parking brake strut and strut spring).
9. Install guide plate over anchor pin.
10. Install the wire link.
Adjustment
Although the brakes are self adjusting a preliminary or
initial adjustment may be necessary after the brakes have
been relined or replaced, or whenever the length of the
adjusting screw has been changed. The final adjustment
is made by using the self adjusting feature.
1. With brake drum off, disengage the actuator from the
star wheel and rotate the star wheel by spinning or Fig. 40—Checking Brake Shoe Lining C learan ce
turning with a small screwdriver. Using Tool J-21177
A C T U A T IN G LEVER .
90
TOP VIEW
A C T U A T IN G LEVER
90c
END VIEW
7. Using Tool J-22348 install brake shoe return
springs.
8 . Holding the star wheel end of the actuating lever as
far as possible past the star wheel, position the
adjusting lever cam into the actuating lever link and
assemble with cap screw.
9. Check the brake shoes for being centered by measur
ing the distance from the lining surface to the edge
of the flange plate at the points shown in Figure 46.
1. In let Fitting Bolts 9. W heel C ylin d er Anchor Screws 17. W heel C ylin d er Piston 24. Lining Rivet
2. In let Fitting Bolt Gaskets 10. A nchor Screw Lock Washer 18. Piston Cup 25. Brake Shoe Lining
3. In let Fittings 11. A nchor Screw Flat Washer 19. Piston Cup F ille r 26. Brake Shoe
4. W h e e l C ylin d er Connection Tube 12. Adjusting Cam and Shoe G u id e Stud 20. Piston Spring 27. Brake Shoe Return Spring
5. Bleeder V a lv e s 13. Cam Stud Flat W asher 21. W h eel C ylin d er Casting 28. Brake Shoe G u id e Washer
6. Inlet Fitting Gaskets 14. Adjusting Cam Spring 22. Brake Shoe Adjusting Cam 29. Brake Shoe G u id e C-W asher
7. W h eel C ylin d er M ounting Screws 15. Backing Plate 23. Shoe G u id e A n ti-R attle 30. Brake Shoe and Lining
8. Mounting Screw Lock Washers 16. W h eel C ylin d er Boot Washers Assembly
BRAKE SHOES
In all cases of brake complaints denoting actual brake
lining or shoe failure, the brake drums should be re
moved and before disassembly of the shoes from the
flange plate, all linings should be inspected for wear,
improper alignment, causing uneven wear or oil and
grease on the linings. If any of these conditions exist, it
will be necessary to replace or reline the shoes. If, in
checking the linings, it is noticed that they have the
appearance of being glazed, this is a normal wearing
condition with the type lining used. It may be necessary
to use a wire brush or an abrasive on the lining to des
troy this glazed surface.
When brake lining replacement is necessary, replace
the shoes and linings on both front wheels or both rear
wheels. On low mileage vehicles where a grease seal
leak or minor chatter has developed, replacement of both
shoes on that wheel is perm issible. In no case should a
single shoe or lining be replaced.
1. Fitting Bolt 9. Anchor Pins 16. W h eel C y lin d e r Cups 23. Adjusting W heels
2. Gaskets 10. Return Spring (Short) 17. W h eel C y lin d e r Pistons 24. G u id e Bolt N u t Lock W ire
3. W h ee l C y lin d e r Mounting Bolts 11. Return Spring (Long) 18. W h eel C ylin d er Boots 25. G u id e Bolt N ut
4. Adjusting Slo t Plugs 12. Shoe and Lining Assembly 19. W h eel C ylin d er Push Rods 26. G u id e Bolt W asher
5. Shoe G u id e Bolts 13. W h eel C y lin d e r Heat Shield 20. W h eel C ylin d er Assembly 27. Brake Shoe
6. Connector Tube 14. Bleeder V a lves 21. Piston Return Spring 28. Brake Shoe Lining
7. Backing Plate 15. W h eel C y lin d e r Body 22. Adjusting W h ee l Locks 29. Lining Rivet
8. Adjusting Screws
BRAKE SHOE LININGS brake shoes and may be replaced. Only brake linings
Bonded Lining specified in Chevrolet Parts Books should be used. These
linings may be purchased in replacement sets of four
Brake linings on front and rear brakes on Series 10 are linings and sufficient rivets of correct specifications.
attached to brake shoes by a special bonding process. When replacing linings, make sure that shoes are clean
When lining becomes worn to the extent that replacement and that linings are installed in a manner that will
is necessary, it is recommended that factory-bonded shoe prevent gaps between lining and shoe.
and lining assem blies be used for replacement. 1967 Conventional lining replacement equipment should be
Chevrolet Trucks 50 as well as 60 Series have premium used. Make sure lining fits firmly against shoe, and that
type facings. rivets are properly upset.
WHEEL CYLINDERS
Removal (Fig. 53)
Duo-Servo Type
Duo-ServoType
1. Place pistons, cups and spring or spring assembly
3. At rear, connect metal brake tube to wheel cylinder
or to connector. At front, thread brake hose fitting
into wheel cylinder housing or connector, using a
in cylinder with parts positioned as shown in new copper gasket on hose fitting. Insert fitting at
Figure 53. other end of hose through frame and secure with
2. Assemble boots and push rods, then install boots toothed lock washer and nut or with spring lock,
over ends of cylinders. depending upon type used. Connect metal brake tube
to hose fitting inside frame side rail.
TwinplexType
1. Place pistons, cups, spring and expander assembly
4. Install brake shoes as directed under "B rake Shoe
Installation . ' ’ Bleed brake system as previously
in cylinder. directed under “ Bleeding Brakes.”
2. Assemble boots on push rods, being sure bead on
boot engages groove in push rod. Install boots and
push rods on cylinder, engaging bead on outer edges
TwinplexType
of cylinder housing. NOTE: Upper and lower cylinders are not
interchangeable. Lower cylinder has threaded
Type“F”
1. Insert piston spring, cup filler, and cup into cylinder
inlet opening drilled near center of cylinder
bore. Upper cylinder has threaded bleeder valve
bore. Cup filler bumper and cup lip must face closed opening drilled at extreme outer edge of cylinder
end of cylinder. bore. Cylinders must be positioned with con
2. Assemble boot on piston, making sure the boot snaps necting tube openings toward each other.
over the brake shoe guide. 1. Position heat shields on cylinder, place wheel cylin
3. Install piston and boot, inserting piston into cylinder ders on flange plate, and attach with cap screws and
and engaging boot lip in groove in edge of cylinder. lock washers. Tighten cap screws firmly.
Position brake shoe guide so slot in guide is parallel 2. Install connecting tube between the two cylinders and
with flat mounting surface of cylinder. tighten connections firmly. Connect brake tube to
inlet opening in lower cylinder at inner side of flange
plate. Install bleeder valve in threaded opening in
upper cylinder at inner side of flange plate.
3. Install brake shoes as directed under "Brake Shoe
Installation.” Bleed brake system as previously
directed under "Bleeding Brakes.”
Type“F”
NOTE: The two wheel cylinders mounted on
each brake are identical; however, cylinders on
right-and left-hand brakes have opposite cylinder
castings. Clean mating surfaces of cylinders
and flange plate to insure proper alignment.
1. Place each cylinder on flange plate and attach with
one large and two small cap screws and lock
washers.
2. Position wheel cylinder connecting tube and fitting
assembly and attach fitting to lower opening in upper
cylinder with inlet connector, using new copper gas
ket on both sides of fitting. ^Attach fitting to lower
opening in lower cylinder with special bolt, using
new copper gasket on both sides of fitting. Tighten
Fig . 55—C hecking Wheel C ylin d e r Piston Fit inlet connector and special bolt firmly.
3. Install bleeder valve in upper opening in each An out-of-round drum makes accurate brake shoe
cylinder. adjustment impossible and is likely to cause excessive
4. Install brake shoes as directed under "B rake Shoe wear of other parts of brake mechanism due to its
Installation." Bleed brake system as previously eccentric action.
directed under “ Bleeding B ra k es." A drum that is more than .010" out-of-round on the
diameter is unfit for service and should be rebored. Out-
Type “ FR -3”
of-round, as well as taper and wear can be accurately
NOTE: Upper and lower wheel cylinders on measured with an inside micrometer fitted with proper
both right-and left-hand brakes are interchange extension rods.
able. Cylinders must be positioned on flange If drum is to be rebored for use with standard size
plate so that the long stroke end of the cylinder brake facings which are worn very little, only enough
faces the shoe toe (adjustment end of shoe) or metal should be removed to obtain a true smooth braking
the adjusting slot in backing plate. Make sure surface. If drum has to be rebored more than .010" over
mating surfaces of cylinders, heat shields, and the standard diameter, however, it should be rebored to
flange plate a r e clean to assure proper .060" oversize on the diameter and the brake facing
alignment. should be replaced with .030" oversize facings.
A brake drum must not be rebored more than .060
1. Position heat shield on each wheel cylinder, and in (.090" on 15" by 4, 5, 6 or 7" wide) over the maximum
stall on flange plate. Attach each cylinder with two standard diameter, since removal of more metal will
cap screws and lock washers. affect dissipation of heat and may cause distortion of
2. Attach connecting tube fitting to lower opening in the drum. Chevrolet brake facing is not furnished larger than
upper cylinder, and to the upper opening in the lower .030" oversize and this will not work efficiently in drums
cylinder. Install bleeder screw in upper opening of bored more than .060" oversize.
the upper cylinder. Connect brake line at lower
Brake drums may be refinished either by turning or
cylinder fitting.
grinding. Best brake performance is obtained by turning
3. Install brake shoes as directed under “ Brake Shoe
drums with a very fine feed. To insure maximum lining
Installation." Bleed brake system as previously
life, the refinished braking surface must be smooth and
directed under “ Bleeding B ra k es."
free from chatter or tool marks, and run-out must not
exceed .005" total indicator reading.
BRAKE DRUMS
Installation
All front brake drums except those used on 3/4 and 1
1. Make sure mating surfaces of hub, drum and oil
ton trucks are the non-demountable type, that is, they
deflector are clean and smooth and assemble as out
cannot be removed without removing the hub. Whenever
lined in Section 3.
this type drum is removed, wheel bearings must be ad
2. On front, install drum and hub assembly to wheel
justed as outlined in Section 3. Rear brake drums on all
spindle and adjust bearings on 1 / 2 , 1 1 / 2 and 2 ton
models are demountable, that is, they may be removed
without removing the wheel hub. as outlined in Section 3. On 3/4 and 1 ton install
drum and retain in place with retaining screws.
Removal 3. On rear, assemble drum assembly over hub studs
Front
and install retaining screws, if used.
4. Replace wheel assembly and lower vehicle to floor.
1. Jack up front end of vehicle and remove wheel.
2. Remove hub and brake drum assembly. BRAKE PEDAL (EXCEPT TILT CAB AND
NOTE: 3/4 and 1 ton drums may be removed by
CHEVY VAN)
The brake pedal (fig. 56) is an integral design with the
removing 2 slotted head screws which retain
clutch pedal, necessitating the removal of the clutch pedal
drums to hub. On all other models, hub and
before removing the brake pedal.
drum are removed as an assembly.
Removal
3. Remove brake drum from hub as outlined in Section
3. 1. Remove the clutch pedal as outlined under “ Clutch
Pedal" in Section 7.
Rear 2. Remove the pull back spring from the body bracket.
1. Jack up rear end of vehicle and remove wheel. 3. Remove the sleeve assembly screw attachment and
2. Remove countersunk screws, where used, and re remove sleeve.
move brake drum from outer flange of hub. 4. Disengage the push rod from the master cylinder and
Inspection and Reconditioning drop the pedal to check for worn parts—inspect the
Whenever brake drums are removed they should be return spring, bracket attachment, and bushings for
thoroughly cleaned and inspected for cracks, scores, deep needed repairs.
grooves and out-of-round. Any of these conditions must Installation
be corrected since they can impair the efficiency of brake Reverse the above procedure and make certain the
operation and also can cause premature failure of other brake pedal (fig. 56) is secure and adjusted properly be
parts. fore operating the vehicle. See Maintenance and Adjust
Smooth up any slight scores by polishing with fine ments for brake pedal adjustment.
emery cloth. Heavy or extensive scoring will cause ex
cessive brake lining wear and it will probably be neces BRAKE PEDAL-TILT CAB
sary to rebore in order to true up the braking surface.
The complete brake pedal consists of two separate
VIEW A
MAIN
CYLINDER
MAIN BRAKE
PA20-30 TA40-50-60 CYLINDER
— __________________
BRAKES 5-32
assem blies—upper pedal assembly and lower pedal as Cleaning and Inspection
sembly. The following procedure applies to both pedal 1. Wash all metal parts with an approved cleaning
assemblies; however, it is not necessary to remove lower solvent.
assembly if only upper assembly is to be replaced. 2. Inspect
Removal Installation
1. Disconnect and remove brake pedal return spring and 1. Position lower pedal arm pivot shaft through
clutch pedal over-center spring. channel cutout.
2. Disconnect main cylinder push rod clevis at lower 2. Install pivot sleeve through channel cutout so that
pedal arm, and remove push rod and clevis from pedal arm pivot shaft is retained by sleeve. Install
main cylinder (fig. 56). retaining screws to sleeve bracket, and install
3. Disconnect and remove upper pedal arm. grease fitting. Install washer and retainer to pedal
4. Remove grease fitting from lower pedal arm pivot arm pivot shaft.
sleeve. Access at cutout in underside of channel. 3. Position upper pedal arm through toe pan, align
5. Remove retainer and washer from pedal arm pivot serrations on pedal arms, install retaining bolt,
shaft. s lockwasher and nut. Refer to torque specifications at
6 . Remove two screws from pivot sleeve and bracket rear of manual for correct torque value.
assembly, and remove assembly from channel. 4. Connect clutch pedal over-center spring and brake
7. Withdraw lower pedal arm from channel. pedal return spring.
5. Insert main cylinder push rod through rubber boot ®gpween the brake pedal and main cylinder push rod
and into piston. Install retaining bolt, lockwasher
and nut. Refer to torque specifications at rear of 2 #T ttrn eccentric bolt as required to provide correct
manual for correct torque valve. adjustment. Movement of pedal pad before push rod
6 . Adjust push rod until 1/8 to 1/4 inch free movement contacts main cylinder piston must be 1/16" to 1/4".
is obtained at pedal pad. NOTE: Eccentric Adjustment bolt should be
7. Lubricate pivot shaft at fitting. installed with projection in down position before
adjustment.
BRAKE PEDAL-CHEVY VAN (Fig. -57)
3. Tighten check nut on eccentric bolt to 22 lb. ft.
Removal
torque, and recheck movement.
1. Disconnect brake pedal return spring.
2. Remove upper to lower brake pedal arm nut and
PARKING BRAKE-REAR WHEEL TYPE
remove upper arm.
3. Remove nut and eccentric bolt holding main cylin Refer to hand brake levers and cable routing as shown
der push rod to lower pedal assembly. by Figures 58 through 63.
4. Remove pivot shaft retainer and screw from bracket
assembly. Remove pivot shaft using a small brass PARKING BRAKE-CHEVY VAN
drift if needed. Handle Assembly (Fig. 63)
5. Remove grease fitting from arm assembly.
Removal
Inspection 1. Place parking brake handle in released position.
1. Inspect pivot shaft and pedal bushings for wear or 2. Remove front cable to equalizer by removing check
other damage. nut at rear of cable.
2. If necessary to remove bushings from pedal use a 3. Engage parking brake handle until ball on front end
cape chisel for removal, then deburr. of cable can be slipped out of handle assembly.
3. Install new bushings in each side of pedal bore 4. Remove two handle attaching screws, washers and
using a vise as a press. nuts from front of engine compartment housing and
Installation also nut from underside of floor, attaching base of
1. Reverse r e m o v a l procedure to install p e d a l handle assembly to floor.
assembly. Installation
NOTE: (A) Assemble eccentric push rod to 1. Reverse removal procedure.
pedal attachment bolt with projection in up 2. Adjust parking brake as outlined previously in this
position before adjustment. (B) Mark on upper section.
and lower pedal assemblies must be assembled
in line. Front Cable (Fig. 63)
2. Adjust push rod to main cylinder clearance as de Replacement
scribed in this section. 1. Refer to first three steps under Parking Brake
3. Check stop light operation and adjust switch if re Handle Assembly Removal for cable replacement.
quired as described in Section 12. 2. Adjust parking brakes as described in this section.
4. Grease fitting until grease passes thru bushing and
comes out both sides of pivot bore. Rear Cables (Fig. 63)
Adjustment Removal
1. Loosen check nut on the eccentric bolt attachment 1. Place parking brake handle in released position.
V IE W C
V IE W B
V IE W A
V IE W C
V IE W B
PA209-213-309-313
NV IE W B
V IE W A ^ PA215-315
PA20-30
3. Slide drum and flange assembly over splines onto shaft. Tighten bolt to 68-73 ft. lbs. torque.
output shaft.
4. Place lock washer and special serrated flat washer 5. Connect propeller shaft at transmission and attach
on flange retaining bolt and install bolt in output center bearing bracket to frame crossmember.
press serrated bolts (if used) into place, or install a. Install new copper gasket on cylinder end of hose
bolts and nuts. (male end).
2. Slide drum and flange assembly over splines onto b. Moisten threads with brake fluid and install hose
output shaft. in wheel cylinder inlet.
3. On jobs with parking brake drum assembly attached 2. For junction block installations,
to output shaft by a center bolt place lockwasher and a. Moisten threads on male end with brake fluid.
special serrated flat washer on bolt. Install center b. Turn male end into junction block and tighten
bolt applying 83-100 foot pounds torque on Power- securely.
matic equipped vehicles, and 68-73 foot pounds with 3. With weight of vehicle on wheels and suspension in
other transmissions. normal position (front wheels straight ahead) pass
On vehicles with parking brake drum assembly re female end of hose through support bracket, allowing
tained to output shaft by a nut on shaft end, install hose to seek its own position. Insert hex of hose
nut and torque to 230-280 foot pounds on 5 speed fitting into the 1 2 point hole in support bracket in
transmissions. Install cotter pin. position which induces least twist to hose (fig. 6 6 ).
4. Position propeller shaft flange against brake drum
NOTE: Do not twist hose unduly during this
(or output shaft flange). If removed, attach propeller
operation as its natural curvature is absolutely
shaft center bearing hanger bracket to crossmember.
necessary to maintain proper hose-to-suspen
Replace all lockwashers and nuts and tighten
sion clearance through full movement of the
securely.
suspension and steering parts.
5. Install brake band and adjust brake as directed in
Brake Band Installation. 4. Install “ U” shaped retainer spring to secure hose in
support bracket.
5. Inspect by removing weight completely from wheel.
PARKING BRAKE CABLE—LUBRICATION
If working at front wheels, turn steering geometry
Refer to Maintenance and Adjustments in this section. from lock to lock while observing hose position. Be
sure that hose does not touch other parts at any time
during suspension or geometry travel. If contact
ANCHOR PIN REPLACEMENT-CHEVY VAN does occur, remove hose retainer spring and rotate
1. Raise vehicle and place on jack stand. the female hose end in the support bracket one or
2. Remove wheel and drum as outlined in this section. two points in appropriate direction, replace retainer
3. Remove brake shoe pull back springs, link and guide spring and re-inspect as outlined in this paragraph.
plate. 6 . Place steel tube connector in hose fitting and tighten
4. Disengage anchor pin lock and remove anchor pin re securely.
taining nut and washer and remove pin from flange 7. Bleed all brakes as outlined in this section.
plate. (Threaded type).
Two type anchor pins are used in production. The Hydraulic Brake Tubing
riveted type is not serviced and if failure or damage Hydraulic brake tubing used on all trucks is a double
should occur to either the anchor pin or flange plate,
both parts will have to be replaced and the threaded
type anchor pin used.
5. Position anchor pin to flange plate, install lock
washer and nut, and torque pin to 80 lb. ft. and lock
by peening over washer tabs.
6 . Install brake shoe guide plate, link and pull back
springs.
7. Adjust brakes, install drum and wheel as outlined
previously in this section. Test brake operation.
RAM
Removal
1. Disconnect battery cable.
2. Disconnect electrical lead from pressure differential
switch.
Fig . 68—Single and Double Lap Flare Fig. 70—Flaring O peration—First Flare
1. Vacuum C heck V a lv e 9. Reaction Disc 16. A ir V a lv e Push Rod and 22. Center Plate
2. Grommet 10. Plunger Spring Plunger Assembly 23. Center Plate Hub
3. Front Sh ell 11. Bearing Seal 17. Dust Boot Seal
4. Front Diaphragm Plate 12. Poppet V a lv e 18. A ir Filters and 24. Power Piston Spring
5. Front Diaphragm 13. Poppet Retainer Silencers 25. Push Rod Seal
6. Rear Shell 14. A ir F ilte r and 19. Poppet Spring 26. H ydraulic Push Rod
7. Rear Diaphragm Silencers 20. Seal 27. Adjusting Screw
8. Rear Diaphragm Plate and 15. A ir F ilte r Retainer 21. Rear Diaphragm Retainer
Control V a lv e Body
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Master Vac (fig. 72) is a self-contained hydraulic sary—one a vacuum connection from manifold to check
and vacuum unit for power braking, utilizing manifold valve located on front shell; the other a hydraulic con
vacuum and atmospheric pressure for its power. nection from the main cylinder outlet directly into the
The Master-Vac power brake unit permits the use of a hydraulic system. The unit is mounted on the engine side
low brake pedal as well as less pedal effort than is re of the fire wall and connected to the brake pedal through
quired with the conventional (nonpower) hydraulic brake an auxiliary lever and rod.
system. Only two external line connections are neces-
MAINTENANCE j D ADJUSTMENTS
Inspection 2. Inspect all hydraulic lines and connections at the
1. Check vacuum line and vacuum line connections as wheel cylinders and main cylinder for possible hy
well as vacuum check valve in front shell of power draulic leaks.
unit for possible vacuum loss. 3. Check brake assemblies for scored drums, grease or
brake fluid on linings, worn or glazed linings, and should be filled as described in this section, using only
make necessary adjustments. recommended brake fluid.
4. Check the brake fluid level in the hydraulic reser
voir. The reservoir should be filled to within 1/2" Bleeding Instructions
of the top of the filler cap opening. Inspect the
The power system may be bled manually or with a
reservoir cover for fluid leaks at gasket.
pressure bleeder as outlined in this section.
5. Check for loose mounting bolts at main cylinder and
Use only recommended brake fluid. Do not use power
at power section.
assist while bleeding. The engine should not be running
6 . Check air cleaner filter located in the power piston
and the vacuum reserve should be reduced to zero, by
extension—replace filter if necessary.
applying the brake several times before starting the
7. Check brake pedal for bending and misalignment
bleeding procedure.
between pedal and push rod.
Air Cleaner Service
Lubrication
The air cleaner filter used with the power brake unit
The M aster-Vac power brake unit is lubricated at as should be cleaned at least twice a year. To clean, re
sembly and needs no further lubrication other than main move air cleaner element and wash thoroughly in cleaning
taining normal reservoir fluid level. The reservoir solvent—allow element to dry before reinstalling.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
Removal (Fig. 73) MAIN CYLINDER-SINGLE RESERVOIR TYPE
1. Disconnect push rod clevis at brake pedal arm. (Midland Ross)
NOTE: This model cylinder is installed on
NOTE: If clearance hole through fire wall is
CE-CS-SA50-60 series vehicles.
not large enough, it may be necessary to remove
clevis from push rod. Note approximate location Removal (Fig. 1)
of clevis on rod. 1. Wipe main cylinder and line clean with a clean cloth.
Place dry cloths below main cylinder area to absorb
2. Disconnect vacuum hose from check valve in front any fluid spillage.
shell of power section. 2. Disconnect hydraulic line from main cylinder. Cover
3. Disconnect hydraulic lines at main cylinder. Cover open line end with clean lint-free material to prevent
main cylinder outlet ports and ends of brake tubes foreign matter from entering the system. Disconnect
to prevent entry of foreign matter. vacuum hose from manifold.
4. Disconnect stoplight switch wires. 3. Remove main cylinder from power booster.
5. Remove four nuts and lockwashers securing power
unit to fire wall, and remove power unit and spacer
from engine compartment.
Installation
1. Mount the power brake assembly and spacer in place
and install four attaching nuts and lockwashers. Be
certain to place push rod through cutout in fire wall.
2. Attach vacuum line to check valve.
3. Connect stoplight switch wires.
4. Secure hydraulic lines to main cylinder.
5. Adjust push rod clevis to brake pedal assembly.
Adjust pedal height by means of clevis on brake
pedal push rod at pedal. Pedal height is obtained
by measuring from floor covering at toe pan to top
of pedal pad.
NOTE: Check operation of stop light after ad
justing pedal height.
6 . Bleed brakes as outlined in this section.
NOTE: After completing the bleeding opera
tion, make sure reservoir fluid level is at cor
rect height. The reservoir should be filled to
1/4 inch of filler cap opening.
7. Check operation of the brakes as outlined in this
section. Fig . 73—Power C ylin d e r Bracket and Spacer
ROTATED 90°
21 22 23 24 25 26 27
1. Check V a lv e Spring 8. Diaphragm G asket 15. Push Rod Bushing 22. V a lv e Body
2. “ O ” Ring Seal 9. Spring Retainer 16. “ O ” Ring Seal 23. Spring
3. Check V a lv e Retainer 10. Snap Ring 17. Retainer 24. Washer
4. Check V a lv e Assembly 11. Push Rod Assembly 18. Washer 25. Snap Ring
5. Body 12. Push Rod Return Spring 19. Push Rod Cup 26. Piston Cup
6. C over 13. Lock Ring 20. Piston 27. “ O ” Ring Seal
7. Screw 14. Retainer 21. Piston V a lv e Insert
Disassembly (Fig. 74) 14. Remove check valve retainer (3) and discard "O ”
NOTE: The key numbers shown below in paren ring seal (2 ).
thesis refer to Figure 74. 15. Remove check valve (4) and spring (1).
Cleaning
1. Remove screw (7), cover (6 ), and diaphragm gasket
(8 ) from main cylinder body (5). Dump out hydraulic Wash all metal parts in alcohol or equivalent before
brake fluid. reassembly. Do not use a petroleum base cleaning agent.
2. Remove snap ring (10) and' spring retainer (9). Coat new block vees and rubber parts with hydraulic
3. Remove spring (12). If necessary, remove “ O” ring brake fluid.
seal (27).
4. Remove retainer (14) and unscrew lock ring (13) Assembly
counterclockwise. 1. Place spring (1) and check valve (4) into end of cyl
5. Grasp push rod (11) and slide entire assembly out of inder body.
main cylinder body. 2. Place "O ” ring seal (2) over check valve retainer (3)
6 . Slide bushing (15) off push rod (11) and discard “O " and install check valve retainer into body.
ring seal (16). 3. Install new valve insert (21) in valve body (22).
7. Discard piston cup (26). 4. Slide bushing (15) onto push rod (11). Install new
8 . Remove retainer (17) and washer (18). " 0 ” ring seal (16).
9. Disengage snap ring (25) from piston. 5. Slide new piston cup (26) onto push rod and into
10. Slide piston (20) off push rod (11). Discard push rod bushing.
cup (19). 6 . Replace retainer (17) into piston cup (26). Install
11. Slide valve body off end of push rod (11). washer (18) on push rod.
12. Remove washer (24), spring (23), and snap ring (25). 7. Slide bushing (15), retainer (17), and washer (18)
13. Remove and discard valve insert (21). halfway down push rod.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
The Hy-Power units are located with a bracket on the FLUSHING
truck chassis frame. The slave cylinder is located lower
than the master cylinder, and the bleeder screw on the When installing or servicing a booster unit on a vehicle
booster unit faces upward for ease of servicing. This which has had considerable service, flush entire hy
unit is inserted between the master cylinder and the draulic brake system to remove dirt and sludge. Inspect
wheel cylinders. master cylinder for defects and repair. For flushing
purposes use either recommended brake fluid or Di- A manifold check valve is installed in the vacuum line
Acetone alcohol. Discard fluid after flushing. running from the engine intake manifold to the front
chamber of the booster unit.
CAUTION: Use care when filling hydraulic sys
tem to prevent dirt from entering through top of
master cylinder.
AIR BRAKES
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The air brake system (fig. 78) completely replaces primary air brake system and the auxiliary air operated
all hydraulic brake components with air brake parts for accessories. A minimum air pressure of approximately
producing and utilizing greater braking forces. The air 80 psi is required to lift the valve diaphragm off its seat
compressor in the all air brake system builds up and and permit air to pass to the accessories. Should the air
maintains the air pressure required to operate all of the pressure drop below 80 psi, the diaphragm closes off all
air powered devices. air to the accessories and all remaining air pressure is
A pressure protection valve is installed between the reserved for the brake system.
check the discharge line for carbon. If excessive carbon RELAY VALVE
is found in either check, the cylinder head or discharge
line should be cleaned or replaced. Once each year the relay valve should be disassembled
and cleaned. Rubber parts and parts subject to wear
100,000 Miles: should be replaced if worn or damaged. Strainers at
Depending upon operating conditions and experience, relay diaphragm bleeder passage and exhaust port should
disassemble compressor, clean and inspect all parts be cleaned or replaced. If the relay valve does not
thoroughly. Repair or replace all worn or damaged parts. function as described under Service Checks—Relay Valve,
disassemble the valve and clean all parts.
IMPORTANT: Should it be necessary to drain
the engine cooling system to prevent damage QUICK RELEASE VALVE
from freezing, water cooled compressors must
be drained as both cylinder block and cylinder Every Year or 50,000 Miles
head are water cooled. Use drain cock or re Disassemble valve, clean all parts and replace the
move head and/or block pipe plugs. diaphragm.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
to the compressor. Use a new discharge fitting
AIR COMPRESSOR
gasket.
Removal 9. Align compressor drive and adjust proper belt
These instructions are general and in some cases ad tension.
ditional precautions must be taken. 10. Tighten mounting bolts securely and evenly.
1. Drain air brake system. 11. After installation run compressor and check for air,
2. If water cooled type compressor, drain engine cool oil, or water leaks at compressor connections. Also
ing system, compressor cylinder head and block. check for noisy operation.
3. Disconnect all air lines, water and oil lines to and
from compressor. RELAY VALVE
4. Remove compressor mounting bolts and compressor
The relay valve is normally mounted to operate the
from engine.
brakes on the rear axle or axles of six wheel air braked
5. Use a gear-puller to remove the gear or pulley
tractors or trucks and long wheel base trucks. It is con
from compressor crankshaft.
trolled by the brake valve and delivers the same air
Installation (Cleaning and Inspection) pressure to the brake actuators it controls as is being
1. Clean oil supply line. Before connecting this line to delivered to the relay valve by the brake valve. The relay
the compressor run the engine briefly to be sure oil valve has a direct compressed air supply as can be noted
is flowing freely through the supply line. in Figure 79. It operates as a remotely controlled high
2. Clean the oil return line or return passages through capacity brake valve.
the brackets; these passages must be unrestricted so Type R - l Relay Valves are mounted on a reservoir.
oil can return to the engine. Type R l-C Relay Valves are mounted away from, but
3. Prelubricate compressor cylinder walls and bearings connected to, a reservoir by tubing. Both types operate
with clean engine oil before assembling compressor. in a sim ilar manner.
4. Always use a new mounting gasket and be sure oil Leakage Tests
hole in gasket and compressor is properly aligned 1. Fully charge air brake system.
with oil supply line. 2. Make several service brake applications and check
5. Inspect pulley or gear and associated parts for wear for prompt application and release at all wheels.
or damage. They must be a neat fit on compressor 3. With service brakes released, coat the exhaust port
crankshaft. Replace pulley or gear if worn or of the relay valve with soap suds. A maximum leak
damaged. age as indicated by a one inch soap bubble in not less
6 . Install pulley or gear on compressor crankshaft than three seconds is permissible.
making sure it properly contacts the shaft and does 4. Make and hold a service brake application and coat
not ride the key. Tighten crankshaft nut securely the exhaust port of the relay valve with soap suds.
and install cotter pin. A maximum leakage as indicated by a one inch soap
7. Be sure the air cleaner is clean and properly in bubble in not less than two seconds is permissible.
stalled. If the compressor intake is connected to 5. Release the brakes.
either the engine air cleaner or supercharger, these If valve does not function as described above, or if
connections must be tight with no leakage. leakage is excessive, replace relay valve, or repair
8 . Clean or replace any damage or dirty air or water or replace worn or damaged parts, in which case the
lines which may be corroded, before connecting them following information should prove to be helpful.
Leakage Test
With a full pressure application, check the brake
chamber for leakage. No leakage is permissible.
If leakage is detected around the flange, or clamping
ring, the bolts should be tightened evenly but only enough
to stop the leakage otherwise the diaphragm, flange
sealing surface or clamping ring could be distorted.
Removal
1. Disconnect air line and push rod yoke.
2. Remove brake chamber.
Installation
1. Mount brake chamber to mounting bracket.
2. If possible, push rod should point down to obtain
maximum drainage.
3. Install yoke and its nut on push rod and connect to
slack adjuster.
4. Check the angle formed by the push rod and slack
adjuster. The angle should never be less than 90°
when full air pressure is applied to the brake
chamber when the brakes are cold and properly
adjusted.
Disassembly
1. After cleaning the exterior of the brake chamber,
mark it in such a way that it can be assembled the
same way. If the brake chamber is to be dismantled Fig . 8 2 —Governor
19
1 2 3 4 5 8 9 10 1112 13 14 15 16 17 1
U liX A
Fig. 84—G o ve rn o r—Exploded V ie w
1. C o ver 6. Lower Spring Seats 11. Washer 16. In let and Exhaust V a lv e
2. Retaining Ring 7. Spring G u id e 12. Grommet 17. Inlet-Exhaust V a lv e
3. Adjusting Screw Lock N ut 8. Adjusting Screw 13. Grommet Spring
4. Upper Spring Seat 9. Exhaust Stem 14. Piston 18. Body
5. Pressure Setting Spring 10. Exhaust Stem Spring 15. Grommet 19. Filters
filters exhaust stem, and the pistons are not FOOT OPERATED AIR BRAKE CONTROL VALVE
obstructed.
4. Check springs for cracks, distortion, or corrosion. Removal
1. Exhaust all air from system.
5. Replace all parts not considered serviceable during
2. Remove all lines running to brake valve.
these inspections.
3. Remove pedal push rod clevis pin.
Assembly 4. Remove mounting bolts and remove valve.
NOTE: P rior to assembly lubricate the lower Disassembly (Fig. 85)
body bore, the top of the piston, the piston 1. Remove boot (18) from plunger (17) and bracket (16).
grooves, piston grommets, piston setting spring 2. Remove plunger (17).
guide and adjusting screw. 3. Remove mounting bracket (16) from valve body (10),
1. Install the exhaust stem grommet in its groove in by removing 3 bolts (19) and lock washers (20).
the stem bore of the piston. 4. Remove snap ring (15).
2. Drop the inlet and exhaust valve into place at the 5. Remove piston assembly (14) and spring (11) from
bottom of the piston. valve body (1 0 ).
3. Install the inlet valve spring with its narrow end 6 . Remove two seals (12 and 13) from piston assembly
against the valve. P ress the spring down until the (14).
large coiled end snaps into the groove inside the 7. Invert valve body.
piston. 8 . Remove screw (1), retainer (2), and diaphragm (3)
4. Position the exhaust stem spring over the exhaust from exhaust valve body (5).
stem. Then carefully press the stem into the stem 9. Remove ring (4) from exhaust valve body (5).
bore of the piston. 10. Remove exhaust valve body (5), seal (6 ), spring (7),
5. Install the piston in the body. and valve (9) from valve body (10).
6 . Install one lower spring seat, spring guide, the other 11. Remove seal (8 ) from valve (9).
lower spring seat, pressure setting spring, and the Cleaning and Inspection
hex-shaped upper spring seat on the adjusting screw, 1. Check mounting flange for cracks or breakage.
in that order. 2. Discard all rubber parts.
7. Screw the upper spring seat down until the dimension 3. Inspect the body for scoring and excessive wear. Be
from the top of the seat to the bottom of the stem sure all passages are clear.
head is approximately 1 -7 /8 ". Secure with lock nut. 4. Wash all metal parts in non-toxic cleaning solvent
NOTE: Before placing the adjusting screw and and dry with air.
stem assembly in the governor body, check to 5. Replace all parts found damaged or worn.
be sure the exhaust stem and its spring are in Assembly (Fig. 85)
place in the piston.
NOTE: Lubricate all seals with Lubriplate
Installation grease.
1. Clean or replace both air lines connected to the 1. Place seal (8 ) on valve (9) and place in valve body
governor. (10).
2. Mount governor in place with exhaust port pointing 2. Install spring (7) on valve (9).
toward the ground. 3. Place seal (6 ) on exhaust valve body (5) and install
3. Connect air lines to governor. assembly in valve body ( 1 0 ) piloting on coil spring
4. Test governor for proper operation. (V.
4. Secure exhaust valve body (5) into valve body (10) not fully release, it indicates that the exhaust valve is
with ring (4). not operating sufficiently. This can be caused by:
5. Secure diaphragm (3) and retainer (2) to exhaust 1. Insufficient exhaust valve to valve seat clearance.
valve body (5) with screw (1). 2. Improper adjustment of the brake pedal push rod.
6 . Invert valve body (10). 3. Lack of lubrication in the body causing the piston
7. Install seal (13) on piston (14). Install seal (12) on and spring assembly to bind.
piston (14). 4. Binding pedal and/or linkage.
8 . Install coil spring (11) into valve body (10). If the brake valve does not apply promptly, or does not
9. Install piston assembly (14) into valve body (10) and apply fully, it indicates that the inlet valve is not opening
secure with snap ring (15). sufficiently. This can be caused by:
10. Secure mounting bracket (16) to valve body (10) with 1. Improper adjustment of the linkage, which does not
bolts (19) and lock washers (20). permit the piston to travel far enough when the brake
11. Install plunger (17) into mounting bracket (16). is being applied.
12. Install boot (18) on plunger (17). 2. Binding pedal and/or linkage.
If the brake valve does not graduate the delivered pres
Tests and Adjustments of Rebuilt Unit sure properly check to be sure the bleed hole to the
cavity immediately below the piston is not restricted.
Tests Installation
If facilities are available, the rebuilt brake valve can 1. Mount brake valve in position, install mounting bolts
be tested on a suitable test rack. If such facilities are and tighten.
not available, the brake valve can be tested on the 2. Connect air lines to brake valve.
vehicle. 3. Test operation thoroughly.
Both operating and leakage tests must be made in 4. Adjust brake pedal free play as outlined in this
either case to make certain the brake valve meets the section under Push Rod to Main Cylinder Adjustment.
following specifications:
1. The brake valve must deliver approximately full QUICK RELEASE VALVE
reservoir pressure when the pedal is fully de
pressed. If this test is being made on a vehicle and Removal
brake valve does not deliver approximately full 1. Disconnect air lines at quick release valve (fig. 8 6 ).
reservoir pressure, check to see if the pedal ad 2. Remove mounting bolts and remove valve.
justment linkage is causing any interference. Disassembly
2. The brake valve must control delivered pressures Remove all dirt and grease from exterior of valve,
between approximately 5 and 75 psi. These pres using cleaning solvent and a brush. Inspect exterior of
sures must rapidly vary in accordance with the valve for broken or damaged parts. All broken or dam
position in which the pedal is held. aged parts must be replaced.
3. Leakage at the exhaust port in both the fully applied Unscrew cover, lift out diaphragm spring, diaphragm
or fully released positions must not exceed a one- spring seat and diaphragm (fig. 87).
inch soap bubble in three seconds.
4. No leakage is permissible at any other point on the Cleaning and Inspection of Parts
brake valve with the pedal in the depressed position. Wash all metal parts in cleaning solvent.
Adjustments
If the brake valve does not release promptly, or does
BODY
S P R IN G
C O VER
A.
BRAKES 5-56
Assembly
1. Insert diaphragm into spring seat.
t _.
2. Position diaphragm and spring seat in body with lo c k sleeve m u st come out
spring in place, install and tighten cover securely. AND ENGAGE HEAD OF WORM
sh a ft to lo c k a d ju s t m en t
end of shaft to edge of body (A, fig. 89) is 0.625”. and that all are at the same angle. If angle is less than
Install new welch plug in worm shaft bore. 90 degrees with brakes applied, slack adjuster is going
4. Position cover plates on body and attach with new "over cen ter." Adjust brakes as previously described
rivets. Covers must be flat and in good contact with under "Brake Adjustments."
body after riveting.
BRAKE SHOES AND CAMSHAFTS
Installation (Figs. 89, 90, 91 and 92)
1. If a new slack adjuster is being installed, make sure Removal
it is the same size and type as that removed. Make
sure spacing washer is in place on camshaft. Slide
Front
1. Remove wheel nuts, rim locks and rim and tire
the slack adjuster onto camshaft and attach with assembly.
spacer and lock ring. 2. Remove cotter pin, spindle nut, spacer and outer
2. Connect brake chamber push rod yoke to slack ad bearing.
juster with clevis pin and cotter pin. Refer to 3. Remove wheel and brake drum assembly.
"B rake Chamber Installation" for adjustment of 4. Remove brake shoe pull back springs.
brake chamber push rod. 5. Remove brake shoe hold down nuts, washers and
3. Adjust brakes as previously directed under "Brake anchor pin "horseshoe" clips.
Adjustments." 6 . Remove brake shoes.
6 . Remove wheel and brake drum assembly, being 4. Install brake shoe pull back spring.
careful not to damage outer bearing. 5. Install wheel and brake drum assembly, front wheel
7. Slip pull back spring off of pins on inside of brake bearing, spacer and spindle nut. Tighten spindle nut
shoes. See Figure 91 for parts identification. to 55 foot pounds torque and insert cotter pin. (The
8 . Remove cotter pin from camshaft and tap out cam nut may have to be backed off slightly to allow
shaft (fig. 90). entrance of cotter pin.)
6 . Install rim and tire assembly, rim locks and wheel
Camshaft Bracket Byshing Replacement nuts. Tighten nuts on opposite sides alternately to
1. Using a suitable tool remove grease seal and old torque specified in Section 3 under Wheels and T ires.
bushings.
2. Using suitable bushing installer, install new bushing NOTE: Wheel nuts must be checked at the end
and line ream to a finished diameter of 1.499" to of 500 miles to be certain that rim locks and
1.501". Install a new grease seal. nuts have not loosened.
NOTE: Be certain that a lubrication fitting has
been installed in camshaft bracket.
Rear
1. Make certain camshaft is engaged properly before
installing retainer. Set brake shoes in place and
Installation
Front
1. Slide camshaft into place making certain brake shoes
make certain pins and rollers will engage proper
location on cam. Do not install rollers and pins at
this time.
will contact cam at proper location. 2. Install brake shoe pull back springs.
2. Replace same number spacers as removed and 3. Pry shoes apart and install brake shoe cam rollers
install cotter pin. and roller pins.
3. Install brake shoes, brake shoe “ horseshoe" clips, 4. Install rear wheel. Install axle outer bearing and
hold down nuts, and washers. Lock nuts in place with adjusting nut. Adjust bearing as follows:
cotter pins. a. Tighten adjusting nut with T-handle wrench 12"
long each side, until wrench tight, at the same With brakes released, the angle formed by the push
time rotating hub to make sure all surfaces are rod and camshaft lever must be greater than 90°, and
in proper contact. Then loosen nut at least 45 all units should be set at the same angle. With the brakes
degrees, or more if necessary, until a lip of the applied, after being adjusted, this angle should still be
nut lock will engage the nearest flat on the nut. greater than 90°. In other words, the camshaft lever
b. Make sure wheel turns freely, then install nut should not go "over center” when the brakes are applied.
lock and locking nut. Tighten locking nut firmly. The position of the push rod yoke on the push rod should
Bend lip of nut lock over flat of locking nut. be adjusted if necessary until these conditions prevail.
c. Apply a rope of smooth cup grease around outer Proper shoe-to-drum free play may be obtained by per
bearing. forming the following procedures:
5. Install axle shaft and secure with "sp lit wedge”
locks and retaining nuts.
6 . Install inner rim and tire assembly (make certain
FrontandRear
1. Using the proper size "b o x " wrench or deep socket
valve points toward the outside), rim spacer and wrench, depress the spring loaded collar that locks
outer rim and tire assembly making certain tire the slack adjuster adjusting nut in place (fig. 94).
valve is 180° away from inner tire valve. 2. Turn the adjusting nut until a uniform light drag is
7. Install rim locks and nuts. Tighten nuts alternately felt on the wheels.
on opposite sides, to torque specified in Section 3 3. Back off on nut until wheel is just free; then back off
under Wheels and T ires. three more " fla ts " for facing-to-drum running
clearance. Repeat this operation at all slack
NOTE: Nuts and rim locks must be torqued at adjusters.
the end of 500 miles to be certain they have not
loosened. RESERVOIRS
AIR BRAKE Removal
Adjustment 1. Bleed all air out of brake system.
The brake shoe-to-drum freeplay adjustment of air 2. Disconnect air lines and remove drain cock.
brakes is accomplished by means of the slack adjuster 3. Remove mounting bracket nuts and bolts and remove
which is incorporated in the camshaft lever. reservoir.
STEM-
ADJUSTING
SCREW
LOCK NUT-
PUSH LOCK SLEEVE IN TO
D IS EN G A G E HEAD OF W O R M
SHAFT TO MAKE ADJUSTM ENT
SPRING
SPRING
SEAT BALL
VALVE
BODY-
r'7-miy.p a re
'E W
LOCK SLEEVE MUST CO M E OUT
A N D E N G A G E HEAD OF W O R M
PORT OF
SHAFT TO LOCK ADJUSTM ENT
RESERVOIR
valve seat thoroughly. Check the body and spring cage for 2. Install grommet on cap nut and screw cap nut into
cracks. Be sure the exhaust port in the spring cage is body and tighten securely.
not plugged.
Installation
Assembly Position valve in place with arrow on side of body in
1. Place the ball valve in the body of the safety valve. dicating direction of air flow. Secure air lines to each
2. Place spring release pin and spring seat in spring end of the valve.
cage with the adjusting screw assembly. Position
Testing Rebuilt Unit
the spring seat over the ball valve and screw the
Both operation and leakage tests must be made as out
spring cage to the body.
lined under Service Checks—Single Check Valve.
DIAPHRAGM
LOWER BODY
TRAILER EQUIPMENT
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
For 1967 trailer air brake equipment is available for valve, trailer connectors, separate stop light switch and
some models. The option includes a hand control valve, connecting lines, (fig. 98). Testing and servicing of these
double check valve, emergency air valve, breakaway units is outlined in this section.
EMERGENCY
AIR VALVE
H A N D CONTROL
VALVE
DOUBLE CHECK
VALVE A N D
STOPLIGHT SWITCH
TRAILER
CO NNECTORS
TO SERVICE BREAKAWAY
BRAKE VALVE
TO SERVICE
TANK
Leakage Tests should show full air system pressure. Then pull knob
1. Apply truck brakes and check for leakage at hand out; test gauge should drop to zero.
control valve exhaust port, using soap suds. 3. Again build up air pressure in system to operating
2. Apply trailer brakes only with hand control valve range, then stop engine. Push emergency air valve
and check for leakage at truck brake application knob in. Make a series of brake applications until
valve exhaust port, using soap suds. low air buzzer sounds. Slightly open drain cock in
3. Leakage of a one inch bubble in one second is per the dry air tank to obtain a slow (approx. 1 0 psi per
missible in either of these tests. If leakage exceeds minute) pressure drop in the tractor brake system.
this specification, replace the shuttle valve. When truck air system drops to 45 psi (approx.) the
emergency air valve knob should automatically come
EMERGENCY AIR VALVE AND out and pressure on test gauge should rapidly drop
BREAKAWAY VALVE to zero.
Operating Tests
1. Pull out emergency air valve knob to exhaust air Leakage Tests
pressure from breakaway valve control line. Dis 1. Build up air pressure in truck brake system to oper
connect trailer emergency line from emergency out ating range. Push in emergency air valve knob to
let port at breakaway valve and connect an air charge trailer brake system. Use soap suds to coat
pressure test gauge to emergency outlet port. exhaust ports of emergency air valve and breakaway
2. Start engine and build up air pressure in system. valve.
Low air pressure buzzer should stop operating at 2. When emergency air valve leaks excessively, install
approximately 60 psi. With air pressure in operating new piston O-rings. When breakaway valve leaks
range, push emergency air valve knob in. Test gauge excessively, install new O-rings and plunger seal.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
To Stop
Light Switch DOUBLE CHECK VALVE (Fig. 100)
Gasket
Valve Guide Shuttle Valve Disassembly
Body Cover Remove two cap screws and lock washers attaching
valve cover to body. Remove cover and gasket, then
remove shuttle valve and valve guide.
Installation
Wash all parts in a cleaning solution and wipe dry.
Examine all parts for corrosion or deterioration and
From Trailer
replace as necessary. Make sure shuttle valve will slide
Brake freely back and forth in valve guide.
Application Brake Hand
Valve Control Valve
Assembly
Delivery Port
To Trailer Brake Apply a thin coating of Lubriplate or equivalent to in
Service Line side of valve guide. Place valve guide and shuttle valve
in body. Position cover on body, using new gasket. Install
cover cap screws and lock washers, and tighten evenly
Fig. 100—Double Check V a lv e and firmly.
SPECIAL TOOLS
tggjij
GASOLINE ENGINES
ENGINE TUNE-UP
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c rip tio n ......................................................... 6-1 Instrument C h e c k -O u t...................................................... .... 6-6
Mechanical Checks and A d ju stm en ts.............................. 6-1 Instrument H o o k -U p ...................................................... .... 6-6
Spark Plug R e m o v a l...................................................... 6-1 Check and Adjust D w e l l ................................................ .... 6-6
Test C o m p re s s io n ......................................................... 6-1 Check Dwell Variation ................................................ .... 6-6
Service and Install Spark Plugs ................................. 6-2 Check and Adjust T i m i n g ............................................. .... 6-6
Service Ignition S y s t e m ................................................ 6-2 Adjust Idle Speed and Mixture .................................... .... 6-7
Service Battery and Battery Cables ........................... 6-4 Additional Checks and Adjustm ents................................. .... 6-8
Service Delcotron and R e g u la t o r ................................. 6-4 Testing Crankcase Ventilation V a l v e ........................... .... 6-8
Service Fan B e l t ............................................................ 6-4 Testing Cranking V o l t a g e ............................................. .... 6-8
Service Manifold Heat Valve ....................................... Cylinder Balance T e s t ................................................... .... 6-8
Tighten M a n ifo ld ............ ................................................ 6-5 B a t t e r y ........................................................................... .... 6-8
Service Fuel Lines and Fuel Filter ........................... 6-5 Ig n it io n ............................................................... .. ............. 6-9
Service Cooling S y s t e m ................................................ 6-5 C a r b u r e t o r ..................................................................... .... 6-9
Check and Adjust Accelerator L in k a g e ........................ 6-5 Fuel P u m p ..................................................................... .... 6-9
Service Crankcase Ventilation....................................... 6-5 Cooling S y ste m ............................................................... .... 6-9
Service A ir Injection Reactor System ........................ 6-5 Cylinder Head Torque and Valve A d ju s t m e n t............ .... 6-9
Adjust C h o k e .................................................................. 6-5
Service A ir C le a n e r .................................... ..................
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The engine tune up is important to the modern auto equipment available for this purpose. Always follow the
motive engine with its vastly improved power and per instructions provided by the manufacturer of the par
formance. The higher compression ratios, improved ticular equipment to be used.
electrical systems and other advances in design, make Additional checks and adjustments are included in the
today's engines more sensitive and have a decided effect latter part of this section for use as required. Many of
on power, performance and fuel consumption. these operations can be used to isolate and correct
It is seldom advisable to attempt a tune up by correction trouble located during the tune up. Where conditions
of one or two items only. Time will normally be saved are uncovered requiring major corrective action, refer
and more lasting results assured if the technician will to the appropriate section of this manual or the
follow a definite and thorough procedure of analysis and Truck Chassis Overhaul Manual for detailed service
correction of all items affecting power, performance information.
and economy. Typical illustrations and procedures are used except
The tune up will be performed in two parts. The first where specific illustrations or procedures are necessary
part will consist of mechanical checks and adjustments; to clarify the operation. Illustrations showing bench
the second part will consist of an instrument checkout operations are used for clarifications, however, all
that can be performed with any one of the units of service operations can be performed on the vehicle.
P O R C E L A IN
IN S U L A T O R
IN S U L A T O R C R A C K S
O F T EN O C C U R H ERE
SH ELL
(P R O P E R G A P )
remotely at the starter, with a special jumper 3. Inspect each spark plug for make and heat range.
cable or other means, the primary distributor All plugs must be of the same make and number.
lead must be disconnected from the negative 4. Adjust spark plug gaps to specifications using a
post on the coil and the ignition switch must be round feeler gauge.
in the “ ON” position. Failure to do this will
result in a damaged grounding circuit in the CAUTION: Never bend the center electrode to
ignition switch. adjust gap. Always adjust by bending ground or
side electrode.
3. Crank engine through at least four compression
strokes to obtain highest possible reading. 5. If available, test plugs with a spark plug tester.
4. Check and record compression of each cylinder. 6. Inspect spark plug hole threads and clean before
5. If one or more cylinders read low or uneven, inject installing plugs. Corrosion deposits can be removed
about a tablespoon of engine oil on top of pistons with a 14 mm. x 1.25 SAE spark plug tap (available
in low reading cylinders (through s p a r k plug through local jobbers) or by using a small wire
port). Crank engine several times and recheck brush in an electric drill. (Use grease on tap to
compression. catch chips.)
• If compression comes up but does not necessarily CAUTION: Use extreme care when using tap to
reach normal, rings are worn. prevent cross threading. Also crank engine sev-
• If compression does not improve, valves are eral times to blow out any material dislodged
burnt, sticking or not seating properly. during cleaning operation.
• If two adjacent cylinders indicate low compression
and injecting oil does not increase compression, 7. Install spark plugs with new gaskets and torque to
the cause may be a head gasket leak between the specifications.
cylinders. Engine coolant and/or oil in cylinders NOTE: The following are some of the greatest
could result from this defect. causes of unsatisfactory spark plug performance.
NOTE: If a weak cylinder cannot be located • Installation of plugs with insufficient torque to
with the compression check, see “ Cylinder B al fully seat the gasket.
ance Test” under “ Additional Checks and Ad • Installation of the plugs using excessive torque
justments” in this section. which changes gap settings.
Service & Install Spark Plugs (Fig. 2) • Installation of plugs on dirty gasket seal.
1. Inspect each plug individually for badly worn elec • Installation of plugs to corroded spark plug hole
trodes, glazed, broken or blistered porcelains and threads.
replace plugs where necessary. Refer to spark 8 . Connect spark plug wiring.
ROTOR
(RO U N D )
LOCATOR
(SQ U A R E )
CAM
LUBRICATOR
CENTRIFUGAL
ADVANCE
M EC H A N ISM
CAM
ADJUST DWELL LUBRICATOR
ANGLE SETTING OR REPLACEM ENT
POINT OPENING
CA U TIO N !
N EVER O IL
C A M LU B R IC A T O R —
REPLACE W IC K
Fig. 3— Distributor (In Line) W H E N N EC ESSA R Y
2. Clean rotor and inspect for damage or deterioration.
Replace rotor where necessary. A D JU ST SQ UA RELY
3. Replace brittle, oil soaked or damaged spark plug A N D JU ST
wires. Install all wires to proper spark plug. Proper T O U C H IN G LOBE
OF CAM
positioning of spark plug wires in supports is im
portant to prevent cross-firing.
4. Tighten all ignition system connections. Fig. 4— Distributor (T yp ica l V8)
5. Replace or repair any wires that are frayed, loose clean contact points since particles will embed and
Pulse(Breakerless)Distributor
or damaged. cause arcing and rapid burning of points. Do not
Magnetic attempt to remove all roughness nor dress the
There are no moving parts in the ignition pulse amp point surfaces down smooth. Merely remove scale
lifier, and the distributor shaft and bushings have or dirt.
permanent type lubrication, therefore no periodic main • Clean cam lobe with cleaning solvent, lubricate
tenance is required for the magnetic pulse ignition cam lobe with “ Delco Remy Cam and Ball Bearing
system. Refer to Section 6 Y for an analysis of problems Lubricant" or its equivalent and rotate cam lub
and/or repair procedures encountered on the Transis ricator wick 1 / 2 turn.
torized (Magnetic Pulse) ignition system. • Replace points that are burned or badly pitted.
Standard (Breaker Point) Distributor (Figs. 3 or 4)
NOTE: Where prematurely burned or badly
1. Check the distributor centrifugal advance mechanism
pitted points are encountered, the ignition sys
by turning the distributor rotor in a clockwise direc
tem and engine should be checked to determine
tion as far as possible, then releasing the rotor to
the cause of trouble so it can be eliminated.
see if the springs return it to their retarded position.
Unless the condition causing point burning or
If the rotor does not return readily, the distributor
pitting is corrected, new points will provide no
must be disassembled and the cause of the trouble
better service than the old points. Refer to
corrected.
Section 6 Y for an analysis of point burning or
2. Check to see that the vacuum control operates freely
pitting.
by turning the movable breaker plate counterclock
wise to see if the spring returns to its retarded • Check point alignment (fig. 5) then, adjust distri
position. Any stiffness in the operation of the vacu butor contact point gap to .019" (new points) or
um control will affect the ignition timing. Correct .016" (used points). Breaker arm rubbing block
any interference or binding condition noted. must be on high point of lobe during adjustment.
3. Examine distributor points and clean or replace if
NOTE: If contact points have been in service,
necessary.
they should be cleaned with a point file before
• Contact points with an overall gray color and
adjusting with a feeler gauge.
only slight roughness or pitting need not be
replaced. • Check distributor point spring tension (contact
• Dirty points should be cleaned with a clean point point pressure) with a spring gauge hooked to
file. breaker lever at the contact and pull exerted at 90
Use only a few strokes of a clean, fine-cut con degrees to the breaker lever. The points should be
tact file. The file should not be used on other closed (cam follower between lobes) and the read
metals and should not be allowed to become greasy ing taken just as the points separate. If not within
or dirty. Never use emery cloth or sandpaper to lim its, replace.
LATERAL PROPER
MISALIGNMENT LATERAL ALIGNMENT
HOLD
DO NOT SUCK
IN T O O M U C H
ELECTROLYTE VERTICAL
FLOAT M UST
BE FREE
VALVE
FLAME ARRESTO R VENTED CAP
VALVE
NO N-VEN TED C A P
VALVE
VALVE
FLAME ARRESTOR
NON-VENTED CAP
CLOSED POSITIVE V8 (283-327) (TYPICAL) POSITIVE V8 (283-327) (TYPICAL) CLOSED POSITIVE V8 (366)
ing is TDC and all BTDC settings fall on the " A "
(advance) side of “ O ".
4. Adjust the timing by loosening the distributor clamp
and rotating the distributor body as required, then
tighten the clamp.
5. Stop engine and remove timing light and reconnect
the spark advance hose.
Adjust Idle Speed and Mixture (Fig. 13) (Except When
Equipped With Air Injection Reactor System)
1. As a preliminary adjustment, turn idle mixture
screws lightly to seat and back out 2 turns.
CAUTION: Do not turn idle mixture screw
tightly against seat or damage may result.
2. With engine running at operating temperature (choke
wide open) adjust idle speed screw to bring idle speed
to specified rpm (automatic transmission in drive,
manual transmission in neutral).
3. Adjust idle mixture screw to obtain highest steady
idle speed (1/4 turn out from lean roll).
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 as needed for final adjustment.
5. Shut down the engine, remove gauges and install air
cleaner.
Adjust Idle Speed and Mixture (Fig. 13) (With Air
Fig. 12—Ignition Timing Marks Injector Reactor System)
To produce an acceptable level of exhaust emissions
2 . Start engine and run at idle speed (see tune up chart).
the idle speed and mixture should not be adjusted to
3. Aim timing light at timing tab. obtain the highest steady vacuum reading.
The recommended adjustment procedure for Air In
NOTE: The markings on the tabs are in 2° jection Reactor System equipped engines is as follows:
increments (the greatest number of markings 1. As a preliminary adjustment, turn idle mixture
on the “ A ” side of the “ O” )- The "O ” mark- screws lightly to seat and then back out 3 turns.
IDLE SP EE D
SC REW
IDLE M IXTURE
SC REW
CAUTION: Do not turn idle mixture screw 3. Adjust idle mixture screw (turn in) to "lean roll”
tightly against seat or damage may result. position; then turn screw out 1/4 turn (1/4 turn
rich from "lean roll” ). The definition of "lean
2. With engine running at operating temperature, choke
roll” point is a 20 to 30 rpm drop in engine speed,
wide open, and parking brake applied, adjust idle
obtained by leaning the idle mixture.
speed screw to specified idle speed (automatic
4. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 as needed for final adjustment.
transmission in "d riv e” - manual transmission in
"neutral” ).
IgnitionSwitch
With voltmeter connected as described for the Cranking
cap.
3. If the pressure will not hold, there is either an
internal or external leak in the system.
Voltage Test, turn ignition switch to ON. Voltage should
drop to 5 to 7 volts as current is now passing through Cylinder Head Torque and Valve Adjustment
high resistance wire connected between ignition switch Retorquing the cylinder head bolts is not necessary
and (+) positive terminal of coil. If battery voltage of unless a gasket has been replaced, or a leak is suspected.
12 volts is obtained, the starter solenoid is by-passing Valve lash must always be adjusted after the head has
the high resistance wire connected between ignition been torqued.
switch and (+) positive terminal of coil, thus the starter Before adjusting the valve lash, it is extremely im
solenoid is not functioning properly to bypass the ignition portant that the engine be thoroughly warmed up to
resistance wire or the ignition circuit is incorrectly normalize the expansion of all parts. This is very im
portant because during the warm-up period, the valve
wired.
DistributorResistance
Use equipment as directed by manufacturer. Excessive
clearance will change considerably.
1. After the engine has been normalized, remove rocker
arm covers and gaskets.
resistance in primary circuit must be eliminated before
CAUTION: Do not pry rocker arm cover loose.
continuing with test procedure.
SecondaryResistance
Use equipment as directed by manufacturer.
Gaskets adhearing to cylinder head and rocker
arm cover may be sheared by bumping end of
rocker arm cover rearward with palm of hand or
• Uniform "normal readings" as specified by manu a rubber mallet.
ENGINE MECHANICAL
IN LINE
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip tio n ......................................................... 6-11 Oil P u m p ........................................................................ ...6-18
Component Replacement and A djustm ent........................ 6-11 Rem oval............... ........................................................ ...6-18
Engine A s s e m b lie s ......................................................... 6-11 In sta lla tio n .................................................................. ...6-18
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-11 Oil Seal (Rear M a in )...................................................... ...6-18
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-13 Replacement ............................................................... 6-18
Manifold A s se m b ly ......................................................... 6-14 Torsional D a m p e r ......................................................... ...6-18
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-14 R em oval........................................................................ ...6-18
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-14 In sta llatio n .................................................................. ...6-19
Rocker Arm C o v e r......................................................... 6-14 Crankcase Front C o v e r ................................................ ...6-20
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-14 R em oval........................................................................ ...6-20
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-14 In sta llatio n .................................................................. ...6-20
Valve M echanism............................................................ 6-14 Oil Seal (Front C o v e r )................................................... ...6-20
Removal ......................................................................... 6-14 Replacement.................................................................. ...6-20
Installation and A d ju stm e n t....................................... 6-15 C a m s h a ft ........................................................................ ...6-20
Valve L i f t e r s .................................................................. 6-15 Measuring Lobe L i f t ................................................... ...6-20
Locating Noisy L ift e r s ................................................ 6-15 Rem oval........................................................................ ...6-21
R em oval.............................. * ....................................... 6-15 In sta llatio n .................................................................. ...6-21
In sta lla tio n .................................................................. 6-15 Timing Gears ............................................................... ...6-22
Valve Stem Oil Seal and/or Valve S p r i n g .................. 6-16 Replacement ............................................................... ...6-22
R e p la c e m e n t............................................................... 6-16 Flywheel ........................................................................ ...6-22
Cylinder Head A sse m b lies............................................. 6-16 R em oval........................................................................ ...6-22
Rem oval......................................................................... 6-16 In sta llatio n .................................................................. ...6-22
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-16 Engine M o u n t s ............................................................... ...6-22
Oil P a n ............................................................................ 6-17 Replacement ( F r o n t ) ................................................... ...6-22
Rem oval......................................................................... 6-17 Replacement (Rear) ................................................... ...6-22
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-17
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The In Line engines covered in this section are the Because of the interchangeability and sim ilarity of
230, 250 and 292 cu. in. L 6 engines used in 10-60 Series many engine sub-assemblies and parts, regardless of
truck vehicles. which truck vehicle they are used in, typical illustrations
This section covers the removal and installation of en and procedures are used (except where specific illus
gine assem blies; the removal, installation and adjustment trations or procedures are necessary to clarify the
of some sub-assemblies and replacement of some com operation). Although illustrations showing bench opera
ponents. For service to all components and sub- tions are used, most single operations, when not part of a
assem blies (after removal) and r e m o v a l of some general overhaul, should be performed (if practical) with
sub-assem blies, refer to Section 6 of the Truck Chassis the engine in the vehicle.
Overhaul Manual.
• Disconnect emergency brake cable at emergency • Disconnect Powerglide cooler lines at both ends
brake and retaining brackets. then remove cooler lines.
• Remove bolts retaining control island to support • Place a suitable jack, with the engine cradle (Tool
and swing control island forward. J-21741) attached, under the engine (fig. 1L) then
• Disconnect hoses at radiator surge tank. take engine weight off mounts.
• Remove bolts retaining surge tank to island sup
NOTE: Place the cradle so the forward legs of
port and remove surge tank.
the cradle straddle the fifth pan bolt from the
• Disconnect throttle cable at carburetor and re rear of the engine then install the safety chain
taining brackets. over the flywheel housing.
• Remove left and right island supports.
• Disconnect cab safety lock at rear cab support. • Remove the engine mount bolts and the front mount
• Remove rear cab support. crossmember.
4. Disconnect wires at: 9. Remove engine from vehicle as follows.
• Starter Solenoid CAUTION: Check often during engine removal
• Delcotron to be sure all necessary disconnects have been
• Temperature Switch
made.
• Oil Pressure Switch
• Coil ON CS 10-20-30 SERIES:
5. Disconnect: • On vehicles with automatic or four speed trans
• Accelerator linkage at manifold bellcrank. mission, remove rear mount crossmember.
• Choke cable at carburetor. • Raise engine and transmission assembly and pull
• Fuel line (from tank) at fuel pump. forward until removed.
• Heater hoses at engine connection. ON CS 40-50-60, KS 10-20, MS 50,
• Oil pressure gauge line (if so equipped). SS 40-50 SERIES:
• Vacuum or air lines at engine (as required). • Raise engine and pull forward until disconnected
• Power steering lines at pump end (if so equipped). from transmission.
• Ground straps at engine. • Continue to raise engine until removed from
• Exhaust pipe at manifold. vehicle.
NOTE: Hang exhaust pipe at frame with wire. ON GS 10-20 SERIES:
6 . Remove fan and pulley as outlined in Section 6 K. • Lower the engine and transmission assembly slow
7. Remove clutch cross-shaft or disconnect clutch slave ly, pulling to the rear to clear the front axle.
cylinder (if so equipped). • Move engine and transmission assembly out from
8 . Perform the following operations: under vehicle.
ON PS 10-20-30-40 SERIES:
ON ALL SERIES EXCEPT GS 10-20: • Raise engine and push forward to clear cro ss
• Remove the rocker arm cover as outlined. member and disconnect from transmission.
• Attach lifting adapter at proper cylinder head bolt • Remove engine from vehicle through right side
location. door opening.
• Attach lifting device and take engine weight off
mounts. ON TS 40-50-60 SERIES:
• Raise engine and pull forward until disconnected
NOTE: On Step Vans (PS Series) a crane type from transmission.
lift must be used. Bring arm of crane in right • Continue to raise engine until high enough to come
side door opening. out either side.
ON ALL SERIES EXCEPT CS 10-20-30, 10. If engine is to be mounted in an engine stand perform
GS 10-20: the following:
• Support transmission and disconnect from engine.
• Refer to "Section 7” . ON GS 10-20 SERIES:
• Remove engine mount bolts. • Remove the rocker arm cover as outlined.
• Attaching lifting adapter at proper cylinder head
ON CS 10-20-30, GS 10-20 SERIES: bolt location.
• Remove propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4. • Attach lifting device and remove engine assembly
from engine cradle.
NOTE: If plug for propeller shaft opening in ON CS 10-20-30, GS 10-20 SERIES:
transmission is not available, d r a i n • Remove synchromesh transmission and clutch (if
transmission. so equipped).
a. Remove clutch housing rear cover bolts.
• Disconnect speedometer cable at transmission. b. Remove bolts attaching the clutch housing to
• Disconnect shift linkage at transmission. engine block then remove transmission and
• Disconnect clutch linkage (as required). clutch housing as a unit.
• Remove engine mount bolts (exc. GS 10-20).
NOTE: Support the transmission as the last
ON GS 10-20 SERIES: mounting bolt is removed and as it is being
• Remove the flywheel housing bolt retaining starter pulled away from the engine, to prevent damage
wire harness clip and engine ground strap. to clutch disc.
ON GS 10-20 SERIES:
• Mount engine in engine cradle so the forward legs
of the cradle straddle the fifth pan bolt from the
rear of the engine.
• Remove the lifting device and lifter adapter from
cylinder head bolt location then torque cylinder
Fig. 1L—Engine C rad le Under Engine (G S 10-20) head bolts to specifications.
• Install rocker arm cover as outlined.
c. Remove starter and clutch housing rear cover. 2. Install engine in vehicle as follows:
d. Loosen clutch mounting bolts a turn at a time ON ALL SERIES EXCEPT CS 10-20-30,
(to prevent distortion of clutch cover) until the GS-10-20:
spring pressure is released. Remove all bolts, • Install engine and lower until transmission shaft
clutch disc and pressure plate assembly. lines up with clutch.
• Remove automatic transmission (if so equipped). • Push engine rearward and rotate crankshaft until
a. Lower engine, secured by the hoist, and sup transmission shaft and clutch engage.
port engine on blocks. • Install the engine mount bolts and torque to
b. Remove starter and converter housing under specifications.
pan. • Connect transmission to engine.
c. Remove flywheel-to-converter attaching bolts.
d. Support transmission on blocks. ON CS 10-20-30 SERIES:
e. Disconnect throttle linkage and vacuum modula • Lower engine and transmission assembly and push
tor line. rearward until engine mounts line up.
f. Remove transmission-to-engine mounting bolts. • On vehicles with automatic or four speed trans
g. With the hoist attached, remove blocks from missions, install rear mount crossmember.
the engine only and slowly guide the engine • Install the engine mount bolts and torque to
from the transmission. specifications.
• Install the propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4.
ON ALL SERIES EXCEPT CS 10-20-30,
GS 10-20: ON GS 10-20 SERIES:
• Remove clutch housing. • Move engine and transmission assembly under
• Loosen clutch mounting bolts a turn at a time (to vehicle then raise engine and push forward until
prevent distortion of clutch cover) until the spring engine mounts line up.
pressure is released. Remove all bolts, clutch • Install the front mount crossmember and all en
disc and pressure plate assembly. gine mount bolts and torque to specifications.
11. Mount engine in engine stand and remove lifting de • Remove jack and engine cradle from under engine.
vice and lifting adapter. • Install and connect transmission cooler lines (if
so equipped).
Installation • Install the flywheel housing bolt that retains start
1. If engine was mounted in an engine stand, attach er wire harness clip and engine ground strap.
lifting adapter to engine then using lifting device, • Install the propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4.
remove engine from stand and perform the following: ON ALL SERIES EXCEPT GS 10-20:
ON CS 10-20-30, GS 10-20 SERIES: • Remove the lifting device and lifting adapter from
• Install synchromesh transmission and clutch (if cylinder head- bolt location then torque cylinder
so equipped). head bolts to specifications.
a. Install the clutch assembly on flywheel as out • Install rocker arm cover as outlined.
lined in Section 7. 3. Connect transmission linkage (as required).
b. Install clutch housing rear cover and starter. 4. Install clutch cross-shaft or connect clutch slave
c. Install the transmission and clutch housing as cylinder (as required).
outlined in Section 7. 5. Install fan and pulley as outlined in Section 6 K.
d. Install clutch housing rear cover bolts and 6. Connect:
torque to specifications. • Exhaust pipe at manifold.
• Install automatic transmission (if so equipped). • Power steering lines at pump (as required).
• Vacuum or a ir lines at engine (as required). 7. Check for cracks in manifold castings.
• Oil pressure gauge line (as required). 8 . If necessary to replace either intake or exhaust
• Heater hoses at engine connection. manifolds, separate them by removing one bolt and
• Fuel line at fuel pump. two nuts at center of assembly. Reassemble mani
• Choke cable at carburetor. folds using a new gasket. Tighten finger tight and
• Accelerator linkage at manifold bellcrank. torque to specifications after assembly to cylinder
7. Connect wires at: head. Transfer all necessary parts.
• Coil
Installation
• Oil Pressure Switch 1. Clean g a s k e t surfaces on cylinder head and
• Temperature Switch
manifolds.
• Delcotron
2. Position new gasket over manifold end studs on head
• Starter Solenoid
and carefully install the manifold in position making
8 . Complete installation as follows:
sure the gaskets are in place.
ON TS 40-50-60 SERIES: 3. Install bolts and clamps while holding manifold in
• Install rear cab support. place with hand.
• Connect cab safety lock at rear cab support. 4. Torque bolts to specifications.
• Install left and right island supports.
• Connect throttle cable at carburetor and retaining NOTE: Center bolt and end bolt torque differ.
brackets. 5. Connect exhaust pipe to manifold using a new
• Install radiator surge tank on island support and packing.
connect hoses to surge tank. 6 . Connect crankcase ventilation hose at rocker arm
• Swing control island rearward and connect to cover.
support. 7. Connect fuel and vacuum lines at carburetor.
• Connect emergency brake cable at emergency 8 . Connect choke cable and adjust as outlined in Sec
brake and retaining brackets.
tion 6 M.
• Connect choke cable at carburetor and adjust. 9. Connect throttle rods at bellcrank and install throt
• Connect shift linkage at control island.
tle return spring.
• Install the radiator, radiator support and shroud
10. Install air cleaner, start engine, check for leaks and
as outlined in Section 13.
adjust carburetor idle speed and mixture.
ON PS 10-20-30-40 SERIES:
• Install the radiator and shroud as outlined in Rocker Arm Cover
Section 13. Removal
• Install the battery. 1. Disconnect crankcase ventilation hose(s) at rocker
• Install the floor panel, drivers seat and engine arm cover.
box as outlined in Section IB . 2. Remove air cleaner.
ON GS 10-20 SERIES: 3. Disconnect temperature wire from rocker arm cover
• Connect neutral safety switch wire at connector clips.
(as required). 4. On TS 40-50-60 series, disconnect oil filler tube
• Install engine splash shields. at bracket.
5. Remove rocker arm cover.
ON CS 40-50-60, MS 50, SS 40-50 SERIES:
• Install the front end sheet metal (with hood and CAUTION: Do^ Not pry rocker arm cover loose.
radiator attached) as outlined in Section 11). Gaskets adhering to cylinder head and rocker
arm cover may be sheared by bumping end of
ON CS 10-20-30, KS 10-20 SERIES: rocker arm cover rearward with palm of hand
• Install the radiator and shroud as outlined in or a rubber mallet.
Section 13.
• Install the hood as outlined in Section 11. Installation
9. Install the air cleaner, connect battery cables, fill 1. Clean gasket surfaces on cylinder head and rocker
cooling system and crankcase then start engine and arm cover with degreaser then, using a new
check for leaks. gasket, install rocker arm cover and torque to
specifications.
Manifold Assembly 2. Connect temperature wire at rocker arm cover
clips.
Removal 3. Install air cleaner.
1. Remove air cleaner. 4. Connect crankcase ventilation hoses.
2. Disconnect both throttle rods at bellcrank and re
move throttle return spring. Valve Mechanism
3. Disconnect fuel and vacuum lines and choke cable at
Removal
carburetor.
1. Remove rocker arm cover as outlined.
4. Disconnect crankcase ventilation hose at rocker arm
2. Remove rocker arm nuts, rocker arm balls, rocker
cover.
arms and push rods.
5. Disconnect exhaust pipe at manifold flange and dis
card packing. NOTE: Place rocker arms, rocker arm balls
6 . Remove manifold attaching bolts and clamps then re and push rods in a rack so they may be re
move manifold assembly and discard gaskets. installed in the same location.
Installation and Adjustment The lifters are extremely simple in design, readjust
NOTE: Whenever new rocker arms and/or ments are not necessary, and servicing of the lifters
rocker arm balls are being installed, coat bear requires only that care and cleanliness be exercised in
ing surfaces of rocker arms and rocker arm the handling of parts.
balls with Molykote or its equivalent. Locating Noisy Lifters
1. Install push rods. Be sure push rods seat in lifter Locate a noisy valve lifter by using a piece of garden
socket. hose approximately four feet in length. Place one end of
2. Install rocker arms, rocker arm balls and rocker the hose near the end of each intake and exhaust valve
arm nuts. Tighten rocker arm nuts until all lash is with the other end of the hose to the ear. In this manner,
eliminated. the sound is localized making it easy to determine which
lifter is at fault.
3. Adjust valves when lifter is on base circle of cam
shaft lobe as follows: Another method is to place a finger on the face of the
valve spring retainer. If the lifter is not functioning
a. Mark distributor housing, with chalk, at each properly, a distinct shock will be felt when the valve
cylinder position (plug wire) then disconnect plug returns to its seat.
wires at spark plugs and coil and remove distrib The general types of valve lifter noise are as follows:
utor cap and plug wire assembly (if not previ 1. Hard Rapping Noise - Usually caused by the plunger
ously done). becoming tight in the bore of the lifter body to such
b. Crank engine until distributor rotor points to an extent that the return spring can no longer push
number one cylinder position and breaker points the plunger back up to working position. Probable
are open. Both valves on number one cylinder causes are:
may now be adjusted. a. Excessive varnish or carbon deposit causing ab
c. Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at the push normal stickiness.
rod then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is b. Galling or “ pickup” between plunger and bore of
removed. This can be determined by checking lifter body, usually caused by an abrasive piece
push rod side play while turning adjusting nut of dirt or metal wedging between plunger and
(fig. 2L). When play has been removed, turn ad lifter body.
justing nut in one full additional turn (to center 2. Moderate Rapping Noise - Probable causes are:
lifter plunger). a. Excessively high leakdown rate.
d. Adjust the remaining valves, one cylinder at a b. Leaky check valve seat.
time, in the same manner. c. Improper adjustment.
4. Install distributor cap and spark plug wire assembly. 3. General Noise Throughout the Valve Train - This
5. Install rocker arm cover as outlined. will, in almost all cases, be a definite indication of
6 . Adjust carburetor idle speed and mixture. insufficient oil supply, or improper adjustment.
4. Intermittent Clicking - Probable causes are:
Valve Lifters a. A microscopic piece of dirt momentarily caught
Hydraulic valve lifters very seldom require attention. between ball seat and check valve ball.
b. In rare cases, the ball itself may be out-of-round
or have a flat spot.
c. Improper adjustment.
In most cases, where noise exists in one or more
lifters all lifter units should be removed, disassembled,
cleaned in a solvent, reassembled, and reinstalled in the
engine. If dirt, varnish, carbon, etc. is shown to exist in
one unit, it more than likely exists in all the units, thus
it would only be a matter of time before all lifters caused
trouble.
Removal
1. Remove valve mechanism as outlined.
2. Mark distributor housing, with chalk, at each cylin
der position (plug wire) then disconnect plug wires
at spark plugs and coil and remove distributor cap
and plug wire assembly.
3. Crank engine until distributor rotor points to number
one position, then disconnect distributor primary
lead at coil and remove distributor.
4. Remove push rod covers (discard gaskets).
5. Remove valve lifters.
NOTE: Place valve lifters in a rack so they
may be reinstalled in the same location.
Installation
1. Install valve lifters.
NOTE: A light coat of oil on the seal will help 7. Remove cylinder head bolts, cylinder head and gas
prevent twisting. ket. Place cylinder head on two blocks of wood to
prevent damage.
7. Install the valve locks and release the compressor
Installation
tool, making sure the locks seat properly in the
upper groove of the valve stem. CAUTION: The gasket surfaces on both the
head and the block must be clean of any foreign
NOTE: Grease may be used to hold the locks
matter and free of nicks or heavy scratches.
in place while releasing the compressor tool.
Cylinder bolt threads in the block and threads on
the cylinder head bolt must be cleaned” (Dirt
will affect bolt torque). Do Not use gasket sealer
on composition steel asbestos gaskets.
1. Place the gasket in position over the dowel pins with
the bead up.
2. Carefully guide cylinder head into place over dowel
pins and gasket.
3. Coat threads of cylinder head bolts with sealing
compound and install finger tight.
4. Tighten cylinder head bolts a little at a time in the
sequence shown on the torque sequence chart until
the specified torque is reached.
5. Install coil (if removed).
6 . Connect upper radiator hose and engine ground strap.
7. Connect temperature sending unit wires and install
Fig . 3L—A ir Adapter Tool fuel and vacuum lines in clip at water outlet.
8 . F ill cooling system. 11. Remove the crossmember to frame bolts and lower
9. Install manifold assembly as outlined. the crossmember to rest on the front springs.
10. Install and adjust valve mechanism as outlined. 12. Remove oil pan and discard gaskets and seals.
NOTE: Do Not install rocker arm cover. CAUTION: If any further operations are to be
11. Start engine and allow to warm up retorque cylinder performed or the oil pan is not being reinstalled
head and readjust valves. immediately, the crossmember should be re-
installed and the engine lowered.
Oil Pan
Installation
ExceptGS10-20Series
Removal
Fig . 5 L—Supporting the Engine ( G .S . 100-200) Fig . 6L—O il Pan G asket and Seal Location
EXCEPT GS 10-20-30 SERIES hammer to tap a brass pin punch on one end of seal
a. ON CS 10-20-30: until it protrudes far enough to be removed with
• Using a suitable jack with a flat piece of wood pliers (fig. 8 L).
(to prevent damaging oil pan), raise engine
NOTE: Always wipe crankshaft surface clean
enough to remove 2" x 4" wood blocks from
before installing a new seal. Also clean seal
between the engine mounts and frame brackets.
groove.
• Lower engine, install front mount bolts and
torque to specifications. 5. Lubricate the lip and O.D. of a new seal with engine
b. Install starter and connect battery cable. oil. Keep oil off the parting line surface. Gradually
GS 10-20 SERIES push with a hammer handle, while turning crank
a. I n s t a l l t h e crossmember and torque to shaft, until seal is rolled into place. (Similar to
specifications. installing a main bearing). Be careful that seal bead
b. Lower the engine to rest on the front mounts then on O.D. is not cut. Compress seal towards crank
remove the jack stand and Tool J - 6978-1. shaft as much as possible.
c. Install the front mount b o l t s and torque to 6 . Install the rear main bearing cap (with new seal) and
Installation
1. Align oil pump drive shafts to match with distributor
tang, then install oil pump to block positioning flange
over distributor lower bushing. Use no gasket.
NOTE: Oil pump should slide easily into place,
if not, remove and reposition slot to align with
distributor tang.
2. Install oil pan as outlined.
Installation
CAUTION: The inertia weight section of the
torsional damper is assembled to the hub with a
rubber type material. The installation proce
dures (with proper tool) must be followed or
movement of the inertia weight section on the
hub will destroy the tuning of the torsional
damper.
W
ithoutCoverRem
oval
1. With crankshaft pulley and hub or damper removed,
pry old seal out of cover from the front with a large
screw driver, being careful not to damage the seal
surface on the crankshaft.
2. Install new seal so that open end of seal is toward
the inside of cover and drive it into position with
Tool J-8340 (fig. 13L).
Camshaft
Measuring Lobe Lift
NOTE: Procedure is sim ilar to that used for
checking valve timing. If improper valve opera
tion is indicated, measure the lift of each push Fig. 13L— Installing O il Seal (C over Installed)
T IM IN G
M ARKS
TH RUST
PLATE
SCREW S
WELDS
^ENGINE TRANS.
SYNCHROMESH AUTOMATIC
2. Bend mount bolt french lock tabs away from bolt sion from the vehicle. Replace both halves as a unit.
head, then remove mount bolts, lower mount and 1. Position the fan blade with the blades pointing at the
spacer. four corners of the radiator and insert a piece of
3. Raise engine enough to clear upper mount assembly heavy corrugated cardboard between the fan and the
and remove upper mount from frame member. radiator. (This will prevent the fan from damaging
the radiator in the event the engine is lowered
NOTE: On models using a propeller shaft brake
too far).
of any type, it is necessary to remove screws
2. Raise the vehicle and remove the rear support nut.
from transmission hole cover to allow the engine
3. Place a jack or jack stand under the transmission
to raise because of the limited clearance be
extension and raise until the pressure is off the
tween the brake and transmission hole cover.
rear support.
4. Place new upper mount in place on frame member, 4. Remove the rear support bolt and lower the jack
then lower engine within 1/4 inch of mount. until the rear support is clear of the frame.
5. Align mount so guide dowel enters hole in mount, 5. Remove both halves of the rear support.
install bolt through french lock, lower mount and 6 . Install a new rear support (both halves).
spacer, then install bolt up through frame, upper 7. Raise the jack until the rear support hole lines up
mount and thread into engine bell housing loosely. and install the rear support bolt.
6 . Lower engine completely and tighten mount bolt, 8 . Remove the jack and install the rear support bolt
then bend tabs of french lock to lock the bolt in place. nut and torque to specifications.
GS 10-20Series
The two piece rear support in transmission case ex
9. Lower the vehicle and remove the cardboard from
between the fan and radiator.
tension may be removed without removing the transm is
ENGINE MECHANICAL
V-8
IN D EX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip tio n ......................................................... 6-24 Oil P u m p ........................................................................ ...6-31
Component Replacement and Adjustment ( V 8 ) ............... 6-24 Rem oval........................................................................ ...6-31
Engine A s s e m b lie s ......................................................... 6-24 In sta lla tio n .................................................................. ...6-31
R em oval............... ......................................................... 6-24 Oil Seal (Rear M a in )...................................................... ...6-31
In stallatio n ....................................... .......................... 6-26 Replacement.................................................................. ...6-31
Intake M an ifold............................................................... 6-27 Torsional D a m p e r ......................................................... ...6-32
Removal .........................................................................6-27 Rem oval........................................................................ ...6-32
In sta llatio n ...................................................................6-27 In s ta lla tio n .................................................................. ...6-32
Exhaust M an ifold ............................................................ 6-27 Crankcase Front Cover ................................................ ...6-33
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-27 Removal ............................................................................6-33
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-27 In sta lla tio n .................................................................. ...6-33
Rocker Arm C o v e r......................................................... 6-28 Oil Seal (Front C o v e r )................................................... ...6-33
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-28 Replacement.................................................................. ...6-33
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-28 Timing Chain and/or Sprockets.................................... ...6-34
Valve Mechanism............................................................ 6-28 Replacement.................................................................. ...6-34
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-28 C a m s h a ft ........................................................................ ...6-35
Installation and A d ju stm en t....................................... 6-28 Measuring Lobe L i f t ................................................... ...6-35
Valve L i f t e r s .................................................................. 6-29 R em oval........................................................................ ...6-36
Locating Noisy L ift e r s ................................................ 6-29 In s ta lla tio n .................................................................. ...6-36
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-29 Timing G e a r s .................................................................. 6-37
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-29 Replacement.................................................................. 6-37
Valve Stem Oil Seal and/or Valve S p r i n g .................. 6-29 Flywheel ........................................................................ 6-37
R e p la c e m e n t............................................................... 6-29 R em oval........................................................................ 6-37
Cylinder Head A ssem b lies............................................. 6-30 In s ta lla tio n .................................................................. 6-37
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-30 Engine M o u n t s ............................................................... 6-37
In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6-30 Replacement (F r o n t )................................................... 6-37
Oil P a n ........................................................................... 6-30 Replacement (Rear) ................................................... 6-38
Rem oval........................................................................ 6-30
In stallatio n ........................ ..........................................6-30
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The V8 engines covered in this section are the 283, Because of the inter changeability and similarity of
327 and 366 cu. in. engines used in 10-60 Series Truck many engines, engine sub-assemblies and parts regard
vehicles. less of which passenger vehicle they are used in, typical
This section covers the removal and installation of illustrations and procedures are used (except where
engine assemblies; the removal, installation and adjust specific illustrations or procedures are necessary to
ment of some sub-assemblies and replacement of some clarify the operation). Although illustrations showing
components. For service to all components and sub- bench operations are used, most single operations, when
assemblies (after removal) and removal of some sub- not part of a general overhaul, should be performed (if
assemblies, refer to Section 6 of the Truck Chassis practical) with the engine in the vehicle.
Overhaul Manual.
1
CHEVROLET TRUCK SERVICE MANUAL
ENGINE 6-27
REAR SEAL
FRONT SEAL
Fig. 2 V — Intake M anifo ld G asket and Seal Location Fig. 3V—V a lv e Adjustment
Installation
CAUTION: The gaskets surfaces on both the
head and the block must be clean of any foreign
matter and free of nicks or heavy scratches.
Cylinder bolt threads in the block and threads on
the cylinder head bolts must be clean. (Dirt
will affect bolt torque.)
1. On engines using a STEEL gasket, coat both sides of
a new gasket with a good sealer. Spread the sealer
thin and even. One method of applying the sealer
that will assure the proper coat is with the use of a
paint roller. Too much sealer may hold the gasket
away from the head or block.
CAUTION: Use no sealer on engines using a
composition STEEL ASBESTOS gasket.
Place the gasket in position over the dowel pins with
the bead up.
3. Carefully guide the cylinder head into place over the
dowel pins and gasket. *
4. Coat threads of cylinder head bolts with sealing
compound and install bolts finger tight.
5. Tighten each cylinder head bolt a little at a time in
the sequence shown in the torque sequence chart until
the specified torque is reached.
Install exhaust manifolds as outlined.
Install intake manifold as outlined.
Install and adjust valve mechanism as outlined.
Fig. 5V —Compressing V a lv e Spring
Oil Pan
NOTE: A light coat of oil on the seal will help
Removal
prevent twisting.
1. Drain engine oil.
b. Install the valve locks and release the com 2. Remove oil dip stick and tube.
pressor tool making sure the locks seat properly 3. On vehicles so equipped remove exhaust crossover
in the upper groove of the valve stem. pipe.
NOTE: Grease may be used to hold the locks in 4. On vehicles equipped with automatic transmisssion
place while releasing the compressor tool. remove converter housing under pan.
366 cu. in. Engines 5. Remove oil pan and discard gaskets and seals.
a. Install new valve stem oil seal (coated with oil) NOTE: The oil pan on the 366 cu. in. engine
in position over valve guide. has three 1/4" x 20 attaching bolts at crankcase
b. Set the rotator (exhaust valve), valve spring and front cover. One located at each corner and
damper and valve cap in place. one at lower center.
c. Compress the spring with Tool J-5892 and install
the valve locks then release the compressor tool,
Installation
making sure the locks seat properly in the groove
1. Thoroughly clean all gasket and seal surfaces on oil
of the valve stem.
pan, cylinder block, crankcase front cover and rear
NOTE: Grease may be used to hold the locks main bearing cap.
in place while releasing the compressor tool. 2. Install new oil pan side gaskets on cylinder block
using gasket sealer as a retainer. Install new oil
Install spark plug, using a new gasket, and torque
pan rear seal in rear main bearing cap groove, with
to specifications.
ends butting side gaskets. Install new oil pan front
Install and adjust valve mechanism as outlined.
seal in groove in crankcase front cover with ends
butting side gaskets (fig. 6 V).
Cylinder Head Assemblies 3. Install oil pan and torque bolts to specifications.
Removal NOTE: On 366 cu. in. engines, start bolts
1. Remove intake manifold as outlined. into crankcase front cover before tightening any
2. Remove exhaust manifolds as outlined.
other bolts.
3. Remove valve mechanism as outlined.
4. Drain cylinder block of coolant. 4. Install converter housing under pan (if removed).
5. Remove cylinder head bolts, cylinder head and gas 5. Install exhaust crossover pipe (if removed).
ket. Place cylinder head on two blocks of wood to 6. Install oil dipstick tube and dipstick.
prevent damage. 7. F ill with oil, start engine and check for leaks.
1. With the oil pan and oil pump removed, remove the
FR O N T rear main bearing cap.
SEAL 2. Remove oil seal from the groove by prying from
the bottom with a small screw driver (fig. 7V).
3. Lubricate the lip of a new seal with engine oil. Keep
oil off the parting line surface as this is treated with
glue. Insert seal in cap and roll it into place with
finger and thumb, using light pressure so seal tangs
at parting line do not cut bead on back of seal.
4. To remove the upper half of the seal, use a small
Fig. 6 V — O il Pan G asket and Seal Location hammer to tap a brass pin punch on one end of seal
until it protrudes far enough to be removed with
pliers (fig. 8 V).
Oil Pump NOTE: Always wipe crankshaft surface clean
Removal
before installing a new seal.
1. Remove oil pan as outlined. 5. Lubricate the lip of a new seal with engine oil. Keep
2. Remove pump to rear main bearing cap bolt and re
move pump and extension shaft.
Installation
1. Assemble pump and extension shaft to rear main
bearing cap, aligning slot on top end of extension
shaft with drive tang on lower end of distributor
drive shaft.
2. Install pump to rear bearing cap bolt and torque to
specifications.
NOTE: Installed position of oil pump screen is
with bottom edge parallel to oil pan rails.
3. Install oil pan as outlined.
Fig . 16V—Installing O il Seal (C over Installed) 366 Fig . 18V—Removing Crankshaft Sprocket
Installation
NOTE: Whenever a new camshaft is installed
coat camshaft lobes with Molykote or its
equivalent.
283and327cu.in.Engines
1. Lubricate camshaft journals with engine oil and in
stall camshaft.
2. Install timing chain on camshaft sprocket. Hold the
sprocket vertical with the chain hanging down, and
orient to align marks on camshaft and crankshaft
sprockets. Refer to Figure 41.
3. Align dowel in camshaft with dowel in hole in cam
shaft sprocket then install sprocket on camshaft.
Refer to Figure 20V.
4. Draw the camshaft sprocket onto camshaft using the
mounting bolts. Torque to specifications.
5. Lubricate timing chain with engine oil.
6 . Install fuel pump push rod as outlined in Section 6 M.
7. Install grille as outlined in Section 13.
8 . Install crankcase front cover as outlined. F ig . 24V —C heckin g Camshaft G e ar Runout
Flywheel
Removal
With transmission and/or clutch housing and clutch
removed from engine, remove the flywheel.
Installation
1. Clean the mating surfaces of flywheel and crankshaft
to make certain there are no burrs.
Fig. 25V —Checking Timing G e a r Backlash 2. Install flywheel on crankshaft and position to align
dowel hole of crankshaft flange and flywheel (fig.
5. Check the backlash between the timing gear teeth 28V).
with a dial indicator (fig. 25V). The backlash should NOTE: On Automatic Transmission equipped
not be less than .004" nor more than .006". engines, the flywheel must be installed with the
6 . Lubricate timing gears with engine oil. flange collar to transmission side (fig. 28V).
7. Install fuel pump push rod as outlined in Section 6 M.
8 . Install grille as outlined in Section 13.
Coat thread end of bolts with sealer then install
9. Install crankcase front cover as outlined. bolts and torque to specifications.
10. Install valve lifters as outlined. Engine Mounts
Engine mounts (fig. 29V) are the non-adjustable type
Timing Gears and seldom require service. Broken or deteriorated
mounts should be replaced immediately, because of the
Replacement
added strain placed on other mounts and drive line
366 cu. in. Engines components.
With camshaft removed crankshaft gear may be re
Front Mount Replacement
moved using Tool J-8105 (fig. 26V). To install crankshaft
With 283 or 3 2 7 cu. in. Engine
gear use Tool J-21058 (fig. 27V). For camshaft gear re
1. Remove distributor cap.
placement refer to Section 6 , "Camshaft Disassembly”
2. Remove mount retaining bolt from below frame
of the Overhaul Manual.
mounting bracket.
3. Raise front of engine and remove mount-to-engine
bolts and remove mount.
Fig . 26V —Removing Crankshaft G ear Fig . 28V —Flyw heel Installation (T y p ic a l)
L6 L4
FRONT
FRONT
F ig . I T —Torque Sequence
ENGINE 6-40
SPECIAL TOOLS
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
A pressure cooling system is provided for on all For radiator, refer to Section 13 of this manual. For
models by a pressure type radiator cap (fig. 1). The radiator shroud, refer to Section 11 of this manual.
pressure type radiator cap used is designed to hold a
pressure above atmospheric pressure in the cooling
system. Excessive pressure is relieved by a valve within
the cap that opens to radiator overflow.
The water pump is a ball bearing, centrifugal vane
impeller type. It requires no care other than to make
certain the air vent at the top of the housing and the drain
holes in the bottom do not become plugged with dirt or
grease. Removal and installation of the water pump is
covered in this section. For overhaul procedures of the
water pump refer to Section 6 K of the Passenger Chassis
Overhaul Manual. Fig. 1—Pressure Radiator Cap
are indicative of exhaust gases leaking into the cool 3. Attach a new piece of hose to the radiator outlet
ing system. connection and insert the flushing gun in this hose.
4. Connect the water hose of the flushing gun to a water
Periodic Maintenance outlet and the air hose to an air line.
5. Turn on the water and when the radiator is full, turn
Periodic service must be performed to the engine cool on the air in short blasts, allowing the radiator to
ing system to keep it in efficient operating condition. fill between blasts of air.
These services should include a complete cleaning and
reverse flushing as well as a reconditioning service. CAUTION: Apply air gradually as a clogged
In the course of engine operation, rust and scale ac radiator will stand only a limited pressure.
cumulate in the radiator and engine water jacket. The 6. Continue this flushing until the water from the lead-
accumulation of these deposits can be kept to a minimum away hose runs clear.
by the use of a good rust inhibitor but it should be
remembered that an inhibitor will not remove rust al Cylinder Block and Cylinder Head
ready present in the cooling system. 1. With the thermostat removed, attach a lead-away
Two common causes of corrosion are: (1) air suction-- hose to the water pump inlet and a length of new hose
Air may be drawn into the system due to low liquid level to the water outlet connection at the top of the engine.
in the radiator, leaky water pump or loose hose con NOTE: Disconnect the heater hose when re
nections; (2 ) exhaust gas leakage—Exhaust gas may be
verse flushing engine.
blown into the cooling system past the cylinder head
gasket or through cracks in the cylinder head and block. 2. Insert the flushing gun in the new hose.
3. Turn on the water and when the engine water jacket
Cleaning is full, turn on the air in short blasts.
A good cleaning solution should be used to loosen the 4. Continue this flushing until the water from the lead-
rust and scale before reverse flushing the cooling away hose runs clear.
system. There are a number of cleaning solutions avail
able and the manufacturer's instructions with the particu Hot Water Heater
lar cleaner being used should always be followed. 1. Remove water outlet hose from heater core pipe.
An excellent preparation to use for this purpose is GM 2. Remove inlet hose from engine connection.
Cooling System Cleaner. The following directions for 3. Insert flushing gun and flush heater core. Care must
cleaning the system applies only when this type cleaner be taken when applying air pressure to prevent
is used. damage to the core.
1. Drain the cooling system including the cylinder block Fan Belt
and then close both drain plugs.
2. Remove thermostat and replace thermostat housing. Adjustment
3. Add the liquid portion (No. 1) of the cooling system 1. Loosen bolts at Delcotron slotted bracket.
cleaner. 2. Pull Delcotron away from engine until desired ten
4. F ill the cooling system with water to a level of about sion reading is obtained with a strand tension gauge.
3 inches below the top of the overflow pipe. Refer to Section 6 , "Engine Tune Up” .
5. Cover the radiator and run the engine at moderate 3. Tighten all Delcotron bolts securely.
speed until engine coolant temperature reaches 180
degrees.
Thermostat
6 . Remove cover from radiator and continue to run the The thermostat consists of a restriction valve actuated
engine for 20 minutes. Avoid boiling. by a thermostatic element. This is mounted in the hous
7. While the engine is still running, add the powder ing at the cylinder head water outlet above the water
portion (No. 2) of the cooling system cleaner and pump. Thermostats are designed to open and close at
continue to run the engine for 1 0 minutes. predetermined temperatures and if not operating properly
8 . At the end of this time, stop the engine, wait a few should be removed and tested as follows.
minutes and then open the drain cocks or remove
pipe plugs. Also remove lower hose connection. Replacement
1. Remove radiator to water outlet hose.
CAUTION: Be careful not to scald your hands. 2. Remove thermostat housing bolts and remove water
NOTE: Dirt and bugs may be cleaned out of outlet and gasket from thermostat housing (fig. 2 ).
the radiator air passages by blowing out with air 3. Inspect thermostat valve to make sure it is in good
pressure from the back of the core. condition.
4. Place thermostat in hot water 2 5 ° above the temper
Reverse Flushing
ature stamped on the thermostat valve.
Reverse flushing should always be accomplished after
5. Submerge the valve completely and agitate the water
the system is thoroughly cleaned as outlined above.
thoroughly. Under this condition the valve should
Flushing is accomplished through the system in a direc
open fully.
tion opposite to the normal flow. This action causes the
6 . Remove the thermostat and place in water 10° below
water to get behind the corrosion deposits and force
temperature indicated on the valve.
them out.
7. With valve completely submerged and water agitated
Radiator thoroughly, the valve should close completely.
1. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses and re 8 . If thermostat checks satisfactorily, re-install, using
place the radiator cap. a new housing gasket.
2. Attach a lead-away hose at the top of the radiator. 9. Refill cooling system.
Water Pump
Removal
1. Drain radiator and break loose the fan pulley bolts.
2. Disconnect heater hose, lower radiator hose and
by pass hose (as required) at water pump.
3. Loosen Delcotron and remove fan belt then remove
fan bolts, fan and pulley.
4. Remove pump to cylinder block bolts and remove
pump from engine.
NOTE: On in line engines, pull the pump
straight out of the block first, to avoid damage
to impeller.
Installation
1. Install pump assembly on cylinder block and tighten
bolts securely. Use on new pump to block gasket(s).
2. Install pump pulley and fan on pump hub and tighten
bolts securely.
NOTE: A guide stud (5/16"-24 x 1 -1 /2 " bolt
with the head removed) installed in one hole of
the fan hub will aid in aligning hub, pulley and
fan. Remove stud after starting the remaining
three bolts.
c- o d i - tu
rig . 2 —Replacing Thermostat-
3. Connect hoses and fill, cooling system,
, ,,
4. Install fan belt and adjust as previously outlined.
5. Start engine and check for leaks.
/
SECTION 6M
ENGINE FUEL
CONTENTS OF THIS SECTION
p age Page
Carburetors 6M-1 Fuel Pumps ..................................................................... 6M-13
Governors . 6M-4 Special Tools .................................................................. 6M-17
A ir Cleaners 6M-8
CARBURETORS
INDEX
Page Page
General Description.......................................... Additional Adjustm ents........................... .................. 6M-3
Service P ro c e d u re s .......................................... R em oval...................................................
Preliminary C h e c k s .................................... Test Before Installation ........................
Idle Speed and Mixture A d ju s tm e n t............ In sta lla tio n .............................................
Choke A d ju stm en t....................................... ............ 6M-2 Fuel Filter M aintenan ce........................ .................. 6M-3
Throttle Linkage Adjustm ent.................. .................. 6M-3
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Various carburetors, designed to meet the particular This section covers removal, installation and adjust
requirements of engines, transmission and vehicles are ment (on engine) of carburetors. Also covered in this
used; therefore, carburetors that look alike are not al section are maintenance procedures for choke cables,
ways interchangeable. (Refer to carburetor part number throttle linkages and fuel filters. For carburetor over
and/or specifications.) Carburetors for engines with the haul procedures and additional adjustments (bench), refer
Air Injection Reactor System are designed, particularly to Section 6 M of the Overhaul Manual under the carbu
for these engines; therefore, they should not be inter retor being serviced.
changed with or replaced by a carburetor designed for an Specifications for carburetors are located in the back
engine without the Air Injection Reactor System. of this manual.
IDLE IDLE
SPEED M IXTURE
M IX T U R E
SERVICE PROCEDURES
Preliminary Checks 7. Shut down the engine, remove gauges and install air
1. Thoroughly warm-up engine. If the engine is cold, cleaner.
allow to run for at least 15 minutes.
2. Inspect torque of carburetor to intake manifold bolts Idle Speed and Mixture Adjustment (With Air Injection
and intake manifold to cylinder head bolts to exclude Reactor System)
the possibility of air leaks. The following is the recommended procedure for Air
3. Inspect manifold heat control valve (if used) for free Injection Reactor System equipped engines.
dom of action and correct spring tension.
NOTE: This adjustment should be performed
Idle Speed and Mixture Adjustment (Except Air Injection with engine at operating temperature and parking
Reactor System) brake applied.
NOTE: This adjustment should be performed 1. Remove air cleaner.
with engine at operating temperature and parking 2. Connect tachometer to engine, then set hand brake
brake applied. and shift transmission into neutral.
3. As a preliminary adjustment, turn idle mixture
1. Remove Air Cleaner.
screws lightly to seat and back out 3 turns.
2 .
Connect tachometer and vacuum gauge to engine, then
set hand brake and shift transmission into neutral. CAUTION: Do not turn idle mixture screw
3. As a preliminary adjustment, turn idle mixture tightly against seat or damage may result.
screws lightly to seat and back out 1 - 1 / 2 turns.
4. With engine running (choke wide open) adjust idle
CAUTION: Do not turn idle mixture screw speed screw to specified idle speed, (automatic
tightly against seat or damage may result. transmission in drive, synchronized transmission in
neutral).
4. With engine running (choke wide open) adjust idle
5. Adjust idle mixture screw (turn in) to "lean roll"
speed screw to specified idle speed, (automatic
position; then turn screw out 1/4 turn (1/4 turn rich
transmission in drive, synchronized transmission in
from "lean roll"). The definition of "lean roll"
neutral). point is a 20 to 30 rpm drop in engine speed, obtained
5. Adjust idle mixture screw to obtain highest steady
by leaning the idle mixture.
vacuum at specified idle speed.
NOTE: On air conditioned vehicles, turn air
NOTE: On air conditioned vehicles, turn air conditioning "O FF" on in-line, 283, and 327 cu.
conditioning to the "on" position and hold the hot
in. engines.
idle compensator valve closed while adjusting
idle speed and idle mixture screws. 6. Repeat steps 3 and 4 as needed for final adjustment.
NOTE: On Rochester B carburetors the idle NOTE: If necessary, final adjustment of the
mixture screw should be turned out 1/4 turn carburetor may be made with air cleaner
from the "lean roll" position. The definition of installed.
"lean roll" point is a 20 to 30 rpm drop in en
7. Turn off engine, remove gauges and install air
gine speed obtained by leaning the idle mixture.
cleaner.
6 . Repeat Steps 4 and 5 as needed for final adjustment.
Choke Adjustment
NOTE: If necessary, final adjustment of the 1. Remove air cleaner.
carburetor may be made with the air cleaner 2. Push hand choke knob in to within 1/8" of instrument
installed. panel.
RochesterB
• Float
Fuel Filter Maintenance
1. Disconnect fuel line connection at inlet fuel filter nut.
• Idle Vent 2. Remove inlet fuel filter nut from carburetor with a
Rochester2G
• Float
1 " box wrench or socket.
3. Remove filter element and spring (fig. 5c).
4. Check element for restriction by blowing on cone
• Accelerator Pump end, element should allow air to pass freely.
• Idle Vent 5. Clean element by washing in solvent and blowing out.
• Choke Rod (Fast Idle) Blow in opposite direction of fuel flow.
Rochester4G
• Float
NOTE: Element should be replaced if plugged
or if flooding occurs. A plugged filter will re
sult in a loss of engine power or rough (pulsat
• Accelerator Pump
ing) engine feel, especially at high engine speeds.
• Idle Vent
• Air Valve 6 . Install element spring, then install element in carbu
• Choke Rod retor so small section of cone faces out.
CarterYF
• Float
7. Install new gasket on inlet fitting nut then install nut
in carburetor and tighten securely.
8 . Install fuel line and tighten connector.
• Idle Vent
• Choke Rod (Fast Idle) Throttle Linkage Adjustment
M
odels: C
EE10-20-3K0E-4100--5200-6K
G 0SC
S0-1200-,20-30r
1 ,
Removal
Flooding, stumble on acceleration and other perform
ance complaints are, in many instances, caused by the
ME 10-20,
SE
50-60, PS 10,
,
50-60
Mode/s: CS-M
S-SS40-50-60,PS20-30 Mode/s: CD 50-60, CT40,M
D50,PT20-30
1. Depress accelerator pedal to floor.
1. Depress accelerator pedal to floor. 2. Hold governor lever in wide open throttle position.
2. Hold carburetor throttle lever in wide open throttle 3. Adjust swivel on accelerator control rod until it
position. freely enters hole in accelerator pedal lever.
3. Adjust swivel on accelerator control rod until it
freely enters hole in accelerator pedal lever. Mode/s: CG-M
G-TG50-60
M
odels:GS10-20,PS40
1. Depress accelerator pedal to floor.
1. Depress accelerator pedal to floor.
2. Hold governor lever in wide open throttle position.
3. Adjust swivel on accelerator control rod until it
2. Hold carburetor throttle lever in wide open throttle freely enters hole in governor control lever.
position.
3. Adjust swivel on accelerator control rod until it
freely enters hole in accelerator control lever.
M
odels:TD50-60,TT40
1. Depress accelerator pedal to floor.
M
odels:TE-TS40-50-60
1. Depress accelerator pedal to floor.
2. Hold governor lever to wide open throttle position.
3. Install accelerator control cable assembly with
sleeve tube nut and ball joint sleeve into ball joint
2. Hold carburetor throttle lever in wide open throttle and tighten sleeve tube nut.
GOVERNORS
INDEX
Page Page
Velocity T y p e .................................................................. 6M-4 General D e s c r ip tio n ................................................... 6M-5
General D escrip tion ................................................... 6M-4 Major Service O p e ra t io n s .......................................... 6M-6
Maintenance and A djustm ents.................................... 6M-5 Control V a l v e ......................................................... 6M-6
Adjustments ......................................................... 6M-5 Governor H ousing................................................... 6M-6
Vacuum Spinner Type - 2G C a rb u re t o r s ........................ 6M-5 Trouble Shooting......................................................... 6M-7
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
A velocity type governor is used as optional equipment
on 230, 250, 292 and 283 truck engines.
The governor is mounted between the carburetor and
the intake manifold and automatically governs the maxi
mum speed at which the truck engine may be operated, STABILIZER (NON-CHEATING) GOVERNOR
PISTON AND ROD THROTTLE VALVE
which in turn limits the maximum speed at which the THROTTLE SHAFT THROTTLE SHAFT
vehicle may be operated. NEEDLE TYPE
The governor (fig. 1G) is operated by the vacuum exist ROLLER BEARING -I—
Not Stable
1. If a more senstive governor is desired, adjust main
screw "B " to the left one turn and while holding this
screw in new position, turn nut "A" to the left 1/4
turn at a time until desired regulation is obtained.
2. When adjustment is completed, tap lightly on end of
hollow wrench so that nut "A" will seat properly.
2G ENGINE GOVERNOR
(VACUUM SPINNER TYPE)
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Model 2G Carburetor Governor (fig. 3G) provided valve will be determined by vacuum on the diaphragm and
with 327 and 366 V- 8 engines is a mechanically driven the tension of the governor or spring acting on the gov
vacuum actuated mechanism set to govern engine speed at ernor lever.
4000 rpm maximum under full load conditions. With this Vacuum is applied to the diaphragm through a system
limit, full advantage of engine horsepower is allowed
without danger of excessive wear due to overspeeding.
This 4000 rpm limit establishes an excellent pattern for
shift control for automatic type transmissions.
The governor is comprised of two basic units; the cen
trifugal control valve housed in the distributor (see En
gine Distributors in Section 6 Y), and a carburetor actua
tor which is mounted on the carburetor throttle body
(fig. 4G). These two components are inter-connected by
tubing.
An engine overspeed warning device is incorporated
into the governor as shown in Figure 4G. A description
of the overspeed warning system will be found in Sec
tion 6 Y of this manual.
Operation
The function of the 2G governor is to limit engine speed
and yet allow a wider throttle opening when power is re
quired. The throttle lever is connected to the throttle
shaft in such a manner that turning the throttle lever does
not actually force the throttle valves open but rather al
lows them to follow the throttle lever because of the
governor spring tension. Thus when the throttle lever is
moved to wide open position, the position of the throttle Fig . 3 G - Distributor and Governor Mounting
of vacuum passages and restrictions in the throttle body plied to the diaphragm which acts to close the throttle
and governor housing. A speed sensitive centrifugal valves in opposition to the governor spring tension.
valve in the distributor acts as a vacuum break so that When power is required as load is increased, engine rpm
there is no vacuum applied to the diaphragm until the will drop causing distributor valve to open and allow the
desired governed speed is reached. When the governed governor spring to open the throttle valves further.
speed is reached the valve is closed and vacuum is ap
DISTRIBUTOR CARBURETOR
BUTTERFLY VALVE
AIR INLET
SPIN N ER VALVE
ACTUATOR
IGN ITIO N
SWITCH - ~ £ -
OIL PRESSURE
SWITCH
I I I I I Is
AMBER
LAMP
BATTERY
Cleaning and Inspection 4. Check the throttle shaft for free rotation in the seal,
The throttle lever and bearing assembly should not be then tighten the housing screws. The throttle valves
immersed in any carburetor cleaner, since it might cause must be held in a closed position while tightening the
damage to the neophrene seal protecting the ball bear screws. Recheck for free rotation and repeat as
ings. If the throttle body itself is immersed in solvent, sembly procedure if necessary.
great care must be taken that the throttle shaft bearings 5. Install the diaphragm in the governor housing with
are blown completely dry with compressed air. They may the end of the diaphragm rod pointing inward. With
then be lubricated with very light machine oil. Since the the diaphragm in this position the hole for the vac
calibration of vacuum versus spring tension is of extreme uum passage in the diaphragm should line up with the
importance in governor operation, it can readily be seen vacuum passage in the housing. Assemble the gov
that there should be no bind whatsoever in throttle shaft ernor lever and pin assembly to the diaphragm rod
rotation. If any binding is found, the throttle body as and position the lever on the throttle shaft. Install
sembly must be replaced. the nut and lockwasher, holding one of the throttle
valves between thumb and forefinger while tightening,
Installation to avoid damage to the throttle valves.
1. Position the gasket carefully on the throttle body and 6 . Position the diaphragm carefully over the screw
assemble the throttle lever and bearing assembly to holes in the housing. Position the cover so that
the throttle body with the four screws provided. To cover restriction pilots through the gasket and into
be certain that the throttle lever and throttle shaft the vacuum passage in the body. Install the eight
are in proper relation hold the throttle valve closed screws finger tight. Open the throttle valves wide to
while attaching the throttle lever assembly. Position provide maximum travel of the diaphragm and tighten
the throttle lever during assembly so that it fits the eight cover screws to 25 to 28 inch pounds of
easily onto the throttle body. If this procedure is torque while holding the diaphragm in this position.
followed the assembly will operate freely and Install lockwire on screws (shown in Figure 3G).
correctly. Install the governor spring over the lever pin and the
2. Place the governor housing to throttle body gasket in stationary post in the housing.
place, noting that the narrower edge goes toward the 7. Check again for free operation of the throttle shafts,
top of the carburetor. Then put the housing in place then install the governor, cover and four attaching
over the gasket. screws, and install lockwire (shown in Figure 3G).
3. Slide the leather seal and retainer over the throttle 8 . Attach the pump rod and fast idle cam to the throttle
shaft, position the screw holes in correct relation lever assembly.
and install the housing to throttle body screws 9. Install vacuum tube to diaphragm cover and distribu
loosely. tor and install lockwire in attaching nuts (fig. 3G).
TROUBLE SHOOTING
(2G VACUUM SPINNER TYPE) the vacuum passages were to become clogged with
dirt, oil, or other foreign materials. Areas most
1. Loss of speed control: likely to "clog" are the orifices in the actuator, and
Check for vacuum leaks and operation of bleed valve the area where air bleeds through the distributor
in distributor. Also for proper seal of diaphragm "spinner" valve.
cover and condition of diaphragm itself. Vacuum in Either type of malfunctioning could be caused by:
the governor housing can be checked by removing the improper spinner setting; spring post out of position in
connection to the distributor and attaching a vacuum the carburetor actuator; bent or stretched spring in
line. If there is no vacuum reading check the dia actuator.
phragm for holes and be sure the vacuum passage is
clear. SUGGESTED PROCEDURE FOR FINDING
2. E rratic operation under load: CAUSES OF IMPROPER GOVERNING
Check for binding in throttle shaft and throttle lever.
1. Localize the trouble on the vehicle. With the vacuum
NOTE: Vacuum and free operation are two tube disconnected at the distributor, run the engine at
keys to correct operation of the Rochester gov about 3,000 rpm and place a finger over the end of
ernor. If all parts are free to move as intended the tube. If there is no noticeable change in engine
and there are no vacuum leaks, the unit will operation, the trouble is probably in the actuator or
operate correctly.
tubing. If the engine speed is noticeably affected by
Governing systems generally malfunction in one of two this, the distributor "spinner” can be suspected.
ways: 2. If distributor trouble is indicated perform the follow
1. They do not govern at all. This could result from: ing operation (refer "Ignition System, Servicing units
a. A vacuum leak in the units or tubing. off the Vehicle" in Section 6 Y for detailed operation).
b. "Spinner" unit stuck due to dirt, oil, or some a. Remove distributor from engine, remove spinner
other material depositing in the mechanism. valve and clean and visually inspect the parts and
c. Orifices in the carburetor clogging so no vacuum passages for possible faults.
could be developed in the governing system. b. Check the seals. Do this by connecting the lower
2. The system "over governs”: governs when it should vacuum connector to a vacuum pump, and "plug
not, causes loss of power, etc. This could result if ging" the valve hole in the shaft either with the
fingers or other suitable means. Slight "seepage" tube leakage and tube should be replaced.
around the seals is not abnormal; however, a vac If the tubing is alright, check the actuator unit for
uum gauge reading within 2 " hg. of the maximum leakage. With the orifices "stopped up" with the
that can be obtained with the vacuum hose fingers, or other means, no leakage should occur.
"squeezed" should be possible if the seals are in Also check for proper seal of diaphragm cover
satisfactory condition. If the seals leak exces and condition of diaphragm itself. Vacuum in the
sively they should be replaced. governor housing can be checked by removing the
c. When the spinner parts are reassembled, they connection to the distributor and attaching a vac
should be wiped with a rag saturated with light oil uum line. If there is no vacuum reading check
to provide slight, but not excessive lubrication. the diaphragm for holes and be sure the vacuum
3. If actuator or tubing trouble is indicated: passage is clear.
a. Remove the vacuum tube at the actuator, run the c. If no leakage is found, clean all of the component
engine at about 3000 rpm and place a finger over parts.
the end of the actuator. If there is no change in If tampering is suspected, visually check parts
engine operation, probably the actuator is at fault. with the governing parts of an engine that is gov
A significant change in engine rpm would indicate erning properly.
AIR CLEANERS
INDEX
Page Page
General Description......................................................... 6M-8 Tool J-7825 .................................................................. 6M-10
Maintenance P r o c e d u r e s ................................................ 6M-9 Cleaning Polyurethane B a n d ....................................... 6M-10
Element R ep lacem en t................................................ 6M-9 Cleaning Oil Bath C l e a n e r .......................................... 6M-11
Testing Paper E l e m e n t ............................................. 6M-9
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Air cleaners on all models operate primarily to re is used in conjunction with an exhaust manifold heat stove
move dust and dirt from air before it is drawn into the (fig. 4A). Air temperature is automatically controlled by
carburetor and engine. The air cleaner also helps to a thermostatic valve which selects warmed air from the
reduce engine noise and quenches any flame that may be heat stove and/or cooler air from the engine compart
caused by engine backfire through the carburetor. ment or from outside the vehicle.
Three types of air cleaners are used on 1967 Chevrolet Diesel engine applications require the use of several
trucks. They are the oil wetted paper element air types of oil bath air cleaners. All types are serviced in
cleaner, the two element air cleaner and the oil bath air a manner sim ilar to the gasoline engine oil bath air
cleaner. cleaners.
The oil wetted paper element air cleaner (fig. 1A) con
sists of an accordian pleated oiled paper filter supported
by wire mesh with a plastisol seal on both top and bottom.
The two element air cleaner (fig. 2A) consists of an oil
wetted polyurethane band wrapped around an oil wetted
paper element.
The oil bath air cleaner (fig. 3A) utilizes an oil sump
in the air cleaner bottom and a fibre element.
On most applications of the two element air cleaner it
OIL RESISTANCE
SEAL
BONDED PAPER
BOTTOM ELEMENT COVER
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
Element Replacement Testing Paper Element
1. Remove air cleaner cover. Tool J-7825, is designed to check paper element air
2. Remove element and on two element air cleaners re cleaners to determine whether the element has materially
move polyurethane band from paper element. decreased in efficiency and should be replaced or has
3. Remove bottom section of air cleaner and remove only slightly increased air restriction and is suitable for
and discard air cleaner gasket. further service. In combination with a tachometer, this
4. Clean bottom section of air cleaner and air cleaner instrument will quickly and accurately determine the air
cover thoroughly. cleaner element condition.
NOTE: Check seal on bottom of air cleaner NOTE: Before testing, inspect for holes or
for tears or cracks. Refer to Figure 1A. breaks in the element, as these defects require
immediate replacement. If no holes or breaks
5. Install bottom section of air cleaner with a new air
exist, proceed as follows:
cleaner gasket.
6 . Install new paper element on bottom section of air 1. Remove all hoses and plug all openings except air
cleaner with either end up. On two element air cleaner inlet.
cleaners, install cleaned polyurethane band over 2. Install air cleaner (without polyurethane band on two
paper element before installing paper element. element air cleaner), using Tool J-7825 in place of
7. Install air cleaner cover. the wing nut. Screw Tool J-7825 onto the stud until
it seals tightly against the air cleaner cover. Rotate
the entire tool so that the scale can be read from the
left side of the truck. Be sure the vent hole is to
ward the dash (fig. 5A).
3. Connect a tachometer and place it so that it may be
read simultaneously with Tool J-7825 (fig. 5A).
4. Zero oil level in the inner tube by pulling inner tube
upward until the rubber seal is above the vent hole,
then raise or lower as required until the inner tube
oil level is exactly to the " 0 " mark.
5. Start engine. If engine is cold, allow to run for 2 to
3 minues. The choke must be fully open.
6 . Accelerate the engine slowly until the inner tube oil
level of Tool J-7825 just reaches the 1/4 mark. Al
low engine speed to stabilize and note tachometer
(rpm) reading. Decelerate engine.
Fig. 3A - O il Bath A ir C leaner 7. If the tachometer reading is at or below the follow
CONVENTIONAL CAB
8 . Remove tachometer and Tool J-7825 from vehicle Fig. 6A - F illin g Tool W ith O il
and push down inner tube until seal is below vent
hole to prevent oil loss.
Cleaning Polyurethane Band
CAUTION: Install polyurethane band on two
1. Remove air cleaner element and remove polyure
element air cleaners.
thane band from paper element.
2. Inspect the polyurethane band for tears and replace if
Tool J-7825 necessary. If not torn, wash polyurethane band in
FilingTool
Tool J-7825 is shipped dry and must be filled with the
kerosene or mineral spirits; then squeeze out excess
solvent (fig. 7A).
NOTE: Never use a hot degreaser or any sol
red gauge oil (specific gravity .826) provided.
vent containing acetone or sim ilar solvent.
Pull the knurled inner tube completely out of the gauge
and add oil to the reservoir until the oil level is between 3. Dip element into light engine oil and squeeze out ex
the two "F IL L " lines (fig. 6 A). Refill whenever the level cess oil.
falls below the lower "F IL L " line.
NOTE: Never shake, swing or wring the ele
ment to remove excess oil or solvent as this
Storing Tool
may tear the polyurethane material. Instead,
When the tool is not in use, fully depress the inner
"squeeze" the excess oil from the element.
tube. This seals off the oil reservoir from the vent hole
to prevent oil loss if the tool is tipped. 4. Check the paper element as previously outlined
(without the polyurethane band).
Install the polyurethane band around the paper ele
ment and install the air cleaner element.
Cleaning Oil Bath Cleaner 4. Screw in a new thermostatic element until it just
1. At every engine oil change period, remove the air bottoms on the push rod (with the valve held closed
cleaner assembly. by the spring). Immerse cover and element in water
2. Remove cover and filter element assembly. of 83°F for two to three minutes, then screw the ele
3. Empty oil out of cleaner and clean out all oil and ac ment in further until the cover air valve just begins
cumulated dirt. to open. Tighten jam nut. Raise water temperature.
4. Wash body with cleaning solvent and wipe dry. Valve should be fully open at 120°F.
5. Wash filter element by sloshing up and down in 5. Replace the cover and wing nut, and the sheet metal
cleaning solvent. to air cleaner cover hose.
6 . Dry filter unit with an air hose or let stand until dry.
7. F ill body of cleaner to full mark with SAE 50 engine
oil. If expected temperatures are to be consistently
below freezing, use SAE 20 engine oil.
8 . Assemble filter and cover assembly to body of
cleaner.
9. Install cleaner, making sure it fits tight and is set
down securely.
Thermostat Replacement
1. Remove sheet metal to air cleaner hose from the air
cleaner cover.
2. Remove the wing nut and cover.
3. Loosen the jam nut and unscrew the thermostatic
element. Fig. 8A - Thermostatic A ir V a lv e P a llet Replacement
AIR CLEANERS
FUEL PUMPS
INDEX
Page Page
General Description..........................................................6M-13 Installation . ............................................................ 6M-14
Service P ro c e d u re s ......................................................... 6M-13 Disassembly ......................................................... 6M-14
Fuel Pump Inspection and T e s t ................................. 6M-13 Cleaning and In sp ectio n .......................................... 6M-15
Vacuum Section Inspection and T e s t ........................... 6M-14 A ssem b ly .................................................................. 6M-15
Removal ............................................................... 6M-14
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The fuel pumps used on both six and eight cylinder en
gines are of the diaphragm type. Two types of diaphragm
fuel pumps are used, a servicable combination fuel and
vacuum pump and a non-servicable fuel pump that be
cause of design, is serviced as an assembly only.
The pumps are actuated by an eccentric located on the
engine camshaft. On in-line engines, the eccentric actu
ates the pump rocker arm. On V- 8 engines, a push rod
(located between the camshaft eccentric and fuel pump)
actuates the rocker arm.
SERVICE PROCEDURES
FUEL PUMP INSPECTION AND TEST sure there is gasoline in the tank.
The line from the tank to the pump is the suction side
The fuel pump should be checked to make sure the of the system and the line from the pump to the carbure
mounting bolts and inlet and outlet connections are tight. tor is the pressure side of the system. A leak on the
Always test pump while it is mounted on the engine and be pressure side, therefore, would be made apparent by
dripping fuel, but a leak on the suction would not be ap 3. A further test of vacuum pump may be made by at
parent except for its effect of reducing volume of fuel on taching a vacuum gauge to the inlet port (port con
the pressure side. nected to wiper motor) with outlet pipe disconnected.
1. Tighten any loose line connections and look for bends
or kinks in lines which would reduce fuel flow. CAUTION: Always make this test of vacuum
2. Tighten diaphragm flange screws. pump with outlet open.
3. Disconnect fuel pipe at carburetor. Disconnect dis
tributor to coil primary wire so that engine can be 4. With engine operating at 750 rpm the gauge should
cranked without firing. Place suitable container at show 10 to 12 inches of vacuum. Less than 10 inches
end of pipe and crank engine a few revolutions. If of vacuum indicates an inoperative vacuum pump.
little or no gasoline flows from open end of pipe then
fuel pipe is clogged or pump is inoperative. Before Removal
removing pump disconnect fuel pipe at gas tank and 1. Disconnect fuel inlet and outlet pipes at fuel pump.
outlet pipe and blow through them with an air hose to On "P " Models, disconnect vacuum lines at pump.
make sure they are clear. Reconnect pipes and re 2. Remove fuel pump mounting bolts and remove pump
test while cranking engine. and gasket.
3. On V- 8 engines: if push rod is to be removed, re
CAUTION: Whenever the engine is cranked re
move fuel pump adapter and gasket then remove push
motely at the starter, with a special jumper
rod (283 and 327 engines).
cable or other means, the primary distributor
4. If a new fuel pump is to be installed, transfer fittings.
lead must be disconnected from the negative post
on the coil and the ignition switch must be in the NOTE: After removal of pump from engine and
”ON” position. Failure to do this will result in a before disassembly is started, plug all openings
damaged grounding circuit in the ignition switch. and thoroughly wash exterior of pump with
cleaning solvent to remove all dirt and grease.
4. If fuel flows from pump in good volume from pipe at
carburetor, check fuel delivery pressure to be cer Installation
tain that pump is operating within specified limits as 1. On V - 8 engines: if removed, install fuel pump push
follows: rod and fuel pump adapter. Use gasket sealer on
a. Attach a fuel pump pressure test gauge to discon gasket or pipe fitting.
nected end of pump to carburetor pipe. 2. Install fuel pump using a new gasket and tighten se
b. Run engine at approximately 450-1,000 rpm (on curely. Use sealer on fuel pump mounting bolt
gasoline in carburetor bowl) and note reading on threads.
pressure gauge.
NOTE: On V- 8 engines, a pair of mechanical
c. If pump is operating properly the pressure will be
fingers may be used to hold fuel pump push rod
within specifications and will remain constant at
up while installing fuel pump (fig. 3P).
speeds between 450-1,000 rpm. If pressure is
too low, too high, or varies materially at different 3. Connect fuel pipes to pump. On "P ” Models connect
speeds, the pump should be replaced. vacuum lines to pump.
4. Start engine and check for leaks.
VACUUM SECTION INSPECTION AND TEST
NOTE: These procedures can be used only on
FUEL AND VACUUM PUMP UNIT
the combination pump.
Disassembly
Test the vacuum section of the pump by fully opening 1. Scratch locating marks on fuel cover and pump body
the windshield wiper valve and observe wiper blade speed so that inlets and outlets will be properly located
while alternately idling and accelerating the engine. when pump is reassembled.
Wiper blade speed should be fairly constant regardless of 2. Remove bolt and lockwasher holding down pulsator
engine speed or throttle opening. cover on fuel side of pump. Remove pulsator cover
and pulsator diaphragm.
NOTE: A dry windshield will slow wiper
3. Remove screws and washers holding fuel cover to
speed. If windshield wiper does not operate
pump body and remove cover.
properly, make the following inspection and test.
4. Place pump rocker arm in soft jawed vise so that
1. Make certain that hoses are properly connected at vacuum side is up and remove all vacuum cover
pump, wiper motor and control at instrument panel screws except any two that are diametrically
and double check valve, and that connections are air opposite.
tight. Replace cracked or deteriorated hose. 5. P ress down firmly on vacuum cover to hold heavy
2. If windshield wiper does not operate properly after vacuum diaphragm spring compressed and remove
all points of leakage have been corrected, detach both remaining two screws. Release vacuum cover slowly
pipes at vacuum pump and join them with a piece of and remove cover assembly, diaphragm spring and
tubing. Slowly operate engine from idle to about spring retainer.
1 0 0 0 rpm; the wiper should run at full speed operat
ing on engine vacuum only. If it does not, it can be NOTE: If desired, two 10-32NF 1-1/2" screws
assumed that the wiper motor or tubing is defective. may be screwed diametrically opposite into cover
The pump vacuum section is inoperative if the wind to aid in relieving diaphragm spring pressure
shield wiper operated properly on engine vacuum, but when removing cover.
not on pump vacuum. 6 . Lift vacuum diaphragm and remove vacuum valve
Assembly
1. Install seals by placing seal and retainer in pull rod
recess of pump body with rubber end down toward
Fig. 3P - Installing 283, 327, V8 Engine Fuel Pump links and press down firmly with flat end of 7/8"
diameter round bar.
from body under diaphragm at rocker arm side. 2. Stake die cast lip in four places to retain seals.
7. Unhook vacuum diaphragm pull rod from vacuum 3. Assemble link spacer over fuel link.
link. This can best be done by extending vacuum 4. Place one vacuum link on each side of fuel link. The
diaphragm and tilting towards rocker arm while roll hook ends of vacuum link should come together so
ing pull rod off link (fig. 4P). that they surround fuel link. All link hooks should
8 . Remove pump from vise, invert pump so fuel side is point in same direction.
up, and reinstall rocker arm in vise. Have pump 5. Place assembly of links and spacer between lobes of
body flush with jaw of vise. rocker arm with one spacer washer on outer side of
9. Use a 3 /8 ” or slightly larger drill or a file to re each vacuum link.
move portion of rocker arm pin which is upset over 6 . Slide rocker arm bushing through hole in rocker
pin washer. arm, spacer washers, links and link spacer. Place
10. Drive out rocker arm pin using a long tapered drift. thick washer over both ends of bushing. (See Figure
11. Remove rocker arm, rocker arm spring, spacer 5P for correct placement of all parts in rocker arm
washers, fuel and vacuum links, link spacer and and link assembly.)
rocker arm bushing from pump. 7. Set fuel pump on bench with mounting flange up.
12. Remove fuel diaphragm. 8 . Install rocker arm spring into body placing one end
13. Remove metal around diaphragm pull rod seals, over cone-like projection in pump body.
which was displaced by staking, with chisel, small 9. Holding washers onto rocker arm bushing, slide the
round file or small grinding wheel. Pull seals out of rocker arm and link assembly into pump body (fig.
body with hook shaped tool, using care not to damage 6 P). Projection on link spacer should fit into end of
seal seats. rocker arm spring and open end of link hooks must
14. Remove all valves in fuel and vacuum covers in the point toward vacuum flange.
same manner. 10. Drive new rocker arm pin through bushing and install
ROCKER
ARM A N D
LINK
A SSEM BLY
other hand insert the vacuum diaphragm pull rod piece of metal between rocker arm stop and body.
through oil seal. Have flat of pull rod parallel to This tool can be made from a piece of steel 3/16" x
vacuum links. 3/32" x 6 ". Bend one end to form a right angle 3 /8 ”
from bend to end.
CAUTION: Be extremely careful when insert 26. Place spring retainer on riveted end of diaphragm
ing diaphragm push rod through seal to avoid pull rod and place the diaphragm spring on the re
damaging seal. tainer. Place vacuum cover over spring and align
holes.
23. Let up slightly on pump and turn diaphragm 90° so 27. P ress vacuum cover firmly down against diaphragm
that pull rod rolls onto link (fig. 8 P). and body flange and install two screws diametrically
24. Lift diaphragm cloth and position valve and cage in opposite. (Two 10-32NF x 1-1/2" screws may be
recess close to mounting flange. No gasket is re installed to pull vacuum cover down.) Install re
quired because the diaphragm seals the valve cage. maining vacuum cover screws and tighten until
25. Before installing vacuum cover, rocker arm must be screws just engage lockwashers.
positioned so that vacuum diaphragm will be held 28. Release rocker arm to allow heavy vacuum spring to
level with the body flange while the vacuum cover is push diaphragm to flexing stop in body. Tighten all
installed. This can be done by inserting a 3/32 inch cover screws securely.
SPECIAL TOOLS
J —7825
5% ^
J —11 37
J —5197
J —4552
3
J-6058A
J —6556
J —54961
Lnj
BENDING TOOLS
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Air Injection Reactor (A.I.R.) System (fig. 1), used it through the air manifolds, hoses and injection tubes
on all engines in 10 Series and Suburban Carry-All 20 into the exhaust system in the area of the exhaust valves.
Series Trucks in California consists of: the air injection The fresh air ignites and burns the unburned portion of
pump (with necessary brackets and drive attachments), the exhaust gases in the exhaust system, thus minimizing
air injection tubes (one for each cylinder), a mixture exhaust contamination.
control valve, check valves (one for In Line engines, two The mixture control valve (fig. 3) when triggered by a
for V8 engines) and air manifold assemblies, tubes and sharp increase in manifold vacuum, supplies the intake
hoses necessary to connect the various components. manifold with fresh filtered air to lean out the fuel-air
Carburetors and distributors for engines with the mixture and prevent exhaust system backfire.
A.I.R. System are designed, particularly, for these en The check valve(s) prevent exhaust gases from entering
gines; therefore, they should not be interchanged with or and damaging the air injection pump, as back flow can
replaced by a carburetor or distributor designed for an occur even under normal operating conditions.
engine without the A.I.R. System. When properly installed and maintained, the A.I.R.
The air injection pump (fig. 2) picks up fresh filtered System will keep exhaust emissions well below the re
air from the air cleaner, compresses the air and injects quirements. However, if any A.I.R. component or any
CHECK
DIAPHRAGM VALVE
POSITIONS
P R ESSU R E IN TAK E
RELIEF V A LV E TUBE
Fig. 3—M ixtu re Control V a lv e
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
Drive Belt Pump Pulley
Inspection Replacement
• Inspect drive belt for wear, cracks or deterioration • Hold pump pulley from turning by compressing drive
and replace if required. belt then loosen pump pulley bolts.
• Inspect belt tension and adjust if below 50 lbs. using • Remove drive belt as outlined above then remove
a strand tension gauge. pump pulley.
• Install pump pulley with retaining bolts hand tight.
Adjustment
• Install and adjust drive belt as outlined above.
• Loosen pump mounting bolt and pump adjustment
• Hold pump pulley from turning by compressing drive
bracket bolt.
belt then torque pump pulley bolts to 25 ft. lbs.
• Move pump until belt is tight (55 ± 5 lb. used belt or
• Recheck drive belt tension and adjust if required.
75 ± 5 lb. new belt using a strand tension gauge) then
tighten adjustment bracket bolt and mounting bolt.
Air Manifold, Hose and Tube
CAUTION: Do not pry on the pump housing. Inspection (Fig. 4)
Distortion of the housing will result in extensive • Inspect all hoses for deterioration or holes.
damage to the Air Injection Pump. • Inspect all tubes for cracks or holes.
Replacement • Check all hose and tube connections.
• Loosen pump mounting bolt and pump adjustment • Check all tube and hose routing. Interference may
bracket bolt then swing pump until drive belt may be cause wear.
removed. • If leak is suspected on the pressure side of the sys
• Install a new drive belt and adjust as outlined above. tem or any tubes and/or hoses have been discon
nected on the pressure side, the connections should
Drive Pulley be checked for leaks with a soapy water solution.
With the pump running, bubbles will form if a leak
Replacement
exists.
• Remove drive belt as outlined above then replace
drive pulley. Replacement
• Install and adjust drive belt as outlined above. • To replace any hose and/or tube, note routing then
Replacement
• Disconnect pump outlet hose at check valve. Remove
check valve from air manifold, being careful not to
bend or twist air manifold.
SILVER-250
RED-292
GREEN-283
SPECIAL TOOLS
J-7055-5
J-6585
1-21844
J-21058
.
SECTION 6Y
ENGINE ELECTRICAL
Page Page
B a t t e r y ...............................................................................6Y-1 Starting System 6Y-34
Charging S y s te m ................................................................6Y-7 Special Tools . 6Y-37
Ignition S y ste m ...................................................................6Y-18
BATTERY
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip tio n ......................................................... 6Y-1 Safety Precautions . . ................................................... 6Y-4
Types of B a tte rie s ......................................................... 6Y-1 Charging Procedures......................................................... 6Y-4
Dry Charged Batteries ............................................. 6Y-1 Slow Charging ............................................................... 6Y-4
Activating Dry Charged B atteries.............................. 6Y-2 Fast C h a r g i n g ............................................................... 6Y-4
Wet Charged Batteries ............................................. 6Y-3 Emergency Boost C h a r g in g .......................................... 6Y-5
Periodic S e r v ic e ............................................................... 6Y-3 Test P r o c e d u re s ............................................................... 6Y-5
Common Causes of Failure ...........................................6Y-3 Visual Inspection ......................................................... 6Y-5
Electrolyte Level ......................................................... 6Y-4 In s tru m e n t......................................................................6Y-5
Water U s a g e .................................................................. 6Y-4 Full Charge Hydrometer Test .................................... 6Y-5
Cleaning........................................................................... 6Y-4 Specific Gravity R e a d in g s ............................................. 6Y-5
Cables ........................................................................... 6Y-4 Cell Comparison T e s t ................................................ 6Y-6
C arrier and H olddow n................................................... 6Y-4 Installing Battery ............................................................ 6Y-6
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Battery (fig. lb) is made up of a number of sepa The hard, smooth one-piece cover greatly reduces the
rate elements, each located in an individual cell in a tendency for corrosion to form on the top of the Battery.
hard rubber case. Each element consists of an assembly The cover is bonded to the case with sealing compound
of positive plates and negative plates containing dis that forms an air tight seal between the cover and case.
sim ilar active materials and kept apart by separators. Protection for the Battery charging circuit (10 gage
The elements are immersed in an electrolyte composed wire) is provided by a pigtail lead which is a fusible
of dilute sulfuric acid. Plate straps located on the top link off the battery positive cable (14 gage wire). This
of each element connect all the positive plates and all lead is an integral part of the Battery cable assembly
the negative plates into groups. The elements are con and servicing requires replacing the complete cable
nected in series electrically by .connectors that pass assembly.
directly through the case partitions between cells. The
battery top is a one-piece cover of hard rubber con
struction. The cell connectors, by-passing through the
cell partitions, connect the elements along the shortest DRY CHARGED BATTERIES
practical path (fig. 2b). With the length of the electrical
circuit inside the Battery reduced to a minimum, the There are two types of Batteries—the “ dry charge”
internal voltage drop is decreased resulting in improved type and the “ wet charge” type. The difference in types
performance, particularly during engine cranking at low depends on the method of manufacture. A “ dry charge”
temperatures. Battery contains fully charged elements which have been
ONE PIECE
CELL COVER ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
VENT PLUG
HOLD-DOWN SLOT
F ig. l b —Battery
PERIODIC SERVICING
5. Battery abuse, including failure to keep the Battery
COMMON CAUSES OF FAILURE
top clean, cable clamps and posts clean and tight,
Since the Battery is a perishable item which requires and improper addition of water to the cells.
periodic servicing, a good maintenance program will
insure the longest possible Battery life. If the Battery LEVEL INDICATOR
tests good but fails to perform satisfactorily in service
The Battery features an electrolyte level indicator,
for no apparent reason, the following are some of the
which is a specially designed vent plug with a trans
more important factors that may point to the cause of
parent rod extending through the center (fig. 5b). When
the trouble. the electrolyte is at the proper level, the lower tip of the
1. Vehicle accessories inadvertently left on overnight
rod is immersed, and the exposed top of the rod will ap
to cause a discharged condition. pear very dark; when the level falls below the tip of
2. Slow speed driving of short duration, to cause an
the rod, the top will glow.
undercharged condition.
3. A vehicle electrical load exceeding the generator The Indicator reveals at a glance if water is needed,
capacity. without the necessity of removing the vent plugs (fig. 6 b).
4. Defect in the charging system such as high re s is The Level Indicator is used in only one cell (second
tance, slipping fan belt, faulty generator or voltage cell cap from positive Battery post) because when the
regulator. electrolyte level is low in one cell, it is normally low
INDICATOR
I ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
LOW
Fig . 5b—C u t- A w a y V ie w Showing Electro lyte at Proper Fig . 6b—C u t-A w ay V ie w Showing Electro lyte a t Low
Le ve l, with Indicator Having Dark Appearance Lever, with Indicator Having Light Appearance
in all cells. Thus when the Indicator shows water is so that it will support the Battery securely and keep it
needed, check the level in all six cells. level.
An alternate method of checking the electrolyte level To prevent the Battery from shaking in its ca rrier,
is to remove the vent plug and visually observe the the hold-down bolts should be tight (50-80 in. lbs.).
electrolyte level in the vent well. The bottom of the However, the bolts should not be tightened to the point
vent well features a split vent which will cause the where the Battery case or cover will be placed under a
surface of the electrolyte to appear distorted when it severe strain.
makes contact. The electrolyte level is correct when
the distortion first appears at the bottom of the split BATTERY SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
vent (fig. 4b).
When Batteries are being charged, an explosive gas
ELECTROLYTE LEVEL mixture forms in each cell. Part of this gas escapes
through the holes in the vent plugs and may form an
The electrolyte level in the Battery should be checked explosive atmosphere around the Battery itself if venti
regularly. In hot weather, particularly during trip driv lation is poor. This explosive gas may remain in or
ing, checking should be more frequent because of more around the Battery for several hours after it has been
rapid loss of water. If the electrolyte level is found to charged. Sparks or flames can ignite this gas causing
be low, then colorless, odorless, drinking water should an internal explosion which may shatter the Battery.
be added to each cell until the liquid level rises to the The following precautions should be observed to pre
split vent located in the bottom of the vent well. DO NOT vent an explosion:
OVERFILL because this will cause loss of electrolyte 1. Do not smoke near Batteries being charged or
resulting in poor performance, short life, and excessive which have been very recently charged.
corrosion. 2. Do not break live circuits at the terminals of Bat
CAUTION: During service only water should teries because a spark usually occurs at the point
be added to the Battery, not electrolyte. where a live circuit is broken. Care must always
V be taken when connecting or disconnecting booster
The liquid level in the cells should never be allowed to leads or cable clamps on fast chargers. Poor con
drop below the top of the plates, as the portion of the nections are a common cause of electrical arcs
plates exposed to air may be permanently damaged with which cause explosions.
a resulting loss in performance.
BATTERY CHARGING
WATER USAGE
There are three methods of recharging Batteries.
Excessive usage of water indicates the Battery is They differ basically in the length of time the Battery
being overcharged. The most common causes of over is charged and the rate at which charging current is
charge are high Battery operating temperatures, too supplied. One is the Slow Charge method, the second is
high a voltage regulator setting or poor regulator ground the Fast Charge method, and the third is the Emergency
wire connection. Normal Battery water usage is ap Boost Charge method.
proximately one to two ounces per month per battery. Before recharging a Battery by any method, the elec
CLEANING trolyte level must be checked and adjusted if necessary.
DO N O T SUCK H O LD
IN T O O M U C H TUBE
ELECTROLYTE V ERTICAL
FLOAT M U ST
BE FREE
TAKE R E A D IN G
AT EYE LEVEL
CHARGING SYSTEM
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip tio n ......................................................... 6Y-7 Field Relay Check and A djustm ent........................... 6Y-13
Maintenance and A djustm ents.......................................... 6Y-9 Other Harness C h e c k s ................................................ ....
Static C h e c k s .................................................................. 6Y-10 6.6” System
System Condition Test Field Relay T e s t ......................................................... 6Y-15
Voltage Regulator Adjustm ent....................................... 6Y-10 Generator Field Circuit T e s t .................................... 6Y-15
System Component C hecks............................................. 6Y-11 Generator Field T est................................................... 6Y-15
5.5-6.2” Systems Circuit Resistance T e s t ............................................ 6Y-15
Generator Output......................................................... 6Y-11 Voltage Setting Adjustment.......................................... 6Y-15
Generator Diode and Field T e s t .................................6Y-11 Service O perations............................................................ 6Y-16
Indicator Lamp - Initial Field Excitation G en erato r........................................................................ 6Y-16
Circuit T e s t s ............................................................ 6Y-12 Pulley Replacement...................................................... 6Y-16
Field Circuit Resistance W ire T e s t s ........................6Y-13 Removal and Installation............................................. 6Y-17
Voltage Setting (See System Condition Brush Replacement (6.2” Unit).................................... 6Y-17
Test) ........................................................................ Special T o o ls ..................................................................... 6Y-37
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The charging system includes the battery, generator, Two brushes are required to carry current through the
regulator, telltale light, and necessary wiring to con two slip rings to the field coils wound concentric with the
nect these components. The Delcotron is offered as shaft of the rotor. Six rectifier diodes are mounted in the
standard equipment, although there are various capacities slip ring end frame and are jointed to the stator windings
available on all models. at three internally located terminals.
The Delcotron continuous output A.C. generator (figs. Diodes are mounted in heat sinks to provide adequate
lc and 14c) consists of two major parts, a stator and a heat dissipation. The six diodes replace the separately
rotor. The stator is composed of a large number of wind mounted rectifier as used in other types of application.
ings assembled on the inside of a laminated core that is The diodes change the Delcotron A. C. current to D. C.
attached to the generator frame. The rotor revolves current.
within the stator on bearings located in each end frame. Three regulators are available on truck models. A
RELAY “ BAH”
TERM IN A L “ F” T ERM IN A L TERMINAL
“ BAT"
T ER M IN A GRD 7 T ERM IN A L
N tL L> LIGHT
RELAY RELAY
5.5" SERIES ID DELCOTRON 6.2" SERIES 2D, TYPE 150 DELCOTRON
F ig . l c —Delcotrons
p...... | KCdtO I UR
* * ikimrtTAD
FIELD RELAY
“ LA TC H ”
“ F” TERM IN A L
N O . 2 TERM IN A L
N O . 3 T ERM IN A L V O LT A G E
DEICOTRON ' R. 6 3 AMP
N O . 4 T E R M IN A L R EG U LA TO R MODELS ONLY
DOUBLE CONTACT
double contact two unit type, a transistor unit with an in internally in the field circuit (fig. 2c). The added diode
ternal field relay and a completely static full transistor adapts the regulator to handle the higher field current and
regulator (130 amp generator only). The function of these enables it to absorb the increased inductive voltages of
regulators in the charging system is to limit the genera the field coil with satisfactory contact point life. A wir
tor voltage to a pre-set value by controlling the generator ing diagram of the regulator internal circuit is illuatrated
field current. in Figure 2c.
The two unit double contact unit and the junior tran The light duty transistor regulator (fig. 3c) is an
sistor regulator (when applicable) use the field relay to assembly composed principally of transistors, diodes,
turn out the indicator lamp. The relay unit allows the resistors, a capacitor, and a thermistor to form a com
lamp to light (as a bulb check) with the ignition key on pletely static voltage regulating unit in combination with
and engine not running. When the engine is started and a conventional vibrating type field relay.
the generator begins to charge, the indicator light goes The transistor is an electrical device which limits the
out indicating that the system is operating normally. generator voltage to a preset value by controlling the
The double-contact regulator assembly (fig. 2c) con generator field current. The diodes, capacitor and re
sists of a double-contact voltage regulator unit and a sistors act together to aid the transistors in controlling
field relay unit. This unit uses two sets of contact points the generator voltage. This is the only function that the
on the voltage regulator unit to obtain desired field regulator performs in the charging circuit. The ther
excitation under variable conditions. This regulator, mistor provides a temperature-compensated voltage set
when used with the special 63 amp air conditioning model ting. A wiring diagram of this regulator's internal circuit
generator (4 ohm field coil), uses a field discharge diode is shown in Figure 3c.
ACCESS PLUG TO
VOLTAGE ADJUSTMENT JUNCTION BLOCK
IN D IC A TO R
LAMP
O f , e ld Q
"F” TERMINAL
No. 2 TERMINAL
No. 3 TERMINAL
TRANSISTOR
No. 4 TERMINAL
The voltage at which the generator operates is deter corrections this unit is designed to make.
mined by the regulator adjustment. The regulator voltage 3. The regulator itself is not grounded.
setting can be adjusted externally by removing a pipe 4. It is used with an ammeter and a field relay in the
plug in the cover (fig. 3c) and turning the adjusting arm system.
inside the regulator. This procedure is explained in the Wiring harnesses are protected by fusible links. A
following section, and permits regulator adjustments fusible link is a length of special wire, normally four
without removing the cover. gauges sm aller than the circuit it is protecting, used
The full transistor regulator used with the 130 amp in circuits that are not normally fused such as the
generator (fig. 4c) is a completely static unit composed ignition circuit. The same size wire with a hypalon
principally of transistors, diodes, capacitors and re insulation must be used when replacing a fusible link.
sistors. The rotor field current is controlled by differ The links are located in the engine compartment
ences in internal voltage and resistance values acting on wiring harnesses and each link will be identified with
the transistors, diodes and resistors within the regulator. its gauge size. On most models there is a 16 gauge,
This unit has certain differences from the other red wire fusible link installed as an integral part of
assemblies. the positive battery cable or located between the solenoid
1. The regulator units are not grounded in the regula battery terminal and the junction block. On tilt cab
tor. They are connected to a third lead which is models (TE 40-50-60, TT 40, TD-TG 50-60) this link
brought out of the regulator to a ground location. is a 14 gauge, red wire. School bus models have an
2. It does not use a thermistor for automatic tempera additional link (16 gauge, red wire) located in the battery
ture compensation, because the quantity of current feed circuitry between the engine generator and forward
handled by the system does not warrant the minute lamp harness connector and molded splice junction.
REGULATOR
PLUG FIELD RELAY
(REMOVE TO ADJUST
VOLTAGE SETTING)
"NEG."
"POS."
BATTERY GENERATOR
4. Excessive generator noise or vibration. NOTE: At this point a field circuit has been
Described below are a series of on-the-vehicle quick established and any other problem will lie in
checks which are designed to assist the service techni generator or regulator.
cian in locating troubles within the various components
6 . Turn on high-beam headlights and heater blower
of the engine electrical system. Additional checks, ad
motor to high speed, run engine at or above 1500
justments and overhaul procedures of these components
rpm (for a few minutes, if necessary) and read the
are also described in the “ Charging System s-Service
voltage on meter.
Operations Section” and should be referred to as
necessary. NOTE: Voltage will not greatly exceed 12-1/2
volts until the battery develops a surface charge,
STATIC CHECKS a few minutes generally, unless the battery is
Before making any electrical checks, perform the severely discharged or is hot.
following static checks:
1. Check for loose fan belt. If reading is:
2. Check for defective battery. (Refer to Battery.) a. 1 2 - 1 / 2 volts or more, turn off electrical loads,
3. Inspect all connections, including the slip-on con stop engine and proceed to step 7.
nectors at the regulator and Delcotron. b. Less than 12-1/2 volts, perform “ Delcotron Out
put Test-V oltm eter Method.”
NOTE: Do not short field to ground to check if
generator is charging since this will seriously (1) Delcotron tests bad - refer to “ Service Op
damage the charging system. erations” and repair Delcotron, then repeat
Step 6 .
(2) Delcotron tests good - disconnect regulator
SYSTEM CONDITION TEST connector, remove regulator cover and re
(5.5"-6.2" DELCOTRON SYSTEMS) connect the connector. Then repeat step 6
This test is used to indicate the overall condition of and turn voltage adjusting screw (fig. 6 c) to
the charging system (both good and defective) and to raise setting to 12-1/2 volts. On transistor
isolate the malfunctioning unit if the system is defective. regulator remove pipe plug (fig. 6 c), insert
1. With ignition off, perform the prescribed Static screwdriver into slot and turn clockwise one
Checks outlined in this section. Then set hand brake or two notches to increase setting. Turning
and shift transmission into neutral. counterclockwise decreases setting. For each
2. Connect a voltmeter from junction block on horn notch moved, the voltage setting will change
relay to ground at regulator base. approximately .3 volt. Turn off loads, stop
engine and proceed to step 7. If 12-1/2 volts
CAUTION: Be sure meter clip does not touch cannot be obtained, install a new regulator
a resistor or terminal extension under regulator. and repeat Step 6 .
3. Connect a tachometer on engine.
4. Turn ignition switch to “ ON” and check indicator
ADJUSTING REGULATOR VOLTAGE
lamp. If lamp fails to glow, perform appropriate
tests and corrections (see Indicator Lamp Circuit 7. Connect a 1/4 ohm-25 watt fixed resistor (purchased
tests) before continuing test. commercially) into the charging circuit at horn relay
5. If lamp glows, start the engine and run it at 1500 junction block as shown in Figure 7c.
rpm or above. Check indicator lamp. If lamp fails
to go out, perform appropriate test and corrections NOTE: Between both leads and the terminal.
(see Indicator Lamp Circuit tests) before continuing
test.
ADJUSTING SCREW
(Turn To Adjust
Voltage Setting)
8 . Run engine at 1500 rpm or above for at least 15 7. Connect an adjustable carbon pile across the battery
minutes of warm-up, then cycle regulator voltage posts.
control (by disconnecting and re-connecting regula 8 . Start the engine and slowly bring the speed to 1500
tor connector) and read voltage. RPM and at the same time adjust the carbon pile
load to hold the voltage at 14 volts.
If voltage is 13.5 to 15.2, the regulator is okay. 9. Read the amperage and compare with a specifications
a. Disconnect four terminal connector and remove
chart.
regulator cover. Then re-connect four terminal
10. Turn off ignition, disconnect battery ground cable,
connector and adjust voltage to 14.2 to 14.6
and remove all test equipment.
(Refer to Step 6 and fig. 6 c).
11. If the Delcotron meets the test specifications, the
b. Disconnect four terminal connector and reinstall
problem is not in the generator.
regulator cover, then reinstall connector.
12. If the Delcotron fails to meet the test specifications,
c. Continue running engine at 1500 rpm for 5-10
remove it and perform bench tests and make repair
minutes to re-establish r e g u l a t o r internal
needed.
temperature.
d. Cycle regulator voltage by disconnecting and
re-connecting regulator connector. Read voltage. DELCOTRON DIODE AND FIELD TEST (Fig. 9c)
A reading between 13.5 and 15.2 indicates a NOTE: These tests will indicate good, shorted
good regulator.
CAUTION: Be sure four terminal regulator
connector is disconnected when removing or in
stalling cover. This is to prevent regulator
damage by short circu its.
Ammeter Method
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable at the battery.
2. Disconnect the red wire at Delcotron battery
terminal and connect an ammeter in series between
the wire and terminal.
3. Connect a voltmeter from battery terminal to a
good ground on the generator.
4. Disconnect the F -R terminal connector at the
Delcotron.
5. Connect the jumper wire between Delcotron “ F ”
and battery terminals.
6 . Connect the battery ground cable at the battery. F ig . 8 c —Ammeter Method Output Test Connections
W IRIN G HARNESS
CO N N ECTO R
POSITIVE
END CASE BRUSH GREASE BALL
FRAME DIODES ASSEMBLY ROTOR ASSEMBLY RESERVOIR BEARING
SLIP
RINGS
GREASE
RESERVOIR
BALL
BEARING
system malfunction. Like any other system, we make a TO TEST THE GENERATOR FIELD CIRCUIT
continuity check, voltage setting test, and circuit re
sistance test. 1. Connect the voltmeter to test adapter as shown in
In order to easily make these tests, it is necessary to Figure 14c, Part 2.
use an adapter at the regulator harness connector. 2. Turn the switch on and read the voltmeter.
Notice that the adapter shown in the illustrations has a. If voltmeter reads 1-2 volts less than battery
three different length test leads. This is only for pur voltage, field is O.K. - check generator output.
poses of differentiating during this program. b. If voltmeter reads zero, an open circuit in the
regulator itself is indicated.
c. If voltmeter reads battery voltage, look for an
open field winding or a shorted regulator.
MAKE THE TEST AS FOLLOWS:
1. Make usual visual checks. TEST THE FIELD AS FOLLOWS:
2. Make the battery light load test. IMPORTANT: The regulator defect may have
3. Make a complete charging system test as follows: been caused by a defective generator field.
a. Test the field relay. Check the field as follows before installing the
b. Check the field circuit. new regulator.
c. Check generator output. (Same as on any other)
d. Check circuit resistance. 1. Turn the switch off and disconnect the battery ground
e. Test and adjust the voltage setting. strap.
2. Disconnect the adapter from the regulator.
3. Connect an ohmmeter to the adapter as shown in
TO CHECK THE FIELD RELAY Figure 15c.
4. If the ohmmeter reads high, there is an open, or
1. Connect a voltmeter at test adapter as shown in excessive resistance in the field winding, or in lead.
Figure 14c, Part 1. 5. If the ohmmeter reads low the winding is shorted
2. Make sure the switch is off, then read voltmeter. or grounded.
a. Voltmeter reads zero - relay O.K.
b. Voltmeter reading battery voltage - relay points NOTE: The specified resistance value can be
stuck closed or relay damaged. determined by dividing the voltage by the cur
3. Turn the switch on and read the voltmeter. rent given in specifications. Since the reading
a. Voltmeter reads battery voltage - relay O.K. is taken through the adapter, leads, brushes and
b. Voltmeter reads zero - relay winding bad or slip rings, the ohmmeter reading on a good field
open circuit in wiring to relay. winding will be slightly higher than the specified
4. Make necessary repairs and recheck. value. This is true because the specified value
is for an ohmmeter reading directly across the
slip rings.
6 . Disconnect ohmmeter and reconnect the battery
ground strap.
D IS C O N N E C T TO G R O U N D
FROM O N GEN ERATO R
R E G U LA TO R
6 i
PART 2
OHM M ETER
OHM M ETER
W IR IN G H A R N ESS
SERVICE OPERATIONS
Service Operations described in the following section 2. Remove washer and slide pulley from shaft.
are for the 5.5" Series ID aluminum Delcotron, 6.2" 3. Reverse Steps 1 and 2 to install, use a torque wrench
Series 2D, Type 100 Delcotron and the 6 . 6 " Series 4D, with a craw-foot adapter (instead of box wrench)
Type 150 Delcotron. Where important differences in and torque the nut to 50 ft. lbs. (fig. 18c).
testing and/or service operations are encountered,
separate mention will be made of the three generators.
Double Groove Pulley
1. Place a 15/16" socket (with wrench flats on the
GENERATOR drive end or use Adapter J-21501 and a box wrench)
on retaining nut, insert a 5/16" alien wrench through
PULLEY REPLACEMENT socket and adapter into hex on shaft to hold the
shaft while removing the nut.
2. Remove washer and slide pulley from shaft.
Single Groove Pulley 3. To install, slide pulley and washer on shaft and
1. Place 15/16" box wrench on retaining nut and in start the nut.
sert a 5/16" alien wrench into shaft to hold shaft 4. Use the socket and adapter with a torque wrench
while removing nut (fig. 17c). and tighten nut to 50 ft. lbs. torque.
IGNITION SYSTEMS
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip tio n ............ ............... 6Y-18 R em oval........................................................................ 6Y-23
Maintenance and Adjustments ............... 6Y-19 Disassem bly.................................................................. 6Y-24
Periodic Maintenance. . . . ............... 6Y-19 Cleaning and In sp ectio n .......................................... ... 6Y-25
Breaker Point System . . ............... 6Y-19 A s s e m b ly ..................................................................... 6Y-26
Breakerless System . . . ............... 6Y-19 Governor S e ttin g ......................................................... 6Y-28
Ignition Coil Check . . . . ...................6Y-19 Installation..................................................................... 6Y-28
Spark Plugs ..................... ...................6Y-19 Breakerless Type............................................................ 6Y-29
C a b le s .............................. ...................6Y-20 Rem oval........................................................................ 6Y-29
Governor ........................ ...................6Y-20 Disassembly.................................................................. 6Y-29
Service O perations............... ...................6Y-20 In sta llatio n .................................................................. 6Y-30
Distributor Contact Points . ...................6Y-20 Ignition Pulse A m p lifie r ................................................... 6Y-31
Cleaning.................. . . . ...................6Y-20 Disassembly..................................................................... 6Y-31
Replacement..................... ...................6Y-20 Component C h e c k s ......................................................... 6Y-31
Setting Dwell Angle . . . . ...................6Y-22 Reassemble .................................................................. 6Y-32
Distributor Condenser . . . ...................6Y-23 Ignition Switch Replacem ent............................................. 6Y-32
Performance Diagnosis . . ...................6Y-23 Spark P lu g s ........................................................................ 6Y-32
R e p la c e m e n t.................. .................. 6Y-23 Cleaning and R e g a p p in g ................................................ 6Y-32
Distributor In sta lla tio n ..................................................................... 6Y-33
Breaker Point Type . . . . .................. 6Y-23 Truck Engine Overspeed W arn in g.................................... 6Y-33
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
There are two ignition systems available on 1967
vehicles. The breaker point type which is continued as
the regular production system and the optional transis
tor controlled breakless ignition system (magnetic pulse
type). The transistor ignition system features a specially
designed distributor, control unit (ignition pulse ampli
fier), and a special coil. Two resistance wires are also
used in the circuit; one as a ballast between the coil
negative terminal and ground, while the other resistance
wire provides a voltage drop for the engine run circuit
and is by-passed at cranking. The other units in the
system (the ignition switch, spark plugs, and battery)
are of standard design. The distributor and control unit
(ignition pulse amplifier) are shown in Figures li and
2 i.
Although the external appearance of the distributor
resembles a standard distributor, the internal construc
tion is quite different. As shown in the exploded view
(fig. 23i) an iron timer core replaces the conventional
breaker cam. The timer core has the same number of
equally-spaced projections, or vanes as engine cylinders.
The tim er core rotates inside a magnetic pick-up as tooth for each cylinder of the engine.
sembly, which replaces the conventional breaker plate, The magnetic pick-up assembly is mounted on a plate
contact point set, and condenser assembly. The mag over the main bearing of the distributor housing. The
netic pick-up assembly consists of a ceramic permanent tim er core is made to rotate about the shaft by conven
magnet, a pole piece, and a pick-up coil. The pole piece tional advance weights, thus providing centrifugal
is a steel plate having equally spaced internal teeth, one advance.
BREAKERLESS SYSTEM
Since there are no moving parts in the ignition pulse SPARK PLUGS
amplifier unit mounted forward of the radiator bulkhead,
and the distributor shaft and bushings have permanent Should be removed, inspected cleaned and regapped at
type lubrication, no periodic maintenance is therefore tune-up. Defective plugs should be replaced, see Servic
required for the breakerless ignition system. The dis ing of Units Off the Vehicle.
tributor lower bushing is lubricated by engine oil through
a splash hole in the distributor housing, and a housing
cavity next to the upper bushing contains a supply of
lubricant which will last between overhaul periods. At
time of overhaul, the upper bushing may be lubricated
by removing the plastic seal and then adding SAE 20
oil to the packing in the cavity. A new plastic seal will
be required since the old one will be damaged during
removal.
Tachometer readings for test purposes can be made on
the primary circuit of the breakerless ignition system
in the same manner as on the conventional ignition sys
tem, however before attempting to connect a test tachom
eter into the primary circuit check with your instrument
supplier to insure that satisfactory readings can be ob
tained and the breakerless system will not be damaged by
the tachometer that is to be used.
CAUTION: Never install a condenser of any
rating between the coil positive and ground. The
use of a condenser at this location for radio
suppression can damage the power transistor in
the ignition amplifier unit. F ig . 3 i—Adjusting Spinner Governor
SERVICE OPERATIONS
DISTRIBUTOR C O N TA C T POINTS sarily an indication that they are not functioning satis
factorily. Do not attempt to remove all roughness nor
CLEANING dress the point surfaces down smooth; merely remove
scale or dirt.
Dirty contact points should be dressed with a few Badly burned or pitted contact points should be re
strokes of a clean, fine-cut contact file. The file should placed and the cause of trouble determined so it can be
not be used for other metals and should not be allowed to eliminated. High resistance or loose connections in the
become greasy or dirty. Never use emery cloth to clean condenser circuit, oil or foreign materials on the contact
contact points. Contact surfaces, after considerable use, surfaces, improper point adjustment or high voltages may
may not appear bright and smooth, but this is not neces- cause oxidized contact points. Check for these conditions
where burned contacts are experienced. An out-of
balance condition in the ignition system, often the result
of too much or too little condenser capacity, is indicated
where point pitting is encountered.
REPLACEMENT
CAM LUBRICATOR
Four and Six Cylinder Engine Distributor
CONTACT SET
ATTACHING 1. Release distributor cap hold-down screws, remove
SCREW cap and place it out of work area.
2. Remove rotor.
3. Pull primary and condenser lead wires from contact
point quick disconnect terminal (fig. 4i).
4. Remove contact set attaching screw, lift contact point
set from breaker plate.
5. Clean breaker plate of oil smudge and dirt.
6 . Place new contact point assembly in position on
breaker plate, install attaching screw.
CAUTION: Carefully wipe protective film from
point set prior to installation.
QUICK
DISCONNECT NOTE: Pilot on contact set must engage match
TERMINAL ing hole in breaker plate.
7. Connect primary and condenser lead wires to quick
disconnect terminal on contact point set.
8 . Check and adjust points for proper alignment and
breaker arm spring tension (fig. 5i). Use an aligning
BREAKER PLATE
ATTACHING SCREWS tool to bend stationary contact support if points need
alignment.
F ig . 4 i—Breaker Plate and Attaching Parts NOTE: The contact point pressure must fall
PRIM ARY
LEAD
F ig . 8 i—Inaccurate G auging of Rough Points New points must be set to the larger opening as the
adequate lubrication for cam. Do not apply ad rubbing block will wear down slightly while seating to the
ditional grease to cam surface. cam. Contact points should be cleaned before adjusting if
they have been in service.
7. Start engine and check point dwell and ignition To adjust the contact point opening:
timing. 1. If necessary, align points (fig. 9i) by bending the
fixed contact support. Do not bend the breaker lever.
SETTING DWELL ANGLE Do not attempt to align used points; replace them
Four and Six Cylinder Engine Distributors where serious misalignment is observed. Use an
aligning tool if available.
The point opening of new points can be checked with a 2. Turn or crank the distributor shaft until the breaker
feeler gauge, but the use of a feeler gauge on rough or arm rubbing block is on the high point of the cam
uncleaned used points is not recommended since accurate lobe. This will provide maximum point opening.
mechanical gauging cannot be done on such points (fig. 8 i). 3. Loosen the contact support lock screw.
Contact points must be set to the proper opening. 4. Use a screw driver (fig. lOi) to move the point sup
Points set too close may tend to burn and pit rapidly. port to obtain a .019" opening for new points and a
Points with excessive separation tend to cause a weak .016" opening for used points.
spark at high speed. Proper point setting for all models 5. Tighten the contact support lock screw and recheck
are: the point opening.
.019" for new points 6 . After checking and adjusting the contact point opening
.016" for used points to specifications, the cam angle or dwell should be
checked with a dwell angle meter if such equipment
is available (see Specifications for proper dwell
angle). If the cam angle is less than the specified
minimum, check for defective or misaligned contact
points or worn distributor cam lobes. The variation
in cam angle readings between idle speed and 1750
engine rpm should not exceed 3°. Excessive variation
in this speed range indicates wear in the distributor.
NOTE: Cam angle readings taken at speeds
above 1750 engine rpm may prove unreliable
on some cam angle meters.
the window provided in the cap and inserting a "Hex” which, up to a certain limit, is not objectionable.
type wrench into the adjusting screw head (fig. H i). 3. High Series Resistance - Excessive resistance in the
1. Preferred Method - Turn the adjusting screw until condenser circuit due to broken strands in the con
the specified dwell angle is obtained as measured in denser leak or to a defective connection. This will
degrees (28° to 32°, 30° preferred) by a dwell angle cause burned points and ignition failure upon initial
meter. starts and at high speeds.
2. Alternate Method - Turn adjusting screw in (clock 4. Capacity - Capacity is determined by the area of the
wise) until the engine begins to m isfire, then turn metallic elements and the insulating and impreg
screw 1 / 2 turn in the opposite direction (counter nating m aterials.
clockwise). This will give the approximate dwell For a complete check of the condenser, use a tester
angle required. (Use only when meter is not which will check for all of the above conditions. Follow
available.) the instructions given by the manufacturer of the test
equipment. Condenser capacity should be .18-. 2 3
Off the Vehicle
microfarads.
1. Distributor Test Method:
a. With the distributor mounted on a distributor
REPLACEMENT
testing machine, connect the dwell meter to the
distributor primary lead. Four and Six Cylinder Engine Distributor (Fig. 4i)
b. Turn the adjusting screw (fig. lli) to set the 1. Release distributor cap hold-down screws, remove
dwell angle to 30 degrees. cap and place it out of the work area.
2. Test Light Method:
2. Remove rotor.
a. With the distributor mounted in a vise, connect a 3. Disconnect condenser lead wire from contact point
testing lamp to the primary lead. quick-disconnect terminal.
b. Rotate the shaft until one of the circuit breaker 4. Remove condenser attaching screw, lift condenser
cam lobes is under the center of the rubbing from breaker plate and wipe breaker plate clean.
block of the breaker lever. 5. Install new condenser using reverse of procedure
c. Turn the adjusting screw clockwise (fig. lli)
outlined above.
until the lamp lights, then give the wrench 1 / 2
turn in the opposite direction (counter-clockwise)
to obtain the proper dwell angle. Eight Cylinder Engine Distributor
1. Remove distributor cap.
2. Loosen condenser lead attaching screw (fig. 6 i) and
lift out condenser lead clip.
DISTRIBUTOR CONDENSER
3. Remove screw holding condenser bracket to breaker
plate and slide condenser from bracket.
PERFORMANCE DIAGNOSIS
4. To replace condenser reverse the above procedure.
The following four factors affect condenser perfor
mance, and each factor must be considered in making any
NOTE: Make sure that new condenser lead is
condenser test. installed in proper position (fig. 6 i).
1. Breakdown - A failure of the insulating material. A
direct short between the metallic elements of the
condenser. This prevents any condenser action.
2. Low Insulating Resistance (Leakage) - Low insula DISTRIBUTOR
tion resistance prevents the condenser from holding (BREAKER POINT TYPE)
a charge. All condensers are subject to leakage
REMOVAL
1. Release the distributor cap hold-down screws, re
move the cap and place it clear of the work area.
NOTE: If necessary, remove secondary leads
from the distributor cap after first marking the
cap tower for the lead to No. 1 cylinder. This
will aid in the reinstallation of leads in the cap.
2. Disconnect the distributor primary lead from the coil
terminal.
3. Scribe a realignment mark on the distributor bowl
and engine in line with the rotor segment.
4. Disconnect external connections (vacuum line, drive
cables, etc.), remove the distributor hold-down bolt
and clamp, remove the distributor from the engine.
Note position of vacuum advance mechanism relative
to the engine.
CAUTION: Avoid rotating the engine with the
distributor removed as the ignition timing will
F ig . 11 i —Adjusting Dw ell Angle be upset.
V-8 Engines
Refer to Figure 13i and 14i.
1. Remove the rotor.
2. Remove both weight springs and advance weights.
3. Remove roll pin retaining driven gear to distributor
shaft, slide the gear and spacers from the shaft.
On heavy duty models remove shock mounting unit.
NOTE: When servicing governor type distribu
F ig . 12 i— L —6 Distributor tors (fig. 14i), remove the cover band and
spinner valve assembly at this time. Be sure to
1. Breaker P la te Attaching 10. C o ntact Point
Screws A ttach ing Screw
note the revolutions needed to remove the nut
2. Condenser Attaching 11. C ontact Point Assembly from the spinner valve.
Screws 12. W eigh t C over
3. Condenser A ttaching Screws
4. Before sliding the distributor shaft from the housing,
4. Breaker P la te Assembly 13. W eigh t C o ver check for and remove any burrs on the shaft. This
4a. Cam Lubricator 14. W eight Springs will prevent damage to the seals and bushing still
5. Vacuum Control Assembly 15. A d vance Weights positioned in the housing.
6. Vacuum Control 16. Cam Assembly
A ttaching Screws
5. Slide the distributor mainshaft and cam-weight base
17. M a in Shaft
7. Housing Assembly assembly from the housing.
8. Cap 18. Roll Pin 6 . Remove vacuum advance mechanism retaining
9. 19. D rive G e a r screws, remove the vacuum advance assembly.
7. Remove the spring retainer, remove the breaker CLEANING AND INSPECTION
plate assembly from the distributor housing. Remove
the contact point and condenser from the breaker 1. Wash all parts in cleaning solvent except cap, rotor,
plate. Remove the felt washer and plastic seal lo condenser, breaker plate assembly and vacuum con
cated beneath the breaker plate. trol unit. Degreasing compounds may damage in
sulation of these parts or saturate the lubricating
NOTE: Governor type distributors have no felt in the case of the breaker plate assembly.
breaker plate. The contact point assembly and 2. Inspect the breaker plate assembly for damage or
condenser are attached directly to the distribu wear and replace if necessary.
tor housing. 3. Inspect the shaft for wear and check its fit in the
8 . On distributor with governor remove main shaft bushings in the distributor body. If the shaft or
seals as follows: bushings are worn, the parts should be replaced.
a. With punch shaped as shown in Figure 15i reach 4. Mount the shaft in “ V” blocks and check the shaft
up through the bottom of housing and insert edge alignment with a dial gauge. The run-out should not
of punch between upper and lower seals and push exceed .0 0 2 ".
upper seal out. 5. Inspect the advance weights for wear or burrs and
b. Insert suitable punch into vacuum hole as shown free fit on their pivot pins.
in Figure 16i and loosen lower seal by denting one 6 . Inspect the cam for wear or roughness. Then check
side slightly. its fit on the end of the shaft. It should be absolutely
c. After lower seal has been loosened, use the free without any roughness.
special punch shown in Figure 17i to push out 7. Inspect the condition of the distributor points. Dirty
seal. points should be cleaned and badly pitted points
should be replaced. (See Distributor Contact Points.) 7. Attach vacuum control assembly to distributor
8 .
Test the condenser for series resistance, micro housing.
farad capacity (.18 to .23) and leakage or breakdown, .
8 Check and adjust contact point opening and alignment.
following the instructions given by the manufacturer (See setting and alignment of points.)
of the test equipment used. 9. Check breaker lever spring tension which should be
9. Inspect the distributor cap and spark plug wires for 19-23 ounces. (See contact point replacement.)
damage and replace if necessary. V-8 EN G IN E-(Fig. 13i & 14i)
1. On distributor without governor:
ASSEMBLY a. Fill housing lubricating cavity with proper com
pound, press in new plastic seal and install felt
Four and Six Cylinder Engine washer.
Refer to Figure 12i for Exploded View of Distributor. b. Replace the vacuum advance unit.
1. Replace cam assembly to mainshaft. c. Install the breaker plate in housing and the spring
retainer on the upper bushing.
NOTE: Lubricate top end of shaft with Delco 2. On distributor with governor install seals and as
cam and ball bearing grease or equivalent prior semble governor as follows (figs. 18i and 19i):
to replacing. a. Insert lower seal through side opening and start
2. Install governor weights on their pivot pins, replace seal straight in bore with lip of seal down.
weight springs. Install weight cover and stop plate. b. Place a steel disc approximately 15/16" diam
eter on top of seal. Insert a 7 /'6 " diameter rod
3. Lubricate mainshaft and install it in distributor
housing. through top of distributor and against disc. P ress
4. Install distributor driven gear to mainshaft and seal, to bottom of counterbore.
insert retaining roll pin. Check to see that shaft Install spring washer on top of seal.
turns freely. Start upper seal in bore with lip of seal up and,
5. Install breaker plate assembly in the distributor body using steel disc and rod, press seal flush with
and attach retaining screws. top of counterbore.
6 . Attach condenser and contact point set in proper NOTE: Spring should seat on the “ flat” ma
location with appropriate attaching screws. chined on one side of the mainshaft.
NOTE: Contact point set pilot must engage 3. Lubricate and slide weight cam over mainshaft and
matching hole in breaker plate. Connect primary install weights and spring (fig. 2 0 i).
and condenser leads to contact set quick- 4. Insert mainshaft into housing, indexing it with drive
disconnect terminal. gear and washers.
PUNCH
LOWER
SEAL
VACUUM HOLE
LOWER
REMOVAL
PUNCH
HOUSING
LOWER
SEAL
SEAL
REMOVAL
F ig . 15i—Removing Upper Seal PUNCH
F ig . 18i— Installing Seals in G o ve rn o r Distributor adjustment until reading returns to 5.0 each time the
hose is pinched.
4. Attach vacuum hose to the adapter on the distributor
GOVERNOR SETTING and start tester. Increase speed until the vacuum
reading reaches a maximum value. This maximum
Since governor speed is a function of both the distribu value will vary, depending on the type “ spinner”
tor “ spinner” and the carburetor actuator, the only parts used, but will probably be above 3.8” hg.
positive method of accurately setting speed is to adjust 5. After this maximum reading has been reached,
the spinner on the vehicle. slowly decrease the distributor speed until the vac
If an approximate bench setting of the spinner is de uum gauge hand falls back .1" hg. The speed at which
sired, the following procedure can be followed: this . 1 " hg. drop occurs will be the approximate no
1. With “ spinner” valve adjusted so that at least two load governed speed. (Remember that distributor
threads on the valve are showing behind the nut, rpm is half engine rpm when making this adjustment.)
mount the distributor in a tester.
2. Screw vacuum adapter into lower vacuum opening
INSTALLATION—ENGINE NOT DISTURBED
on the distributor housing.
3. With the vacuum hose pinched or bent double to pre (ALL MODELS)
vent leakage through the hose, adjust vacuum so that 1. Turn the rotor about 1/8 turn in a clockwise direc
gage reads 5.0 inches. Replace hose, then repeat tion past the mark previously placed on the distrib
utor housing to locate rotor.
2. Push the distributor down into position in the block
with the housing in a normal “ installed” position
(figs. 2 1 i and 2 2 i).
NOTE: It may be necessary to move rotor
slightly to start gear into mesh with camshaft
gear, but rotor should line up with the mark
when distributor is down in place.
3. Tighten the distributor clamp bolt snugly and connect
vacuum line. Connect primary wire to coil terminal
and install cap. Also install spark plug and high
tension wires if removed.
NOTE: It is important that the spark plug
wires be installed in their proper location in the
supports (fig. 23i).
4. Time ignition as previously described under Tune-Up
in Section 6 .
INSTALLATION—ENGINE DISTURBED
(ALL MODELS)
1. Locate No. 1 piston in firing position by either of
F ig . 19i—Distributor G overnor Assembly two methods described below.
Fig . 21 i —Six C y lin d e r Engine Distributor MAGNETIC PULSE DISTRIBUTOR (Fig. 23i)
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove screws securing rotor and remove rotor.
2. Remove centrifugal weight springs and weights.
3. Remove cover band and spinner valve assembly. Be
sure to note the revolutions needed to remove the
nut from the spinner valve.
4. Remove pin (file or grind end of pin) retaining driven
gear, then remove distributor gear, washer and shock
mounting assembly from shaft.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the perma
nent magnet, support drive gear when driving
out gear retaining pin.
5. Remove drive shaft assembly. Check for and remove
burrs on the shaft to prevent damage to seals and
bushing still positioned in housing.
6 . Remove centrifugal weight support and timer core
from drive shaft.
F ig . 2 2 i—Eight C ylin d e r Engine Distributor 7 . Remove connector from pick-up coil leads.
MOUNTING
SCREW
RESISTOR R5 DIODE D1
CENTRIFUGAL
ROTOR ADVANCE
ROTATING
POLE PIECE
SCREW
STATIONARY CAPACITOR Cl R1
POLE PIECE MOUNTING C3
SCREW
CAPACITOR C2
TRANSISTOR TR3
PICKUP
8. Remove retaining ring which secures magnetic core
ASSEMBLY support plate to distributor shaft bushing in housing.
9. As a unit, remove the entire magnetic pick-up
assembly from the distributor housing.
10. Remove brass washer and felt pad.
NOTE: Before removing plastic seal, refer to
instructions provided earlier in this article.
11. If necessary to replace the mainshaft seals refer to
the procedures previously described.
12. To reassemble distributor, perform the above steps
in reverse order.
INSTALLATION
1. Check to see that the engine is at firing position for
No. 1 cylinder (timing mark on harmonic balancer
indexed with pointer).
2. Position a new distributor-to-block gasket on the
DISTRIBUTOR block.
HOUSING 3. Before installing distributor, index rotor with hous
ing as noted when distributor was removed.
4. Replace distributor clamp leaving screw loose
enough to allow distributor to be turned for timing
adjustment.
5. Install spark plug wires in distributor cap. Place
wire for No. 1 cylinder in tower (marked on old cap
during disassembly) then install remaining wires
clockwise around the cap according to the firing
order (1 -8 -4 -3 -6 -5 -7 -2 ).
6 . Attach distributor to coil primary wires.
7. Replace distributor cap.
8 . Attach governor vacuum and air intake lines to
distributor.
9. Adjust timing and then fully tighten distributor clamp
F ig . 2 3 i—Magnetic Pulse Distributor Components screw.
CHECKING CHECKING
RESISTOR R1 CAPACITOR Cl
IGNITION PULSE AMPLIFIER In order to check the panel board assembly, it is nec
essary to unsolder at the locations indicated in Figure 5i
the two capacitors C2 and C3. In all of the following
DISASSEMBLY
checks, connect the ohmmeter as shown and then reverse
To check the amplifier for defective components, pro the ohmmeter leads to obtain two readings. Internal
ceed as follows: circuitry of the amplifier is shown in Figure 26i.
1. Remove the bottom plate from the amplifier. 1. Transistors T R l and TR2: Check each transistor by
2. To aid in reassembly, note the locations of the lead referring to Figure 27i. If both readings in Step 1 are
connections to the panel board. zero, the transistor is shorted. If both readings in
3. Remove the three panel board attaching screw, and Step 2 are zero, the transistor is shorted; and if both
lift the assembly from the housing. readings are infinite, the transistor is open. Inter
4. To aid in reassembly, note any identifying markings pret Step 3 the same as Step 3.
on the two transistors and their respective locations 2. Trigger Transistor TR3: If both readings in Step 1
on the panel board and heat sink assembly. are zero, the transistor is shorted. If both readings
5. Note the insulators between the transistors and the in Step 2 are zero, the transistor is shorted; and if
heat sink, and the insulators separating the heat sink both readings are infinite, the transistor is open.
from the panel board. Interpret Step 3 the same as Step 2.
6 . Remove the transistor attaching screws, and sepa
3. Diode Dl: If both readings are zero, the diode is
rate the two transistors and heat sink from the panel shorted; and if both readings are infinite, the diode is
board. open.
7. Carefully examine the panel board for evidence of 4. Capacitor Cl: If both readings are zero, the capaci
damage. tor is shorted.
5. Capacitors C2 and C3: Connect the ohmmeter across
COMPONENT CHECKS (Figs. 24i and 25i) each capacitor (not illustrated). The capacitor is
With the two transistors separated from the assembly, shorted if both readings are zero.
an ohmmeter may be used to check the transistors and 6 . Resistor R l: The resistor is open if both readings
components on the panel board for defects. An ohmmeter are infinite.
having a 1 - 1 / 2 volt cell, which is the type usually found 7. Resistor R2: Use an ohmmeter scale on which the
in service stations, is recommended. The low range 1800 ohm value is within, or nearly within, the mid
scale on the ohmmeter should be used except where dle third of the scale. If both readings are infinite,
specified otherwise. the resistor is open.
A 25 watt soldering gun is recommended, and a 60% 8 . Resistor R3: Use an ohmmeter scale on which the
tin 40% lead solder should be used when re-soldering. 680 ohm value is within, or nearly within, the middle
Avoid excessive heat which may damage the panel board. third of the scale. If both readings are infinite, the
Chip away any epoxy involved, and apply new epoxy which resistor is open.
is commercially available. 9. Resistor R4: Select an ohmmeter scale on which the
DISTRIBUTOR CARBURETOR
BUTTERFLY VALVE
SPINNER VALVE
CARBURETOR ACTUATOR
IGNITION
SWITCH
OIL PRESSURE
SWITCH
AMBER
LAMP
BATTERY
STARTING SYSTEM
STARTING MOTOR
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c r ip tio n ......................................................... 64-34 Starting Motor and Solenoid C h e c k .............................. 64-36
Maintenance and A djustm ents.......................................... 64-36 Service O perations............................................................ 64-36
L u b ric a tio n ..................................................................... 64-36 Removal and Installation ............................................. 64-36
Resistance C h e c k s ..........................................................64-36
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The function of the starting system, composed of the solenoid completes the circuit to the starting motor, and
starting motor, solenoid and battery, is to crank the the motor then does the actual work of cranking the
engine. The battery supplies the electrical energy, the engine.
CONTACT SOLENOID
FINGER PLUNGER RETURN SPRING
SHIFT
LEVER
SPIRAL
SPLINES
riNION
STOP
OVERRUNNING
BRUSH INSULATED BRUSH HOLDER FIELD COIL CLUTCH
BRUSH SPRING ARMATURE
GROUNDED BRUSH HOLDER
SOLENOID SEAL
LINKAGE
SHIFT LEVER
COMMUTATOR
END FRAME
LEVER HOUSING
HOUSING
BRONZE
BUSHING
THRU BRONZE
BOLT BUSHING
BRUSH
GROUNDED INSULATED
BRUSH HOLDER COMMUTATOR ATTACHING INTERMEDIATE
BRUSH HOLDER
POLE SHOE FIELD COIL BOLT DUTY CLUTCH
The starting motor (fig. Is) consists primarily of the housing is extended to enclose the entire shift lever and
drive mechanism, frame, armature, brushes, and field plunger mechanism, protecting them from dirt, splash,
windings. The starting motor is a 12-volt extruded and icing. The flange mounted solenoid switch operates-
frame type, having four pole shoes and four fields, con the overrunning clutch drive by means of a linkage to the
nected with the armature. The aluminum drive end shift lever.
GASKETS HEAVY-DUTY
SOLENOID SWITCH LINKAGE SEAL
LINKAGE
GASKET
COMMUTATOR
END FRAME SHIFT LEVER
LEVER HOUSING
OIL
RESERVOIR BRUSH NOSE HOUSING
OIL WICK
CABLE
BRONZE
BUSHING
COVER ARMATURE / " O ” RING
RINGS BAND HEAVY-DUTY
COMMUTATOR POLE SHOE SHAFT SEAL BRONZE ’BUSHING CLUTCH T-1041
Variations of the enclosed shift lever type starting flange mounted starting motor but a much heavier duty
motor are used in the Chevrolet Truck Programs. Gas design (fig. 3s). Specific mention is made where differ
oline powered engines use the conventional starting ences in service procedures between the two types of
motor of either the flange or pad mounted (figs. 2 s and motors occur.
3s) type housing. Diesel powered truck engines use a
SERVICE OPERATIONS
STARTER MOTOR
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION (Fig. 4s)
The following procedure is a general guide for all
vehicles and will vary slightly depending on the truck
series and model.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable at the battery.
2. Disconnect engine wiring harness and battery leads
at solenoid terminals.
3. Remove starter mounting bolts and retaining nuts and
disengage starter assembly from the flywheel
housing.
4. Position starter motor assembly to the flywheel
housing and install the mounting bolts and retaining
nuts. Torque the mounting bolts 25 - 35 ft. lbs.
5. Connect all wiring leads at the solenoid terminals.
6 . Connect the battery ground cable and check operation
of the unit.
SPECIAL TOOLS
J-7607
IG N IT IO N SW ITCH
NUT REM O VER
J-5184
C H E C K IN G
SCALE J-21 600
H A R N ESS ADAPTER
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
down through a seal boot on the toe pan, to the cross
shaft lever. When the clutch pedal is depressed, the
pedal pull or push rod moves upward rotating the cross
shaft, pushing the fork push rod rearward, and pivoting
the clutch fork to move the throwout bearing against the
clutch release fingers and releasing the clutch.
The Step Van uses mechanical linkage activated by a
floor pedal mounted through a pivot shaft on a frame
bracket (fig. 2). A short pull rod connects the pedal to
the cross-shaft to activate the clutch as before.
The hydraulic controls consist of pedal, pedal push rod,
main cylinder, tubing, slave cylinder, fork push rod,
clutch fork and throwout bearing.
When the clutch pedal is depressed, brake fluid is
forced from the main cylinder into the slave cylinder
(fig. 3) moving the push rod against the clutch fork to re
lease the clutch as before. When the pedal is released,
the clutch fork return spring forces fluid from the slave
cylinder back to the master cylinder.
A fitting is provided on the slave cylinder for bleeding
air from the system as is done with hydralic brakes.
The fluid level should be maintained approximately 1/2"
below the top of master cylinder reservoir.
On 366 cu. in. and Diesel vehicles the clutch release
bearing is moved by a yoke attached to a shaft through the
transmission half of the clutch housing (fig. 4). The hy
Fig . 1 - C lutch Linkage (except Step-Van) draulic slave cylinder pushes a lever attached at the end
of the throwout yoke shaft, rotating the shaft and yoke and
The operating controls for 1967 trucks are either me moving the throwout bearing against release fingers of
chanical or hydraulic. The mechanical linkage (used on clutch assembly.
6 cylinder and V- 8 engine equipped vehicles except "L " On vehicles equipped with a yoke and shaft type release
and "T " Models) consists of pendant type pedal, return lever, the grease cup (attached by hose to release bear
spring, pedal push rod, cross-shaft, fork push rod, clutch ing) is filled with a graphite type grease and should be
fork and throwout bearing (fig. 1). The pedal push rod is turned one-turn each 1 , 0 0 0 miles and refilled each 6 , 0 0 0
routed vertically, inside the cab, from the pedal lever miles.
B BLEED
FITTING
CLUTCH SLAVE
FORK CYLINDER
FULCRUM ADJUSTING
NUT
Installation
NOTE: Use new shaft bushing if needed and
lubricate with Lubriplate or petrolatum.
1. Slide one pedal shaft bushing over shaft, install shaft
in support enough to still clear pedal bumper stop,
hook pedal return (or overcenter) spring to pedal,
then rotate pedal forward of bumper stop; slide shaft
into position in support and release pedal against
bumper stop.
2. Install clutch pedal shaft bushing over pedal shaft end
and into place in sleeve.
3. Assemble pedal push rod lever over pedal shaft and
install bolts, washers, and nut. Torque to 25 ft. lbs.
4. Adjust clutch pedal free travel as needed.
Removal
1. Remove upper-to-lower clutch pedal arm nut and
remove upper arm from lower arm.
2. Disconnect clutch return spring and pedal-to-cross
shaft pull rod.
3. Remove snap ring (retaining pedal on pivot pin) and
remove pedal from pivot pin, then remove brake
pedal return spring.
4. To remove pivot shaft remove nut, washer and drive
pin from boss on bracket using a small brass driver.
5. Remove grease fitting from pivot pin, install Tool
J-8118 and use a slide hammer to remove the pin Fig . 10 - T ilt Cab Clutch Pedal Linkage
2. Install tapered lock pin (from lower side), lock 2. Disconnect slave cylinder hydraulic line, at slave
washer and nut. cylinder.
3. Install clutch pedal over pivot pin, then flat washer 3. Remove retaining bolts from slave cylinder and re
and lock ring. move slave cylinder.
4. Connect pedal pull rod at pedal and at cross-shaft.
5. Install upper pedal arm into lower arm and install Disassembly
washer and nut. Refer to Figure 11.
6 . Adjust pedal height and free travel as previously 1. Remove slave cylinder push rod, push rod boot, and
outlined. fulcrum as a unit.
2. Remove snap ring from slave cylinder, using a small
TILT CAB CLUTCH PEDAL LINKAGE (Fig. 10) screwdriver blade, as shown in Figure 12, be careful
not to scratch the slave cylinder bore.
Removal 3. Remove piston and rubber seal assembly from slave
1. Tilt cab forward and block in place. cylinder bore.
2. Remove upper to lower clutch pedal arm bolt and 4. Wash all parts in clean alcohol.
slide upper arm through floor boards.
3. Disconnect clutch pedal return spring and over NOTE: Since the clutch hydraulic system on
center assist spring. vehicles equipped with a dual master cylinder,
4. Remove clutch push rod lever locking bolt and nut use the same hydraulic fluid and reservoir as
and remove lever from clutch pedal pivot shaft. Re the brake system, it is essential that the system
move push rod and lever from dust boot.
5. Slide clutch pedal lower arm out of mounting bracket
sleeve.
6 . If necessary, remove sleeve by first removing
grease fitting and 2 retaining screws and slide sleeve
from mounting bracket.
Fig. 11 - C lutch Slave C ylin d er Fig. 12 - Removing Slave C ylin d er Snap Ring
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The clutch, used on 230 and 250 cubic inch 6 - Cylinder
engine trucks, is a single plate dry disc type consisting of
two basic assem blies, the driven disc and facing assem
bly and the cover, pressure plate and diaphragm and dia
phragm spring assembly.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
CLUTCH ASSEMBLY CAUTION: Be careful not to use too much lu-
bricant.
Removal From Vehicle
1. Remove transmission as outlined in "Transmission Replace clutch fork ball if removed in the clutch
Section." housing and snap clutch fork onto the ball.
2. Disconnect slave cylinder from clutch fork. 10 . Lubricate the recess on the inside of the throwout
3. Remove clutch throwout bearing from the fork. bearing collar and coat the throwout fork groove with
4. Remove clutch fork by pressing it away from its ball a small amount of graphite grease (fig. 18).
mounting with a screwdriver, until the fork snaps 11. Install throwout bearing assembly to the throwout
loose from the ball or remove ball stud from rear of fork.
clutch housing. 12 . Assemble transmission as outlined in Transmission
Section, and install flywheel underpan.
NOTE: The retainer may be removed from the
13. Align push rod to clutch fork and attach return spring
fork by prying out with a small screwdriver.
to clutch fork.
5. Install Tool J-5824 to support the clutch assembly 14. Adjust clutch linkage (See Adjustments in this sec
during removal. tion).
6 . Loosen the clutch attaching bolts one turn at a time
to prevent distortion of clutch cover until dia
phragm spring is released.
7. Remove clutch pilot tool and remove clutch assembly
from vehicle.
Installation to Vehicle
1. Install the pressure plate in the cover assembly lin
ing up the notch mark on pressure plate with notch
mark on flange of cover.
2. Install pressure plate retracting springs and drive
strap to pressure plate bolts and lockwashers and
tighten to 11 ft. lbs. torque. The clutch is now ready
to be installed.
3. Hand crank the engine until "X " mark on flywheel is
at the bottom.
4. Install clutch disc, pressure plate and cover assem
bly and support them with Tool J-5824.
5. Turn clutch assembly until "X " mark on clutch cover
flange lines up with "X " mark on flywheel.
6 . Install attaching bolts and tighten each one a turn at a
time to prevent distorting the cover as the spring
pressure is taken up.
7. Remove clutch pilot Tool J-5824.
8 . Pack clutch fork ball seat with a small amount of
high melting point grease and install a new retainer
in the groove of the clutch fork if the old retainer is
worn or damaged.
NOTE: Install retainer with high side up, away PACK THIS RECESS
from bottom of the ball socket and with open end
of retainer on the horizontal. Fig . 18 - Lubrication Points on Clutch Throwout Bearing C o lla r
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The clutch used on all 292, 283 and 327 cubic inch and
Diesel truck engines is a coil spring single plate dry disc
type, no adjustment for wear being provided in the clutch
itself. An individual adjustment is provided for locating
each lever in manufacturing but the adjusting nut is
locked in place and should never be disturbed, unless the
clutch is dismantled for replacement of parts.
When the clutch pedal is depressed the release bearing
is moved toward the flywheel and contacts the inner ends
of the release levers, (1) (fig. 19). Each release lever is
pivoted on a floating pin which remains stationary in the
lever and rolls across a short flat portion of the enlarged
hole in the eyebolt (2). The outer end of each release
lever engages the pressure plate lug by means of a strut
(3), which provides knife-edge contact between the outer Fig. 19- Release Lever
end of the lever and the lug. The outer ends of the eye-
bolts extend through holes in the stamped cover (4), and 1. Release Lever 4. C over
are fitted with adjusting nuts (5) to correctly position the 2. Eyebolt 5. Adjusting Nut
levers. 3. Strut
SERVICE OPERATIONS
CLUTCH ASSEMBLY down as the holding screws are removed or when
clutch is removed from engine.
Removal From Vehicle
Installation to Vehicle
Before removing clutch from flywheel, mark with a
punch the flywheel, clutch cover and one pressure plate 1. Assemble driven plate and clutch cover assembly to
lug, so that these parts may be assembled in their same flywheel in accordance with marking on driven plate
relative positions, as they were balanced as an assembly. for flywheel side.
Loosen the holding screws a turn or two at a time to 2. Line up the driven plate assembly and the pilot bear
avoid bending rim of cover. When removing driven plate ing with a dummy shaft before tightening cover hold
be sure to mark flywheel side. ing screws. Tighten holding screws before removing
dummy shaft.
NOTE: It is advantageous to place wood or 3. After transmission has been assembled, adjust pedal
metal spacers (approximately 3/8 thick) between as described under "Clutch Pedal Adjustments,"
the clutch levers and the cover to hold the levers "Hydraulic Clutch Controls."
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The 366 cu. in. engine for 1967 is equipped with a 2 The cover is bolted to the engine flywheel. Coil type
plate, dry disc type clutch consisting of three basic as pressure springs, located between the cover and rear
sem blies: The cover and rear pressure plate assembly, pressure plate, provide positive engagement between the
front pressure plate assembly and dual driven disc as cover, the pressure plates, driven disc assemblies and
sembly. The dual driven disc assemblies are splined to flywheel.
the transmission main drive gear (clutch gear) shaft. The No adjustment for wear is provided in the clutch itself.
front pressure plate, located between the driven discs, An individual adjustment is provided for locating each
has 2 friction surfaces and is coupled to both the rear lever. In manufacturing this lever adjusting nut is locked
pressure plate and cover through pairs of steel drive in place and should never be disturbed unless the clutch
straps bolted at each of its 4 driving bosses. is disassembled for overhaul.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
Removal From Vehicle
1. Refer to applicable procedure in Transmission Sec
tion 7, and remove transmission. Release bearing
and actuating mechanism are assembled in housing at
front of transmission and may be inspected without
disassembly.
Look for "X ” mark stamped on pressure plates,
cover and flywheel. If ”X" is not stamped on all 4
pieces, punch mark them (with prick punch) in a line
at one location for alignment purposes during
installation.
Install aligning tool ( J - 21169) or an old transmission
main drive gear, through hubs of driven discs into
pilot bearing, and place a wood or metal spacer (ap
proximately 1" x 1" x 3 /8" thick) between each re
lease lever and clutch cover (fig. 41) to facilitate
removal and installation.
Rotate the flywheel (if necessary) to locate one cover
mounting bolt at top, then loosen all 4 cover mounting
bolts alternately and evenly until pressure is re
leased from discs.
Remove top bolt and install alignment stud (part of
Tool J-21169) in its place. Fig. 21 - C lutch Release Finger Adjustment
Remove 3 remaining bolts (allowing clutch assembly
to hang from stud), then slide clutch assembly from
stud to remove from vehicle.
Installation to Vehicle
1. Place alignment tool (stud section) in upper clutch
mounting bolt hole.
2. Install alignment tool (arbor section) through rear
driven plate splines and install front driven plate
over tool with hub section of plate toward flywheel.
3. Lift complete clutch assembly (with one hole held to
top) and slide upper bolt hole over alignment stud in
flywheel, then work clutch discs as needed to slide
arbor pilot into pilot bearing.
4. Install three bolts loosely, then remove alignment
stud and install last bolt loosely.
5. Thread alignment stud in arbor (to act as arbor
handle), make sure discs are in good alignment, then
tighten the cover attaching bolts a turn or two at a
time in rotation to prevent distortion.
6 . Adjust clutch fingers (if cover was disassembled) by
placing a straight-edge over the alignment arbor end
and fingers, and adjust fingers level as shown in
Figure 21.
7. After adjustment is completed, stake the adjusting
nuts to eye bolts to lock the adjustment, then remove
arbor and install transmission as outlined in Sec
tion 7.
Fig . 20 - C lutch Removal or Installation 8 . Adjust clutch pedal linkage as previously outlined.
LIPE-ROLLWAY CLUTCH
( 1 2 , 1 3 , AND 14-INCH)
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The clutch consists of two basic assemblies - the driven bearing. The pilot bearing, pressed into engine flywheel,
disc and facing assembly, and the clutch cover and pres carries the forward end of the transmission main drive
sure plate assembly as shown. The dirven disc is splined gear. This bearing requires lubrication only at time of
to the transmission main drive gear. The cover assem clutch overhaul.
bly is bolted to the engine flywheel. The pressure plate The release fork engages a groove in the release bear
is driven by the cover through driving lugs which engage ing collar for actuating the release levers. Clutch is
slots in the cover. Coil type pressure springs between disengaged by a foot pedal, hydraulically connected to the
the cover and pressure plate force the pressure plate release fork or lever.
against the driven member when clutch is engaged.
Clutch release bearing and support assembly slide on CLUTCH REPLACEMENT
the transmission main drive gear bearing cap. The re
lease bearing is a permanently packed ball bearing and Instructions covering removal and installation of the
requires no additional lubrication during the life of the clutch are explained under the previous clutch section.
SPECIAL TOOLS
b3A3~1 " ,l
0
O
_LEV £* o
13" "
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
Two three-speed synchromesh transmissions are used
as standard equipment on 10-20 Series (1/2 and 3/4
ton) trucks. The Muncie transmission incorporates all
helical gears which are machined from drop forged steel
gear blanks, heat treated and shot peened for strength and
long life. The shafts are machined from high grade steel,
heat treated and ground to close limits.
The rear end of the clutch gear is supported by a heavy
duty ball bearing at the front end of the transmission case
and is piloted at its front end in an oil impregnated bush
ing mounted in the engine crankshaft. The front end of
the mainshaft is piloted in a double row of roller bearings
set into the hollow end of the clutch gear and the rear end
is carried by a ball bearing.
The countergear is carried on roller bearings at both
ends while thrust is taken on thrust washers located be
tween ends of gear and front and rear of the case.
The reverse idler gear is carried on ball-indented
bronze bushings while thrust is taken on thrust washers
located between ends of gear and front and rear of the
case.
The Sagninaw three speed fully synchonized transmis
sion is the same as used in passenger vehicles. Refer to
Fig. 1G - Steering Column G earshift
the Passenger Chassis Service Manual for service
procedures. tion. The shifter gate for selection between first and
Gearshifting is manual through steering column gear reverse and second and high is contained in the shifter
shift mechanism to the transmission cover located on the housing mounted on the lower portion of the steering col
side of the transmission. Shifting is accomplished by umn mast jacket. Two shifter control rods connect the
two rotating cranks which directly engage the gears to be shifter levers on the transmission to the outer shifter
shifted, thus affording a highly efficient mechanical ac- levers on this housing.
joint trunnion bearings to the drive flange. Lower Fig. 4 G - Transmission Controls (PA20 M odels)
the rear of the propeller shaft and slide front flange
off the mainshaft. it is necessary to remove cover from transmission case.
2. Using a punch against seal, drive oil seal out of ex 1. Drain transmission and disconnect control rods from
tension or use Tool J-5859 as shown in Figure 5. levers.
3. Coat new seal with Permatex or equivalent and start 2. Remove cover assembly.
seal straight in bore in extension. Using Tool 3. Remove outer shifter lever retaining bolts and pull
J-5154, tap seal into counterbore. levers from shafts.
4. Remove nuts and locks and remove shifter interlock
TRANSMISSION SIDE COVER ASSEMBLY retainer. This will allow removal of shifter shaft and
fork assembly, poppets and springs or interlock from
On any replacement of parts in the side cover assembly cover.
5. Replace necessary parts. Coat shifter shaft and "O"
ring seal with transmission lubricant before install
ing in cover and bend tab on locks after installing
interlock retainer nuts.
6 . Install outer shifter levers on shafts and install re
tainer bolts.
7. With transmission gears in neutral and shifter forks
in neutral, install cover to transmission using a new
gasket. Coat cover screws with Permatex No. 2 or
equivalent and tighten to 15-18 ft. lbs. torque.
NOTE: Hump on first and reverse shifter fork
(fig. 6 ) must be toward rear of transmission.
8. Attach control rods to shifter levers.
9. Fill transmission with lubricant.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
REMOVAL FROM VEHICLE INSTALLATION IN VEHICLE
TRANSMISSION OVERDRIVE
IN D EX
Page Page
General Description......................................................... 7-15 Closing V o ltage................................................... 7-16
Maintenance and Adjustments.......................................... 7-16 S o le n o id .................................................................. 7-17
Governor Switch and P i n io n ....................................... 7-16 Closing Coil ...................................................... 7-17
Sun Gear Solenoid, Oil Seal & Control Cable Bracket . 7-16 Engaging Spring ................................................ 7-17
Case Rear Oil S e a l...................................................... 7-16 Ignition Grounding Contact................................. 7-17
Control Shaft Lever and/or "O " Ring Oil Seals . . . . 7-16 Governor S w itch ...................................................... 7-17
Speedometer Driven G e a r .......................................... 7-16 Kickdown Sw itch ...................................................... 7-17
Electrical Unit C hecks................................................ 7-16 Linkage A djustm ent................................................ 7-17
Overdrive Relay ................................................... 7-16 Diagnosis - O v e rd riv e ...................................................... 7-18
A ir G ap ............................................................... 7-16 M e c h a n ic a l.................................................................. 7-18
Point O p e n in g ................................................... 7-16 E le c tric a l............................................................ ... . . 7-19
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
GOVERNOR SWITCH AND PINION Three checks and adjustments are required on the
overdrive relay; air gap, point opening and closing volt
To remove governor switch, disconnect wires at gover age. The air gap contact point opening checks and ad
nor switch and screw governor out of housing, using Tool justments should be made with the battery disconnected.
J-4653 on the flat hexagonal surface of governor case.
The pinion may be separated from the governor by re Air Gap
moving the snap ring on the shaft. The air gap should not normally require adjustment
unless the relay has been misadjusted. Check the air gap
SUN GEAR SOLENOID, OIL SEAL AND with the points barely touching and adjust if necessary by
CONTROL CABLE BRACKET bending the lower point support (fig. IB).
Remove the solenoid by taking out the two mounting
Point Opening
bolts and lock washers, removing the cable bracket with
Check the contact point opening and adjust by bending
the lower bolt. Turn the solenoid 1/4 turn and pull sole
the upper armature stop (fig. 2B).
noid plunger out of adapter. The oil seal may be pried
out of the adapter.
Closing V o lta g e
CASE REAR OIL SEAL To check the relay closing voltage, connect a potentiom
eter or variable resistance of sufficient value (not less
Removal than 50 ohms) in series with the "KD" terminal, connect a
1. Remove propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4. voltmeter to the "IGN" and "KD" terminals. With the ig
2. Using a punch against seal in housing, pry out seal nition switch on, slowly decrease the amount of re sist
from housing. ance in order to check the relay closing voltage (the
overdrive solenoid and relay should click when the relay
Installation
closes). Adjust the closing voltage by bending the arma
1. Prelubricate between sealing lips and coat outside of
ture spring post (fig. 3B). Bend down to increase the
new oil seal with a suitable sealant, then start seal
closing voltage and bend up to decrease the closing
into bore in overdrive housing.
voltage.
2. Using Tool J-5154 drive oil seal into counterbore.
To check the sealing voltage, increase the voltage after
3. Install propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4.
the relay closes until the armature seals against the
core. Decrease the sealing voltage by reducing the relay
CONTROL SHAFT LEVER AND/OR “ O” RING
a ir gap.
OIL SEALS
To remove the control shaft, disconnect the control
cable, remove tapered pin and pull lever out. Replace
the two "O" ring seals on the control shaft. Insert shaft
and new "O” ring seals into housing and install tapered
pin. Connect control wire to lever.
1
Overdrive Relay h..... ... --.....—
■
■■
*
Specifications and checking procedures fo r this relay Fig . IB - Checking Relay A ir Gap
A R M A TU R E S P R IN G POST
(BEND TO ADJUST CLOSING VOLTAGE)
Solenoid
Closing Coil
Remove solenoid from transmission, connect a jumper
wire between negative terminal of battery and mounting
flange of solenoid. Connect a second jumper wire be Fig. 3B - Adjusting Relay Closing Vo ltage
tween the battery positive terminal and solenoid terminal
No. 4; this should cause the solenoid pawl to move out.
If solenoid chatters, Hold-In Coil is defective. or switch case is grounded.
Governor Switch
Remove overdrive wire at governor and connect test
lamp between governor overdrive terminal and positive
terminal of battery. Drive car on road or raise on jacks.
The lamp should light at a car speed of between 26 to 30
MPH. Upon decreasing speed, the lamp should go out at
between 28 and 23.5 MPH. The car speed differential
between light "on" and light "off" should be 2 or 3 MPH.
Kickdown Switch
Disconnect the 4 wires at kickdown switch.
1. Connect test lamp between "SW" terminal and posi
tive terminal of battery; with switch in normal posi
tion, lamp should light when "R E L " terminal is
grounded but should not light when "IGN" or "SOL"
terminals or switch case is grounded.
2. Connect test lamp between "IGN" terminal and posi
tive terminal of battery; with switch stem pushed in,
lamp should light when "SOL" terminal is grounded,
but should not light when "SW" or "R E L " terminals Fig . 4B - O verdrive Linkage Adjustment
DIAGNOSIS—OVERDRIVE
MECHANICAL switch through the switch bracket are tightened
sufficiently to bend the switch shank, thus pre
Any one of the following general complaints may be due venting free motion of the switch stem. This may
to non-standard mechanical conditions in the overdrive usually be remedied by loosening the upper of the
unit: two nuts.
1. Does not drive unless locked up manually. d. Improper installation of solenoid—If car cannot
2. Does not engage, or lock-up does not release. be rolled backward under any circumstances and
3. Engages with a severe jolt, or noise. there is no relay click when the ignition is turned
These troubles may be diagnosed and remedied as de on, it probably indicates that the solenoid has
scribed in the following paragraphs. been installed directly, without twisting into the
1. Does not drive unless locked up manually bayonet lock between solenoid stem and pawl,
a. Occasionally, the unit may not drive the car for thus jamming the pawl permanently into over
ward in direct drive, unless locked up by pulling drive engagement. If the car will occasionally
the dash control. This may be caused by one or roll backwards, but not always, (and there is no
more broken rollers in the roller clutch, the relay click when the ignition switch is turned on)
remedy for which is the replacement of the entire it may indicate that, upon installation, the bayonet
set of rollers. lock was caught, and the solenoid forcibly twisted
b. This may also be caused by sticking of the roller into alignment with the attaching flange, thus
retainer upon the cam. This retainer must move shearing off the internal keying of the solenoid.
freely to push the rollers into engaging position, Under these circumstances, the end of the sole
under the pressure of the two actuating springs. noid stem may not catch in the pawl, and upon
c. Sometimes this is due to slight indentations, worn release of the solenoid, the pawl will not be with
in the cam faces by the rollers spinning, reme drawn promptly from engagement, but simply
died by replacement of the cam. drift out. If the solenoid stem end has its two
2. Does not engage, or lock-up does not release flats exactly facing the two solenoid flange holes,
a. Dash control improperly connected--Unless the it will not withdraw the pawl properly. If the
overdrive dash control wire is connected to the stem can be rotated when grasped by a pair of
lockup lever on the left side of the overdrive pliers, it indicates that the internal keying has
housing in such a manner as to move the lever all been sheared.
the way back when the dash control knob is pushed e. Improper positioning of blocker ring--Occasion
in, it may hold the shift rail in such a position as ally, either in assembly at the factory, or in
to interlock the pawl against full engagement re service operations in the field, the internal parts
sulting in a buzzing noise when overdrive engage of the overdrive unit may have been rotated with
ment is attempted. the solenoid pawl removed, causing the blocker
To correctly make this connection, loosen bind ring to rotate, so that its two lugs are not located
ing post at lever, pull dash control knob out 1/4", with respect to the pawl as shown in Figure 12B.
move lever all the way to the rear, and tighten In other words, the solid portion of the blocker
binding post. ring may be in alignment with the pawl, which
b. Transmission and overdrive improperly aligned-- will prevent full engagement of the pawl with the
The same symptoms as above may also result sun gear control plate.
from misalignment, at assembly, of the overdrive
housing to the transmission case, resulting in
binding of the overdrive shift rail, so that the re
tractor spring cannot move the rail fully forward,
when the dash control knob is pushed in, and the
transmission is not in reverse. Under such con
ditions, the unit may remain fully locked up.
To test for this, be sure that the transmission
is not in reverse; disconnect the dash control
wire from the lockup lever, and feel the lever for
free forward movement. If the lever can be
moved forward more than 1/4", it indicates that
misalignment probably exists. To correct this,
loosen the capscrews between the overdrive hous
ing and transmission case, and tap the adapter
plate and overdrive housing until a position is
found where the rail shifts freely; tighten
capscrews.
c. Kickdown switch improperly adjusted--The posi
tion of the kickdown switch should be adjusted, by
means of the two large nuts which clamp the
switch shank, so the switch plunger travels 3/16"
before the throttle lever touches its stop.
Occasionally the large nuts which clamp the F ig . 5B - O verdrive E le ctrica l C ircu it W iring Diagram
To test for this condition, remove solenoid "R EL"). If the solenoid clicks when one terminal
cover, pull dash control knob out, roll car 2 ft. is grounded but not the other, replace the switch.
forward. Push dash control in, turn ignition If the solenoid does not click when either of the
switch on. Then ground the "KD" terminal of terminals is grounded, check the wiring between
relay, and watch movement of center stem of the relay and the kickdown switch and replace if
solenoid. It should not move more than 1/8" when defective.
the solenoid clicks. Then, with the relay terminal e. If the solenoid clicks as each terminal is
still grounded, shift into low gear, and roll car grounded in Step d, ground the governor switch
forward by hand. Solenoid stem should then move terminal. If the solenoid clicks, the governor
an additional 3 /8 ", as the pawl engages fully. switch may be defective. If the solenoid does not
These two tests indicate proper blocker action. click, check the wiring between the kickdown and
Unless both tests are met, the blocker ring is governor switches and replace if necessary.
probably not in the correct position. 2. Does not release
3. Engages with a severe jolt or noise a. Remove the connection to the "KD” terminal of
Insufficient blocker ring friction may cause the ring the relay. If this releases overdrive, look for a
to lose its grip on the hub of the sun gear control grounded control circuit between the relay and
plate. Check the fit and tension of the ring as de governor switch.
scribed under "Cleaning and Inspection". b. If the overdrive is not released in Step a, discon
4. Free-wheels at speeds over 30 MPH nect the lead to the "SOL” terminal of relay. If
If cam roller retainer spring tension is weak the unit this releases the overdrive, replace the relay.
will free wheel at all times. Check spring action as 3. Does not kickdown from overdrive
described under "Cleaning and Inspection". a. With the engine running, connect a jumper lead
between the No. 6 terminal of the solenoid and
ground. Operate the kickdown switch by hand.
ELECTRICAL This should stop the engine. If it does, the sole
noid is probably defective and it should be
Any one of the following general complaints may be due checked for dirty ground-out contacts or other
to electrical trouble in the overdrive circuit. defects within the ground-out circuit of the sole
1. Does not engage. noid (fig. 4B). Clean the contacts or replace the
2. Does not release. contact plate as required.
3. Does not kickdown from overdrive. b. If the engine does not stop in Step a, ground one
These troubles may be traced and remedied as de and then the other of the two terminals (identified
scribed in the following paragraphs. as "IGN" and "SOL") farthest from the stem of
1. Does not engage the kickdown switch. The engine should stop when
a. With the ignition switch on, ground the "KD" ter one of the two terminals (IGN) is grounded. If the
minal of the solenoid relay with a jumper lead. If engine does not stop when the terminal is
the solenoid clicks, the relay and solenoid c ir grounded, the wiring or connections to the switch
cuits are in operating condition. If no click is between the switch and coil are defective. When
heard in the relay, check the fuse and replace if the other terminal (SOL) is grounded, the engine
defective. should stop when the kickdown switch is operated.
b. If the fuse is good, use a second jumper lead to If the engine does not stop when the kickdown
connect the "SOL" and "BAT" terminals of the switch is operated with the second terminal
relay. If a click is now heard in the solenoid, the grounded, the kickdown switch is defective. If the
relay is probably at fault and should be repaired trouble is in the kickdown switch, adjust the link
or replaced. age to give more travel of the switch rod. If this
c. If the solenoid does not click in Step b, check the does not correct the trouble, replace the kickdown
wiring to the No. 4 terminal of the solenoid and switch.
replace if necessary. If the wiring is not defec If the kickdown switch operates as it should,
tive, the trouble is probably in the solenoid. Re check for an open circuit in the wiring between
move the solenoid cover, examine the solenoid the kickdown switch and the No. 6 terminal of the
contacts in series with the pull-in winding and solenoid.
clean if necessary. Test again for clicks, as in c. If the trouble is not located by the above checks,
Step b, after replacing solenoid cover and lead the upper contacts of the kickdown switch may not
wires. Replace the solenoid if trouble has not be opening. To check for this condition, ground
been corrected. the overdrive control circuit at the governor
d. If the relay and solenoid circuits are in good con switch. This should cause the solenoid to click.
dition as determined in Step a, leave the ignition Operate the kickdown switch by hand. This should
switch on and make sure the manual control knob cause a second click as the solenoid releases. If
is in the overdrive position. Ground one and then there is no second click, adjust the linkage to give
the other of the two terminals next to the stem of more travel of the switch rod. If this does not
the kickdown switch (identified as "SW" and correct the trouble, replace the kickdown switch.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The four speed transmission is a heavy duty type, de loose roller type bearing inside the clutch gear, while the
signed to give efficient service in every type of truck rear end receives its support from a ball bearing in the
operation. The transmission incorporates synchromesh transmission case.
action in second, third and fourth gears. All gears are The countershaft is supported at the rear by a single
helical except first and reverse. row ball bearing which takes the thrust load, and by a
The clutch gear is supported by a heavy-duty ball bear roller bearing at the front.
ing. The forward end of the mainshaft is supported by a
VIEW B
TG 500-600
transmission should be fully assembled except for the direction enough to obtain approximately 1/32" run
power take-off cover. Then proceed as follows: ning clearance. This clearance can be observed
1. Loosen the eccentric nut and rotate the eccentric, through the power take-off opening.
using a screwdriver in the slot in outer end of ec 4. Shift the transmission into reverse and check for
centric, until slot with dot on end is to the rear. This clearance between reverse idler gear and transmis
places the reverse idler in its extreme rear position sion case at the rear. If necessary, rotate the ec
and will provide for maximum engagement when the centric an additional amount in a counterclockwise
transmission is shifted into reverse. direction to obtain running clearance at this point.
2. Shift the transmission into second gear. 5. Tighten the eccentric nut to 40 ft. lbs. and to next
3. Check for interference between the reverse idler lock index. Install lock spring.
gear and the first and reverse gear. If interference 6 . Reinstall the power take-off cover and tighten cover
exists, rotate the eccentric in a counterclockwise bolts to 20-25 ft. lbs.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
REMOVAL FROM VEHICLE INSTALLATION IN VEHICLE
1. Drain lubricant from transmission. 1. Install transmission through opening in floor.
2. On all except 1/2 ton models, disconnect parking 2. Place the transmission on guide pins and start main-
brake and remove lever as outlined in Section 5. shaft in clutch disc and slide forward.
3. Remove the propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4. 3. Install the lower transmission mounting bolts, re
4. Remove transmission gearshift lever as outlined un move the upper guide pins and install the top mount
der "Maintenance and Adjustments." ing bolts.
5. Remove screws which fasten steering jacket grom 4. Install the flywheel underpan.
met to floor and slide grommet up jacket out of the 5. Install the propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4.
way. 6 . On all except 1/2 ton models, install and adjust the
6 . Remove accelerator pedal and floor mat. parking brake as outlined in Section 5.
7. Remove the sheet metal screws attaching transm is 7. Install transmission gearshift lever and adjust re
sion cover to body floor and remove cover. On verse idler gear eccentric as outlined under "Main
Forward Control models, remove both front and rear tenance and Adjustments."
floor pans. 8 . Connect speedometer cable to the driven gear fitting
8 . Disconnect the speedometer cable from the driven in the transmission rear bearing retainer.
gear fitting at the transmission rear bearing 9. Fill the transmission with 5-1/2 pts. of S.A.E. 90
retainer. gear lubricant and tighten drain and filler plugs to
9. Remove the two top cap screws attaching the trans 30-35 ft. lbs.
mission to clutch housing and insert the two Guide 10. Install the transmission floor cover to body floor.
Pins, Tool J-1126, in these holes. On Forward Control models, install front and rear
10. Remove the flywheel underpan and remove the two floor pans.
lower transmission to clutch housing capscrews. 11. Install the floor mat and connect the foot accelerator
11. Slide the transmission straight back on the guide pins pedal.
until the clutch gear is free of the splines in the 12. Slide the mast jacket grommet in position and install
clutch disc. The guide pins in the top holes support the retainer screws.
the transmission during this operation and prevent 13. Road test the vehicle for operation of transmission
damage to the clutch disc. in all speeds.
12. Remove transmission from vehicle.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The New Process four-speed heavy duty transmission tion. The main drive gear is supported by a ball bearing
is a synchromesh type with helically cut gear teeth. The assembly at the front of the transmission case. The front
transmission is bolted directly to the clutch and flywheel of transmission mainshaft is supported by bearing rollers
housing at the rear of the engine. The countergear located in a cavity in rear of transmission main drive
cluster is a solid type with trunnion bearings mounted on gear and a ball bearing assembly supports the mainshaft
rollers in the case. There are four sets of gear teeth, at rear of the transmission case. Rear end of the main
three helical and one spur (low gear) cut on this one- shaft is fitted with a universal joint yoke, end of which
piece forging. Gear teeth at front end are constantly locates in an oil seal in end of the rear bearing cap. The
meshed with main drive gear and second and third speed conventional transmission shift lever is attached by
gear teeth are always meshed with mainshaft second and means of a bayonet lock and can be installed directly into
third speed gears. The reverse idler gear is driven by transmission cover from the outside without removing the
the countergear and mainshaft low and reverse sliding cover from transmission. Optional remote controls are
(spur) gear engages teeth on countergear for first speed the two rod type.
operation or with reverse idler gear for reverse opera
SERVICE OPERATIONS
TRANSMISSION REPLACEMENT
Removal housing until main drive gear shaft clears clutch disc
1. On transmissions equipped with remote controls, splines.
disconnect control rods from shift levers at 8 . Lower transmission and remove it from the vehicle.
transmission.
2. Remove transmission cover from cab floor on mod Installation
els not equipped with remote controls.
3. Disconnect speedometer drive cable from driven NOTE: Before installing transmission in the
gear adapter at rear of transmission. vehicle, be sure rear surface of clutch housing
4. Disconnect propeller shaft as outlined in PROPEL and front surface of transmission case are
LER SHAFT (SEC. 4). clean. Coat main drive gear splines and pilot
5. Disconnect hand brake (if used) at transmission as bearing in engine flywheel with lubricant speci
described in "HAND BRAKE" (Sec. 5). fied in LUBRICATION (SEC. 0).
6 . While properly supporting the transmission remove
transmission to clutch housing attaching bolts and 1. With transmission properly supported on sutable
lock washers. transmission jack, move transmission into position
7. Pull transmission straight away from the clutch under vehicle.
1. Roll Pin 6. Lock Nut 10. Shift Finger 14. Ball Jo in t Assembly
2. Shift Yoke G u id e 7. Roll Pin 11. Bell Crank 15. Rail Selector
3. Shift Rail Yoke 8. C over 12. N ut 16. Lock Washer
4. Shift Rail Boot 9. Shift Rail 13. Lock Washer 17. N ut
5. Boot Retainer
2. Raise transmission into position aligning main drive roll pin (24) retaining 3rd and 4th shift fork (23) to
gear shaft with clutch disc hub. Guide pins screws 3rd and 4th shift rail (17).
into transmission mounting bolt holes in clutch hous 2. Remove 3rd and 4th shift rail (17) and shift fork (23)}
ing will help keep transmission in alignment with driving shift rail out through welch plug opening in
clutch during installation. Move transmission toward cover forcing out welch plug.
clutch housing, turning main drive gear as necessary 3. Remove detent ball (20) and spring (19).
to allow splines of drive gear to engage splines in 4. Using #2 easy out (fig. 3K), remove roll pin (25)
clutch disc hub. from 1 st and 2 nd shift lug (26).
3. Remove guide pins if used; then install transmission 5. With #2 easy out (fig. 3K), remove roll pin (5) from
to clutch housing bolts and lock washers. Tighten 1 st and 2 nd shift fork (6 ).
bolts securely. 6. Using hammer and drift, drive 1st and 2nd shift rail
4. Connect hand brake (if used) at transmission as de (27) out of cover (2) forcing out welch plug. Remove
scribed in "HAND BRAKE” (SEC. 5). shift rail (27), 1st and 2nd shift lug (26), and 1st and
5. Connect propeller shaft to output yoke as described 2 nd shift fork (6 ).
in PROPELLER SHAFT (SEC. 4). 7. Remove detent ball (28) and spring (29).
6 . Connect speedometer cable to driven gear adapter at 8. Using #2 easy out, remove roll pins ( 8 and 10) from
rear of transmission. Tighten connector firmly. reverse shift lug assembly (12) and shift fork (7).
7. On transmissions equipped with remote controls, 9. With hammer and drift, drive reverse shift rail (9)
connect control rods to levers. Refer to "Trans out of cover (2) forcing out welch plug. Remove re
mission Shift Control Linkage” described earlier for verse shift lug assembly (1 2 ), and reverse shift
adjustment procedures. fork (7).
8 . If lubricant was removed from transmission, refill 10. Remove detent ball (13) and spring (14). Remove two
with proper lubricant as described in LUBRICATION shift rail interlock plungers (15 and 18) and interlock
(SEC. 0). pin (16) from cover (2 ).
9. Install cover in cab floor if previously removed. 11. Using a screw driver, remove retaining ring (11)
10. "Road Test" vehicle for operation in all speeds. from reverse shift lug assembly (12). Remove
washer, plunger (2 1 ), and spring (2 2 ) from reverse
shift lug (1 2 ).
TRANSMISSION COVER DISASSEMBLY
Transmission Cover Assembly
Key Numbers in Text Refer to Fig. 2K
Key Numbers in Text Refer to Fig. 2K
1. Using a #2 easy out as shown in Figure 3K, remove 1. Position detent spring (29) and ball (28) in bore of
cover (2 ).
2. Partially insert 1st and 2nd speed shift rail (27) into
bore of cover (2). Position 1st and 2nd speed shift
fork (6 ) and 1 st and 2 nd speed shift lug (26) on
rail (27).
3. Push 1st and 2nd speed shift rail (27) the remaining
distance (to neutral position) into cover and install
new lock pins (5 and 25).
2. 8. Reverse Shift Fork 10. Install detent spring (19) and ball (20) in bore of
o
D
>>
1. Expansion Plug 7. Shift Yoke G u id e 13. Ball Jo in t Assy. 19. Snap Ring
2. G earshift Lever Rail 8. Shift Rail Boot 14. Roll Pin 20. O-Ring Seal
3. Screw and Lock W asher Assy. 9. Shift Rail Yoke 15. Lock Washer 21. Boot Retainer
4. C over Gasket 10. Nut 16. Nut 22. O il Seal
5. Remote Control Cover 11. Lock Washer 17. Bell Crank 23. Shift Finger
6. Lock Nut 12. Rail Selector 18. Snap Ring 24. Roll Pin
12. Push 3rd and 4th shift rail (17) the remaining dis 5. Using hammer and punch, remove split pin (24) re
tance into cover (2 ) and install new lock pin (24). taining shift finger (23) to shift rail (2).
6 . Drive shift rail (2) forward out of cover (5) forcing
NOTE: Tapered end of pin goes in first.
out expansion (welch plug).
13. Check interlocks by shifting reverse shift rail in re 7. Remove nut (10) and lock washer (11) retaining shift
verse position. Other shifts rails should not shift rail selector (12) to ball joint assembly (13). Re
when this rail is shifted (fig. 5K). move selector from the assembly (13).
14. Install three new welch plugs in bores of shift rail 8 . Remove nut and lock washer retaining bell crank (17)
holes. Install rail interlock hole plug. to ball joint assembly (13). Turn bell crank off the
assembly (13).
REMOTE CONTROL ASSEMBLY 9. Remove grease fitting from bell crank (17).
Key Numbers in Text Refer to Fig. 4K Remote Control Shift Rail Yoke
Bushing Replacement
NOTE: Following procedures apply only to
On transmissions having remote controls, accomplish
transmissions having remote controls, such as
the following procedures:
transmissions used on Tilt Cab Model vehicles.
1. P ress or drive shift rail yoke bushing out of bore in
Disassembly yoke.
1. Using a punch and hammer, remove retaining split 2. Using a suitable sleeve, press or drive new bushing
pin (14) from remote control shift rail (2). Remove into bore of shift rail yoke.
shift yoke (9) and selector (12) from shift rail (2).
2. Remove rubber shift rail boot (8 ) and O-ring boot Remote Control Shift Rail
retainer (21). Discard boot and retainer. Cover Oil Seal Replacement
3. Remove O-ring seal (20) from shift rail (2). With
snap ring pliers, remove snap ring (19) from shift Key Numbers in Text Refer to Fig. 4K
rail (2 ).
4. Loosen lock nut (6 ) and remove shift yoke guide (7) On transmissions having remote controls, accomplish
from cover (5). Remove lock nut (6 ) from guide (7). the following procedures:
1. P ress or drive oil seal (22) out of remote control 5. Install snap ring (19) in groove of shift rail (2). In
cover (5) bore. stall new O-ring seal (2 0 ) on shift rail against the
2. With a suitable sleeve, press or drive new oil seal snap ring.
(22) into bore of cover (5) flush. 6 . Install new shift rail boot (8 ) with new retaining ring
(2 1 ) on shift rail (2 ).
Remote Control Assembly 7. Position shift rail yoke (9) and rail selector (12)
(with offset toward front) on yoke guide (7) and shift
Key Numbers in Text Refer to Fig. 4K rail (2 ).
8 . Install retaining pin (14) into holes in rail selector
NOTE: On transmissions having remote con (1 2 ) and shift rail (2 ).
trols only, accomplish the following procedures: 9. Install ball joint assembly (13) on rail selector (12)
1. Insert remote control shift rail (2) part way into retaining with nut (1 0 ) and lock washer (1 1 ).
cover (5), with flat on rail toward gasket face.
2. Position shift finger (23) on shift rail (2) with off- NOTE: The word "L E F T " on ball joint assem
center hole to front. Push shift rail the remaining bly goes down.
distance into cover.
3. Install roll pin (24) retaining shift finger (23) on shift 10. Install bell crank (17) on ball joint assembly (13)
rail (2 ). attaching with nut (16) and lock washer (15).
4. With locknut (6 ) installed on shift yoke guide (7), 11. Install expansion plug (1) in shift rail opening in
install guide in cover (5). Tighten locknut firmly. cover (5).
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The 5 -speed transmission (New Process) is a selective is supported at the rear by a single row ball bearing lo
synchromesh type with five speeds forward and one re cated in the rear of the transmission case. The counter
verse housed in a cast iron case. A 9 -1 /2 " x 2-1/2" shaft is supported in a single row ball bearing at the front
band type parking brake is mounted on the rear of the which takes the thrust load and by a roller bearing at the
transmission, and standard S.A.E. six bolt power take-off rear. The reverse idler cluster gear rotates on two
openings are provided on both sides of the case. All steel backed bronze bushings which are a press fit in
gears are helical with the exception of the first and re each end of the gear.
verse gear and synchromesh action is provided in second, Pin type synchronizer assemblies are used. The syn
third, fourth and fifth gears. The mainshaft, counter chronizer assembly used for 2nd and 3rd speeds consists
shaft, reverse idler shaft and all gears are machined of two inner synchronizer rings, or cones, and one outer
from alloy steel and carburized for durability. In addi synchronizing ring, or plate. The synchronizer for 4th
tion, all gear teeth are shot peened for high fatigue and 5th speeds consists of two inner rings, or cones, and
resistance. two outer rings, or plates.
The main drive or clutch gear is supported by a single Shifting is accomplished by a floor mounted gearshift
row ball bearing mounted in the front of the transmission lever attached directly to the transmission cover. Fig
case. The mainshaft is supported at the front by roller ure 64 shows layout of transmission parts.
bearings located in the hollow end of the clutch gear and
Installation
4TH AND 5TH
1. Place the gearshift lever in position in transmission SHIFTER FORK
cover.
2. Slide the open end of Tool J-8109 over the lever,
engage the lugs of the tool in the open slot of the re 2ND AND 3RD
SHIFTER FORK
tainer cap, press down on the tool and turn to the
right to engage the lugs on the retainer cap.
TRANSMISSION COVER
Removal
1. Remove accelerator pedal, floor mat and transmis
sion cover from body floor on conventional models.
On Forward Control models, remove the front floor
pan.
2. Shift transmission into 2nd or 3rd gear, then remove
gearshift lever from transmission cover, using Tool
J-8109.
3. Remove cap screws attaching transmission cover to
transmission case and remove cover.
of the notch in the shifter shaft and, with other teeth on the 1 st speed sliding gear will butt against
shifter shafts in neutral position, drive 1 st shifter the low speed teeth on the countershaft, as the sliding
shaft out of cover. Shifter shaft will push out expan gear is pushed rearward. (This will prevent the
sion plug. sliding gear from moving too far rearward.)
4. Put shift forks in cover into 3rd gear position. Place
NOTE: The shifter shafts are in neutral posi new gasket on case and install cover as follows:
tion when the ends of all four shafts are in ap a. Engage reverse shifter fork on reverse idler
proximate alignment toward the rear end of the gear.
transmission cover. b. While keeping left side of cover up, align 4th-5th
shifter fork on 4th-5th synchronizer clutch.
3. Drive out the pins retaining the other forks and heads c. Engage 2nd-3rd shifter fork in 2nd-3rd synchro
to their shaft and remove the shafts, one at a time as nizer clutch.
in Step 2. d. Make sure that 1st speed shifter fork is engaged
in 1 st speed sliding gear and drop cover in place.
CAUTION: Care should be taken so that the 5. Align holes in cover with holes in case and install a
shifter lock balls and springs and the interlock shouldered dowel screw, with lockwasher, in the
balls and pins are not lost as the shifter shafts second hole from front in each side of cover (arrows,
are removed. fig. 2NP). Install all other screws and lockwashers
in cover and torque to 20-25 ft. lbs.
6 . Using Tool J-8109, replace gearshift lever and check
operation by shifting into all gears.
7. Replace transmission cover to body floor, install
floor mat and replace accelerator pedal.
Installation
1. Remove cardboard covering from transmission case.
2. Put reverse idler gear in neutral (move forward).
Put 2nd-3rd sliding clutch into 3rd gear position
(move foward) and put 4th-5th sliding clutch slightly
ahead of neutral.
3. Rotate mainshaft by turning clutch gear until the Fig. 3 N P - Installing O il Seal with Tool J-6416
joint flange, and universal joint flange retainer nut on 8. Install propeller shaft and install and adjust propel
mainshaft. Tighten retainer nut to 125 ft. lbs. and ler shaft brake.
install cotter pin. 9. If the transmission was drained, refill with S.A.E. 90
7. Replace speedometer driven gear. gear lubricant.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
TRANSMISSION 12. Remove the transmission from vehicle.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The 5 -speed transmission (Spicer) is a manually single row ball bearing at the rear. The reverse idler
shifted, synchromesh, helical gear type. Fifth forward cluster rotates on two straight roller bearings. A 9 -1 /2 "
speed is direct drive. The clutch or main drive gear x 3" band type propeller shaft parking brake is mounted
bearing is a single row ball type. The mainshaft is sup at the rear of the transmission, except tandems with
ported by a straight roller pilot bearing at the front and a auxiliary transmissions. Power take-off openings are
single row ball bearing at the rear. The countershaft is provided on both the right and left sides of the transmis
mounted on a straight roller bearing at the front and a sion case.
Removal Installation
1. P ress down on gearshift lever spring cup and drive 1. Insert lever in housing with slot in lever in line with
locking pin out of lever. Lift off cup, spring, cap and hole through side of cover, and curve in lever to
seal (fig. IS). rear.
2. Remove snap ring from groove in lever housing and 2. Install slotted pin through housing and lever and in
SPRING
INTERLOCK
SHIFTER SHAFT
Fig. 4S - Removing Poppet Springs
lock pin in shaft as shown in Figure 7S. Fig. 7S - Removing Interlock Pin
5. Slide shaft the rest of the way in, holding shaft level
so pin will stay in shaft. Install set screw in shaft 6 . Tilt cover and install interlock poppet into position
and lock with wire. against second-and-third shifter shaft (fig. 6 S).
7. Insert fourth-and-fifth shifter shaft through hole in
2nd & 3rd front of cover. Position previously installed shifter
SHIFTER FORK 4th & 5th shafts so interlock poppet will permit passage of this
1st & REVERSE SHIFTER FORK
SHIFTER FORK shaft and slide shaft through forward boss.
8 . Install shifter fork on shaft with fork to front as
shown in Figure 9S. Install set screw and lock with
PLUGS
wire.
9. Install plugs in front of cover (fig. 5S), using a small
amount of Permatex or equivalent around plugs to
seal.
10. Place cover right side up on bench and install poppet
balls and springs in holes in cover (fig. 10S).
11. Position first-and-reverse shifter lever in control
lever housing with boss next to housing and install
stud from inside housing. Secure stud with nut and
lockwasher, then insert plunger pin in first-and-
reverse shifter lever (fig. 3S). Assemble new gasket
Fig. 5S - Shifter Shaft and Fork Installation on cover and install housing so lever fits in slot in
shifter head.
12. Insert outer plunger pin in cover and install spring
and retainer as shown in Figure 2S.
Installation
1. Remove cardboard covering from transmission case.
2. Make sure all transmission gears are in neutral and
SHIFTER
HEAD
FORWARD
BOSS
install cover assembly with new gasket to transmis 3. Install transmission cover attaching bolts and tighten
sion case, making sure shifter forks slide over their to 20-25 ft. lbs.
proper gears and that reverse shifter lever properly 4. Install gearshift lever and check operation by shifting
engages reverse shifter head. into all gears.
5. Install transmission cover to body floor, install floor
mat and replace accelerator pedal.
Fig. 9S - Installing 4th and 5th Shifter Fork Fig. 10S - Installing Poppet Balls and Springs
SERVICE OPERATIONS
TRANSMISSION Installation in Vehicle
Removal From Vehicle 1. Slide transmission into position and install mounting
bolts, using Permatex or equivalent to seal. Torque
1. Drain lubricant from transmission. bolts to 70-75 ft. lbs.
2. Disconnect parking brake and remove lever as out 2. Install flywheel underpan and the access panel on
lined in Section 5. housing.
3. Remove the propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4. 3. Install propeller shaft as outlined in Section 4.
4. Remove floor mat and transmission floor pan cover 4. Install parking brake lever and adjust brake as out
and seal. lined in Section 5.
5. Remove gearshift lever. 5. Install transmission gearshift lever as outlined under
6 . Disconnect the speedometer cable from the driven "Maintenance and Adjustments."
gear fitting at the transmission. 6 . Connect speedometer cable to the driven gear fitting
7. Remove flywheel under pan and remove access panel in the rear bearing retainer.
from clutch housing. 7. Install the drain plug and fill the transmission with
8 . Support transmission and remove mounting bolts. 12 pts. of SAE 90 gear lubricant. Install filler plug.
Move transmission to rear until the clutch gear is 8 . Install the transmission floor cover and mat and in
free of the splines in the clutch disc, and lower the stall accelerator pedal.
transmission away from vehicle. 9. Road test the vehicle.
The four-speed auxiliary transmission is used as op take-off is provided on the right and left hand side of the
tional equipment for model M600 tandem axle trucks. The transmission and a disc-type parking brake is mounted at
transmission is manually shifted and has four speeds for the rear of the transmission.
ward: 1st, 2nd, direct, and overdrive. A six bolt power
1. Direct and O ve rd rive Shift Rod 5. 1st and 2nd Shift Fork
2. Shifter Housing (Cover) 6. 1st and 2nd Shift Rod
3. Lock W ire 7. Direct and O ve rd rive
4. Shift Fork Screw Shift Fork
Assembly
1. Mount cover (2) in vise. Coat oil seal recesses with
sealing cement, and press new shift rod oil seals into
recess.
2. Insert 1st and 2nd shift rod (6 ) (longest rod) in bot
tom hole of cover (2 ) being careful not to damage oil
seal.
3. Move shift rod through support and install 1st and
2nd shift fork (5) on rod with offset toward front as
rod is moved into position.
Fig. 3Q - Transmission Mounting 4. Install clamp screw (4 ), move rod to neutral position,
and tighten clamp screw. Install lockwire (3) re
Shift Cover and Forks taining clamp screw.
5. Insert interlock in rod support, then insert direct and
Refer to Figure 4Q overdrive shift rod (1 ) (short rod) in top of cover.
6 . Install direct and overdrive shift fork (7) on rod with
Disassembly offset toward front and move rod through rod support
1. Mount cover in vise and remove lock wires (3) and boss.
shift fork clamp screws (4). 7. Install poppet balls, springs, retainer, and poppet
2. Remove poppet screw from each side of cover and screws.
ja r springs, balls, and retainer out through poppet 8 . Move rod (1) to neutral position, tighten fork clamp
holes. screw (4 ) firmly and retain with lockwire (3).
ALUMINUM POWERGLIDE
INDEX
Page Page
General Description......................................................... .... 7-38 Warming Up Transm ission .......................................... 7-41
Maintenance and Adjustments ....................................... .... 7-38 Shop Warm U p ......................................................... 7-41
Oil Level C h e c k ......................................................... .... 7-38 Road Warm Up ...................................................... 7-41
Periodic Oil C h a n g e ................................................... .... 7-38 Checking Fluid Level and C o n d itio n ........................... 7-41
Periodic Low Band A d ju stm e n t................................. .... 7-39 Manual L in k a g e............................................................ 7-42
Manual Shift Linkage Check and A d j u s t ............... .... 7-39 Oil L e a k s ..................................................................... 7-42
Throttle Valve L in k a g e .......................................... .... 7-40 Basic Pressure Checks ............................................. 7-42
Neutral Safety S w itch ............................................. .... 7-40 Wide Open Throttle Upshift Pressure Check . . . . 7-42
Throttle Return Check Valve (Dashpot) ............... .... 7-40 Idle Pressure in Drive R a n g e ................................. 7-42
Component Parts R eplacem en t....................................... .... 7-40 Manual "Low " Range Pressure C h e c k .................. 7-43
Transmission R e p lacem en t....................................... .... 7-40 Drive Range Overrun (Coast) P r e s s u r e .................. 7-43
Other Service O p erations................................................ .... 7-41 Powerglide Shift P o in ts................................................ 7-43
D ia g n o s is .................................... .. ..................................... 7-41
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The case and converter housing of the two speed alumi ernor which requires a hole through the output shaft.
num Powerglide Transmission is a single case aluminum The reverse clutch assembly is a multiple disc type
unit. When the manual control is placed in the drive po clutch. The steel plates are splined directly to the case
sition, the transmission automatically shifts to low gear while the face plates are splined to the internal or ring
for initial vehicle movement. As the car gains speed and gear. The clutch piston operates within the rear portion
depending on load and throttle position, an automatic shift of the case. The internal diameter of the piston is sealed
is made to high gear. A forced downshift feature pro to an integral hub portion of the case rear bulkhead. The
vides a passing gear by returning the transmission to low outside diameter is sealed to a machined portion of the
range. case. The piston is hydraulically applied and is released
The oil pump assembly is a conventional gear type and by separate coil springs. The valve body assembly is
the oil pump housing is of the large diameter type acting bolted to the bottom of the transmission case and is ac
as the front bulkhead of the transmission. The torque cessible for service by removing the oil pan assembly.
converter is a conventional three element welded design The valve body consists of an upper and lower body lo
bolted to the engine flywheel which drives through a two- cated on either side of a transfer plate. The vacuum
speed planetary gearset. The high clutch assembly is modulator is located on the left rear face of the trans
typical of the designs used in this type transmission. The mission case. The modulator valve bore is located in the
aluminum Powerglide uses an output shaft mounted gov upper valve body.
PERIODIC LOW BAND ADJUSTMENT (Fig. IPG ) wheel. Allow the selector lever to be positioned in
drive (D) by the transmission detent.
Low band adjustment should be periodically performed
at 1 2 , 0 0 0 mile intervals, or sooner, as necessary if op NOTE: Do_ not use the indicator pointer as a
erating performance indicates low band slippage. reference to position the selector lever. When
1. Raise vehicle and place selector lever in neutral. performing linkage adjustment, pointer is ad
2. Remove protective cap from transmission adjusting justed last.
screw.
3. On some models: To gain clearance between under 3. Release the selector lever. The lever should be in
body and transmission, it may be necessary to re hibited from engaging low range unless the lever is
move rear mount bolts from crossmember, and move lifted.
transmission slightly toward passenger side of 4. Lift the selector lever towards the steering wheel,
vehicle. and allow the lever to be positioned in neutral (N) by
4. Loosen adjusting screw lock nut 1/4 turn and hold in the transmission detent.
this position with wrench. 5. Release the selector lever. The lever should now be
5. Using Special Tool J - 21848 adjust band to 70 in. lbs. inhibited from engaging reverse range unless the
and back off four (4) complete turns for a band which lever is lifted.
has been in operation for 6 , 0 0 0 miles or more, or 6 . A properly adjusted linkage will prevent the selector
three (3) turns for one in use less than 6,000 miles. lever from moving beyond both the neutral detent,
and the drive detent unless the lever is lifted to pass
CAUTION: Be sure to hold the adjusting screw over the mechanical stop in the steering column. See
lock nut at l / 4 turn loose with a wrench during schematic diagram.
the adjusting procedure. 7. In the event that an adjustment is required, place the
selector lever in drive (D) position as determined by
6. Tighten the adjusting screw lock nut to specified the transmission detent. See Steps 2 and 3.
torque. 8 . Loosen the adjustment swivel at the mast jacket
lever, and rotate the transmission lever so that it
CAUTION: The amount of back-off is not an contacts the drive stop in the steering column.
approximate figure, it must be exact. 9. Tighten the swivel and recheck the adjustment. See
Steps 2 and 6 .
10. Readjust indicator needle if necessary to agree with
the transmission detent positions. See Section 9.
11. Readjust neutral safety switch if necessary to pro
vide the correct relationship to the transmission
detent positions. See Section 12. same time the ball stud contacts end of slot in upper
T. V. rod.
Throttle Valve Linkage Adjustment 5. Adjust swivel on end of upper T. V. rod to obtain set
ting described in Step 4. Allowable tolerance is ap
L-6 Models proximately 1/32”.
With accelerator pedal depressed, bell crank on L - 6 6 . Connect and adjust accelerator linkage as described
models must be at wide open throttle position. in Section 6 .
Dash lever must be 1/64”-1 /1 6 " off lever stop and 7. Check for throttle linkage freedom.
transmission lever must be against transmission internal
stop.
V-8M
odelswithUni-DirectionalLinkage Neutral Safety Switch Adjustment
NOTE: Observe converter when moving the 3. Raise transmission into place at rear of engine and
transmission rearward. If it does not move with install transmission case to engine upper mounting
transmission, pry it free of flywheel before bolts, then install remainder of the mounting bolts.
proceeding. Torque bolts to 25-30 ft. lbs.
4. Remove support from beneath engine, then raise
CAUTION: Keep front of transmission upward
rear of transmission to final position.
to prevent the converter from falling out. Install
5. Through flywheel cover opening align as closely as
converter holding Tool J-9549 immediately (or
possible the "white" flywheel balance mark stripe
a sim ilar tool constructed as shown in Figure
and the "blue" painted stripe on end of converter
3PG, or, in an emergency, a length of strong
cover and housing. If scribed during removal, align
wire may be used) after removal from the scribe marks on flywheel and converter cover. In
engine. stall converter to flywheel attaching bolts. Torque
bolts to 18 ft. lbs. (75 ft. lbs. on 292 cu. in. engines)
Installation
6 . Install flywheel cover.
NOTE: The "light" side of the converter is de 7. Reinstall transmission support cross member to
noted by a "blue" stripe painted across the ends transmission and frame.
of the converter cover and housing. This mark 8 . Remove transmission lift equipment.
ing should be aligned as closely as possible with 9. Connect propeller shaft to transmission.
the "white" stripe painted on the engine side of 10. Connect manual and TV control lever rods to
the flywheel outer rim, denoting the "heavy" transmission.
side of the engine. 11. Connect vacuum modulator line, and speedometer
drive cable to transmission.
1. Mount transmission on transmission lifting equip 12. Refill transmission through filler tube, using funnel
ment installed on jack or other lifting device. J-4264 and following the recommended procedure
2. Remove converter holding tool. provided earlier in this section.
CAUTION: Do not permit converter to move 13. Check transmission for proper operation and for
forward after removal of holding tool. leakage. Check and, if necessary, adjust linkage.
DIAGNOSIS
MANUAL LINKAGE
OIL LEAKS
Fig. 4 P G - Pressure Test Plug
Before attempting to correct an oil leak, the actual
source of the leak must be determined. In many cases operational checks for the Aluminum Powerglide trans
the source of the leak can be deceiving due to ’’wind flow" mission. All checks should be made only after thoroughly
around the engine and transmission. warming up the transmission.
The suspected area should be wiped clean of all oil
before inspecting for the source of the leak. Red dye is • Wide Open Throttle Upshift Pressure.
used in the transmission oil at the assembly plant and • Idle Pressure in "Drive" Range.
will indicate if the oil leak is from the transmission. • Manual "Low" Range Pressure.
The use of a "black light" to identify the oil at the • "Drive" Range Overrun (Coast) Pressure.
source of leak is also helpful. Comparing the oil from
the leak to that on the engine or transmission dip stick It is not recommended that stall tests be conducted
(when viewed by block light) will determine the source of which would result in engine vacuum falling below 1 0 "
the leak. Hg.
Oil leaks around the engine and transmission are gen Pressure gauge hose connections should be made at
erally carried toward the rear of the car by the air the low servo apply (main line) test point (fig. 11PG).
stream . For example, a transmission "oil filler tube to Run the gauge line into the driving compartment by push
case leak" will sometimes appear as a leak at the rear ing aside the mast jacket seal. Tie line out of the way of
of the transmission. In determining the source of an oil the drivers feet and connect to pressure gauge J - 21867.
leak it is most helpful to keep the engine running.
The mating surfaces of servo cover, converter housing, • Wide Open Throttle Upshift Pressure Check
transmission case and transmission case eJrtension
should be carefully examined for signs of leakage. The Refer to the pressure check chart for upshift pressure
vacuum modulator must also be checked to insure that points as indicated on the low servo apply (main line)
the diaphragm has not ruptured as this would allow trans gauge.
mission oil to be drawn into the intake manifold. Usually,
the exhaust will be excessively smoky if the diaphragm • Idle Pressure in "Drive” Range
ruptures due to the transmission oil added to the com
bustion. The transmission case extension rear oil seal In addition to the oil pressure gauges, a vacuum gauge
should also be checked. All test plugs should be checked is needed for this check.
to make sure that they are tight and that there is no sign With the parking brake applied and the shift selector
of leakage at these points. The converter underpan should lever in "Drive", low servo apply (main line) pressure
also be removed. Any appreciable quantity of oil in this should be as shown on the pressure check chart.
area would indicate leakage at the oil pump square seal If pressures are not within these ranges, the following
ring, oil pump seal assembly, or oil pump bolt sealing items should be checked for oil circuit leakage:
washers. 1. Pressure regulator valve stuck.
2. Vacuum modulator valve stuck.
BASIC PRESSURE CHECKS 3. Hydraulic modulator valve stuck.
4. Leak at low servo piston ring (between ring and
Four basic pressure checks are used fo r diagnosis and bore).
5. Leak at low servo piston rod (between rod and bore). lowing possibilities:
6. Leak at valve body to case gasket. 1. Partially plugged oil suction screen.
7. Leak at valve body gaskets. 2. Broken or damaged ring low servo.
8 . Front pump clearances. 3. Pressure regulator valve stuck.
9. Check passages in transmission case for porosity. 4. Leak at valve body to case gasket.
5. Leak between valve body gaskets.
• Manual "Low” Range Pressure Check 6 . Leak at servo center.
7. Front pump clearances.
Connect a tachometer, apply the parking brake, place • Drive Range Overrun (Coast) Pressure
the selector lever in "Low” range, and adjust the engine
speed to 1 0 0 0 rpm with the car stationary. With the vehicle coasting in "Drive" range at 20-25
Low servo apply (main line) pressure should be as MPH with engine vacuum at approximately 20" Hg., low
shown on the pressure check chart. servo apply (main line) pressure should be as shown on
P ressures not within this range can indicate the fol the pressure check chart.
L-230
L-250
96 - 112 60 - 74 88 - 101 124 - 139 48 - 54
L-292
283 V- 8
CLUTCHES
CE 20 MODEL
CS 10 MODEL TRUCK (MPH) CE 10 MODEL TRUCK (MPH) CS 20 MODEL TRUCK (MPH)
AND
TRUCK (MPH)
L250 (BASE) L292 (L25) V283 (Base) V327 (L30) L250 (Base) L292 (L25) V283 (Base)
Engine
TRANSMISSIONS
3.73 Axle - 8.15-15 3.73 Axle - 8.15-15 3.73 Axle - 8.15-15 3.73 Axle - 8.15-15 4.57 Axle - 7-17.5 4.57 Axle - 7-17.5 4.57 Axle - 7-17.5
Tire Tire Tire Tire Tire Tire Tire
Throttle
Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down
Position
Closed 12.3-15.3 11.2-14.4 12.3-15.3 11.2-14.4 12.3-15.3 11.2-14.4 12.4-15.3 11.3-14.4 10.7-13.4 9.8-12.6 10.9-13.4 9.8-12.6 10.7-13.4 9.8-12.6
7-44
Detent
36.0-45.0 19.3-29.9 36.0-45.0 19.3-29.9 36.0-45.0 19.3-29.9 40.9-49.9 14.0-21.4 31.4-39.3 16.9-26.1 31.4-39.3 16.9-26.1 31.4-39.3 16.9-26.1
Touch
Full
43.6-50.2 40.0-47.2 43.6-50.2 40.0-47.2 43.6-50.2 40.0-47.2 50.1-56.3 46.8-53.4 38.1-43.9 35.0-41.2 38.1-43.9 35.0-41.2 38.1-43.9 35.0-41.2
Detent
CE 20 MODEL
CE 10 MODEL TRUCK (MPH) PS 20 MODEL TRUCK (MPH) GS 10 MODEL TRUCK (MPH)
TRUCK (MPH)
V327 (L30) L230 (Base) L250 (L22) L250 (Base) L292 (L25) L230 (Base) L250 (L22)
Engine
4.57 Axle - 7-17.5 4.11 Axle - 8.15-15 4.11 Axle - 8.15-15 4.57 Axle - 7-17.5 4.57 Axle - 7-17.5 3.36 Axle - 6.95-14 3.36 Axle - 6.95-14
Tire Tire Tier Tire Tire Tire Tire
Throttle
Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down
Position
Closed 10.8-13.4 9.9-12.6 11.1-13.9 10.2-13.0 11.1-13.9 10.2-13.0 10.7-13.4 9.8-12.6 10.7-13.4 9.8-12.6 12.4-15.5 11.4-14.6 12.4-15.5 11.4-14.6
Detent
35.8-43.6 12.3-18.7 32.6-40.8 17.5-27.1 32.6-40.8 17.5-27.1 31.4-39.3 16.9-26.1 31.4-39.3 16.9-26.1 36.5-45.6 19.6-30.3 36.5-45.6 19.6-30.3
Touch
Full
43.8-49.2 40.9-46.7 39.6-45.6 36.4-42.8 39.6-45.6 36.4-42.8 38.1-43.9 35.0-41.2 38.1-43.9 35.0-41.2 44.2-51.0 40.7-47.9 44.2-51.0 40.7-47.9
Detent
GE 10 MODEL GE 20 MODEL
GS 20 MODEL TRUCK (MPH)
TRUCK (MPH) TRUCK (MPH)
Throttle
Up Down Up Down Up Down Up Down
Position
Detent
SERVICE MANUAL
Full
40.4-46.6 37.2-43.7 40.4-46.6 37.2-43.7 44.2-51.0 40.7-47.9 40.4-46.6 37.2-43.7
Detent
CLUTCHES AND TRANSMISSIONS 7-45
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Turbo Hydra-Matic transmission is a fully auto Manual Linkage - To select the desired op
matic unit consisting primarily of a 3 - element hydraulic erating range.
torque converter and a compound planetary gear set. Engine Vacuum - To operate a vacuum mod
Three multiple-disc clutches, one sprag unit, one roller ulator unit.
clutch, and two bands provide the friction elements re 12 Volt Electrical - To operate an electrical
quired to obtain the desired function of the compound Signal detent solenoid.
planetary gear set.
The torque converter couples the engine to the plane A vacuum modulator is used to automatically sense
tary gears through oil and provides hydraulic torque any change in the torque input to the transmission. The
multiplication when required. The compound planetary vacuum modulator transmits this signal to the pressure
gear set produces three forward speeds and reverse. regulator for line pressure control, to the 1 - 2 accumula
The 3 -element torque converter consists of a pump or tor valve, and to the shift valves so that all torque re
driving member, a turbine or driven member, and a sta quirements of the transmission are met and smooth
tor assembly. The stator is mounted on a one-way roller shifts are obtained at all throttle openings.
clutch which will allow the stator to turn clockwise but The detent solenoid is activated by an electric switch
not counterclockwise. on the carburetor. When the throttle is fully opened, the
The torque converter housing is filled with oil and is switch on the carburetor is closed, activating the detent
attached to the engine crankshaft by a flex plate and solenoid and causing the transmission to downshift for
always rotates at engine speed. The converter pump is passing speeds.
an integral part of the converter housing, therefore the The selector quadrant has six selector positions: P,
pump blades, rotating at engine speed, set the oil within R, N, D,L2, L I.
the converter into motion and direct it to the turbine, P. - Park position positively locks the output shaft to
causing the turbine to rotate. the transmission case by means of a locking pawl
As the oil passes through the turbine it is traveling in to prevent the vehicle from rolling in either di
such a direction that if it were not re-directed by the rection. The engine may be started in Park
stator it would hit the rear of the converter pump blades position.
and impede its pumping action. So at low turbine speeds, R. - Reverse enables the vehicle to be operated in a
the oil is re-directed by the stator to the converter pump reverse direction.
in such a manner that it actually assists the converter N. - Neutral position enables the engine to be started
pump to deliver power or multiply engine torque. and run without driving the vehicle.
As turbine speed increases, the direction of the oil D. - Drive Range is used for all normal driving condi
leaving the turbine changes and flows against the rear tions and maximum economy. Drive Range has
side of the stator vanes in a clockwise direction. Since three gear ratios, from the starting ratio to direct
the stator is now impeding the smooth flow of oil, its rol drive. Detent downshifts are available by de
ler clutch releases and it revolves freely on its shaft. pressing the accelerator to the floor.
Once the stator becomes inactive, there is no further L2. - L2 Range has the same starting ratio as Drive
multiplication of engine torque within the converter. At Range, but prevents the transmission from shifting
this point, the converter is merely acting as a fluid coup above second speed to retain second speed accel
ling as both the converter pump and turbine are being eration when extra performance is desired. L2
driven at approximately the same speed - or at a one-to- Range can also be used for engine braking. L2
one ratio. Range can be selected at any vehicle speed, and
A hydraulic system pressurized by a gear type pump the transmission will shift to second gear and re
provides the working pressure required to operate the main in second until the vehicle speed or the
friction elements and automatic controls. throttle are changed to obtain first gear operation
External control connections to transmission are: in the same manner as in D Range.
L I. - LI Range can be selected at any vehicle speed, and It is very important that any communication concerning
the transmission will shift to second gear and re the Turbo Hydra-Matic always contain the transmission
main in second until vehicle speed is reduced to serial number and that all transmission parts returned to
approximately 40 MPH, depending on axle ratio. Chevrolet Motor Division always be tagged with the
LI Range position prevents the transmission from transmission serial number.
shifting out of first gear.
8. Loosen the adjustment swivel at the mast jacket, and 12. When properly adjusted the following conditions must
rotate the transmission lever so that it contacts the be met by manual operation of the steering column
drive stop in the steering column. shift lever:
9. Tighten the swivel and recheck the adjustment. See a. From reverse to drive position travel, the trans
Steps 2 and 6 . mission detent feel must be noted and related to
10. Readjust indicator needle if necessary to agree with indicated position on dial.
the transmission detent positions. See Section 9. b. When in drive and reverse positions, pull lever
11. Readjust neutral safety switch if necessary to pro rearward (towards steering wheel) and then re
vide the correct relationship to the transmission lease. It must drop back into position with no
detent positions. See Section 12. restrictions.
VIEW B
VIEW A
NEUTRAL SAFETY SWITCH ADJUSTMENT 5. Remove the governor pipes and manual valve from
control valve body.
The neutral safety switch must be adjusted so that the
car will start in the park or neutral position, but will not Installation
start in the other positions. For replacement refer to Installation of the control valve body is the reverse of
Section 12 of this Manual. the removal.
TRANSMISSION REPLACEMENT
Before raising the car, disconnect the battery and re 9. Remove converter to flywheel bolts.
lease the parking brake. 10. Loosen exhaust pipe to manifold bolts approximately
1. Remove propeller shaft. 1/4 inch, and lower transmission until jack is barely
2. Disconnect speedometer cable, electrical lead to supporting it.
case connector, vacuum line at modulator, and oil 11. Remove transmission to engine mounting bolts and
cooler pipes. remove oil filler tube at transmission.
3. Disconnect shift control linkage. 12. Raise transmission to its normal position, support
4. Support transmission with suitable transmission engine with jack and slide transmission rearward
jack. from engine and lower it away from vehicle.
5. Disconnect rear mount from frame crossmember.
CAUTION: Use converter holding Tool J-5384
6 . Remove two bolts at each end of frame crossmember
when lowering transmission or keep rear of
and remove crossmember.
transmission lower than front so as not to lose
7. Remove oil cooler lines, vacuum modulator line,
converter.
speedo cable, and detent solenoid connector wire at
transmission. The installation of the transmission is the reverse of
8 . Remove converter under pan. the removal.
Always check the oil level before road testing. Oil Before attempting to correct an oil leak, the actual
must be visible on dip stick prior to operating the vehi source of the leak must be determined. In many cases
\
the source of the leak can be deceiving due to "wind d. Foreign material between pump and case, or be
flow" around the engine and transmission. tween pump cover and body.
The suspected area should be wiped clean of all oil e. Case - porous, pump face improperly machined.
before inspecting for the source of the leak. Red dye is f. Pump - shy of stock on mounting faces, porous
used in the transmission oil at the assembly plant and casting.
will indicate if the oil leak is from the transmission.
The use of a "black light"* to identify the oil at the CA Si POROSITY—REPAIR
source of leak is also helpful. Comparing the oil from
the leak to that on the engine or transmission dip stick Transmission leaks caused by aluminum case porosity
(when viewed by black light) will determine the source of have been successfully repaired with the transmission in
the leak. the vehicle by using the following procedure.
Oil leaks around the engine and transmission are gen 1. Road test and bring the transmission to operating
erally carried toward the rear of the car by the air temperature.
stream. For example, a transmission "oil filler tube 2. Raise the car and, with the engine running, locate the
to case leak" will sometimes appear as a leak at the rear source of the oil leak. Check for leaks in all operat
of the transmission. In determining the source of an oil ing leaks.
leak it is most helpful to keep the engine running.
NOTE: The use of a m irror will be helpful in
POSSIBLE POINTS OF OIL LEAKS finding leaks.
3. Shut off engine and thoroughly clean area with a sol
1. TRANSMISSION OIL PAN LEAK vent and air dry.
a. Attaching bolts not correctly torqued. 4. Using the instruction of the manufacturer, mix a
b. Improperly installed or damaged pan gasket. sufficient amount of epoxy cement, part #1360016, to
c. Oil pan gasket mounting face not flat. make the repair.
2. REAR EXTENSION LEAK 5. While the transmission is still hot, apply the epoxy
a. Attaching bolts not correctly torqued. to the area, making certain that the area is fully
b. Rear seal assembly - damaged or improperly covered.
installed. 6 . Allow epoxy cement to dry for three hours and re
c. Gasket seal - (extension to case) damaged or im test for leaks, as outlined in Steps 1 and 2.
properly installed.
d. Porous casting. OH. PRESSURE CHECK
3. CASE LEAK
a. F iller pipe "O" ring seal damaged or missing; With Vehicle Stationary
misposition of filler pipe bracket to engine -
"loading" one side of "O" ring. Transmission oil pressure gauge and engine tachom
b. Modulator assembly "O" ring seal - damaged or eter should be connected and the oil pressures should
improperly installed. check as follows:
c. Governor cover, gasket and bolts - damaged, 1. Pressures indicated below are at 0 output speed with
loose; case face leak. the vacuum modulator tube disconnected and with
d. Speedo gear - "O" ring damaged. engine at 1 2 0 0 rpm.
e. Manual shaft seal - damaged, improperly
installed. Approximate Drive Ll
f. Line pressure tap plug - stripped, shy sealer Altitude of Check Neutral or
compound. (Ft. above seal level) Park L2 Reverse
g. Parking pawl shaft cup plug - damaged, improp
erly installed. 0 150 150 244
h. Vent pipe (refer to Item 5). 2 ,0 0 0 150 150 233
i. Porous case. 4,000 145 150 222
4. FRONT END LEAK 6 ,0 0 0 138 150 212
a. Front seal - damaged (check converter pack for 8 ,0 0 0 132 150 203
nicks, etc., also for pump bushing moved for 1 0 ,0 0 0 126 150 194
ward); garter spring missing from pump to con 1 2 ,0 0 0 121 150 186
verter seal. 14,000 116 150 178
b. Pump attaching bolts and seals - damaged, m iss
ing, bolts loose. 2. Pressures indicated below are with the vacuum tube
c. Converter - leak in weld. connected for normal modulator operation, and with
d. Pump "O" ring seal - damaged. (Also check the engine at 1 2 0 0 rpm.
pump groove and case bore).
NOTE: Pressures are not significantly af
e. Porous casting (pump or case).
fected by altitude or barometric pressure when
5. OIL COMES OUT VENT PIPE
the vacuum tube is connected.
a. Transmission over-filled.
b. Water in oil. Drive, Neutral, Park L l or L2 Reverse
c. Pump to case gasket mispositioned. 70 150 107
*A "Black Light" testing unit may be obtained from several different service tool suppliers.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Fig. 2ST - C hevrolet Truck (exc. C h evy Van) Three-Speed Transmission Special Tools
1. J-0936 (J-936) - C lutch G e a r Bearing Remover 6. J-5154A (J-5154) - Rear Bearing Retainer Seal Installer
2. J-0933 (J-933) - C lutch G e a r Bearing Retainer W rench 7. J-0932 (J-932) - Synchronizer Ring Retaining Spring Remover and
3. J-0937 (J-937) - C lutch G e a r and Bearing Puller Replacer
4. J-5750 - Transmission Holding Fixture 8. J-1126 - Transmission G u id e Pins
5. J-5778 - Extension Housing Bushing Remover and Installer 9. J -5777 - Countergear Assembly Tool
CLUTCHES AND TRANSMISSIONS 7-53
1. J-4869 - Speedometer G e a r Remover and Replacer Set 5. J-5589 - Countershaft Assembly Tool
2. J- 1 1 2 6 - Transmission G u id e Pins 6. J-8039 - (K M O 410) - Snap Ring Pliers
3. J-5590 - Transmission Front Bearing Installer 7. J-5750 - Transmission Holding Fixture
4. j-5154 - Rear Bearing Retainer Seal Installer
1. J-2680 - Reverse Id ler G e a r Bushing Staking Tool 9. J —1453 - Clutch G e a r Bearing Replacer
2. J- 1 6 1 9 - Transmission Mainshaft Bearing Puller 10. J-2228 - Clutch G e a r Bearing Remover Plate
3. J-8109 (K-353) - G e a r Shift Lever Remover and Replacer 11. J-1614 - Reverse Idler G e a r Bushing Remover and Replacer
4. J-8107 (TR-278-R) - Countershaft Rear Bearing Remover 12. J —1488 - Rear Bearing Retainer O il Seal Driver
5. J-1126 - Transmission G u id e Pin Set (2) 13. J-4869 - Speedometer G e a r Replacer
6. J —2671 - Third Speed G e a r Bushing Installer 14. J-0358 ( J —358-1) - Press Plate Holder
7. J-7785 - O il Seal Installer 15. J-2668 - Reverse Idler G e a r Bushing Reamer (1 .1 2 8 ")
8. J-2667 - M ainshaft and Bearing Assembly Remover and Replacer (10-30 M odels)
(10-30 M odels)
1. J-8109 (K-353) - G ea rsh ift Lever Remover 3. J-8108 (K-342) - C lutch G e a r Bearing 6. J-6416 - Rear Bearing Retainer Seal Installer
and Replacer Replacer 7. J - l 126 - Transmission G u id e Pins
2. J-2228 - C lutch G e a r Bearing Remover 4. J-0358 - Press Plate Holder 8. J-1619 - Transmission M ainshaft Bearing
Plate 5. J-6382 - Reverse Idler Shaft Remover Pu ller
1. J- 6 1 16-01 Rear U nit Holding Fixture 15. J-5384 Converter Holding Strap
2. J-8092 D river Handle 16. J- 2 1 465-01 Bushing Tool Set
3. J —21359 Pump O il Seal Installer 17. J - 2 1465-5 Part of Bushing Too Set
4. J -21364 Holding Fixture Adapter (Used w ith J- 6 1 16-01 18. J - 2 1465-3 Part o f Bushing Too Set
Fixture) 19. J-21465-2 Part of Bushing Too Set
5. J-2619 Slid e Hammer (Used w ith 2619-4 Adapter and 20. J - 2 1465-1 Part o f Bushing Too Set
Remover Tools J- 2 1 465-01) 21. J - 2 1465-17 Part of Bushing Too Set
6. J-5154 Extension O il Seal Installer 22. J- 2 1465-8 Part of Bushing Too Set
7. J-6585 Slid e Hammer W eights 23. J- 2 1 465-13 Part o f Bushing Too Set
8. J-9539 S lid e Hammer Bolts (3/8 - 16 Threads) 24. J- 2 1465-6 Part of Bushing Too Set
9. J-5590 Speedo G e a r Installer 25. J- 2 1 465-15 Part of Bushing Too Set
10. J -21867 Pressure G auge and Hose 26. J- 2 1465-16 Part of Bushing Too Set
11. J - 2 1370-6 Rear Band A p ply Fixture 27. J- 2 1 465-9 Part of Bushing Too Set
12. J-21370-5 Rear Band A p ply Pin 28. J- 2 1 465-10 Part o f Bushing Too Set
13. J - 2 1795-1 G e a r Unit Assembly Holding Tool 29. J-22182 Extension Bushing Remover and Installer
14. J- 2 1 795-2 Part of Above Holding Tool (N o t Illustrated)
1. J-8763 Transmission Holding Fixture 9. J - 2 1363 Seal Protector - Intermediate C lutch - Inner
2. J-3289-14 Holding Fixture Base 10. J —21409 Seal Protector - Forward Clutch - O uter
3. J - 2 1427-1 Speedo G e a r Remover 11. J-21664 Clutch Spring Compressor Adapter Ring
4. J-9539 Slid e Hammer Bolts (3/8" - 16 Threads) 12. J-4670 Clutch Spring Compressor
5. J-8105 Speedo G e a r Remover Puller 13. J-8059 Snap Ring Pliers
6. J - 2 1885 Accum ulator Piston Installer 14. J-5586 Snap Ring Pliers
7. J - 2 1369 C onverter Pressure Check Fixture 15. J-5403 Snap Ring Pliers
8. J - 2 1362 Seal Protector - Forward and D irect C lutch - Inner 16. J —1313 Torque W rench 0-140 Ft. Lbs.
FUEL TANK
INDEX
Page Page
General Description............... 8-1 Filler Neck Assembly - Chevy V a n ........................... 8-4
Service O p e ra t io n s ............... 8-1 Fuel Line Service ...................................................... 8-5
Draining T a n k .................. 8-1 Fuel F i l t e r .................................................................. 8-5
Gauge Unit or Fuel Strainer 8-2 Special Tools .................................................................. 8-8
Fuel Tank........................... 8-2
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
All cab model trucks (except Tilt Cabs) have a 21 gal Fuel tank filler caps and neck assemblies conform to
lon capacity (approx.) fuel tank mounted behind the seat the latest SAE Standards for filler caps and related filler
within the cab. The tank is constructed of two steel neck cams. These units are not directly interchangeable
sections, seam welded together. The filler neck extends with past models for service replacement.
through the left side of the cab, at a convenient height Upper and lower filler necks vary as to size, length and
from the ground. Exceptional stiffness is secured by the shape, depending on model requirements. These necks
combination of the welded flanges and depressed ribs in are treated so that rust will not form and get into the
both the front and rear halves. The tank is bolted to the fuel system. Lower filler necks are first bolted or riv
rear of the cab and to the floor panel. eted to the tank except on cab models, and then sweat
Frame mounted tanks are located on the right side of soldered in place to eliminate any possibility of leakage
the chassis and lay lengthwise outside the frame side rail at this point.
on Forward Control, 1-1/2, and 2 ton models. All tanks are equipped with a vented filler neck cap.
On 1 ton models, the above information also applies All 40 through 60 Series trucks incorporate a pressure
except that the tank is mounted on the outside of the left relief valve which reduces fire hazard by eliminating an
side frame rail. A strong mounting of two metal straps open vent to the atmosphere and preventing spillage in
anchor these tanks to mounting brackets which are bolted case of overturn.
to the frame side member. The fuel pickup pipe is built integrally with the tank
On 1/2 and 3/4 ton conventional and 4-wheel drive gauge unit, located at the top of the tank in line with
models the tank is located to the rear of the axle and be safety recommendations. A large area, fine-mesh screen
tween the side rails and envelopes the forward edge of the located on the bottom of the fuel pickup pipe. This screen
spare tire. These tanks are supported by a single steel is designed to prevent the entrance of dirt or water into
strap which is held at either end by a hook into the side the fuel system, and operates with a self-cleaning action.
rail. Metal to metal contact between tank and brackets Frame mounted tanks consist of an upper and lower
or straps is prevented by the use of anti-squeak material. half, each with a wide flange and baffles which are
The Chevy Van Fuel Tank is 20 gallon capacity (ap pressed into the tank halves. The two tank sections are
proximate), with left hand side fill and is mounted between seam welded at the flange around the entire tank to a s
the frame rails behind the rear axle. The tank is held in sure leakproof construction. Exceptional stiffness is
place by two metal straps attached individually to the secured by the combination of the welded flanges and de
underbody at each end. The straps hinge at the forward pressed ribs in both upper and lower tank sections. Baf
end and secure the tank at the rear with an adjustable bolt fle plates are incorporated to provide additional stiffness
and nut assembly (fig. 6 ). and to prevent the surging of gasoline within the tank.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
DRAINING THE TANK less, I.D. is not recommended as it is quite dif
ficult to erect and maintain a siphon using this
The following procedure is <recommended for con- method with a larger hose.
•structing a siphon hose and draining the tank: 2. Insert a small nipple (at least 1/8" larger O.D. than
1. Obtain an 8 to 10 foot length of 3/8", or slightly less, the hose I.D.) into opposite end of hose from slit.
I.D. hose and cut a flap type slit 18" from one end. 3. Lift or jack rear of vehicle so that tank is at least
See Figure 1. one foot higher than normal.
4. Insert nipple end of hose into tank until it strikes
NOTE: Hose with larger than 3/8", or slightly bottom.
FUEL TANK
5. With the opposite end of the hose in a suitable con Removal and Installation—
tainer, insert an air hose into the flap type slit and Cab Mounted Tanks (Fig. 2)
trigger the flow of fuel. 1. Remove front seat and back cushions.
Installation
The fuel lines should be inspected occasionally for Frame mounted fuel filters are standard equipment on
leaks, kinks or dents. If evidence of dirt is found in the P20-30, T40 and C-M -S-T 50-60 series vehicles. The
carburetor, fuel pump or on a disassembly, the lines fuel filter element should be replaced at the recom
should be disconnected and blown out. Check the fuel mended mileage intervals outlined in Section 0, this
strainer in the tank for damage or omission. manual. Typical installation is shown in Figures 7 and 8 .
All fuel lines are 5/16" diameter tubing except: L - 6
and 283 cu. in. engines equipped with an optional frame
FUEL LINE RETAINER CLIP
mounted fuel filter; 327 and 366 cu. in. V - 8 engines; and
all diesel engine models. Joints must be of the double-
Removal and Installation
lap flare type, constructed as shown in Section 5 of this
manual. If fuel pipes and retainer clips are removed, Tool
CAUTION: Always completely drain gasoline J-7777 should be used to install new retainer clips (fig.
from fuel tank and all fuel lines if vehicle is to 9). After removal of the old clip from the frame, posi
be stored for any appreciable length of time. tion the new clip in the location of the old clip. Index the
This precaution will prevent gum formation and "blind rivet” and press hard (hand pressure should do) to
resultant improper engine performance. expand rivet.
VIEW B
EXHAUST SYSTEM
SPECIAL TOOLS
TAPER
I
TO 1 / 2 "
1. J-8950 Fuel Tank G auge Unit Spanner 2. J -7777 Fuel Line C lip Installer
STANDARD STEERING
INDEX
Page Page
General D e s c rip tio n ......................................................... 9-1 Intermediate Steering Shaft - Models with
Maintenance and A djustm ents.......................................... 9-1 Splined Slip Joint......................................................... ...9-5
L u b ricatio n ...................................................................... 9-1 Steering Gear - Except Chevy Van and P20-30 . . . . 9-5
Adjustments...................................................................... 9-1 Steering Gear - P20-30 ................................................ ...9-6
Steering G e a r ............................................................... 9-1 Steering Gear - Chevy V a n .......................................... ...9-6
Steering Gear High Point Centering Sector Shaft Oil Seal R ep lacem en t.............................. ...9-7
C-P10, C20-30 ......................................................... 9-2 Mast Jacket - Except Tilt Cab M o d els........................ ...9-7
Steering Wheel A lig n m e n t.......................................... 9-3 Mast Jacket - Tilt Cab M o d e ls .................................... ...9-10
Mast Jacket Lower Bearing A d ju stm en t.................. 9-3 Steering L in k a g e ............................................................... ...9-10
Shifter Tube A djustm ent............................................. 9-3 Tie R o d ........................................................................... ...9-10
Component Replacement and R e p a i r s .............................. 9-4 Relay Rod - C-P10, C20-30 .......................................... ...9-11
Steering W h e e l ............................................................... 9-4 Idler Arm - C-P10, C20-30 .......................................... ...9-11
Mast Jacket Upper B e a r i n g .......................................... 9-4 Pitman A r m ..................................................................... ...9-11
Steering Coupling............................................................ 9-4 Steering Connecting R o d ................................................ ...9-12
Flexible Joint T y p e ................................................... 9-4 Steering A r m s ............................................................... .. 9-12
Universal Joint T y p e ................................................... 9-5
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The steering gear used on all truck models is of the transmitted to the tie rods through a relay rod connected
recirculating ball type and the service procedures are to the pitman arm on the left and an idler arm on the
basically the same for all units. right. All other models use a single adjustable tie rod,
Two types of steering linkages are used. C-P10 and connecting the left and right steering arms. Steering
C20-30 series units have an adjustable tie rod connected effort is relayed to the left steering arm, from the pit
to the steering arm at each wheel. Steering effort is man arm, by a non-adjustable connecting rod.
CAUTION: Do not turn steering wheel hard juster screw. F irst turn the steering wheel gently
against stops when steering relay rod is dis from one stop all the way to the other, carefully
connected as damage to ball guides may result. counting the total number of turns. Then turn wheel
4. Using an inch pound torque wrench and socket on back exactly half way, to center position. Turn lash
steering wheel nut, measure torque required to keep adjuster screw clockwise to take out all lash in gear
the wheel in motion. If torque does not lie within teeth, and tighten locknut. Check torque at steering
limits given in specifications section, worm bearing wheel, taking highest reading as wheel is turned
preload adjustment is necessary. through center position. See Specifications for prop
5. To adjust worm bearings, loosen worm bearing ad er sector lash adjustment. Readjust if necessary to
juster locknut and turn worm bearing adjuster shown obtain proper torque.
in Figure 3 until there is no perceptible end play in NOTE: If maximum specification is exceeded,
worm. Check torque at steering wheel, readjusting turn lash adjuster screw counterclockwise, then
if necessary to obtain proper torque. Tighten lock- come up on adjustment by turning the adjuster in
nut and recheck torque. If the gear feels "lumpy” a clockwise motion.
after adjustment of worm bearings, there is probably
damage in the bearings due to severe impact or to 7. Tighten locknut then recheck torque as it must lie
improper adjustment and the gear must be disas between specified limits.
8 . On 10, 20 and 30 Series trucks reassemble pitman
sembled for replacement of damaged parts.
6 . After proper adjustment of worm is obtained, and all
arm to sector shaft, lining up marks made on dis
mounting bolts securely tightened, adjust lash ad- assembly. Torque nut to specifications. On 40, 50
and 60 Series trucks assemble steering connecting
rod to pitman arm.
9. Install horn cap or ornament and connect horn wire
at chassis connector.
DO N O T M ISA LIG N
M ORE THAN O N E
INCH FROM VERTICAL
number of turns or in different directions will from center (figs. 4 & 5), remove steering wheel and
disturb the toe-in setting of the wheels. reposition.
4. R e a d j u s t toe-in as outlined in Section 3 (if
necessary). Mast Jacket Lower Bearing Adjustment
1. Loosen clamp on steering shaft.
Steering Wheel Alignment 2. Adjust clamp to allow steering shaft end play indi
NOTE: On C-P10-C20-30 series units check cated in specifications section.
steering gear for high point centering before NOTE: On 10, 20 and 30 Series trucks check
checking steering wheel alignment. distance from top edge of washer to lower edge
1. Set wheels in straight ahead position by driving of bearing (fig. 6 ).
vehicle a short distance. 3. Tighten clamp bolt.
2. Note steering wheel position. If off more than 1 inch
Shifter Tube Adjustment
3-Speed Transimission
1. Loosen adjusting ring attaching screws and clamp
bolt.
2. Rotate adjusting ring to give .005" end play between
adjusting ring and first and reverse shifter lever
(fig. 7).
3. Tighten attaching screws and clamp bolt.
With Automatic Transmission mum to .060" maximum between the adjusting ring and
shift lever. Also, “ C ” type clamp is used in place of the
The correct end play for the shift tube is .020" mini- hose type at the adjusting ring.
NOTE: This is a special bolt and will require steering gear wormshaft.
a 12 pt. socket or box wrench. 2. On tilt cab models, remove plate-to-floor panel
2. Tap with a soft mallet to remove coupling from screws.
wormshaft. The coupling is splined to the steering 3. From the upper yoke of the universal joint, remove
wormshaft. the two snap rings, then remove the two yoke bush
3. Remove the two retaining nuts, bolts, reinforce ings and cork washers, by tapping yoke shaft with
ments, and lock washers. Separate the lower "sp lit- plastic mallet.
clamp” and, remove the wafer type coupling and 4. Move the center cross as necessary, to separate the
two locking pins. upper and lower portions of the coupling.
5. Remove the coupling from the vehicle.
6 . Disassemble lower portion of coupling on bench, by
Installation
repeating Steps 3 and 4.
1. If disassembled, first set the flexible coupling in
place, then match up the large locking pin with the Installation
large slot in the flange. Be sure pins are centered
in flange slots. Install and tighten the attaching 1. Position center cross in lower yoke of coupling.
bolts, nuts, washers and retainers. Torque to 20 2. Position bushing and new cork washer on center
ft. lb. cross. Install retaining snap ring.
2. Align the "sp lit-clam p '’ to the steering gear worm 3. Place a second bushing and new cork washer on
shaft and install the coupling. center cross and retain with snap ring.
3. Install the special bolt into the clamp and tighten. 4. With cross installed in lower yoke, install coupling
in vehicle by assembling lower yoke to upper yoke as
Universal Joint Type (Fig. 10) outlined in Steps 2 and 3.
5. Assemble coupling to steering gear wormshaft align
NOTE: Some models use an intermediate shaft ing mark on wormshaft with mark on steering shaft.
with a splined slip joint. On these models, 6 . Install clamp bolt nut and washer and tighten.
lowering the steering gear or steering column 7. On tilt cab models secure floor pan seal plate to
is not necessary. Separate the upper coupling floor pan.
as described below, remove intermediate shaft
and coupling and disassemble lower coupling on Intermediate Steering Shaft Models with Splined
bench.
Slip Joint (Fig. 10)
Removal Removal and Installation
1. After making steering shaft to worm shaft relation Remove and install as outlined under "Steering
ship remove bolt, nut and washer from clamp on Coupling—Universal Joint Type".
Disassembly
1. With shaft on bench straighten tangs on dust cap and
slide yoke shaft out of yoke tube.
2. Remove felt washer dust cap and plastic washer.
Discard felt washer.
3. On Tilt Cab models, remove toe panel seal and seal
plate from shaft.
Assembly
1. On tilt cab models, install toe panel seal and seal
plate on yoke shaft.
2. Position dust cap, plastic washer, and new felt
washer on yoke shaft.
3. Aligning the arrow on the yoke shaft with the arrow
on the yoke tube, insert yoke shaft into yoke tube.
4. Push plastic washer, felt washer and dust cap into
position, on end of yoke tube, and bend tangs of dust
cap down against yoke tube.
Installation
1. With steering gear fully assembled, slip mast jacket
over steering shaft and secure with clamp.
2. From inside the vehicle, position steering gear on
frame rail and loosely assemble mast jacket to dash
panel clamp.
3. Install steering gear to frame rail mounting bolts
and tighten.
4. Install pitman arm to sector shaft and tighten nut to
specifications.
5. Tighten mast jacket to dash panel support bolts.
6 . Install floor panel at mast jacket.
7. Locate and secure mast jacket to floor pan seal.
8 . Install steering wheel.
Installation
1. When reinstalling steering gear assembly after re
placement of worm shaft, determine the correct mid
position of the worm shaft as follows:
a. Turn the shaft all the way through its travel,
counting the number of turns.
b. Turn the shaft back one-half the total number of
turns. The gear should now be on high point.
NOTE: On production C-P10-C 20-30 Series
worm shafts, this mark will coincide with the
mark already on the shaft.
2. Position steering gear in place on frame, at the
same time sliding the worm shaft into the flexible or
universal joint coupling. Check that the steering
wheel is in the straight ahead position.
3. Attach and tighten mounting bolts and tighten bolt at
the coupling or universal joint.
4. Install pitman arm.
Removal
1. Remove steering wheel.
2. Loosen and pull mast jacket seal away from floor
pan.
3. Remove floor pan from around mast jacket.
4. Remove pitman arm from steering gear.
5. Remove steering gear to frame mounting bolts.
lower end of mast jacket through opening in firewall, Fig. 16—Medium and H eavy Duty Mast Ja c k e t
guiding the steering coupling onto the steering gear Mounting (T y p ica l)
wormshaft.
2. Loosely install mast jacket support clamp at dash 6 . Install seal at firewall and reconnect parking brake
panel and, on light-duty models, at firewall. cable if necessary.
3. Adjust position of mast jacket and tighten clamps at 7. Adjust lower mast jacket bearing as outlined under
steering gear and mast jacket supports. Maintenance and Adjustments.
4. On 3-speed and automatic transmission models, con 8 . Connect wiring.
nect transmission shift linkage.
Disassembly—10-20-30 Series (Fig. 17)
5. On 10, 20, and 30 series trucks install parking brake
support and lever assembly, and trim plate at dash NOTE: For units without shifter tube, omit
panel. Steps 1, 8, 9, 10 and 11.
1. Slide rubber grommet back from shift lever support 3. Place felt seal on shifter tube. Push in place up to
housing, drive out selector lever pivot pin and re spring.
move shift lever. 4. Insert shifter tube into mast jacket.
2. Remove steering wheel retaining nut and washer 5. On 3-speed models;
from shaft. Temporarily install spacer, low and reverse shifter
3. Slide steering shaft from mast jacket and remove lever and lower adjusting ring. Place a block of
back-up lamp switch. wood on top of adjusting ring and tap until shifter
4. Remove three locking screws from the directional tube bottoms. Remove spacer, low and reverse shift
signal housing, rotate the housing and remove hous lever and adjusting ring.
ing assembly.
5. Remove spacer and thrust washer from shifter lever NOTE: Bearing must be seated against the
housing and remove housing. three locating tabs.
6 . Remove bushing and bushing seat from upper end of
mast jacket. On automatic transmission models;
7. Remove bolt and screws from adjusting ring clamp at Align three holes in selector (detent) plate with
lower end of mast jacket and remove clamp lower three holes in bottom of mast jacket. Position
bearing and adjusting ring. clamping ring, align holes and install the three bolts.
8 . On 3-speed models, also remove first and reverse 6 . On 3-speed models;
shift lever and spacer. Lubricate and install spacer, low and reverse shifter
9. On automatic transmission models, remove 3 screws lever (tang on lever must be towards top of mast
from selector plate clamping ring. jacket).
10. Place mast jacket upright on floor while supporting 7. Install lower adjusting ring with clamp and attaching
with two pieces of wood. Push down on shift lever screws.
with foot and place block of wood on upper end of 8 . Position bushing seat and bushing on upper end of
tube. Tap on block to remove tube and withdraw from mast jacket.
mast jacket assembly. 9. Lubriplate inner diameter of shifter lever support
housing and install on upper end of mast jacket
NOTE: In some tolerance stack-up cases it
assembly, fitting keyway in housing over key on
may be necessary to use a press. Be careful not shifter tube.
to damage shifter tube or mast jacket. 10. Position spacer and thrust washer onto upper end of
11. Remove felt seal from shifter tube. shifter housing.
12. Remove firewall clamp and seal and dash panel seal 11. Install directional signal switch and housing assem
from mast jacket. bly, feeding wires through gear shift lever support
housing. Secure with three attaching screws.
Assembly (Fig. 17) 12. Adjust shifter tube as outlined under Shifter Tube
Adjustment.
NOTE: For units without shifter tube omit
13. Position clamp, washer, spring and lower mast
Steps 3, 4, 5, 6 , and 12.
jacket bearing on steering shaft, and insert shaft
1. Install dash panel seal, firewall seal and clamp onto into mast jacket from bottom.
mast jacket. 14. Install nut and washer on steering wheel end of
2. Lubricate all bearing surfaces on shift tube. steering shaft to hold the shaft in position.
Installation
1. With mast jacket completely assembled and inter
mediate steering shaft yoke tube assembled to upper
steering shaft, place assembly in vehicle and assem
ble intermediate shaft yoke tube to yoke shaft align
ing the arrows.
2. Hold mast jacket in position at dash panel and
assemble support clamps.
3. Push felt washer, plastic washer and dust cap into
position and secure by bending tabs of dust cap
against yoke tube.
4. Connect wiring harness to mast jacket.
TIE ROD
Removal
1. Remove cotter pins from ball studs and remove cas
tellated nuts.
2. To remove outer ball stud, tap on steering arm at
Disassembly—40-50-60 Series (Fig. 18)
tie rod end with a hammer while using a heavy ham
1. Loosen lower bearing clamp, push steering shaft mer or sim ilar tool as a backing (fig. 23). If neces
slightly upward and remove snap ring retainer at sary pull downward on tie rod to remove from
upper mast jacket bearing. steering arm.
2. Slide steering shaft out of mast jacket from bottom, On C-P10 and C20-30 series, remove inner ball
along with lower bearing clamp, seal spring and stud from relay rod using same procedure as des
bearing seat. cribed in Step 2.
3. Loosen turn signal switch retaining screws and re To remove tie rod ends from tie rod loosen clamp
move turn signal housing and switch assembly. bolts and unscrew end assemblies.
Installation
Assembly (Fig. 18) 1. If the tie rod ends were removed, lubricate the tie
1. Install turn signal switch and housing assembly on rod threads with EP Chassis lube and install ends on
upper end of mast jacket. tie rod making sure both ends are threaded an equal
2. Position clamp, seal, spring, lower bearing and distance from the tie rod.
lower bearing on steering shaft. 2. Make sure that threads on ball studs and in ball stud
nuts are perfectly clean and smooth. Install neoprene
NOTE: Lubricate seal with a silicone grease. seals on ball studs.
3. Carefully insert steering shaft into mast jacket from
bottom. NOTE: If threads are not clean and smooth,
4. Install upper mast jacket bearing retainer (snap ring) ball studs may turn in tie rod ends when
in groove in steering shaft. attempting to tighten nut.
5. Adjust lower mast jacket bearing as outlined under
Maintenance and Adjustments. 3. Install ball studs in steering arms and relay rod.
I
STEERING 9-11
4. Install ball stud nut, tighten and install cotter pins. Fig. 22— K10-20 Steering Linkage
Lubricate tie rod ends.
5. Adjust toe-in as described in Section 3. 3. Detach relay rod from pitman arm. Shift steering
linkage as required to free pitman arm from relay
NOTE: Before locking clamp bolts on the rods, rod.
make sure that the tie rod ends are in align 4. Remove cotter pin and nut from idler arm and re
ment with their ball studs (each ball joint is in move relay rod from idler arm.
the center of its travel). If the tie rod is not in Installation
alignment with the studs, binding will result.
Also, the slit in the tie rod must be in alignment 1. Install relay rod to idler arm, making certain idler
with the slot in the clamp and, on C-P10 and stud seal is in place, then install and tighten nut to
C20-30 series, facing foreward. specifications. Advance nut just enough to align
castellation with cotter pin hole and install pin.
RELAY ROD—C-Pl 0 and C20-30 2. Raise end of rod and install on pitman arm. Secure
Removal with nut and cotter pin.
1. Remove inner ends of tie rods from relay rod as 3. Install tie rod ends to relay rod as previously de
described under Tie Rod - Removal. scribed under Tie Rods. Lubricate tie rod ends.
2. Remove cotter pin and nut from relay rod ball stud 4. Adjust toe-in (see Section 3) and align steering wheel
attachment at pitman arm. as described previously in this section under Steer
ing Wheel Alignment and High Point Centering.
Installation
1. Position idler arm on frame and install mounting
bolts (with special plain washers under heads); tight
ening nuts to specifications.
2. Install relay rod to idler arm, making certain seal is
on stud, and install and tighten nut to specifications.
3. Install cotter pin and secure.
PITMAN ARM
Removal
1. Remove cotter pin from pitman arm ball stud and
remove nut.
2. Remove relay rod from ball stud by tapping on side
of rod or arm in which the stud mounts with a ham
Fig . 2 1 - 4 0 -5 0 -6 0 Series Steering Linkage - Typ ical mer while using a heavy hammer or similar tool as
STEERING ARMS
If, through collision or other damage, it becomes nec
essary to remove and replace either steering arm,
proceed as follows:
Rem oval
Fig. 23—B a ll Stud Removal - Typical
1. Remove tie rod and, on models so equipped, steering
connecting rod, from steering arm as outlined in
a backing (fig. 23). Pull on linkage to remove from
this section.
stud.
2. Remove front wheel, hub and brake drum as a unit by
3. Remove pitman arm nut from sector shaft or clamp
removing hub cap and dust cap, cotter pin from spin
bolt from pitman arm, and mark relation of arm
dle nut and the spindle nut. Pull assembly toward
position to shaft.
outside of vehicle. If removal is difficult, it may be
4. Remove pitman arm, using Tool J-5504 for Chevy
necessary to back off brake adjustment to increase
Van, J-6632 or J-5504 for 10-20-30 Series, and
brake shoe-to-drum clearance; see Hydraulic Brake
J-3186 for 40-50-60 Series.
Adjustment, Sec. 5.
Installation 3. With wheel and drum assembly removed, steering
arm retaining bolt heads are accessible and removal
1. Install pitman arm on sector shaft, lining up the
of steering arm from vehicle may be accomplished
marks made upon removal.
by removing retaining nuts.
NOTE: If a clamp type pitman arm is used,
spread the pitman arm just enough, with a wedge, Installation
to slip arm on to sector shaft. Do not spread 1. Place steering arm in position on vehicle and install
pitman arm excessively or damage to arm will
retaining bolts. Note that longer bolt is installed in
result. Do not hammer or damage to steering
forward hole.
gear will result.
2. Install nuts and torque to specifications. Use only
2. Install sector shaft nut or pitman arm clamp bolt and the special locknut listed for this use in the
torque to specifications. Chevrolet Parts Catalog.
3. Position ball stud on to pitman arm. Install nut and 3. Pack wheel bearings using a high quality wheel
torque to specifications. Continue to tighten nut bearing lubricant. Install bearings and wheel-hub-
enough to align castellation with hole in stud and in brake drum assembly removed previously.
stall cotter pin. 4. Install keyed washer and spindle nut. Proceed as
outlined under “ Front Wheel Bearings - Adjust’ ’ in
STEERJNG CONNECTING ROD Section 3.
5. Install tie rod ball stud and if used, steering con
Removal
necting rod ball stud, in steering arm. Be sure that
1. Remove cotter pins from ball studs and remove cas the dust cover is in place on ball stud.
tellated nuts. 6 . Install castellated nut on ball stud, tighten to speci
2. Remove ball studs from steering arm and pitman fications and install cotter pin.
arm by backing up steering arm boss and/or pitman 7. Following directions given in Section 3 to check cor
arm boss with a heavy hammer and striking other nering wheel relationship and toe-in; correct as
side of boss with lighter hammer (fig. 23). required.
POWER STEERING
INDEX
Page Page
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
All truck power steering installations consist of three The power cylinders used differ in capacity and mount
basic components, pump, control valve and power cyl ing. C10-20-30 series have the cylinder mounted between
inder, connected by hydraulic lines. The pump is a vane the frame and relay rod. The mounting for units equipped
type with the mounting to the engine peculiar to the par with 9000 lb. front axle is between the frame and pitman
ticular model and engine application involved. arm. Axle-to-tie rod mounting is used on all other
Two types of control valves are used, light-duty models models.
use the linkage type mounted between the pitman arm and Some medium and heavy-duty models use a power
relay rod or steering connecting rod. Medium and heavy- steering oil cooler mounted at the front of the vehicle.
duty models use a rotary valve type, mounted on the
steering gear box between the steering shaft and worm
shaft.
I
STEERING 9-16
4. Remove the retaining nut from the ball stud to pit Fig . 30—Side Mounted P .S . C y lin d e r
man arm connection and disconnect the control valve
from the pitman arm.
5. Turn the pitman arm to the right clear of the control
Cl0-20-30Series
a. Remove cotter pin, nut, retainer and grommet
valve and unscrew the control valve from the relay from power cylinder rod attached to the frame
rod on conventional models or from steering con bracket. Also remove grommet and retainer
necting rod on 4 -wheel drive models. from bracket if replacement parts are required.
6 . Remove the control valve from the vehicle. b. Remove cotter pin, nut and ball stud at relay rod.
F4r0o-n5t0A
-6x0
lesS)eries(Except9,000lb.and11,000lb.
Installation
1. Install the control valve on the vehicle by reversing
the removal procedure.
2. Reconnect the hydraulic lines, fill the system with a. Loosen dust covers from ball joints at each end of
fluid and bleed out air using the procedure outlined cylinder.
under "Maintenance and Adjustments” . Grease ball b. On each end of power cylinder remove the cotter
joint. pin locking the adjusting screw in position and
back out adjusting screw far enough to pull cyl
inder off ball stud.
POWER STEERING GEAR AND CONTROL V A LV E -
40, 50 and 60 Series (Fig. 24) K10-20Series
Removal a. Remove cotter pin, nut, retainer and grommet
1. Mark steering shaft to control valve stub shaft re from power cylinder rod attached to tie rod.
lationship and disconnect the steering shaft from the b. Remove cotter pin, nut and ball stud at relay rod.
lower coupling.
2. Remove hoses from valve.
3. Remove pitman arm bolt, nut, washer and pitman
60 Serieswith9,000lb.or11,000lb.FrontAxles(Fig.30)
arm. a. At frame attachment, loosen dust cover, remove
4. Remove mounting bolts and steering gear. cotter pin locking the adjusting screw in position
and back out adjusting screw sufficiently to pull
Installation cylinder off ball stud.
1. Install power steering gear on vehicle by reversing b. Remove cotter pin, nut and ball stud at pitman
removal procedure. arm.
2. Check steering gear for proper lubricant level.
2. Remove power cylinder from vehicle.
3. Fill power steering system with fluid and bleed out
air using the procedure outlined under "Maintenance
Installation
and Adjustments” .
1. Install the power cylinder on the vehicle by reversing
removal procedures.
POWER CYLINDER NOTE: When installing power cylinders incor
Removal porating an adjusting screw at the ball stud at
1. Disconnect the two hydraulic lines connected to the tachment, tighten screw, with ball stud in place
power cylinder and drain fluid into a container. until it bottoms, then back off to nearest hole
Do not reuse. and secure with cotter pin.
2. Reconnect the two hydraulic lines, fill the system the straight ahead position, then turn the wheels to the
with fluid and bleed out air using the procedure out right and left, while observing movement of the hoses.
lined under "Maintenance and Adjustments". Grease Note and correct any hose contact with other parts of the
ball joint. vehicle that could cause chafing or wear.
Any maintenance operation, on the power steering
POWER STEERING HOSES equipment, should include a thorough inspection of the
hydraulic line system, including the oil cooler if used.
When servicing power steering hoses, avoid twisting Figure 31 illustrates typical installations.
the hoses unnecessarily. Install hoses with the wheels in
SPECIAL TOOLS
1. J -7079-2 Handle 8. J —8526—1 Top C over Seal and 20. J —2619—4 Slid e Hammer Adapter
2. J-8522 Steering G e a r .and Idler Arm Bearing Installer 21. J-5822 Puller
Support Bushing Installer 9. J -8526-2 Top C over Seal and 22. J —5741 (8619-1) Bearing Removing Plates
(50 and 60 Series) Bearing Remover 23. J-9225 Sector Shaft Seal Installer
3. J-1614 Steering G e a r and Idler Arm 10. J -2565-3 Mast Ja c k e t Bearing Installer 24. J-9226 Sector Shaft Bushing Tool
Support Bushing Remover 11. J -2565-4 M ast Ja c k e t Bearing Remover 25. J-8119 Bearing Cup Remover
(50 and 60 Series) 12. J —6217 V a lv e Connector Seat 26. J-5853 Inch-Pound Torque W rench
4. J —8523—1 Steering G e a r and Idler Arm Instal ler 27. J-8359 Sector Bearing Remover
Support Bushing Installer 13. J-7624 Spanner W rench 28. J —5421 Thermometer
(70 and 80 Series) 14. J-4245 Snap Ring Remover 29. J-5245 Snap Ring Pliers
5. J-8523-2 Steering G e a r and Idler Arm 15. J -2927-A Steering W h ee l Puller 30. J-3186 Pitman Arm Remover
Support Bushing Remover 16. J-5178 P u ller Gauge 31. J —7316 Belt Tension Gauge
6. J -8524-1 Adjuster Plug Bearing 17. J-6632 Pitman Arm Pu ller 32. J —21239-1 Power Steering Pu lley Remover
and Seal 1nstaller 18. J-5176 C hecking G auge with J-5900 for Stamped Pulleys
7. J -8524-2 Adjuster Plug Bearing and Adapter Kit 33. J-8433-1 Power Steering Pu lley Remover
Seal Remover 19. J —2619 S lid e Hammer J -8433-2 for Cast Pulleys
j
SECTION 10
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The 1967 truck is equipped with a wide range of tube or short spoke, pierced disc, or cast spoke type depending
tubeless type tires and wheels selected according to the on model application. The dual rear wheel option is
truck GVW rating and type of service. Wheels are of the available beginning with the C20 series trucks.
MAINTENANCE
Tire Inflation Jacking Instructions
Tire pressures should be checked at least once a week The chart will assist in performing wheel and tire
and inflated according to the following table. If payload changes using vehicle jacks supplied with or recom
distribution or special equipment is such as to impose mended for use on Chevrolet Trucks.
heavy loads on the front axle, inflation of front tires
Jacking Point on Vehicle
should be increased accordingly but should not exceed Model
pressure shown for rear tires. Front Rear
CP10, C20-30 Lower Control Arm Pivot Axle Housing
• Avoid under inflation to prevent rim bruises, excessive K10-20 Under Front Axle Near Axle Housing
heat, and irregular or rapid wear. P20-30-50 Spring Seat
40-60
• Avoid overinflation to prevent tire ruptures, hard rid
ing, irregular or rapid wear and reduction of skid Chevy Van Under Axle at Front Axle Housing
resistance. Spring
• Valve Caps should always be installed and tightened
TIRE INFLATION TABLES FOR
firmly to prevent dust and water entering arid dam
age to valve seats. The caps also act as an air seal. HIGHWAY SERVICE
PASSENGER CAR TYPE
Puncture Inspection and Repair Tire pressures should be adjusted to the load being
carried by the tire as shown in the following charts. For
At each lubrication, tires should be checked for for severe service and heavy duty operation, it is perm issi
eign objects in the tread or breaks in the tread or side ble to increase maximum pressures of passenger type
wall. If tire is punctured or otherwise damaged, it tires shown 6 psi with no increase in load carrying ca
should be repaired using one of several repair kits avail pacity. However, for optimum ride comfort, minimum
able through tire manufacturers' outlets. required pressures are recommended for front tires.
Loads and Inflation Pressures (Lb./Sq. In.)
Tire Size Ply
For Heavy Duty Operation, Pressures Listed Below May be increased 6 P.S.I.
Tubeless Tube-Type Rating 32 34 36
20 22 24 26 28 30
6.95-14 4 950 1000 1050 1100 1140 1190 1230
7.35-14 8 1040 1100 1160 1210 1260 1310 1360 1400 1450
7.75-15 7.75-15 8 1150 1210 1270 1330 1380 1440 1500 1550 1600
8.15-15 8.15-15 4 1240 1300 1370 1430 1490 1550 1610
8.15-15 8 1240 1300 1370 1430 1490 1550 1610 1660 1720
6.50-16 6.50-16 6 1105 1165 1225 1280 1330 1380
TRUCK TYPE
Tire Size Ply Loads and Inflation Pressures (Lb./Sq. In.)
Tubeless Tube- Type Rating 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 85
SERVICE OPERATIONS
Wheel Nut Torques Misalignment W ear--This is wear due to excessive
On all vehicles equipped with disc or cast spoke toe-in or toe-out. In either case, tires will revolve with
a side motion and scrape the tread rubber off. If mis
wheels, it will be necessary to retorque the wheel nuts at
alignment is severe, the rubber will be scraped off of
firs t 1000 miles and every 6000 miles thereafter. See
both tires; if slight, only one will be affected.
Specifications for correct nut torques.
The scraping action against the face of the tire causes
Correcting Irregular Tire Wear a small feather edge of rubber to appear on one side of
the tread and this feather edge is certain indication of
Heel and Toe W ear--This is a saw-toothed effect where
misalignment. The remedy is readjusting toe-in, or re
one end of each tread block is worn more than the other.
checking the entire front end alignment if necessary.
The end that wears is the one that first grips the road
when the brakes are applied. Uneven Wear--Uneven or spotty wear is due to such
Heel and toe wear is less noticeable on rear tires than irregularities as unequal caster or camber, bent front
on front tires, because the propelling action of the rear suspension parts, out-of-balance wheels, brake drums
wheels creates a force which tends to wear the opposite out of round, brakes out of adjustment or other mechan
end of the tread blocks. The two forces, propelling and ical conditions. The remedy in each case consists of
braking, make for more even wear of the rear tires, locating the mechanical defect and correcting it.
whereas only the braking forces act on the front wheels,
and the saw-tooth effect is more noticeable. Cornering Wear--When a truck makes an extremely
A certain amount of heel and toe wear is normal. Ex fast turn, the weight is shifted from an even loading on
cessive wear is usually due to high speed driving and ex all wheels to an abnormal load on the tires on the outside
of the curve and a very light load on the inside tires, due
cessive use of brakes. The best remedy, in addition to
to centrifugal force. This unequal loading may have two
cautioning the owner on his driving habits, is to inter
change tires regularly. unfavorable results.
F irst, the rear tire on the inside of the curve may be
Side Wear—This may be caused by incorrect wheel relieved of so much load that it is no longer geared to
camber, underinflation, high cambered roads or by taking the road and it slips, grinding off the tread on the inside
corners at too high a rate of speed. half of the tire at the excessive rate. This type of tire
The first two causes are the most common. Camber shows much the same appearance of tread wear as tire
wear can be readily identified because it occurs only on wear caused by negative camber.
one side of the treads, whereas underinflation causes Second, the transfer of weight may also overload the
wear on both sides. Camber wear requires correction of outside tires so much that they are laterally distorted
the camber first and then interchanging tires. resulting in excessive wear on the outside half of the tire,
There is, of course, no correction for high cambered producing a type of wear like that caused by excessive
roads. Cornering wear is discussed further on. positive camber.
Cornering wear can be most easily distinguished from Wheel and Tire Balancing
abnormal camber wear by the rounding of the outside
shoulder or edge of the tire and by the roughening of the It is desirable from the standpoints of tire wear and
tread surface which denotes abrasion. vehicle handling ease to maintain proper balance of front
Cornering wear often produces a fin or raised portion wheel and tire assemblies on all models. All wheels in
along the inside edge of each row in the tread pattern. tended for use on front of vehicle, such as those switched
In some cases this fin is almost as pronounced as a toe- during periodic tire rotation and those installed as new or
in fin, and in others, it tapers into a row of tread blocks repaired replacement equipment should be accurately
to such an extent that the tire has a definite "step wear” balanced. This may be accomplished by either of the two
appearance. types of balancing systems in current use which balance
The only remedy for cornering wear is proper instruc wheels either on the vehicle or off. The "on the vehicle”
tion of operators. Driving more slowly on curves and type, however, is the more desirable in that all rolling
turns will avoid grinding rubber off tires. To offset nor components (brake drums, bearings, seals, etc.) are in
mal cornering wear as much as possible, tires should be cluded in the balancing procedure and thereby have any
interchanged at regular intervals. existing unbalance corrected.
FRONT WHEELS
REAR WHEELS
Truck Wheel Balance Weights CAUTION: When removing wheel, loosen all
All 1967 truck wheels equipped with a tubular side ring nuts approximately flush with end of stud, then
(rolled flange rim) on the outboard side of the wheel rims tap clamps to loosen wheel. Do not remove nuts
require special design weights to fit. Dynamic balancing until clamps are free as clamp may fly off stud.
can be accomplished through use of these special balance
Installation of Rims on Wheels
weights which are designed only for installations on the
outboard side of these wheels. Conventional weights fit
only the inboard side of these wheels. DualW
heels
1. Before positioning inner rim, thoroughly clean all
Static Balance contact surfaces on both rim and wheel.
2. After inner rim is positioned, install separator ring
Static balance (sometimes called still balance) is the as shown in Figure 3.
equal distribution of weight of the wheel and tire assem 3. Install outer rim and proceed as outlined under "Dual
bly about the axis of rotation in such a manner that the and Single Wheels".
assembly has no tendency to rotate by itself, regardless
of its position. For example: A wheel with a chunk of
dirt on the rim will always rotate by itself until the heavy
side is at the bottom. Any wheel with a heavy side like
this is statically out of balance. Static unbalance of a
wheel causes a hopping or pounding action (up and down)
which frequently leads to wheel "flutter" and quite often
to wheel "tramp".
Dynamic Balance
Dynamic balance (sometimes called running balance)
means that the wheel must be in static balance, and also
run smoothly at all speeds.
To insure successful, accurate balancing, the following
precautions must be observed:
• Wheel and tire must be clean and free from all foreign
matter.
bead may "bind" on the rim, and refuse to seat. Allowing 3. Starting at the split in the clamp ring, raise its end
pressure to continue to build up within the assembly in an out of the rim gutter using a screwdriver and the tire
attempt to seat the tire bead is a DANGEROUS PRAC iron (fig. 5). Then remove the clamp ring by prying
TICE which can result in a broken tire bead, and serious it out of the gutter with the tire iron, moving pro
injury to the serviceman. gressively around the rim (fig. 6).
4. Drive the curved end of the tire iron in between the
Be Safe!
side ring and the tire bead (fig. 7). Then pry down
1. Make sure that rim flanges and bead ledge (espe
on the opposite end of tire iron to move the tire bead
cially hump and radius) areas are smooth and clean.
away from the side ring flange (fig. 8).
Remove any oxidized rubber, dried soap solution,
Continue the foregoing operation progressively
rust, heavy paint, etc. with a wire brush, or, in ex
around the tire until the side ring is removed. In
treme cases, a file. some cases it may be necessary to work around the
2. Lubricate tire beads, rim flanges, and bead ledge
tire more than once.
areas with a liberal amount of thin vegetable oil soap
solution, or approved rubber lubricant. NOTE: The tire bead seat on the side ring is
3. Insure that air pressure build-up during the bead slightly tapered; this design makes removal of
seating process is not allowed to exceed 40 pounds ring much easier.
pressure. 5. Push the valve stem up inside the tire to prevent
If beads have not seated by the time pressure damage while removing the tire. The tire may be
reaches 40 pounds, assembly should be deflated, re removed from the rim by turning it over and follow
positioned on rim, re-lubricated and re-inflated. ing the procedure in Step 4.
4. Make sure valve core is inserted in valve stem prior
to inflating.
5. Use an extension gauge with clip on chuck so air
pressure buildup can be closely watched and so that
you can stand well back from the assembly during
the bead seating process.
Tube Type Wheels and Tires
Tube type tires using two or three piece rims are
available as optional equipment. T ires and tubes may be
demounted and mounted as outlined in this section.
ThreeSectionRim
s—
Dem
ountingTire
1. Completely deflate tire by removing the valve core.
2. Using a hammer, tap around the side ring progres
sively to move it in toward the center of the rim until
it clears the clamp ring (fig. 4).
ThreeSectionRim
s—
MountingTire TwoSectionRim
s—
Dem
ountingTire(2Ton)
To facilitate assembly and removal, two cutaway sec
1. Remove all rust scale from the rim, side ring and tions "A" (fig. 7) and an operating notch "B ” are incor
clamp ring. porated in the locking flange of the side ring.
2. Insert tube in tire and inflate until tube is nearly In separating the side ring from the wheel rim of the
rounded out. spare or new wheel for tire installation, stand the wheel
3. Lubricate tire beads, rim sides of tube, and both up with the operating notch in the side ring at the top.
sides of flap with a solution of neutral vegetable oil The straight end of a tire iron is inserted and driven into
soap or Ru-Glyde or equivalent rubber lubricant. the operating notch (fig. 11). The tool is moved as a
Insert flap in tire. lever to lift the side ring away from the rim. After the
4. Place tire on rim with valve in line with the valve side ring has passed over the rim gutter at the operating
hole in rim. Insert valve through hole; then work notch work progressively around entire rim until side
tire onto rim. ring is separated from wheel rim.
5. Place side ring into position on tire and rim; then 1. Completely deflate tire by removing the valve core.
press the side ring into tire and onto the rim using 2. Loosen the tire bead from its seat in the side ring
the tapered end of tire iron until the clamp ring gut- by driving the bead loosening end of a tire iron be-
tween the tire bead and the side ring (fig. 10). Repeat
this operation progressively around the side ring
prying until bead is loose. Fig . 13 - Disengaging Side Ring from Rim G u tter
3. Insert straight end of tire iron into operating notch
located at double pimples "B " (fig. 13).
4. Push side ring down at point opposite operating notch repair only. Simply loosen tire bead from wheel
and force tire iron handle down causing side ring to rim as in Figure 12. Then turn assembly over
disengage from rim gutter. Repeat progressively and remove ring with tire attached as in Figure
around side ring prying ring from rim gutter until 15.
free.
5. To free opposite tire bead from wheel rim, turn tire
over and repeat bead loosening operation (fig. 14).
TwoSectionRim
s—
MountingTire
1. Remove all rust scale from wheel rim and side ring.
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove side ring 2. Insert tube in tire and inflate until tube is nearly
from tire bead if tire is to be removed for tube rounded out.
Tubeless Tires
Tubeless tires mounted on one piece full drop center
rim s are standard on some Chevrolet trucks. These
tires have a safety inner liner which if punctured, tends
to cling to the penetrating object forming a partial seal
until the object is removed from the tire.
The mounting and demounting of tubeless truck tires
will present no problem when a rubber lubricant, such as
Ru-Glyde or equivalent is applied to tire beads and rim
flanges. Ru-Glyde or equivalent in addition to materially
assisting in mounting and demounting also prevents rust
ing at the tire sealing area and thus prevents tires from
adhering to the wheel.
Demounting and Mounting
All tubeless tires used on Chevrolet trucks with the
exception of the 7.75-15 and 6.50-16 sizes should be de
mounted and mounted as described in this section. The
7.75-15 and 6.50-16 sizes may be demounted using Fig. 19- Inserting Tire Iron to Lift Bead
CONVENTIONAL TRUCKS
INDEX
Page Page
Service O p e ra tio n s ......................................................... 11-3 Front Sheet Metal Assem bly............................................. 1 1 - 4
Hood A s s e m b ly ............................................................... 11-3 Flat Face Cowl M o d e l s ............................................. 11-6
Hood Hinge Spring Replacement................................. 11-3 Radiator S u p p o rt......................................................... 11-6
Hood H in g e .................................................................. ..... 11-3 F e n d e r s .............................................................................. 11-9
Hood Lock Assembly ................................................ ..... 11-3 S k irt.............................................................................. 11-10
Running B o a r d .................................................................. 11-11
A d ju s tm e n t............................................................ ..... 11-3
Hood Assembly Removal and In stallatio n .................. ..... 11-4
Hood Assembly A lignm en t.......................................... ..... 11-4
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
SERVICE OPERATIONS
HOOD ASSEMBLY
Installation
1. Remove through bolt from Tool J - 5544-1 and hinge Fig. 4 - Hood Hinges and Springs (10 thru 60 Series)
spring.
NOTE: If installing a new spring, expand new
HOOD HINGE (Fig. 4)
spring and install Tool J - 5544-1 (fig. 3).
Removal
2. Install spring end in hinge mount bracket. 1. Prop the hood in the extreme open position and place
3. Lower hood sufficiently to allow opposite end of protective covering over the cowl and fenders.
spring to engage cutout in hood hinge. 2. Scribe position of hinge attachment on hood rear
4. Lower hood until Tool J - 5544-1 is freed, and remove reinforcement and remove two bolts.
tool. 3. Remove hood hinge spring as explained in preceding
5. Raise hood and check spring retention-close and se write-up.
cure hood. 4. Scribe position of hinge attachment on fender assem
bly and remove bolts.
5. Remove hinge.
Installation
1. Install hinge assembly to fender and align within
scribe marks. Install bolts.
2. Install hood hinge spring.
3. Install bolts and align hood. See Hood Alignment in
this section.
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
A bolt-type hood lock is used as shown in Figure 5 and
6. The lock bolt, located on the hood dovetails with the
mounted striker plate, preventing upward or downward
movement of the hood while the vehicle is in motion.
Integral with the striker plate is the combination lock re
lease lever and safety catch.
Replacement
1. Open hood and remove the four bolts holding the
combination lock catch and lock bolt.
NOTE: If original hood lock assembly is to be
replaced, scribe a line around lock for alignment
on installation.
2. Place hood lock assembly in position.
3. Adjust as outlined under Adjustments.
Adjustment
1. Open hood and adjust tightness of lock bolt support so
that they are just "snug" enough to hold lock bolt in
F ig . 3 - Hood Spring Tool Installation position.
HOOD ASSEMBLY
Removal
1. Lay a fender cover along cowl top to prevent hood
from scratching cowl top.
2. Open hood and prop in full open position.
Installation
1. If original hood is to be installed, position hood to
hinges and install four cap screws snug which attach
hinges to hood.
NOTE: If a new hood is to be installed, per
form procedures as outlined under Alignment,
directly below.
2. Shift hood on hinges to location marks made before
removal of hood, then tighten attaching cap screws at
hinges firmly. Close hood and check fit. If neces
sary to align hood perform procedure as outlined
under "Alignment" which follows.
Alignment
1. Loosen hood hinge bolts. Note that rear most bolt
hole in hinge is slotted to allow hood trailing edge to
move up and down.
2. Adjust hood rear bumper so that hood and cowl sur
faces are flush.
3. Perform hood lock adjustment as outlined in this
section if necessary.
NOTE: Hood Lock Assembly to be adjusted
fore and aft until nubbin (part of Hood Lock Bolt
Support Assembly) enters center of elongated
guide (Socket). Bending nubbin to accomplish
this adjustment may seriously effect lock opera
tion and safety catch engagement and is, there
fore, NOT RECOMMENDED.
FRONT SHEET METAL ASSEMBLY
Removal of entire front sheet metal assembly including
radiator is a relatively simple operation involving, basi
cally disassembly of mounts, disconnecting radiator hoses
and removal of front bumper. Vehicles equipped with air
conditioning and/or power steering will require special
handling.
Refer to appropriate sections of this manual for
F ig . 5 - Hood Lock Assembly (40 thru 60 Series) instructions.
Shims which are found at various locations should be 6 . Install bolts at steering column skirt reinforcement,
recorded to ease installation of sheet metal assembly. final torque 25 ft. lbs.
Proceed as follows: 7. a. Tighten each radiator support mounting bolt 33
ft. lbs. and bend tab over nut.
10 THROUGH 30 SERIES b. Torque bolts at fender to cowl 25 ft. lbs.
8 . Install front bumper.
Removal (See Fig. 6A) 9. Connect wire connectors at dash and toe panel, At
1. Drain radiator and remove radiator hoses. Discon tach generator and regulator wires.
nect oil cooler lines if so equipped. 10. Connect upper and lower radiator hoses. Connect oil
2. Disconnect wire connectors at the dash and toe panel cooler lines to the radiator on models so equipped.
and wire connector to horn and voltage regulator. 11. Install cowl grille and wiper arms.
Installation
1. With a helper place sheet metal assembly in position.
NOTE: Install all bolts loosely to facilitate
aligning after complete installation.
2. Shim at radiator support to align fender to door lead
ing edge.
3. Install combination bolt and flat washer assembly
into each fender reinforcement while inserting shims
required between fender reinforcement and body.
(See Figure 8 .)
4. Install two bolts and shims required at each fender
rear lower edge to hinge pillar.
5. Install bolt in each fender skirt to sill extension.
40 THROUGH 60 SERIES
Removal
1. Remove windshield wiper arms and cowl grille.
2. Drain radiator and remove radiator hoses.
3. Disconnect transmission cooler lines; and disconnect
air cleaner intake hose at fender skirt, if so
equipped.
4. Disconnect wire connectors at dash and toe panel.
Disconnect the battery, generator and regulator wire
leads.
5. Disconnect power steering fluid reservoir from in
side grille.
6 . Remove front bumper bolts and remove bumper,
a. Remove two bolts from underneath front frame
crossmember and attachments securing sheet
metal. (See Figure 8 a.)
7. Remove one screw, each side attaching cowl bracket
to fender (plastic plug covers) access from inside
cab, on cowl (fig. 9). DO NOT remove cowl bracket.
8 . Remove two bolts attaching fender upper edge to
plenum and hinge pillar (fig. 9).
9. Tape shims in their respective positions for reas
sembly ease.
10. Remove two screws (each side) attaching fender gus
set to cowl (fig. 1 0 ).
11. Working from underneath rear of fender, remove
bolts which attach each fender skirt to the fender
extension flange.
12. Remove two bolts from radiator support mount. Fig . 7 - Radiator Support Mounting
13. Remove bolt attaching each fender skirt to cab sill
extension. 14. Connect wire connectors at dash and toe panel. Con
14. With a helper, remove front sheet metal assembly nect battery, generator and regulator leads.
with radiator, battery, horn and voltage regulator. 15. F ill radiator, start engine and check for leaks.
grille filler panel to radiator support. 14. Install screw from underside of skirt to center of
8 . Place right fender in position and loosely install fender flange.
bolts and shims at fender top to cowl. 15. Tighten rearmost bottom screw of fender skirt
9. Attach grille upper to right fender bolts loosely. previously installed loosely.
10. Attach bolts from inside of grille lower to right 16. Install snugly remainder of skirt to right fender
fender lower (limited access between radiator sup screws.
port outer face and grille inner face).
11. Install radiator support to fender.
12. Using drift line up right fender skirt rearmost bot
tom screw with fender flange and attach loosely.
13. Attach right fender skirt inner top bolts to fender
underside.
FRONT FENDER
10 thru 30 Series
Removal Fig. 13 - Front Fender and Skirt Attachment (10 thru 30 Series)
1. Remove windshield wiper arm s, cowl grille and at
taching screws. 10. Remove two bolts and shims at top rear of fender
2. Remove hood and hinge assembly. attaching to cowl.
3„ Remove head lamp door, wiring and attachments
from fender. Installation
4. Remove screws attaching fender wheel opening flange To install, reverse the removal procedure using seal
to skirt. ing tape between filler panel and fender. Check sheet
5. Remove 2 skirt to fender bolts, located inboard on metal alignment.
underside of skirt.
6 . Remove two screws attaching gusset to fender. 40 thru 60 Series
7. Remove two screws attaching radiator support to
front fender. Removal
8 . Remove four bolts attaching radiator grille to fender. 1. Remove windshield wiper arms.
9. Remove bolt and shim attaching to trailing edge of 2. Remove cowl grille--disconnecting radio antenna
fender to hinge pillar. lead.
3. Remove hood, outlining hinge bolts at fender before
removing.
4. Lift hood off.
5. Remove two bolts and shims attaching fender to cowl.
6 . Remove 1 screw from inside cab (plastic plug covers
access mounting). (Do not remove cowl bracket.)
7. Remove screws connecting skirt edge to fender
flange.
8 . Right fender removal necessitates removal of battery
cables, battery and three screws attaching battery
tray to fender.
9. Remove 1 bolt hidden from view connecting grille
lower panel to front inboard edge of fender (access
hole provided).
10. Remove bolts connecting grille to front fender from
inside of engine compartment.
11. Remove 3 bolts fastening gusset to fender and grille
(fig. 1 2 ).
12. Remove two bolts fastening gusset to fender.
13. Remove all electrical connections.
Installation
To install, reverse the removal procedure using seal
ing tape between filler panel and fender. Check sheet
metal alignment.
F ig . 14 - Running Board and Fender Extension Fig. 16 - Running Board and Braces
(40 thru 60 Series) (See Illustration for Series)
7. Underneath the skirt, inboard, remove a large bolt 40, 50 and 60 Series (Except F /F Cowl and School Bus)
fastened through the fender to the cowl extension.
Note shim and record. 1. Remove bolt from inside door opening attached to
8 . Under the hood remove 2 screws attaching skirt re lower extension.
inforcement to skirt. 2. Remove bolts from under front of running board to
9. Rotate skirt outward over tire, then remove extension bottom.
rearward. 3. Remove 3 bolts fastening skirt to flange of lower
Installation extension.
Reinstall in reverse order of removal. Note condition 4. Pull lower fender extension downward then out.
of tape sealing full length of fender skirt flange. Replace
if necessary. OTHER RUNNING BOARDS
RUNNING BOARD AND FENDER EXTENSION Refer to Illustrations
TILT CABS
V IE W A
V IE W B
TT40, TD-TG50-60
Fig. 19 - Designation and Name Plates Fig. 20 - Front End Access Panel and Emblem
SPECIAL TOOLS
•
SECTION 12
ELECTRICAL-BODY AND CHASSIS
CONTENTS OF THIS SECTION
Page
Lighting System.................................................................. 12-1
Instruments and G a u g e s ................................................... 12-11
Directional S ig n a ls ............................................................ 12-21
Windshield Wipers and W a s h e r s ....................................... 12-24
Wiring D ia g ra m s ............................................................... 12-30
LIGHTING SYSTEM
INDEX
Page Page
General Description ........................................... ............... 12-1 Directional Signal Lamps ........................... ............ 12-5
Maintenance and Adjustments........................ Wiper Switch Replacem ent........................... ............ 12-8
Headlamp A d ju s tm e n t.............................. ............... 12-3 Light Switch R ep lacem en t........................... ............ 12-8
Service O p e ra t io n s ........................................... ............... 12-5 Stoplamp Switch R ep lacem en t ....................... ............. 12-8
Sealed Beam Unit R e p lacem en t ................. ................. 12-5 Dimmer Switch Replacement .......................... ............ 12-8
Parking Lamp R eplacem en t..................... ............... 12-5 Neutral Safety Switch Replacement . . . . . ............ 12-9
Rear Lighting .......................................... ............... 12-5 Backing Lamp Switch Replacement. . . . . . ............ 12-10
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The lighting system includes the main light switch; stop All wiring systems incorporate a fusible link which
light, dimmer and backing lamp switches; head and park provides increased overload protection to all electrical
ing lamps; stop, tail and directional signal lamps; instru circuits, except the starting motor circuit, not protected
ment illumination and indicator lamps; and the necessary by fuses. Composite wiring diagrams (figs. 40 thru 76)
wiring to complete the various circuits. A bulk head fuse are included at the end of this section. The standardized
panel (fig. 1 ) provides convenient power take offs and fuse color code is common to all wiring harnesses. Under
clips for the appropriate circuits. The engine wiring this color code, the color of the wire designates a partic-
harness and forward lamp harness connectors are bolted lar circuit. The harness title indicates the type of har
to the fuse panel. ness, single or multiple wire, and also describes the
location of the harness.
12-2
ELECTRICAL—BODY AND CHASSIS 12-3
HORIZONTAL ADJUSTMENT
VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT
8 . a. Numeral ”2" (fig. 5) should appear in the "down"
window of each aimer. If not, loosen knob at
underside of aimer arm and slide back and forth
until the numeral does appear. Fig. 7 - Selecting Level Aiming Area
NOTE: This setting will give a 2" drop of the smooth inner ring of the Aimer. To install Aimer,
headlamp high beam spot centerline on a screen press firmly on the knob extending out from the
placed 25 feet forward of the vehicle. Check center of the Aimer base. This forces the suction
state laws for proper vertical setting. cup into place on the Sealed Beam unit.
3. Loosen the slider knob beneath the aimer arm and
b. Turn headlamp vertical aim screw (fig. 5) on left- set the numeral ”2" in the DOWL view window
hand unit counter-clockwise until the bubble is at (fig. 7). Back vertical lamp adjusted out on each
the inner end of the glass tube. Then turn screw lamp until bubble is outside of black line of vial,
clockwise until bubble is centered in tube. then center bubble in between black line of vial by
c. Repeat this procedure on right-hand headlamp turning clockwise.
unit to complete vertical adjustment of lamps. 4. After both bubbles are centered, turn the car around
9. Recheck the string at the ends of each crossarm for end for end, making sure the tires are in the spots
correct setting and the bubble on each aimer for made on the floor before the car was moved.
centered position. 5. If the bubbles are still within the two outside black
10. Remove the aim ers by pulling on the suction cup tabs marks on the vials, the floor is level enough to use
through the openings in the aimers (fig. 6 ). the Aimer as it comes from the factory.
11. With headlamps properly aimed, replace headlamp
NOTE: A quick level check can be made by
bezels.
using the T-3 Safety-Aimer as a level. Use with
a true eight to ten foot two by four as an exten
HOW TO SELECT A LEVEL AIMING AREA sion. Make sure pads on base of Aimer are
used. Place the board where you expect the
1. Select area you believe to be level.
wheels to be and take readings as outlined above.
2. Remove headlamp bezels and install Aimers on each
headlamp (fig. 3) making sure aiming lugs engage 6 . If either bubble moves outside the black lines of the
vial there is too much slant to the floor. Try driving
the car in at different angles onto the aiming area.
If bubbles can not be centered follow procedure under
"How to Compensate for Unlevel Floor."
NOTE: When level portion of floor is obtained,
mark tire spots on floor so spots can be used
next time without calibrating Aimer.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
SEALED BEAM UNIT REPLACEMENT (Fig. 9) PARKING LAMP BULB REPLACEMENT (Fig. 9)
1. Remove bezel retaining screws and bezel. 1. Remove headlamp bezel on 40-60 series trucks.
2. Disconnect wiring harness connector located at rear 2. Remove lamp housing retaining nuts, and disengage
of unit in engine compartment. assembly from grille or panel opening.
3. Disengage spring from retaining ring. 3. Disconnect parking lamp wiring from forward wiring
4. Turn headlamp unit to disengage assembly from harness.
headlamp adjusting screws. 4. Connect wiring of new unit to vehicle harness.
5. Position lamp housing in grille or panel opening, as
NOTE: Do not disturb adjusting screw setting. appropriate and install retaining nuts.
6 . Install bulb, lens and bezel as required.
5. Remove retaining ring and headlamp from mounting
ring.
6 . Position new sealed beam unit in mounting ring and REAR LIGHTING (Fig. 10)
install retaining ring.
Exploded views of the different rear lighting arrange
NOTE: The number molded into lens face must ments are shown in Figure 10. The bulbs may be re
be at top. placed by removing the lamp lens attaching screws and
lamp lens. The lamp housings may be replaced by re
7. Install headlamp assembly in panel opening, twisting moving the housing attaching nuts or screws, or by
slightly to engage mounting ring tabs with adjusting removing the nuts and bolts from the bracket.
screws.
8 . Install retaining ring spring and attach wiring har DIRECTIONAL SIGNAL LAMPS
ness connector to unit, then check operation of unit
and install bezel. Directional Signal lights are either an integral part of
the parking and taillight assemblies or are mounted on
PARKING LAMP HOUSING REPLACEMENT (Fig. 9) each side of cab (tilt cab only).
1. Remove retaining screws and lens from housing. NOTE: On vehicles using parking and taillight
2. Replace bulb and check operation of unit. assemblies for directional signals; refer to ap
3. Install lens and retaining screws. plicable light assemblies for bulb replacement.
VIEW C
CA 31 (04)
(34) CA 30 (03-12)
5. Replace floor mat. 6 . Connect wiring harness to terminals and check op
eration of switch.
NEUTRAL SAFETY SWITCH REPLACEMENT Column Shift—Switch Located on Transmission
(Fig. 15)
Column Shift—Switch Located on Mast Jacket 1. Raise and support vehicle.
1. Disconnect wiring harness connectors at switch 2. Disconnect switch wiring from engine wiring harness
terminals. and remove bolt attaching the switch wiring retaining
2. Remove switch retaining screws and switch from clip to the transmission.
mast jacket. 3. Remove the bolt attaching the switch to the trans
3. To install, position shift lever in drive and locate mission and disengage switch from shift lever rod.
lever tang against transmission selector plate. 4. Position new switch to transmission and install
4. Align slot in contact support with hole in switch and switch attaching bolt.
insert pin (3/32" dia.) to hold support in place. 5. Loosen transmission lever extension bolt and with
Switch is now in drive position. transmission in neutral position and the switch
5. Place contact support drive slot over shifter tube pinned in neutral position attach switch rod to switch.
drive tang and tighten screws. Remove clamp and 6 . Tighten transmission lever extension bolt to 12-16
STOPLIGHT
SV/ITCH
HORN
RELAY
HORN RELAY
BACKING —
LAMP SWITCH
AIR BRAKE —
WARNING BUZZER STOPLIGHT
i SWITCH
DIMMER-
SWITCH
7. Connect switch wiring to engine wiring harness and NOTE: Position gear shift in neutral before
install wiring retaining clip bolt. assembling switch to mast jacket.
8 . Check operation of switch and lower vehicle.
4. Check operation of switch.
BACKING LAMP SWITCH REPLACEMENT
Switch Located on Transmission Side Cover (Fig. 16)
Switch Located on Mast Jacket (Fig. 13)
1. Raise and support vehicle.
1. Disconnect wiring at switch terminals. 2. Disconnect wiring at switch terminals.
2. Remove switch attaching screws and switch from 3. Remove two bolts attaching switch and switch wiring
mast jacket. retaining clip to transmission side cover; disengage
3. Position replacement switch to mast jacket, install switch from shift lever rod.
retaining screws and connect wiring to switch 4. Mount replacement switch loosely to transmission
terminals. side cover and connect wiring to switch terminals.
5. Use suitable pin to lock switch lever in reverse 7. Tighten bolts to proper torque, remove pin from
position. switch lever and check operation of switch; lower
6 . With transmission lever in reverse position install vehicle.
shift lever rod.
Fig. 15 - N eutral Safety Sw itch - C h evy Van Fig. 16 - Backing Lamp Switch - C hevy Van
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
All instruments and gauges of the 1967 Trucks are in cluster housing, on all other models the lamp sockets are
stalled in the instrument cluster. The entire cluster clip retained and can be quickly snapped in or out of
may be removed from the vehicle for servicing of the position.
instruments and gauges. Illuminating and indicator lamps Regular maintenance is not required on the instrument
may be replaced without removing the cluster from the cluster or its components other than maintaining clean,
vehicle. On models with a laminated die cut circuit the tight electrical connections, replacing defective parts and
bulbs are installed in plastic holders which lock into the keeping the speedometer cable properly lubricated.
SERVICE OPERATIONS
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER 3. Remove windshield wiper knob and bezel nut.
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION 4. Remove light switch rod and bezel.
5. Disconnect speedometer cable and chassis wiring
10-30 Conventional Cab Models (Fig. 17) harness connector at rear of instrument panel.
6 . Protect mast jacket with suitable covering.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 7. Remove cluster retaining screws from face of as
2. Remove choke control knob. sembly and remove cluster assembly from console.
Chevy Van
8 . To install, reverse removal procedure. 1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect speedometer cable at speedometer head.
40-60 Conventional Cab Models (Fig. 17) 3. Remove two nuts attaching cluster to dash panel.
Cluster may now be pulled clear of dash panel.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 4. Disconnect all indicator and illuminating bulb sock
2 . Remove choke control knob and bezels. ets, carefully noting their location for proper rein
3. Remove windshield wiper knob and bezel nut. stallation. Remove cluster.
4. Remove light switch rod and bezel. 5. To install, reverse removal procedure.
5. Disconnect speedometer cable and chassis wiring
harness connector at rear of instrument panel. Tilt Cab Models (Fig. 19)
6. Disconnect air pressure and oil pressure gauge feed
pipes. 1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
7. Loosen mast jacket upper support clamp bolts and 2. From under dash, disconnect speedometer cable and
lower mast jacket to prevent interference with lower wiring.
edge of instrument cluster. 3. Disengage cluster retaining clips by inserting Tool
J-7900 in provided slots as shown in Figure 19 and
CAUTION: Protect mast jacket with suitable remove cluster.
covering. 4. To install, reverse removal procedure.
ing notches in case, and turn clockwise to lock in the circuit and must be reinstalled to provide the
place. proper ground connections for the laminated
circuit.
All. Other Models
4. Remove fuel, temperature and ammeter terminal
To replace any indicator or illuminating bulb, unsnap nuts retaining laminated circuit to cluster cover.
the proper socket from rear of instrument cluster, re 5. Remove laminated circuit from rear of instrument
place bulb, and reinsert unit onto rear of cluster housing. cluster.
6 . To install, reverse removal procedure and check
LAMINATED CIRCUIT REPLACEMENT operation of unit.
NOTE: These screws serve as a ground fo r 1. Remove instrument cluster assembly and laminated
Chevy Van
NOTE: Assemble the two parts with alignment Fig. 19 - Instrument- Cluster Removal - T ilt Cab
dowels properly positioned.
described in this section.
2. Remove instrument lamps, ground screws and term i
3. Remove two screws securing speedometer head to
nal nuts retaining laminated circuit to fuel gauge
cluster back panel; carefully remove speedometer
section of cluster assembly.
head.
3. Carefully move the laminated circuit from fuel gauge
4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
area and remove three retaining screws, cover and
operation of unit.
gauge assembly from cluster housing.
4. Remove attaching nuts and gauge from cover plate.
Tilt Cab Models 5. To install, reverse removal procedure and check op
eration of unit.
1. Remove instrument cluster assembly as previously
described in this section.
2. Remove eight screws securing cluster bezel to back
panel assembly and remove bezel. Flatface Cowl Models
3. Remove two screws attaching speedometer head to
1. Remove instrument cluster assembly as previously
back panel assembly and carefully remove speedom
described in this section.
eter head.
2. Uncrimp bezel (7 places) and remove bezel.
4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
3. Remove nuts securing fuel gauge to cluster case and
operation of unit.
remove gauge.
SPEEDOMETER CABLE REPLACEMENT OR 4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
LUBRICATION; ALL MODELS operation of unit.
1. Instr. Cluster Conn. Brake Warning Ind. 9. O il Pressure Ind. 13. Battery Gauge
2. Laminated C ircu it G en erator Ind. 10. "H ig h " Beam Ind. 14. Ignition Terminal
3. Instr. Cluster Lamp R. H. D irectional 11. Overspeed W arning/Low Vacuum 15. Temperature Gauge
4. Temperature Ind. L. H. D irectional 12. G en erator G auge 16. Fuel Gauge
panel assembly and remove bezel. the engine is started, one or more of the following condi
3. Pull off plastic caps on terminal nuts and remove tions is indicated:
terminal nuts; carefully remove fuel gauge. Low oil pressure
4 . To install, reverse removal procedure and check Defective wiring or sender unit
operation of unit. Defective bulb
High engine temperature
TEMPERATURE INDICATOR LIGHT
OIL PRESSURE GAUGE REPLACEMENT
10-30 Conventional Cab Models, Chevy Van
The temperature indicator circuit consists of two re
40-60 Conventional Cab Models
motely located units, indicator light and sender unit. The
1. Remove instrument cluster assembly and laminated
lamp unit is a single red light which indicates an over
heated engine condition. circuit as previously described in this section.
2. Remove rear cover retaining screws, cover and
gauge assembly from cluster housing.
TEMPERATURE GAUGE REPLACEMENT 3. Remove pipe fitting and retaining nut and remove
gauge unit from cover.
40-60 Conventional Cab Models
4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
1. Remove instrument cluster assembly as previously operation of unit.
described in this section.
2. Remove terminal nuts retaining laminated circuit to Flatface Cowl Models
gauge unit.
3. Remove three attaching screws, cover and gauge as 1. Remove instrument cluster assembly as previously
sembly from cluster housing. described in this section.
4. Remove terminal attaching nuts and gauge unit from 2. Uncrimp bezel (7 places) and remove bezel.
cover plate. 3. Remove nut securing oil pressure gauge to cluster
5. To install, reverse removal procedure and check case and remove gauge.
operation of unit. 4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
operation of unit.
Flatface Cowl Models
1. Remove instrument cluster assembly as previously
OIL PRESSURE SENDER UNIT REPLACEMENT
described in this section.
All Models
2. Uncrimp bezel (7 places) and remove bezel.
3. Remove 2 nuts securing temperature gauge to cluster
1. Disconnect wiring harness connector from sender
case and remove gauge.
unit terminal (located in block above starter on L - 6
4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
engines and at left front of distributor on V- 8
operation of unit.
engines).
2. Remove sender unit using Tool J - 21757, replace with
Tilt Cab Models new unit and check operation.
1. Remove instrument cluster as previously described
in this section. GENERATOR INDICATOR
2. Remove eight screws securing cluster bezel to back
panel assembly and remove bezel. 10-30 Conventional Cab Models, Chevy Van,
3. Pull off plastic caps on terminal nuts and remove Tilt Cab Models
terminal nuts; carefully remove temperature gauge.
Ignition on, engine not running and telltale light off:
4. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
1. Indicator bulb burned out; replace bulb.
operation of unit.
2. Open circuit or loose connection in the telltale light
circuit.
TEMPERATURE SENDER UNIT REPLACEMENT
Telltale light stays on after engine is started; refer to
Charging Systems under Engine Electrical, Section 6 Y.
All Models
1. Drain engine cooling system to a level below unit. AMMETER GAUGE REPLACEMENT
2. Remove sender unit (located in the inlet manifold
near water pump housing on V- 8 engines and in the 40-60 Conventional Cab Models
cylinder head near an exhaust port on L - 6 engines)
1. Remove instrument cluster assembly and laminated
and replace with new unit.
circuit as previously described in this section.
3. Refill cooling system and check operation of unit.
2. Remove terminal nuts retaining printed circuit to
gauge unit.
OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR LIGHT 3. Remove three attaching screws, cover and gauge as
sembly from cluster housing.
10-30 Conventional Cab Models, Chevy Van, Tilt
4. Remove terminal attaching nuts and gauge unit from
Cab Models cover plate.
If the light does not come on when the ignition switch is 5. To install, reverse removal procedure and check
turned on, or if the light comes on and remains on after operation of unit.
' . . ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ELECTRICAL—BODY AND CHASSIS 12-25
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Type "E " two-speed electric windshield wiper as ing, stopping and parking of the Type "E " wiper motor.
sembly (fig. 36) incorporates a non-depressed type The manually operated start, stop switch is located on the
(blades park approximately 2 " above windshield molding) instrument panel, while the cam operated park switch is
motor and gear train. The rectangular, 12 volt, com located in the wiper gear box.
pound wound motor is coupled to a train consisting of a The windshield washer pump used on the 2-speed Type
helical drive gear at the end of the motor armature shaft, "E " wiper motor assembly is a positive displacement
an intermediate gear and pinion assembly, and an output type pump employing a small bellows, bellows spring and
gear and shaft assembly. The crank arm is attached to valve arrangement. The pumping mechanism is actuated
the output gear shaft. Depending on the wiring harness by a four lobe cam and driven directly by the wiper
of the different trucks, the wiper motors are equipped motor (fig. 37). Thus, when the wiper is operated, this
with three or four terminals. For service replacement rotor is always turning with the gear. Programming is
a four terminal assembly is used, servicing both, the accomplished electrically and mechanically by a relay
three terminal and the four terminal models. assembly and ratchet wheel arrangement.
Two switches, connected in parallel, control the start
SERVICE OPERATIONS
WIPER MOTOR
Gear Box
Fig. 31 - W indshield W ip e r Assy. - T ilt Cab CAUTION: Failure to clamp crank arm may
result in stripping of wiper gears!
1. Crown Nut O u ter Washer
2. Lock W asher Inner Washer 4. Remove crank arm, seal cap, Tru-Arc retaining
3. W ip e r Arm Assembly Shaft Ferrule (Part of Motor ring, and end-play washers.
4. Knurled Driver Assembly)
5. Rain Shield 10 . Retaining Bolts
NOTE: Seal cap should be cleaned and re
6. Shaft Ferrule Retaining 11. M otor Assembly (Includes
packed with a water-proof type grease before
Nut Bracket)
reassembly.
BRUSH HOLDER
R EM O V E BR U SH S P R IN G FR O M SLO T
A N D PLACE IT IN G R O O V E A S S H O W N
Motor
Reassemble motor using reverse of disassembly
procedures.
Gear Box
Refer to Figure 32 for exploded view of motor and gear NOTE: No coil polarity is necessary when re
train. soldering coil leads.
H O LD IN G C O N T A C T S O P E N
TO CLUTCH
HOUSING
IGNITION
SW
. 12R
SHUNT>“ 18b
AMMETER
RESISTOR V V ^
AMMETER GAGE
12R —
16B/W-
+ BAT _
(P
16B
•12R »12R • 12R* f — 4Bf PS 20
4B -30
SHUNT i JUNCTION BLOCK 6B PS 40
AMMETER Iw
RESISTOR
1 1
■18Y«
TO TRANS
*12P*
DDST
A Or
iiiijioiii 9
MM 1 I i 111 m mm
■18DG D IGNITION
SW
TEMP GAGE
16B----
16B/W*
AMMETER GAGE
JU NCTIO N B LO C K
------ a a Z H I
FUSIB LE L IN K
DASH P A N E L -
T A IL & STO P
L P HARN
CONN
•20T—[
-*B R N —«
■*Y -
-*DG
-18 LG —
^20T-
OUTSIDE
FUEL I
TAN K __
■20T~oc® j
BRAKE W ARNING SW
♦"FOR W IRE GAGE SEE CHASSIS & T A IL L A M P W IRIN G SHEET
JUNCTION B LO C K
...............12R ■ ■*£
/ — v\A/— ^ DASH-
16R FUSIB LE L IN K
PANEL
I — 6 B --------
T A IL & STO P
L P HARN
CONN
/ 12 PP L
'20W /O R /PPL— 2QW/OR/PPLv
16LG
20DBL' »20DBL>v
^ >-20PPL-^
R. H. P A R K IN G &
DIR. SIG N AL L P . •18DG
18LG<
CE 30 (04-09)
C E -K E i0 -20 (04-09-34)
W /R PO M16-20-28
CE 20 -30 W /R PO E57
""" " 12PPL— s
> -2 0 D G "" 20D B L\
TEM P ,
<3 GEN & FWD L P 20DS
sw m A . C, Uh
H ARN CONN
GEN.*
/> — 16LG ------- - s ...
20PPL-
20PPL'
16BRN
12R —
16W—- '
16DBL —
►16BRN'
20 LB L 20 L B L ^ ENG HARN
CONN
20PPL
L . H. PA R K IN G &
DIR. SIG N AL L P .
TO SHEET M E T A L — * BRN •
—*Y---
16LG - *D G —
16LG - 18LG-
-1 8 T . ^**2 0 T “7
-1 8 T .
» 18B
OUTSIDE FUEL-
12DG
R A D IA T O R SU PPO RT TANK
HORN 20T— —<Jt=f]
♦F O R W IRE GAGE SEE CHASSIS & T A IL L A M P W IRIN G SHEET BRAKE W ARN IN G SW
JU NCTION B LO C K
........ 12R C fl'l
t-----s / W — i
T A IL & STOP
L P HARN CONN
V *B R W
Y‘
•*DG“
•18LG-
00B-
(FRAME MOUNTED)
TAIL It STOP
LAMP HARN
CONN
FUSE
JO
f PL*>
R.H. PARKING fc
DIR. SIGNAL LP TEMP
SENDER
PPG
■
B -
A.C,{ GEN &FWD LP
QENJ HARN CONN
14LG-
i
12R
•JOPPI
»20DBL«
-12R—
V 1 8 B/W- *BRN—
.18B — *Y -
'•DG —
1ST-
-RADIATOR ltDG*
SUPPORT
CO IL
^ ^
k - r' 0/s sw
(327 & 366
|20W/OR/PPLv— 20W/OK —4^
ENG O N L Y )
(283 E N G )] (327 & 366 ENG)
20Y- *
2 4 6 8
9 9 g
V-8 EHSr
-----
y Do/l
6
1 3 5 7
O IL PRESS
SW
■24BRN/W- 124BRN/W
-1 2 P --------- » 12P —
— 20DG ■ «20DG">
. 12 PP L
1 2 PP L
• 12R
18B ‘
18B/LBL*
18DBL* HORN C O N TA C T
18BRN •
18PPL < -TO D IRE CTIO N SIG. SW. FU SE PN L
18B/Y «
18D G -
18B/W-
CLU S TE R
-18LB Lr
LAM P
•18DBL-
•18B----
-T E M P GAGE
LAM P
BRAKE W ARN IN G
-2 0 P LAM P
© • “ 20BRN
I39’ - 2 0 L G C LU STER
•12R — [EH 12* “ 20LB L LAM P
’ 20P — N. 2 0 T ---- G p - 20DBL
20PPL- 20DBL- 120GY R. H. DIR.
' 14LBL-
SIG. L A M P
■18W — C LU S TE R CONN
•20LG-
-G EN E RA TO R
‘ 20BRN-
LAM P
•18BRN-
' 20LBL-
-O IL PRESS
■20DBL.
LAM P
•20T—
•20DBL.
•L. H. DIR.
•20GY—
SIG. L A M P
■20T—
-20T — 18LB L ■ • C LU STER
•16DG — 18DBL- LAM P
-160R —
18B — V IS J w / s WASHER &
W IP E R SW •HIGH BEAM
LAM P
OUTSIDE C LU STER
FU E L T A N K n LAM P
L IG H T SW
20T _
-*B R N -
„ * Y ___
. *DG _
, 18LG .
180R -
180R-
18W—
OUTSIDE F U E L T A N K
180R
20T-
-*BRN> •*BRN■
•*Y— •*Y —
-*DG - -*DG“
200R - '200R-
•18W- ■18W-
TEMP GA
CLUSTER LP
AIR GA LP
•16DG OVER SPEED
160R IND. LP.
•10P ■♦ 18P
(CE-SE 50 -60 )
LIGHT SW
18T—
*BRN<
*Y —
*DG—
18LG-
18T-
16UK "■ V
160R------- «l a------------ 180R--------
18W-......- fl&j) S9 - 18W_____
R .H . DIR.
SIG. L P
C L U S TE R CONN
-2 0 D B L . - L .H . DIR.
SIG. L P
-20DG —
■20GY— ~ C L U S TE R L P
•20D B L-
■20 LB L-
HIGH BEAM L P
■20LG —
• 2 0 B ----
•20B/W- C L U S TE R L P
■20P —
•20T—
160R-
-INSIDE F U E L
W/S W ASHER &
TA N K
W IP E R SW
18T-
L IG H T SW
18T —
-♦B RN - ♦BRN-
- * Y ---- *Y —
*DG —
-2 0 0 R - 200R -
-1 8 W - 18W -
R .H . D IRECTION
SIG N AL
vv JjA M r
® r - i8FpL
L . H. D IRE CTIO N
SIGNAL
F ig . 61 - Instrument Panel and Forward Lamp W iring Harness - TE-TS 40-50 (E x c . 13)
O VER/SPEED IND L P
F U E L GA
D IR E C TIO N SIG. L P
O IL PRESS IND L P
C L U S TE R L P
C L U S TE R L P
H I BEAM IND L P
R .H . D IRE C TIO N
SIG N AL ST" ln p
L .H . D IR E C TIO N
SIG N AL
R .H . W/S WASHER
W IP E R SW
L .H . W/S W ASHER
& W IP E R SW
VAC W ARN L P
20P
2 ot
20DBL
JeT
........F U E L
^
20 L B L — DI RECT I ON SIG. L P .
12DG 20DG ■
R. H. D IRE C TIO N
SIG N AL
L . H. D IRE C TIO N
SIG N AL
c f t r l L H.W/S WASHER
& WIPER SW.
CLUSTER LP.
CLUSTER LP.
10DG 20DG-
W IRE
GAGE MODELS
14 CD -CG 50 , C D -C G -M G 60
CE-C S 40 , C E -C S -M E -M S 50 ,
16 C E -C S -M E 60 (EX C 02-62)
18 C A -K A 10 -20 , C A 30 ,
■16LG
OUTSIDE F U E L GAGE
02, 05, 06,12, 16, 45 & 62 MDLS
R. H. BACKING L A M P
(04-09 & 34 MODELS O N L Y )
18B-|li
20T
■180R >
■18W-------i 1
Qaffll
r—
■16BRN" Id
DOME L A M P
LIC EN SE L A M P
INSIDE F U E L GAGE
03, 04, 09,13 & 34 MDLS
■16LG
L. H. BACKING L A M P
(04-09 & 34 MODELS O N L Y )
■16BRN*
■16BRN-
■16Y
18W
’ 180P
DOME L P
F U E L GAGE -18BRN- Jo
LIC EN SE L P
■18B-HI'
18T
FUSE
•18W—
■180R-
18BRN
F U E L GAGE CONN
■18T«
18Y« -1 8 Y -
-18B RN -
•18 W *
■14 OR
•20 D B L
•12 DG ■
•18 T —
R .H . P A R K •14 L B L ' .18 OR.
& DIR SIG L P HEATER VJ • 16 LG <
RESISTOR •18 T —
20 P P L -
-12 DG
•20 PPL*
• 20 LBL*
• 20 LG —
• 14 LBL •
B R A K E F LU ID • 16 LG —
W A R N IN G SW ITCH • 18 T -----
V ■18 T *
18 W -
18 O R*
L .H . P A R K S T O P L P SW
& DIR SIG L P
■12 R ----
•12 DG -
■20 B ----
■14 O R-
■14 Y ----
•14 LBL
18 DG -
12 PPL
20 DG -
16 BRN
20 DBL
12 R —
12 P —
r ) '
18 LG -
18 W- 18 W
20 DBL
S> <md
o o
&«SmQ0 Sj
•14 OR -
•14 Y —
I!
■14 LBL
14 OR
LEGEND 14 Y
"" CHEVROLET WRG 14 LBL
— FISHER BODY WRG
— —* CHEVROLET RPO WRG
>18 DG 18 DG<
SPECIAL TOOLS
.JUNCTION BLOCK
OUTSIDE FUEL-
TANK
-----18T-
HORN BRAKE WARN
SWITCH
♦FOR WIRE GAGE SEE CHASSIS & TAIL LAMP WIRING SHEET
.JUNCTION BLOCK
HORN
♦FOR WIRE GAGE SEE CHASSIS & TAIL LAMP WIRING SHEET
♦FOR WIRE GAGE SEE CHASSIS & TAIL LAMP WIRING SHEET
SPECIAL TOOLS
J-21 932
BEZEL N U T R EM O V E R
F ig . 77 - Sp ecial Tools
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
P and T series trucks, and G series trucks with 230 on each side at the top, secure the radiator in position.
cu. in. engine and manual transmission, are equipped This section covers the service procedures for all
with down-flow type radiators. All other models are truck radiator and grille assemblies. Removal and in
equipped with cross-flow type radiators. The cross- stallation procedures for air conditioning components are
flow radiator is sim ilar to the conventional down-flow covered in Section 1A. Refer to Section 14 for Front
radiator except it is mounted sideways in the vehicle and Bumper Service procedures and Section 11 for Front
attached in the conventional manner. Two retainers, one Sheet Metal.
Fig . 2 - Radiator Mounting - P10 Models Fig. 3 - Radiator and Shroud Mounting P20 and P30 Models
GE MODELS (Fig. 4 and 5) 6 . Remove bolts securing radiator support to frame and
lower radiator and support from vehicle.
Radiator Replacement 7. Remove screws securing shroud to upper radiator
support and remove shroud from vehicle.
1. Raise vehicle and place on jack stands. 8 . Install radiator and shroud following the removal
2. Remove bolts attaching air deflector to radiator procedure in reverse order. Connect radiator hoses
support, frame, and body and remove air deflector. and transmission coolant line, fill cooling system,
(Refer to Figure 4.) and check for leaks. If no leaks are present, install
3. Remove bolts attaching left and right splash shields air deflector and splash shields.
to frame and remove splash shields. (Refer to
Figure 4.) GS MODELS (Fig. 6)
4. Drain radiator and disconnect radiator hoses and
transmission coolant line if so equipped. Radiator Replacement
5. Remove lower shroud screws. 1. Raise vehicle and place on jack stands.
5. Inspect lower pads and retainers and replace if PA40 MODELS (Fig. 10)
necessary.
6 . Lower shroud and radiator into position and secure
Radiator Replacement
shroud with bottom attaching screws. 1. Drain radiator and disconnect water hoses and trans
7. Install two retainers at top of radiator and shroud mission coolant line if so equipped.
with four screws. 2. Remove screws securing fan shroud to supports and
8 . Connect radiator hoses and transmission coolant carefully hang shroud over engine fan assembly to
line, fill cooling system, and check for leaks. provide clearance for radiator removal.
9. Refer to torque specifications in rear of manual for 3. Remove screws securing radiator to supports and
correct torque values. remove radiator and shroud from vehicle.
4. Replace radiator mounting components if necessary.
CD-CG50-60, MG60 MODELS (Fig. 9) 5. Install radiator and shroud following removal pro
cedure in reverse order. Connect radiator hoses
Radiator Replacement and transmission coolant line, fill cooling system,
and check for leaks.
Radiator replacement for these trucks is the same as 6 . Refer to torque specifications in rear of manual for
outlined in steps 1 thru 9 immediately above. The only correct torque values.
F ig . 8 - Radiator Mounting - C A 4 0 , C E -C S -M A -S A 5 0 ,
C E -C S -S A 6 0 Models
5. Remove radiator and support assembly from the procedure in reverse order. Connect radiator hoses
vehicle as a unit. Remove fan shroud. and transmission coolant line, fill cooling system,
6. Replace radiator, supports, and mounting components and check for leaks.
as necessary. Refer to torque specifications in rear of manual for
7. Install shroud and radiator following the removal correct torque values.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
All 1967 truck front and rear bumpers are of a single
piece design. Bumper attachments are the standard
bracket and brace to frame mountings. This section
contains procedures for the removal and installation of
face bars, brackets, braces and license plate brackets.
each bracket) securing brackets to frame. FRONT BUM PER-G MODELS (Fig. 5)
2. Remove left and right upper bumper connections by
removing speed nuts and plugs (one at center of each Removal
1. Remove screws securing bumper braces to frame
bracket); remove lock nuts, washers, and bolts se
curing face bar to upper brackets. cross sill.
2. Remove bolts securing bumper face bar to frame
3. Remove bumper from vehicle. If necessary, re
extensions.
move lower bumper brackets from face bar by re
3. Remove bumper from vehicle.
moving lock nuts, washers, and bolts attaching
brackets to face bar. Disassembly
1. Remove bolts attaching bumper braces to face bar
Installation and remove braces.
Assemble and install front bumper following the re 2. Remove screws securing license plate bracket to
moval procedure in reverse order. Refer to torque face bar and remove license plate bracket.
Removal
NOTE: On tilt cab models equipped with air
'
-------------------- „------
SPECIFICATIONS
HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING
SECTION 1
ALIGNMENT SPECIFICATIONS
2
MA50
CA-SA TA40
CA-PA CA-20 C A -PA - SA531 TD50 CA-MA CA-MA
Models G10, 20 K10, 20 PA20, 30 50 (Exc. TE-TS MA60
10 30 SA-40 CA-MA TA60 TA60 TA60
SA531) TG50
SA60
King 6 1/4°
Pin 7 1/4° 5 1/4° LH 5 3/4° LH
- - 7 1/4° to 7 1/4° 7 1/4° 7 1/4° 7 1/4° 7 1/4° 5°
Inclination 6 1/4° RH 6 1/4° RH
8 1/4°
See See
Chart Chart + 1/4° LH + 1/4° LH
Camber l-l/2°±l/4 ° 1 1/2° 1 1/2°± 1/4° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1°
Fig. 9 Fig. 9 - 1/4° RH - 1/4° RH
Sec. 3 Sec. 3
See See
Curo Chart Chart
Caster 3 l/4 °±l° 3° 2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 1 1/2° 2 1/4° 2 1/4° 2 1/2°
Fig. 9 Fig. 9
Sec. 3 Sec. 3
Toe In
(Per l/32"-3/32 l/32"-3/32" l/ l6 "-l/ 8 " 1/16"-l/8" 1/16"-3/16" l/32"-3/32" l/32"-3/32” l/32"-3/32" l/32”-3/32” l/32”-3/32" l/32”-3/32" l/32"-3/32" l/32"-3/32"
Wheel)
Wheel
- - 20° 20° 20° 20° 20° 20° 20° 20° 20° 20°2 20°
Outer
Turn
Inner - - 35° to 36° 29° to 30° 22° to 23° 23 1/4° 22 3/4° 24° 24° 23 3/4° 24 1/2° 24 1/2° 23 1/4°
REAR SUSPENSION
SECTION 4
1 1 ,0 0 0
• Torque to Specification given, Back Off 1/8 Turn. Install Lock Nut and Torque
@Trucks equipped with Disc Wheels Torque to 475
All Torques given in Foot Pounds
40
50
60
PA20, 30
CA-PA 10
Series
Series
Series
CA20
CA30
GIO
G20
K20
K10
Tie Rod Attaching
- - 135 135 - - - - - - -
Bolts - (Axle)
- (Frame) - - 135 135 — — — — — — —
Axle to Control Arm
- - 215 215 - - - - - - -
U Bolts
Spring U
125 125 - - 150 150 120 300 300 300 150
Bolts
Control Arm Front
- - 145 145 - - - - - - -
Attaching Bolts
Coil Spring Attaching
- - 45 45 - - - - - - -
Bolt Lower
Coil Spring Attaching
- - 50 50 - - - — - - -
Bolt Upper
Spring Front
65 65 - - 155 155 10 70 70 155 10
Bushing Bolt
Spring Rear Shackel
50 50 - - 155 155 5 - - - 5
Bolts
Shock Absorber
75 75 75 75 65 65 65 - - - 120
Attaching Bolts
Universal Joint
15 15 15 20 15 20 20 20 20 20 20
Rear
Inter mediant Shaft
- - 15 15 - - - - 20 20 -
Universal Joint
Front Universal
Joint - - - - - - 20 20 20 20 20
Rear Stabilizer — — — — — — — — — — 25
TANDEM
Equalizing Beam 270 270
- - - - - - - - -
Adapter Bolts
Saddle Cap Stud - - - 190 190
- - - - - -
Nuts
Spring Hinge - - — 35 35
- - - - - -
Lock Bolts
Top Pad Set - - -
- - - - - - 100 100
Screw
Spacer Bolts — - - - - - - - 65 65 -
Spring Saddle Top - - - - 290 290 -
- - - -
Pad B olts
Torque Arm - - - - - - 300 300 -
- -
Nuts
Torque Arm Bracket - - - - - 65 65 -
- - -
Bolts
Prop Shaft - - - - - - - - 50 50 -
SPECIFICATIONS 6
DIFFERENTIAL SPECIFICATIONS
(Single Speed
(Two Speed)
(Two Speed)
Tandem
Tandem
Eaton
Eaton
Eaton
Eaton
Gear Backlash
.005"- .005"- .005"- .005"- .005"- .205"- .005"- .006"- .005"- .006"- .006"- .006"-
Preferre .016" .016"
.008" .008" .008" .008" .008" .008" .008" .016" .008" .016"
.003"- .003"- .003"- .003"- .003"- .003"- .003"- .006" .003"- .006"- .006"- .006"-
Min and Max.
.0 1 0 " .0 1 2 " .0 1 2 " .0 1 2 " .0 1 2 " .0 1 2 " .0 1 2 " .016" .0 1 2 " .016" .016" .016"
Pinion Bearing
Preload (In. Lbs.)
New 20-30 6-14 25-35 6-14
Ring Gear 50 110 110 105 110 160 160 90 140 140 90 90
Differential Bearing LH 230 LH 350
55 100 100 205 205 205 205 210 230 230
Caps RH 160 RH 425
Filler Plugs 20 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Differential Pinion
Lock
20 - - - — - - - - - - -
Drive Pinion Nut - 220 220 220 220 220 220 500 - 500 600 600
Differential Carrier
- 45 45 85 85 85 85 165 150 165 130 230
to Axle House
Differential Case - 110 110 105 110 160 160 100 70 90 90 90
Differential Bearing
- 15 15 15 15 15 15 165 10 165 115 165
Adjusting Lock
Shift Unit to
Carrier — - - - - - - - 45 50 - -
Pinion Bearing Cage
- 95 95 165 165 95 95 115 95 115 145 145
To Carrier
Trust Pad Lock
- - - 135 - 135 135 - - - - -
Nut
Input Shaft
- - - - - - - - - - 425 425
Nut
Input Shaft
- - - - - - - - - - 80 80
Bearing Cover
Differential Carrier
- - - - - - - - - - 115 v 115
Cover to Carrier
Output Shaft
- - - - - - - - - - 425 425
Nut
Inter Axle
Differential Case - - - - - - - - - - 60 60
Lockout Shift Lever
- - - - - - - - - - 45 45
Bracket to Carrier
SPECIFICATIONS 7
ENGINE
SECTION 6
PISTON PIN:
Diameter .9895"
.9270"-.9273"
.9898"
.00025" .00015"
Production .00015"-.00025" .00025"-.00035"
Clearance .00035" .00025"
Service .001" (Max.)
Fit in Rod .0008"-.0016" (Interference)
CRANKSHAFT:
#1 # l-2 -3 -4
2.2987"-2.2997" 2.7482"
All 2.7492"
Diameter #2-3-4
2.2983"-2.2993" 2.2983"-2.2993"
#5
Main #5 2.7478"
J ournal 2.2978"-2.2998" 2.7488"
Production .0002" (Max.)
Taper
Service .001" (Max.)
Out of Production .0002" (Max.)
Round Service .001" (Max.)
# l-2 -3 -4 # l-2 -3 -4
All .0003"
Main All .0008"-.0024"
Production .0025"
Bearing .0008"
.0003"-.0029" #5
Clearance .0034" #5
.0015"
.0010"-.0026"
.0031"
Service .004" (Max.)
CAMSHAFT:
Lobe Lift ± .002" (Int. & Exh.) .1896" .2217" .2315" .2658" .2343"
VALVE SYSTEM:
Lifter Hydraulic
Valve Lash (Int. & Exh.) One turn Down from Zero Lash
Intake 45°
Face Angle
Exhaust 45° 46° 45° 46° 46°
.0 0 1 0 "
Int. .0010"-.0027" .0025"
Production
Stem .0 0 1 2 "
Clearance Exh. .0015"-.0032" .0010"-.0027"
.0029"
85-93 84-96
Closed 56-64 @ 1.66" 78-86 @ 1.66"
@ 1.69" @ 1.80"
Pressure
Valve lbs. @ in. 210-230
170-184 180-192 174-184
Spring Open 170-178 @ 1.26"
@ 1.33" @ 1.27" @ 1.30" @ 1.40"
1.80"
Free Length N.A. 1.94"
1.92"
Damper
Approx. # of Coils N.A. 4 3 -5 /8 "
ENGINE TORQUES
TUNE UP CHART
CARBURETOR
SECTION 6M
3908463
230 & 250 Syn. All-exc. with Air Injection Reactor
(4375S)
3908464
230 & 250 Auto. All-exc. with Air Injection Reactor
(4376S)
YF
3908465
230 & 250 Syr- All with Air Injection Reactor
(4369S)
CARTER
3908466
230 & 250 Auto. All with Air Injection Reactor
(4370S)
3908468
230 & 250 Auto. All-with Air Injection Reactor
(437 2 S)
05 05 05 CO IT5 CO ^ E~- -— * CO ^
Part Number CM O O CO CO
Tfl Lfi CD CO CD CO CO CO CD CQ CD CO
o © o o CO 05 O T f T -l ^ CM
(Mfg. Number) CD D- 00 t -
O CO
00 C - 0 0 CD 00 C - 00 c- 00 t -
CM CM eo O CO O CO O CO O CO O CO
o o O O o 0 5 Tt< 05 05 05 05 ^ 05
c- c- t- CO w CO eo CO w eo co
7027105 283 All Exc. O.D. All exc. with Air Injection Reactor
7027106 283 Gov Syn. All exc. with Air Injection Reactor
7037105 283 All Exc. O.D. All with Air Injection Reactor
ENGINE ELECTRICAL
SECTION 6Y
BATTERY
G-10 230 & 250 292L-6, School G-10 & 4-53 &
6V-53
Application G-10 Sport L -6 , 327 & 366 Bus & Optional D-478
Diesel
Van 283 V - 8 V- 8 Optional P-Models Diesel
Cranking Power
2300 2300 2350 2900 3150 3150 - -
(Watts) @ 0°F.
Capacity @ 20 Hour
45 45 53 61 70 70 150 205
Rate (Ampere Hour)
GENERATOR
DISTRIBUTORS
C-4457 C-3936
L -6 - 230 Cu. In. - 140 HP 1110362 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 6” Hg. 4° BTDC Manual 500 AC-46N
G10 & P10 A ll Transmissions 1110363 10° @ 1200 RPM 21° @ 14.5" Hg. Automatic 500
(G10) 30° @ 3200 RPM
C-4627 C-3936
L6 - 230 Cu. In. - 140 HP 1110387 0 @ 950 RPM 0 @ 6" Hg. 4° BTDC Manual 700 AC-46N
G10 & P10 RPO K19 - 1110390 17° @ 2100 RPM 21° @ 14.5” Hg. Automatic 500
A ll Transmissions (G10) 26° @ 4000 RPM
C-4442 C-3936
L6 - 250 Cu. In. - 155 HP 1110351 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 6" Hg. 4° BTDC Manual 500 700 AC-46N
L.D. Truck - A ll Trans. - 1110395 7.5° @ 1200 RPM 21° @ 14.5” Hg. Automatic 500 500
w/ & w/o RPO K19 (G10) 15° @ 1600 RPM
28° @ 2800 RPM
C-4489 C-3036
V8 - 283 Cu. In. - 195 HP 1111150 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 8" Hg. 4° BTDC Manual 500 AC-44
L.D. Truck (175 HP) - 10° @ 1500 RPM 15° @ 15.5" Hg. Automatic 500 600
A ll Exc. Truck K19 15° @ 2000 RPM
w/Manual Transmission 28° @ 4200 RPM
C-4461 C-3036 6“ ATDC Manual 700 A C -44
V8 - 283 Cu. In. - 175 HP 1111114 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 8" Hg.
L.D. Truck RPO K19 with 17° @ 1200 RPM 15° @ 15.5" Hg.
Manual Transmission 30° @ 2400 RPM
40° @ 4000 RPM
C-4633 C-3036
V8 - 327 Cu. In. 1111249 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 8" Hg. Pass. Manual 500 AC-44
Truck - 4-bbl. (220 HP) 11° @ 1500 RPM 15° @ 15.5" Hg. 8° BTDC Automatic 500
A ll Exc. with RPO K19 26° @ 4100 RPM L.D. Truck
2° BTDC
C-4489 C-3036
V8 - 327 Cu. In. 1111150 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 8" Hg. Pass. Manual 700 AC-44
Truck - 4-bbl. (220 HP) 10° @ 1500 RPM 15° @ 15.5" Hg. 6° BTDC Automatic 600
RPO K19 - A ll Transmission 15° @ 2000 RPM L.D. Truck
28° @ 4200 RPM TDC
C-4462 C-3912
L6 - 292 Cu. In. Truck - 1110364 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 7" Hg. 4° BTDC Manual 500 AC-44N
170 HP, A ll Transmissions 6° @ 1200 RPM 23° @ 16" Hg. Automatic 500 600
and RPO K19 with 26° @ 2500 RPM
Powerglide Transmission
C-4497 C-3912
L6 - 292 Cu. In. Truck - 1110375 0 @ 900 RPM 0 @ 7" Hg. 2° ATDC Manual 700 AC-C44N
170 HP, RPO K19 with 11° @ 1200 RPM 23° @ 16" Hg.
Manual Transmission 30° @ 2450 RPM
C-2865
V8 - 327 Cu. In. - Truck 1112795 0 @ 700 RPM None 8° BTDC A ll 500 AC-C43
185 HP RPO L30, (Special 11° @ 1600 RPM
500-600 Series, Gear) 24° @ 4600 RPM
Governed @ 4000 RPM
C-3794
V8 - 366 Cu. In. Truck 1111309 0 @ 600 RPM None 6° BTDC A ll 500 AC-C42N
220 HP, RPO L41, - (Special 24° @ 2000 RPM
500-600 Series, Gear) 32° @ 4400 RPM
Governed @ 4000 RPM
C-4448
V8 366 Cu. In. Truck 1111303 0 @ 600 RPM None 6° BTDC A ll 500 AC-C42N
220 HP, RPO L41 - (Special 24° @ 2000 RPM
500-600 Series, Gear) 32° @ 4400 RPM
Governed @ 4000 RPM
1107399 1107496 1107497 1107274 1107321 1107372 1107591 1113183 1113184 1113659 1114101 1107365 1108332 1107370 1107383
250 L-6,
250 L-6, 250 L-6,
Auto.
283 & 327 382 & 327 292 L-6, 366 V-8 D-351 3-53 4-53 D-478 6V-53 283 & 327
194 L-6 Trans. Optional
Application V-8 V-8 3 & 4 Spd. 4 & 5 Spd. Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel Diesel V-8 Optional Optional
G-10 (Optional G-10
Power- 3-Spd. Trans. Trans. 50 Series 50 Series 60 Series 60 Series 80 Series Auto.
250 L-6
glide Trans. Trans.
Taxi)
Brush Spring
35 35 35 35 35 35 35 80 80 80 80 35 40 40 40
Tension, Oz.
Volts 10.6 10.6 10.6 10.6 10i6 10.6 10.6 11.5 11.5 11 11.5 10.6 11.8 11.8 11.8
Free Amperes 49-87* 49-87* 49-87* 65-100* 65-100* 55-95* 75-100* 57-70* 57-70* 105-155* 90-130* 70-99* 72 72 72
Speed
6200- 6200- 6200- 3600- 3600- 3800- 6450- 5000- 5000- 6800- 5600- 7800-
m 6025 6025 6025
10,700 10,700 10,700 5100 5100 6000 8750 7400 7400 10,400 7600 12,000
Volts 4.2 4.2 4.2 3.5 3.5 3.5 5 - - - - 3.0 3.5 3.5 3.5
Resistance Test
Armature Locked
Amperes 290-425* 290-425* 290-425* 300-360* 300-360* 300-360* 720-870* - - - - 410-480* 295-365 295-365 295-365
CHEVROLET
♦Includes Solenoid
TRUCK
SERVICE MANUAL
> ) \
SPECIFICATIONS 17
IGNITION COIL
POWERGLIDE
TURBO HYDRA-MATIC
STEERING
SECTION 9
40-50-60 9000#
G10-20 C-P10 C20-30 K10-20 P20-30 Except 11000#
T Model T Models
Steering Gear
5 to 9 5 to 9 5 to 9 4 to 7 9 to 13 4 to 7 4 to 7
Worm Bearing Preload in. lbs. in. lbs.
in. lbs. in. lbs. in. lbs. in. lbs. in. lbs.
Worm Bearing Lock 85 lb. ft. 85 lb. ft.
85 lb. ft. 85 lb. ft. 85 lb. ft. 85 lb. ft. 85 lb. ft.
Nut
5 to 11 ~ 5 to 11 ^ 4 to 7 ^ 18 to 72 4 to 7 4 to 7
Sector Lash Adjustment 5 ‘V 1 ® in. lbs.®
in. lbs. in. lbs.® in. lbs.® in. lbs.® in. lbs.® in. lbs.®
Sector Lash Lock Nut 30 lb. ft. 30 lb. ft. 30 lb. ft. 30 lb. ft. 30 lb. ft. 30 lb. ft. 30 lb. ft.
Total Steering Gear 18 in. lbs. 18 in. lbs. 18 in. lbs. 14 in. lbs. 35 in. lbs. 14 in. lbs. 14 in. lbs.
Preload Max. Max. Max. Max. Max. Max. Max.
Power Steering 1 to 3 + 1 to 3 1 to 3 *
- - - -
Adjuster Plug in. lbs. in. lbs. in. lbs.
Pump Pressure 850 — 1,000 psi
SECTION 10
SECTION 12
WINDSHIELD WIPERS
TWO-SPEED WIPER
Crank Arm Speed (RPM’s) (No Load)
L o ............................................................................. 34 Min.
H i ............................................................................. 65 Min.
Current Draw. AMPS
No Load (Lo S p e e d )..................................................... 3.6
Installed in Car—(Dry G l a s s ) ................................... 4.5
S t a l l ................................................................................. 12
WASHER
Number of “ squirts” at full p r e s s u r e ..................... 12
Pressure ( P S I ) ............................................................... 11-15
Coil Resistance (ohms)................................................. 20
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
TA Models (Radiator)
Shroud and Radiator Brace Bolts. . . 120 lb. in.
BUMPERS
SECTIO N 14
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS